Documenti di Didattica
Documenti di Professioni
Documenti di Cultura
20 March 2011
Space engineering
Structural materials handbook Part 4: Integrity control, verification
guidelines and manufacturing
NOTE:
Thispdffiledoesnotcontainautomaticcrossreferences.Tomakeuseof
thecrossreferencespleaseusetheMSWordversionofthisdocument.
ECSS Secretariat
ESA-ESTEC
Requirements & Standards Division
Noordwijk, The Netherlands
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Foreword
ThisHandbookisonedocumentoftheseriesofECSSDocumentsintendedtobeusedassupporting
materialforECSSStandardsinspaceprojectsandapplications.ECSSisacooperativeeffortofthe
European Space Agency, national space agencies and European industry associations for the
purposeofdevelopingandmaintainingcommonstandards.
ThishandbookhasbeenpreparedbytheECSSEHB3230WorkingGroup,reviewedbytheECSS
ExecutiveSecretariatandapprovedbytheECSSTechnicalAuthority.
Disclaimer
ECSS does not provide any warranty whatsoever, whether expressed, implied, or statutory,
including,butnotlimitedto,anywarrantyofmerchantabilityorfitnessforaparticularpurposeor
anywarrantythatthecontentsoftheitemareerrorfree.InnorespectshallECSSincuranyliability
for any damages, including, but not limited to, direct, indirect, special, or consequential damages
arisingoutof,resultingfrom,orinanywayconnectedtotheuseofthisdocument,whetherornot
baseduponwarranty,businessagreement,tort,orotherwise;whetherornotinjurywassustained
bypersonsorpropertyorotherwise;andwhetherornotlosswassustainedfrom,oraroseoutof,
theresultsof,theitem,oranyservicesthatmaybeprovidedbyECSS.
Publishedby:
Copyright:
ESARequirementsandStandardsDivision
ESTEC,P.O.Box299,
2200AGNoordwijk
TheNetherlands
2011bytheEuropeanSpaceAgencyforthemembersofECSS
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Change log
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
Firstissue
20March2011
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table of contents
Change log .................................................................................................................3
Introduction..............................................................................................................28
33 Aspects of damage tolerance............................................................................29
33.1 Introduction............................................................................................................... 29
33.1.1
33.1.2
33.1.3
33.2.2
Durability..................................................................................................... 30
33.2.3
Damage ...................................................................................................... 30
33.2.4
33.2.5
Impact damage........................................................................................... 33
General....................................................................................................... 34
33.3.2
Load paths.................................................................................................. 35
33.3.3
Environment ............................................................................................... 35
33.3.4
Damage ...................................................................................................... 35
33.3.5
Residual strength........................................................................................ 36
33.3.6
Safe-life ...................................................................................................... 36
33.3.7
Fail-safe...................................................................................................... 36
33.3.8
Stiffness...................................................................................................... 36
33.3.9
Loads.......................................................................................................... 36
General....................................................................................................... 37
33.4.2
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
33.5 Effect of macroscopic defects on static load ............................................................ 40
33.5.1
Composite failure........................................................................................ 40
33.5.2
33.5.3
Multi-angle laminates.................................................................................. 40
General....................................................................................................... 41
33.6.2
Constituent tests......................................................................................... 43
33.6.3
33.6.4
33.6.5
33.6.6
33.6.7
Delamination............................................................................................... 44
33.7.2
33.7.3
33.7.4
33.7.5
33.7.6
33.7.7
General....................................................................................................... 47
33.8.2
33.8.3
General....................................................................................................... 48
33.9.2
33.9.3
MIL standards............................................................................................. 49
Quality assurance....................................................................................... 50
34.3.2
Repairs ....................................................................................................... 52
Basic considerations................................................................................... 52
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34.5 Definition of inspection procedures .......................................................................... 53
34.5.1
Procedures ................................................................................................. 53
34.5.2
34.5.3
Introduction................................................................................................. 55
34.6.2
34.6.3
Advances in NDT........................................................................................ 55
34.6.4
Techniques ................................................................................................. 56
34.6.5
General....................................................................................................... 57
34.7.2
34.8.2
Detection of defects.................................................................................... 59
General....................................................................................................... 65
34.9.2
Visual inspection......................................................................................... 65
34.9.3
34.9.4
34.9.5
Backscattering techniques............................................................ 71
34.10.11
34.10.12
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34.12.1 General....................................................................................................... 79
34.12.2 Basic principles........................................................................................... 80
34.13 Holography ............................................................................................................... 81
34.13.1 Introduction................................................................................................. 81
34.13.2 Laser interferometric techniques ................................................................ 82
34.13.3 Vibration, pressure and thermal loading..................................................... 83
34.13.4 Electronic imaging ...................................................................................... 83
34.13.5 Examination of space structures ................................................................ 84
34.14 Laser shearography ................................................................................................. 85
34.14.1 Introduction................................................................................................. 85
34.14.2 Basic technique .......................................................................................... 85
34.14.3 Characteristics of shearography................................................................. 86
34.15 Thermography .......................................................................................................... 87
34.15.1 Introduction................................................................................................. 87
34.15.2 Techniques ................................................................................................. 88
34.15.3 Heat sources and pulse duration................................................................ 92
34.15.4 Detection capabilities.................................................................................. 92
34.15.5 Limitations of thermography ....................................................................... 93
34.16 X-ray radiography..................................................................................................... 94
34.16.1 Introduction................................................................................................. 94
34.16.2 X-ray techniques......................................................................................... 95
34.16.3 Digital radiographic system developments ................................................. 96
34.16.4 Defect resolution......................................................................................... 99
34.17 Computer tomography.............................................................................................. 99
34.17.1 Introduction................................................................................................. 99
34.17.2 Basic technique .......................................................................................... 99
34.17.3 Attributes of CT scanning ......................................................................... 100
34.17.4 Micro-tomography..................................................................................... 101
34.18 Eddy currents ......................................................................................................... 101
34.18.1 Introduction............................................................................................... 101
34.18.2 Developments in eddy current techniques ............................................... 102
34.19 Other NDT techniques............................................................................................ 103
34.19.1 General..................................................................................................... 103
34.19.2 Microwave ................................................................................................ 104
34.19.3 Heat and photosensitive agents ............................................................... 104
34.19.4 Electrical impedance ................................................................................ 104
34.19.5 Acoustic microscopy................................................................................. 104
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34.19.6 Nuclear magnetic resonance (NMR) ........................................................ 105
34.19.7 Neutron radiography................................................................................. 105
34.19.8 Gamma radiography................................................................................. 105
34.19.9 D sight - Diffracto sight ............................................................................. 105
34.20 NDT for adhesive bond defects .............................................................................. 106
34.20.1 General..................................................................................................... 106
34.20.2 Disbonds, voids and porosity.................................................................... 106
34.20.3 Cohesion and adhesion............................................................................ 107
34.21 NDT for space applications .................................................................................... 107
34.21.1 Introduction............................................................................................... 107
34.21.2 Developments in inspection...................................................................... 108
34.21.3 Summary of NDT techniques ................................................................... 108
34.22 Rupture tests .......................................................................................................... 110
34.22.1 Application ................................................................................................ 110
34.23 Test related items ................................................................................................... 111
34.23.1 General..................................................................................................... 111
34.23.2 Major items ............................................................................................... 111
34.23.3 Qualification tests ..................................................................................... 112
34.24 Structural test reports ............................................................................................. 123
34.25 Analysis and test documents.................................................................................. 124
34.26 References ............................................................................................................. 126
34.26.1 General..................................................................................................... 126
34.26.2 ECSS documents ..................................................................................... 138
General..................................................................................................... 139
35.1.2
35.1.3
Guidelines................................................................................................. 141
36.2.2
36.3.2
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
36.4 Guidelines on carbon and other fibre prepreg procurement................................... 147
36.4.1
36.4.2
36.4.3
36.4.4
36.4.5
36.5.2
37.3.2
Material..................................................................................................... 155
37.5.2
General..................................................................................................... 160
38.1.2
General..................................................................................................... 162
38.3.2
38.3.3
38.4.2
38.4.3
38.4.4
38.4.5
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.4.6
38.4.7
38.5.2
38.5.3
38.5.4
Mandrels................................................................................................... 181
38.5.5
38.5.6
General..................................................................................................... 182
38.6.2
38.6.3
General..................................................................................................... 185
38.7.2
38.7.3
38.7.4
38.7.5
38.7.6
38.7.7
38.8.2
38.8.3
10
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.12.3 Microwave ................................................................................................ 198
38.12.4 UV curing.................................................................................................. 199
38.13 Preform technology ................................................................................................ 199
38.13.1 General..................................................................................................... 199
38.13.2 Braids ....................................................................................................... 200
38.13.3 Commingled fibre performs ...................................................................... 200
38.14 Fibre placement...................................................................................................... 201
38.14.1 Introduction............................................................................................... 201
38.14.2 Advantages............................................................................................... 204
38.14.3 Repeatability in lay-up and properties ...................................................... 205
38.14.4 Mixed materials in the same lay-up .......................................................... 206
38.14.5 Major advantages of fibre placement compared with other
technologies ............................................................................................. 207
38.14.6 Examples of European launcher and satellite structures made by
fibre placement ......................................................................................... 208
38.15 Out of autoclave ..................................................................................................... 209
38.15.1 Introduction............................................................................................... 209
38.15.2 Aerospace structural parts........................................................................ 209
38.15.3 Composite materials................................................................................. 210
38.15.4 Tooling...................................................................................................... 210
38.16 References ............................................................................................................. 211
38.16.1 General..................................................................................................... 211
38.16.2 ECSS standards ....................................................................................... 217
General..................................................................................................... 218
39.2.2
39.3.2
39.3.3
General..................................................................................................... 221
39.4.2
39.4.3
39.4.4
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
39.5.1
39.5.2
39.5.3
39.5.4
General..................................................................................................... 226
39.6.2
39.6.3
39.8.2
39.9.2
40 Manufacturing costs.........................................................................................236
40.1 Introduction............................................................................................................. 236
40.2 Cost drivers ............................................................................................................ 237
40.2.1
General..................................................................................................... 237
40.2.2
40.2.3
40.2.4
40.2.5
40.2.6
40.2.7
40.2.8
40.2.9
12
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
40.2.11 Unit numbers ............................................................................................ 239
40.2.12 Product life and sourcing .......................................................................... 240
40.3 Cost optimisation.................................................................................................... 240
40.3.1
40.4.2
General..................................................................................................... 246
40.6.2
40.6.3
40.6.4
General..................................................................................................... 253
40.7.2
40.7.3
40.7.4
41.2.2
41.2.3
41.3.2
General..................................................................................................... 269
41.4.2
41.4.3
13
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
41.5.2
41.5.3
41.5.4
Manufacture.............................................................................................. 271
41.6.2
41.6.3
41.6.4
Manufacture.............................................................................................. 273
41.7.2
41.7.3
41.7.4
Manufacture.............................................................................................. 274
41.8.2
41.8.3
Manufacture.............................................................................................. 275
General..................................................................................................... 276
42.2.2
42.2.3
42.3.2
42.3.3
42.3.4
42.3.5
Processing................................................................................................ 283
42.4.2
42.4.3
14
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
42.5.2
Introduction............................................................................................... 288
42.6.2
42.6.3
42.6.4
General..................................................................................................... 303
General..................................................................................................... 305
43.1.2
Composition.............................................................................................. 307
43.2.2
43.2.3
43.2.4
43.2.5
Elemental.................................................................................................. 311
43.2.6
Glass-ceramics......................................................................................... 313
43.2.7
Guidelines................................................................................................. 315
43.3.2
43.4.2
43.4.3
43.4.4
43.4.5
43.4.6
43.4.7
43.4.8
43.5.2
43.5.3
15
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.6.1
43.6.2
43.7.2
43.8.2
43.9.2
43.9.3
16
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.15.6 ZERODUR: Design ................................................................................ 394
43.15.7 ZERODUR: Application examples ......................................................... 401
43.15.8 ULE Ultra low expansion titanium-silicate glass .................................... 401
43.15.9 ULE: Properties...................................................................................... 402
43.15.10
43.15.11
General..................................................................................................... 433
44.1.2
44.1.3
44.1.4
44.1.5
17
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
44.1.6
44.1.7
44.1.8
44.2.2
44.3.2
44.3.3
Processing................................................................................................ 447
44.3.4
44.4.2
44.4.3
Processing................................................................................................ 449
44.4.4
44.4.5
44.5.2
Composites............................................................................................... 451
44.5.3
General..................................................................................................... 453
44.6.2
44.6.3
44.6.4
44.6.5
45.3.2
General..................................................................................................... 460
45.4.2
18
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
45.5 Continuously reinforced copper composites .......................................................... 461
45.5.1
General..................................................................................................... 461
45.5.2
45.5.3
General..................................................................................................... 462
Figures
Figure 33.2-1 Summary: Defects in composite materials.................................................... 32
Figure 33.4-1 - Metal structures: Idealisation of a volumetric defect...................................... 38
Figure 33.4-2 - Composite structures: Idealisation of defects by standard circular
defect ................................................................................................................... 39
Figure 33.6-1 - Building block approach: Test programme development............................... 42
Figure 33.6-2 - Building block approach: Composite materials.............................................. 43
Figure 34.10-1 - Leaky-Lamb-wave technique for composites .............................................. 71
Figure 34.10-2 - Detection of fibre orientation by backscattering measurement .................... 72
Figure 34.10-3 Phased-array transducers: Element configurations .................................... 73
Figure 34.10-4 Phased-array transducers: Functionality .................................................... 74
Figure 34.10-5 - Non-contact ultrasonics: Air-coupled sensor configurations........................ 76
Figure 34.10-6 - Non-contact ultrasonics: Capacitive sensors in plate wave
configuration set-up ............................................................................................. 77
Figure 34.10-7 Airscan (air-coupled ultrasonics) system: Non-contact NDI of
Fokker solar panel substrates.............................................................................. 78
Figure 34.12-1 - Laser ultrasonic test system: Diagrammatic representation ........................ 80
Figure 34.13-1 - Holography by electronic imaging with random vibration excitation ............ 84
Figure 34.14-1 - Electronic shearographic system: Schematic diagram ................................ 85
Figure 34.15-1 - Basic thermographic technique ................................................................... 88
Figure 34.15-2 - Thermal-wave imaging: Photo-optical detection.......................................... 90
Figure 34.15-3 - Thermal-wave imaging: Photothermal and piezoelectric detection ............. 91
Figure 34.15-4 - Thermal-wave imaging: Photoacoustic gas cell........................................... 91
Figure 34.16-1 - Typical digital radiography systems............................................................. 97
Figure 34.17-1 - Computer tomography facility .................................................................... 100
Figure 34.19-1 - D sight - Diffracto sight schematic ............................................................. 106
Figure 37.5-1 - Probability of exceedance: Tensile strength 0............................................ 157
Figure 37.5-2 - Probability of exceedance: Tensile strength 90.......................................... 158
Figure 37.5-3 - Probability of exceedance: Compressive strength 90 ................................ 159
Figure 37.5-4 - Probability of exceedance: Interlaminar shear strength............................... 160
19
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure 38.3-1 - Hand lay-up process for mat or cloth........................................................... 163
Figure 38.3-2 - Prepreg: Direct lay-up.................................................................................. 167
Figure 38.3-3 - Prepreg: Indirect lay-up ............................................................................... 167
Figure 38.4-1 - Vacuum bag moulding method, with vertical bleeder .................................. 172
Figure 38.4-2 - Pressure bag moulding................................................................................ 172
Figure 38.4-3 - Pressure bag moulding: Press modifications............................................... 173
Figure 38.4-4 - Autoclave moulding method, with vertical bleeder....................................... 173
Figure 38.4-5 - Bag moulding: Edge bleed out system ........................................................ 176
Figure 38.4-6 - Typical cure schedule for autoclaved prepregs ........................................... 178
Figure 38.5-1 - Filament winding: Impregnation of fibres ..................................................... 180
Figure 38.6-1 - Filament winding: Polar vertical ................................................................... 183
Figure 38.6-2 - Filament winding: Polar horizontal............................................................... 183
Figure 38.6-3 - Filament winding: Polar tumbling................................................................. 184
Figure 38.6-4 - Filament winding: Helical ............................................................................. 184
Figure 38.7-1 - Resin transfer moulding (RTM): Process..................................................... 185
Figure 38.8-1 - Pultrusion: Basic process ............................................................................ 190
Figure 38.12-1 EB curing: Examples of parts and structures............................................ 197
Figure 38.13-1 - Preform technology: Architecture of woven commingled AS4/PEEK
150g 0/90 ........................................................................................................ 201
Figure 38.14-1 Fibre placement: Schematic view of the system....................................... 202
Figure 38.14-2 Fibre placement: Head.............................................................................. 203
Figure 38.14-3 Fibre placement: General view of working area........................................ 203
Figure 38.14-4 Fibre placement: Complex curvature ........................................................ 204
Figure 38.14-5 Fibre placement: Specific orientations ...................................................... 205
Figure 38.14-6 Fibre placement: Complex trajectories ..................................................... 206
Figure 38.14-7 Fibre placement: Variation of band width.................................................. 206
Figure 38.14-8 Fibre placement: Mixed-material lay-up.................................................... 207
Figure 39.3-1 - Router: Opposed helix for aramid/epoxy ..................................................... 220
Figure 39.3-2 - Router for trimming aramid/epoxy composites ............................................ 221
Figure 39.4-1 - Sanding of composites ................................................................................ 222
Figure 39.5-1 - Reverse bandsawing aramid/epoxy laminates ............................................ 224
Figure 39.5-2 - Circular sawing: Feed rate versus thickness of composite materials .......... 225
Figure 39.5-3 - Sabre sawing: Alternating tooth blade for aramid/epoxy ............................. 226
Figure 39.6-1 - Countersink for aramid/epoxy composite .................................................... 227
Figure 39.8-1 - Proper milling technique .............................................................................. 228
Figure 39.9-1 - Drill bits for composites................................................................................ 230
Figure 39.9-2 - Daggar drill in hand feed units ..................................................................... 232
Figure 39.10-1 Orbital drilling principle.............................................................................. 232
20
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure 39.10-2 Orbital drilling: Equipment mounted on a jig ............................................. 233
Figure 39.10-3 Orbital drilling: Application examples ........................................................ 234
Figure 40.3-1 - Mass/cost sensitivity for central thrust structure .......................................... 242
Figure 40.3-2 - Mass/cost sensitivity for complete structure ................................................ 243
Figure 40.3-3 - Mass to cost envelope for material improvements ...................................... 244
Figure 40.6-1 - Candidate fairing and intertank constructions.............................................. 247
Figure 40.6-2 - Fairing cylinder costs for different designs (life cycle costs per unit)........... 248
Figure 40.6-3 - Launcher fairing cylinder: Kepner-Tregoe evaluation scores for the
section designs .................................................................................................. 250
Figure 40.6-4 - Launcher fairing: Unit life cycle costs for sandwich fairing cylinder
designs for different fabrication processes ........................................................ 252
Figure 40.6-5 - Launcher fairing: Kepner-Tregoe evaluation scores for processes to
fabricate the monocoque and sandwich cylinder............................................... 253
Figure 40.7-1 - Thermoplastic components: Manufacturing unit costs as a function of
production volumes............................................................................................ 257
Figure 40.7-2 - Relative part costs for thermoplastic aircraft components: Dornier 328
landing flap rib ................................................................................................... 260
Figure 41.3-1 - Damage categories: Scratch ....................................................................... 266
Figure 41.3-2 - Damage categories: Notch .......................................................................... 266
Figure 41.3-3 - Damage categories: Chipping ..................................................................... 267
Figure 41.3-4 - Damage categories: Debonding .................................................................. 267
Figure 41.3-5 - Damage categories: Delamination............................................................... 268
Figure 41.3-6 - Damage categories: Perforation .................................................................. 268
Figure 41.4-1 - Basic repair concepts .................................................................................. 270
Figure 41.5-1 - Typical flush repair....................................................................................... 271
Figure 41.5-2 - Flush repair, used by Airbus Industrie ......................................................... 272
Figure 41.5-3 - Flush repair with adhesive film and cover plies ........................................... 272
Figure 41.6-1 - External repair: Pre-cured patches .............................................................. 273
Figure 41.6-2 - External repair: Cured in place .................................................................... 273
Figure 41.7-1 - Bolted and bonded repair using a composite patch..................................... 274
Figure 41.8-1 - Sandwich repair ........................................................................................... 276
Figure 42.2-1 - Classification of advanced metallic and ceramic materials with
temperature ....................................................................................................... 280
Figure 42.2-2 - Specific strength against temperature for advanced materials.................... 281
Figure 42.6-1 - SiC Nicalon fibre tensile strength at elevated temperature.......................... 293
Figure 42.6-2 - SiC Nicalon standard grade fibre tensile strength at elevated
temperature ....................................................................................................... 294
Figure 42.6-3 - SiC Nicalon ceramic grade fibre: tensile strength at elevated
temperature ....................................................................................................... 295
21
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure 42.6-4 - SiC Nicalon fibre: tensile strength after high temperature exposure in
air....................................................................................................................... 296
Figure 42.6-5 - SiC Nicalon fibre: tensile strength after high temperature exposure in
argon.................................................................................................................. 296
Figure 42.6-6 - SiC fibres Nicalon and Tyranno: tensile strength at elevated
temperature ....................................................................................................... 297
Figure 42.6-7 - SiC fibres Nicalon and Tyranno: modulus at elevated temperature ............ 298
Figure 42.6-8 - Alumina fibres: tensile strength at elevated temperature............................. 298
Figure 42.6-9 - Alumina fibres: modulus at elevated temperature ....................................... 299
Figure 42.6-10 - Alumina fibres: tensile strength against exposure to elevated
temperature ....................................................................................................... 299
Figure 42.6-11 - Alumina fibres: tensile strength against exposure time ............................. 300
Figure 42.6-12 - Alumina-boria-silica single filament: tensile strength at elevated
temperature in air............................................................................................... 300
Figure 42.6-13 - Alumina-boria-silica single filament: tensile modulus at elevated
temperature in air............................................................................................... 301
Figure 42.6-14 - Modulus for various fibres and matrix materials ........................................ 302
Figure 42.6-15 - Coefficients of thermal expansion for various fibres and matrix
materials ............................................................................................................ 303
Figure 43.4-1 Technical ceramics: Manufacturing processes ........................................... 320
Figure 43.9-1 Technical ceramics: pyrolitic boron nitride structure ................................ 341
Figure 43.12-1 Cesic: Basic processing sequence.......................................................... 358
Figure 43.12-2 Cesic: Silicon-infiltration processing equipment ..................................... 359
Figure 43.12-3 Cesic: Coefficient of thermal expansion ................................................. 361
Figure 43.12-4 Cesic ceramic: Example of integrally-stiffened panel............................. 362
Figure 43.12-5 SiC 54S ceramic: Process sequence ..................................................... 363
Figure 43.12-6 SiC 54S: NIRSpec prototype mirror ....................................................... 366
Figure 43.12-7 SiC-100: Production process - schematic for Herschel primary
mirror ................................................................................................................. 368
Figure 43.12-8 SiC-100: 1m diameter Demonstration Mirror ready to polish.............. 373
Figure 43.12-9 SiC-100: 1m diameter Demonstration Mirror green part joining
by ceramic bonding............................................................................................ 374
Figure 43.12-10 SiC-100: 1.35 m diameter HERSCHEL Demonstrator Breadboard
before and after brazing.................................................................................. 374
Figure 43.12-11 SiC-100: 3.5 m diameter HERSCHEL Primary Mirror
manufactured by brazing 12 SiC segments ....................................................... 375
Figure 43.12-12 SiC-100: 3.5 m diameter HERSCHEL Primary Mirror after
assembly............................................................................................................ 376
Figure 43.12-13 SiC-100: NIRSpec Optical Bench Breadboard...................................... 377
Figure 43.12-14 SiC-100: Optical Assembly of NIRSpec for James Webb Space
Telescope .......................................................................................................... 377
22
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure 43.15-1 - Glass ceramics: Coefficient of thermal expansion with temperature materials for optical instruments in space.......................................................... 387
Figure 43.15-2 - Zerodur: Production process schematic.................................................. 388
Figure 43.15-3 - Zerodur: Annealing process .................................................................... 389
Figure 43.15-4 - Zerodur: Summary of engineering data .................................................. 390
Figure 43.15-5 - Zerodur: Optical transmission curve ....................................................... 391
Figure 43.15-6 - Zerodur: Thermal expansion cryogenic behaviour............................... 392
Figure 43.15-7 - Zerodur: Coefficient of thermal expansion different glass
ceramics ............................................................................................................ 392
Figure 43.15-8 - Zerodur: Thermal expansion of different glass ceramics ........................ 393
Figure 43.15-9 - Zerodur: Thermal conductivity characteristics of different glasses ......... 393
Figure 43.15-10 - Zerodur: Failure probability for test surfaces processed with
bonded grit of different sizes.............................................................................. 398
Figure 43.15-11 - Zerodur: Failure probability of Zerodur for test surfaces processed
with loose grit of different sizes.......................................................................... 398
Figure 43.15-12 - Zerodur: Failure probability, F, as a function of test surface area,
SL ...................................................................................................................... 399
Figure 43.15-13 - Zerodur: Bending strength under constant load.................................... 399
Figure 43.15-14 - ULE: Transmission curve ...................................................................... 403
Figure 43.15-15 - ULE: Thermal expansion characteristics............................................... 404
Figure 43.17-1 Technical ceramics: CVD diamond sand erosion .................................. 412
Figure 43.18-1 NIRSpec optical bench development: Cesic ceramic demonstrator
structure............................................................................................................. 416
Figure 43.18-2 NIRSpec optical bench development: Test set-up and I-beam
sample with joint line.......................................................................................... 417
Figure 43.18-3 NIRSpec optical bench development: Test set-up for instrumented
bench cells......................................................................................................... 417
Figure 43.18-4 NIRSpec optical bench development: Test set-up for shaker
vibration tests..................................................................................................... 418
Figure 43.18-5 NIRSpec optical bench development: Test set-up for cryogenic
temperature test................................................................................................. 418
Figure 43.18-6 NIRSpec optical bench development: Thermal contraction under
cryogenic test..................................................................................................... 420
Figure 43.18-7 NIRSpec optical bench development: Linear displacement under
cryogenic test..................................................................................................... 421
Figure 43.18-8 NIRSpec optical bench development: Out-of-plane displacement
under cryogenic test .......................................................................................... 421
Figure 43.19-1 Zerodur: Optical bench for LISA pathfinder mission................................ 423
Figure 44.5-1 - Magnesium alloys: Momentum wheel bracket for satellite - Example ......... 452
Figure 44.5-2 - Carbon fibre-reinforced magnesium alloy: Space mirrors
(experimental) - Example................................................................................... 453
23
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure 45.3-1 - Copper ODS alloys: Elevated temperature stress-rupture properties of
Glidcop ODS alloys compared with some high conductivity copper alloys........ 458
Tables
Table 34.8-1 - Detection of manufacturing defects by contact NDT techniques .................... 60
Table 34.8-2 - Detection of manufacturing defects by non-contact NDT techniques ............. 61
Table 34.8-3 - Detection of in-service damage by contact NDT techniques .......................... 62
Table 34.8-4 - Detection of in-service damage by non-contact NDT techniques ................... 63
Table 34.14-1 - Defect detection by shearography ................................................................ 87
Table 34.15-1 - Thermography: Summary of diameter/depth ratios from different
studies ................................................................................................................. 93
Table 34.15-2 - Thermography: Detection levels established for flat bottomed holes
(FBH) from ESTEC study .................................................................................... 93
Table 34.18-1 - Detection of damage by eddy current and ultrasonics................................ 103
Table 34.21-1 - Summary of NDT techniques for polymer composite space structures ...... 109
Table 34.23-1 - Interrelationship of items influencing the test.............................................. 112
Table 34.23-2 - Effects of local failure modes on global behaviour of the structure............. 113
Table 34.23-3 - Detection of techniques to various failures occurring during test................ 114
Table 34.23-4 - Interrelation between failure modes and their possible locations ............... 115
Table 34.23-5 - Interrelation between type of loading and possible failure modes .............. 116
Table 34.23-6 - Failure modes which have to be covered by the specific tests ................... 117
Table 34.23-7 - Appropriate instrumentation of particular areas of the structure ................. 118
Table 34.23-8 - Interrelation between particular areas of the structures and possible
dangerous loads ................................................................................................ 119
Table 34.23-9 - Testing of particular areas of the structure ................................................. 120
Table 34.23-10 - Load combinations for the relevant cases ................................................ 121
Table 34.23-11 - Testing different load cases ...................................................................... 122
Table 36.3-1 - Resin procurement: General Information...................................................... 143
Table 36.3-2 - Resin procurement: Base resin..................................................................... 144
Table 36.3-3 - Resin procurement: Hardener....................................................................... 144
Table 36.3-4 - Resin procurement: Catalyst......................................................................... 145
Table 36.3-5 - Resin procurement: Modifier......................................................................... 145
Table 36.3-6 - Resin procurement: Solvent.......................................................................... 145
Table 36.3-7 - Resin procurement: Blend ............................................................................ 146
Table 37.5-1 - Test data for HM carbon/epoxy specimen .................................................... 156
Table 38.3-1 - Wet lay-up and laminating: Troubleshooting guide....................................... 165
Table 38.3-2 - Hand wet lay-up: Selection factors ............................................................... 166
Table 38.3-3 - Process steps for prepreg lay-up .................................................................. 168
24
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table 38.4-1 - Tooling for composites: Relative merits of various types for CFRP .............. 177
Table 38.12-1 EB curing: Advantages and drawbacks of epoxy and acrylate resins........ 195
Table 38.12-2 EB curing: Mechanical properties of some acrylate and epoxy resins....... 196
Table 38.12-3 EB curing: Typical mechanical properties of unidirectional IM carbon
fibre/acrylate resin ............................................................................................. 196
Table 40.3-1 - Cost optimisation: Eurostar Bus/Inmarsat 2 study ........................................ 241
Table 40.6-1 - Launcher fairing constructions: Mass and cost of various designs ............... 247
Table 40.6-2 - Launcher fairings: Kepner-Tregoe trade study evaluation criteria ................ 249
Table 40.7-1 - Selected thermoplastic component: Cost/producibility trade-off
analysis.............................................................................................................. 256
Table 40.7-2 - Selected thermoplastic components: Relative manufacturing costs and
major contributors to cost .................................................................................. 258
Table 42.6-1 - Reinforcing fibres available for use in inorganic composites ........................ 289
Table 42.6-2 - Continuous fibre and filament reinforcements used in MMCs and
CMCs................................................................................................................. 291
Table 43.2-1 Technical ceramics: Oxides - general features ............................................ 308
Table 43.2-2 Technical ceramics: Carbides - general features......................................... 309
Table 43.2-3 Technical ceramics: Nitrides - general features ........................................... 310
Table 43.2-4 Technical ceramics: Carbons - general features.......................................... 312
Table 43.2-5 Technical ceramics: Sources - examples..................................................... 314
Table 43.3-1 Technical ceramics: ISO standards - summary ........................................... 318
Table 43.3-2 Technical ceramics: ISO standards - drafts ................................................. 319
Table 43.4-1 Technical ceramics: green shape processes ............................................. 321
Table 43.5-1 Technical ceramics: Materials - mechanical components............................ 328
Table 43.5-2 Technical ceramics: Materials - thermomechanical components................. 329
Table 43.5-3 Technical ceramics: Materials - electrical .................................................... 330
Table 43.5-4 Technical ceramics: Materials optical and dimensionally-stable
structures ........................................................................................................... 331
Table 43.6-1 Technical ceramics: alumina typical properties......................................... 334
Table 43.6-2 Technical ceramics: ZTA zirconia toughened alumina typical
properties........................................................................................................... 335
Table 43.7-1 Technical ceramics: Aluminium nitride typical properties.......................... 337
Table 43.8-1 Technical ceramics: boron carbide typical properties ............................... 339
Table 43.9-1 Technical ceramics: boron nitride typical properties ................................. 343
Table 43.10-1 Technical ceramics: carbon types typical properties............................... 347
Table 43.10-2 Technical ceramics: carbon-graphite grades typical properties .............. 348
Table 43.10-3 Technical ceramics: carbon foams typical properties ............................. 350
Table 43.11-1 Technical ceramics: silica typical properties ........................................... 352
Table 43.12-1 Technical ceramics: silicon carbides comparison of materials
properties produced by different process routes ............................................... 355
25
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table 43.12-2 Cesic: Mechanical properties .................................................................. 360
Table 43.12-3 Cesic: Thermal properties ....................................................................... 361
Table 43.12-4 SiC 54S: Mechanical properties ............................................................... 364
Table 43.12-5 SiC 54S: Thermal properties .................................................................... 365
Table 43.12-6 SiC 100: Manufacturing size constraints - practical size limitations
for finished part .................................................................................................. 370
Table 43.12-7 SiC 100: Typical characteristics ............................................................... 371
Table 43.12-8 SiC 100: Micro-VCM test E544 - outgassing values................................. 371
Table 43.13-1 Technical ceramics: silicon nitrides comparison of materials
properties produced by different process routes ............................................... 379
Table 43.14-1 Technical ceramics: partially stabilised zirconia typical properties ......... 381
Table 43.15-1 Technical ceramics: Zerodur glass typical properties............................ 384
Table 43.15-2 Technical ceramics: ULE glass typical properties ................................. 385
Table 43.15-3 - Zerodur: Characteristic strength, Weibull factor and stress corrosion
factor.................................................................................................................. 397
Table 43.15-4 - Zerodur: Fracture toughness of some glasses......................................... 400
Table 43.15-5 - ULE: Summary of engineering data ......................................................... 402
Table 43.17-1 Technical ceramics: CVD diamond typical properties............................. 409
Table 43.17-2 Technical ceramics: CVD diamond Weibull modulus.............................. 409
Table 43.17-3 Technical ceramics: CVD diamond Youngs modulus ............................ 410
Table 43.17-4 Technical ceramics: CVD diamond typical optical properties for
high-power laser systems .................................................................................. 413
Table 43.17-5 Technical ceramics: CVD diamond typical dielectric properties for
high-power microwave systems......................................................................... 414
Table 43.19-1 Zerodur: Overview of terrestrial astronomical telescope mirrors .............. 423
Table 44.1-1 - Magnesium alloys: ASTM designation system - alloys and tempers ............ 434
Table 44.1-2 - Magnesium alloys: Sources - examples ....................................................... 436
Table 44.2-1 - Magnesium alloys: Nominal chemical compositions..................................... 438
Table 44.2-2 - Magnesium alloys: Typical mechanical properties, at room
temperature ....................................................................................................... 440
Table 44.2-3 - Magnesium alloys: Typical low temperature tensile properties at 196C................................................................................................................. 442
Table 44.2-4 - Magnesium alloys: Typical tensile properties at elevated temperatures....... 443
Table 44.2-5 - Magnesium alloys: Typical elevated temperature creep properties .............. 444
Table 44.2-6 - Magnesium alloys: Typical fatigue and fracture toughness properties at
room temperature .............................................................................................. 445
Table 44.2-7 - Magnesium alloys: Damping capacity of selected alloys and other
metals ................................................................................................................ 446
Table 44.3-1 - SiC particulate reinforced AZ61 magnesium alloy: Typical mechanical
properties........................................................................................................... 447
26
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table 44.3-2 - SiC particulate reinforced magnesium alloy: Typical mechanical
properties........................................................................................................... 448
Table 44.4-1 - Continuous fibre reinforced magnesium MMC materials: Examples ........... 448
Table 44.4-2 - Magnesium continuous reinforced MMCs: Typical mechanical
properties........................................................................................................... 450
Table 45.3-1 - Copper ODS alloys: Ambient temperature tensile properties ....................... 459
Table 45.3-2 - Copper ODS alloys: Short term properties at 538C .................................... 460
Table 45.3-3 - Copper ODS alloys: Creep strength at 538C .............................................. 460
Table 45.5-1 - Continuous fibre reinforced copper: Thermal conductivity of carbon/Cu
and carbon/Al composites ................................................................................. 462
27
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Introduction
TheStructuralmaterialshandbook,ECSSEHB3220,ispublishedin8Parts.
Aglossaryofterms,definitionsandabbreviatedtermsforthesehandbooksiscontainedinPart8.
Thepartsareasfollows:
Part1
Overviewandmaterialpropertiesandapplications
Clauses19
Part2
Designcalculationmethodsandgeneraldesignaspects
Clauses1022
Part3
Loadtransferanddesignofjointsanddesignofstructures
Clauses2332
Part4
Integritycontrol,verificationguidelinesandmanufacturing
Clauses3345
Part5
Newadvancedmaterials,advancedmetallicmaterials,
generaldesignaspectsandloadtransferanddesignofjoints
Clauses4663
Part6
Fractureandmaterialmodelling,casestudiesanddesignand
integritycontrolandinspection
Clauses6481
Part7
Thermalandenvironmentalintegrity,manufacturingaspects, Clauses82107
inorbitandhealthmonitoring,softmaterials,hybrid
materialsandnanotechnoligies
Part8
Glossary
28
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
33
Aspects of damage tolerance
33.1
Introduction
33.1.1
Damage tolerance
Damagetoleranceistheabilityofacompositematerialstructuretoresisttheonsetofdamageand
perform to the stipulated design parameters, with damage present, throughout its remaining life
time.
TheguidelinespresentedaretobereadinconjunctionwithnormativeECSSstandardsECSSQST
20;ECSSQST40;ECSSQST70;ECSSEST30seriesandECSSEST3201.
33.1.2
Damage events
Composite structuresareusually exposed toa variety ofevents during their life. This can include
normal inservice loading, inservice events that result in damage initiation and structural
degradation,alongwithenvironmentrelatedevents.
Damagecanalsooccurduringmanufactureorhandlingbeforethestructureentersservice.
The ability of a composite material to resist certain potential damage events is known as damage
resistance.Itdiffersfromdurabilitybecausedurabilityaddressesthepreventionofdamageunder
normaloperatingconditions.
33.1.3
Many agencies impose damage tolerance criteria. The details of such criteria are tailored to the
structureofinterest,althoughtherearesomecommonthemes,[See:33.3]:
Defectsareoftenstandardisedforanalysispurposes,[See:33.4],i.e.
defectsthatcanariseduringmanufacture,[See:19.2],
damagethatcanoccurwhilstinservice,[See:19.3].
The effect of macroscopic defects on static load; failure modes and the use of fracture
mechanics,[See:33.5].
Testing and analysis: cyclic loading, nogrowth criterion, residual strength and inspection,
[See:33.6].
29
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
33.2
General guidelines
33.2.1
Fracture control
Thedamagetoleranceevaluationoflaminatedcompositestructuresisbasedonthefracturecontrol
requirements of normative standard ECSSEST3201, [See also: 34.10 for analysis and test
documentation]
33.2.2
Durability
Durability considerations are typically combined with damage tolerance to meet economic and
functionality objectives. Specifically, durability is the ability of a structural application to retain
adequateproperties,e.g.strength,stiffness,andenvironmentalresistance,throughoutitslifetothe
extent that any deterioration can be controlled and repaired, if there is a need, by economically
acceptablemaintenancepractices,Ref.[332].
Durability largely addresses economic issues, while damage tolerance is focussed on safety. For
example,durabilityoftenaddressestheonsetofdamagefromtheoperationalenvironment.Under
the principles of damage tolerance design, the small damages associated with initiation can be
difficulttodetect,butdonotthreatenstructuralintegrity,Ref.[332].
33.2.3
Damage
The location of damage initiation sites are often difficult to identify and thorough inspections are
neededusingtraditionaltechniquesandNDTnondestructivetestingtechniques.
Inmanymetals,failureinvolvesthegrowthofasmallcrackperpendiculartotheappliedstress.
By contrast, in laminated composite materials stress relaxation and fracture results from
combinationsof:
Splittingparalleltothefibres,
Matrixmicrocracking,
Fibrefailure,
Delamination,
Pullingoutoffibres,
Pullingoutofcompleteplies.
33.2.4
Defects in composites
33.2.4.1
General
Defectsincompositeelementscanbedescribedaseither:
Globaldeviations,or
Localimperfections.
Figure33.2.1summarisesthevarioustypesofdefectsthatcanoccurincompositematerials,Ref.[33
4].
30
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
33.2.4.2
Global
Globaldeviationsarerelatedto:
Acompleteelement,or
Alargeareaofanitem.
The effect of a global deviation is to reduce the capability of an element. The level of reduced
performance is dependent on the particular deviation, e.g. that occurring within a cure cycle.
Adequatecontrolcanbeachievedby,[Seealso:Chapter19]:
Aprocesscompanionsample;alsoknownasawitness,or
Nondestructivechecksofkeypoints.
As the whole item is affected, control is related more to the quality, i.e. coverage of all potential
sourcesofdegradation,thantoquantity.
31
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Component defects
Holes:
- oversized holes
- breakout or broken fibres on hole exit
- mislocated and repaired holes (resin)
- out-of-round hole
- resin-starved bearing surfaces
Fasteners
- tear-out or pull-through in countersink
- over-torqued or undersized fasteners
- improper seating of fasteners
- tool impressions
Thickness deviation on:
- manufactured hardware
- process control coupons
Non-uniform bond thickness
Warpage on:
- detailed parts
- assembled parts
Figure33.21Summary:Defectsincompositematerials
32
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
33.2.4.3
Local
Nonuniformdistributionofresinandfibres.
Interruptedorbrokenfibres.
Disbondsatfibretomatrixinterfaces.
Voids.
Inclusions.
Astheselocaldefectsarestatisticallydistributed,theyarecoveredbythelowerboundofmaterial
properties.
Significantlylarger imperfections can cause progressive failure.Only local macroscopic deviations
areconsideredhere,whichalthoughmacroscopic,thevolumeofacriticallocaldefectcanberather
small.Adequatecontrolprocedurespreventsuchpotentialdefectsoccurringinthewholeitem.
The screening of the structure needs to be performed with sufficiently highresolution, sensitivity
andreliability.Thereforethecontrolproblemsrelatetobothqualityandquantity.
33.2.4.4
Proof test
The use of proof testing for flight articles, as a means of damage tolerance demonstration, can be
consideredonacasebycasebasis.Inconsideringanysuchdemonstration,itisnecessarytoreview
thetestlevelandensurethat:
Thetestdoesnotintroduceanyunwarranteddamage,and
Theworstlimitloadcasesarecoveredbysuchatest.
33.2.5
Impact damage
33.2.5.1
Laminates
Impactdamageiscontainedwithinthelaminateitself.
33.2.5.2
Sandwich structures
Incontrasttolaminates,insandwichconstructionstherearetwoloadpathsseparatedbyacorethat
isresponsibleforshearloadtransfer.
Impactdamageistypicallyunsymmetrical,sothisneedsabetterunderstandingoftheprogression
ofthedamageandtheresidualstrength.Damagetoleranceofsandwichstructuresismorecomplex
thanlaminatedstructuresasdamagecaninclude:
Penetrationordelaminationofthefacings;sometimesboth.
Corecrushing
Facingtocoredebonding
33
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Cores tend to absorb and retain moisture which can reduce mechanical properties as well as
increasingthestructuralweight.
Typicallyimpactdamageisnotuniformthroughthethicknessofthesandwichstructure,sincean
impactor or projectile can penetrate or damage the outward facing skin whilst the inner skin
remainsundamaged.
Compositefacingsorskinsonsandwichstructurestypicallyfailasaresultof:
Matrixcracks
Fibrefracture
Fibrebuckling
Delamination.
Ifonlyonefacingisdamagedsignificantly,thiscancausearedistributionofstressesinthedamaged
facesheet.
Visualinspectionsfordamagethenbecomemoredifficultbecausethecorecanmaskthedamageor
hindertheeffectivenessofanondestructiveevaluationtechnique.
33.3
33.3.1
General
33.3.1.1
Types of flaw
Forcompositestructuresthedamagetolerancephilosophyisprimarilyconcernedwiththetypesof
flaw,i.e.:
Alargeundetectedmanufacturingdefect,whichcanbeassumedtobeaninclusionorother
defectthatcausesadelamination.
A surface scratch, where the length and depth of the scratch is defined and the orientation
andlocationisassumedtobeinthemostcriticallocationforagivenstructure.
Undetected impact damage, where the damage area is assumed to be consistent with BVID
barelyvisibleimpactdamageandinacriticallocation,[Seealso:19.5].
Anundetectedimpactdamageisthemostseriousofthetypesofflawformanystructures.
33.3.1.2
Effect of flaw
Incompositestructures,assumptionsaremadeabouttheflaws,i.e.:
Thegrowthofaflawisunstable.
Theinitialflawdoessignificantlyaffectthestaticstrength.
Themainaimistoreducemaintenancebytheuseofanalysisandtestingtodemonstratethat
thedamagedoesnotamounttoasafetyriskoverthedesignlifeofthestructure.
34
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
33.3.1.3
Threats
To construct a damage tolerance assessment for composite structures, the threats are defined for
eachstructure,.i.e.:
Damagefrommanufacturingprocesses.
Accidentaldamagefromassemblyandhandling.
Accidentaldamagefrominserviceoperation.
33.3.1.4
Modes of damage
The next step is to define the modes of damage for each threat, e.g. porosity, delamination,
puncture,crushedcore.
Foreachmodeofdamage,characteristicssuchasinitialflawsize,thresholdofdetectability,critical
size,andwhethergrowthduringloadingaredefined.
In many composite structures subjected to spectrum or block cycle loading, the growth of impact
damageischaracterisedbyperiodsoflittleornogrowthatalowloadlevelfollowedbyrelatively
large growth at relatively high loads. A significant effect of impact damage is the significant
reduction in static strength once the impact has occurred and often the most critical damage is
inducedbyalowvelocityimpactevent,[Seealso:19.5].
Themostcriticalmodeofloadingformetallicstructureistension,whichcausescrackopening.The
critical modes of loading for composite structure is identified for purposes of selecting principal
structuralelementsandfordevelopingappropriatetesting.
33.3.2
Load paths
Indamagetoleranceassessments,anogrowthcriterionisappliedindemonstratingtheintegrityof
individualloadpathsortheindependenceofloadpaths.
33.3.3
Environment
Structuraldetails,elements,andsubcomponentsofcriticalstructuralareas,designatedFCIsfracture
criticalitems,aretestedunderenvironmentalloadsrepresentativeofoperationalusage.Thistesting
canformthebasisforvalidatinganogrowthapproachtothedamagetolerancerequirements.The
testingassessestheeffectoftheenvironmentontheflawgrowthcharacteristicsandthenogrowth
validation.
33.3.4
Damage
Damage levels, including lowlevel impact damage, typical of those that can occur during
fabrication,assemblyandoperationareintroduced.Theextentofsuchinitiallydetectabledamageis
establishedand is consistent with the inspection techniques employed duringmanufacture and in
operation.
Flawordamagegrowthdataisobtainedfromoperationrelatedloadcyclingofsuchintrinsicflaws
ordelaminationsormechanicallyintroduceddamage.
Thenumberofcyclesneededtovalidateanogrowthconceptisstatisticallysignificantandcanbe
determinedbysuchloadorlifeconsiderationsasreflecttheoperationalusage.Thegrowthorno
35
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
growthevaluationisestablishedbytestssupportedbyanalysisorbytestsatthecoupon,elementor
subcomponentlevel.
Anogrowthevaluationisapplied,unlessthereissufficientevidenceforgrowthevaluation.Thisis
relatedtotheoperationaluseinspectionprogrammebeingacceptablefortheparticularFCI.
33.3.5
Residual strength
33.3.6
Safe-life
In the case of a safelife demonstration, the evaluation demonstrates compliance with the fracture
controlrequirementsofECSSEST3201.
33.3.7
Fail-safe
In the case of failsafe structures, the residual strength is sufficient to permit the safe operation at
limitloadsthroughoutthetimeintervalbetweenscheduleinspections.
33.3.8
Stiffness
It is also demonstrated that the stiffness properties have not changed beyond acceptable levels in
relationtoaeroelasticandanyotherstiffnessrequirementsasaresultofthedamageidentifiedfor
theresidualstrengthassessments.
33.3.9
Loads
Thestructureisabletowithstandstaticloads,consideredaslimitloads,thatareexpectedduringthe
completionoftheservicelifeonwhichdamageresultingfromobviousdiscretesourcesoccur,e.g.
dropped tools, meteoroid impact. The extent of damage is based on each discrete source. This
damagedefinitionandanyverificationprogrammeisthesubjectofreview.
33.3.11 Inspection
An inspection programme is developed consistingof frequency, extent andmethods of inspection
forinclusioninthemaintenanceplan.
Theinspectionintervalsareestablishedsuchthattheextentofthedamageiscarefullycheckedwith
respect to the residualstrength capability including the nogrowth design concept. Any areas
deemednoninspectablearesubjectofaspecialdesignandtestprogramme.
36
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
33.3.12 Summary
Themainstagesofadamagetoleranceevaluationare,Ref.[331]:
Selecttheprincipalstructuralelementstobeevaluated.
Defineordevelopforeachlocation:
stressspectrum.
environment.
crackgrowthratedata.
fracturetoughnessdata.
structuralcategory.
criticaldamagesizeunderlimitloadandinserviceload.
crackgrowthcurvesfromspectrumloading.
Establishinitialdamagesize.
Establishdamagethresholdofdetectabilityforeachlocation.
Validateresidualstrengthandcrackgrowthanalysismethodswithtesting.
33.4
Defect standardisation
33.4.1
General
33.4.1.1
Metal structures
Theassessmentofdefectsinhomogeneousandisotropicmetallicstructuresbyfracturemechanics
stillinvolvessimplifications.Therealvolumetricdefect,e.g.apore,isconservativelyrepresentedby
a mathematical cut of the size of its projection; as shown in Figure 33.4.1. The sharp edges of the
assumedcrackaremoreseverethanthoseofrealdefects.
37
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure33.41Metalstructures:Idealisationofavolumetricdefect
33.4.1.2
Composite structures
Theassessmentoftheeffectofdefectsneedsasimplifiedrepresentationoftherealdefectinorderto
reducethecomplexityaddedbythematerialheterogeneityandanisotropy.
Likefracturemechanics,afewstandardtypesofdefectscovermostlocaldeviations.Thisappliesto:
Assessmentandverification,and
Degreeofresolutioninnondestructiveinspection
33.4.2
Types of defects
Forthesimplificationofrealdefects,[See:Chapter19],thefactorstoconsiderinclude:
Localdefects:Forthethinlaminatesoftenusedforlightweightspacestructures,mostlocal
defects can be represented by a throughthethickness defect. It is difficult to justify that a
surface defect, e.g. a severe scratch in a laminate having a few plies, relates to a part of the
pliesonly,sothisapproachisnotconsideredtobetooconservative.
38
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Circular defects: Experience shows that circular defects, through a laminate, usually have a
slightly higher influence on residual strength than slots having a length equivalent to the
diameter.
Standardiseddefectsthatenableanassessmentofmosttypesofmanufacturingandoperationally
induceddefectsare:
Circularholes,and
Circulardelaminations.
Figure33.4.2showstheidealisationofrealdefectsincompositestructuresusingastandardcircular
defect.
Figure33.42Compositestructures:Idealisationofdefectsbystandardcircular
defect
39
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
33.5
33.5.1
Composite failure
Incompositematerials,mainlyCFRP,fracturebehaviourisprimarilyelastic,i.e.thereisnoplastic
deformationcomparedwiththatofductilemetals.
Materials with such brittle failures are sensitive to notches and cracks under static and cycling
loading,especiallywithrespecttoresidualstrengthunderquasistaticloads.
Careful observation of the failure process during testing of notched specimens shows that under
steadily increasing loads, the failure initiates within individual plies, either along or transverse to
fibres, but also between certain plies long before the maximum load capability is reached. The
partialdamagewithinorbetweencertainpliesproducesaredistributionofthelocalstressesthatin
turnresultsinacomplicated,interactivefailureprocess.
Anyattempttorelatethefinalfailuretothedistributionofinitialstressesisquestionable.
[Seealso:Chapter14]
33.5.2
33.5.2.1
Isotropic materials
ThewideapplicationofLEFMlinearelasticfracturemechanicstohomogeneousisotropicmaterialis
supportedbyitsrelativesimplicity.Oneparameter,thetoughness,candescribethefailureloadofa
precrackedelement.
33.5.2.2
Anisotropic plates
Theconditionsunderwhichthetechniquesofisotropicfracturemechanicscanbedirectlyappliedto
anisotropicplatesaredescribed.
33.5.3
Multi-angle laminates
The conditions cannot be maintained correctly for multiangle laminates. The inhomogeneity is
createdbythe:
Fibre/matrix(microheterogeneity),and
Stacking(macroheterogeneity).
Withtheintenttogenerateafailurecriterionphenomenologically,onecanconsiderthelaminateto
besufficientlyhomogeneousforthestressesresultingfromexternalloadingtoberelatedtothetotal
thicknessofthelaminate(grossstresses).
Implicitly, with the assumption of homogeneity, the considerations are limited to defects passing
throughthethickness,i.e.holes.
Furthermore, as the toughness of unidirectional laminates is different under longitudinal and
transverse loading, the toughness of an arbitrary multiangle laminate cannot be expected to be a
materialconstant.
40
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Inphenomenologicalfracturemodels,theinitiationandpropagationofdamage,occurringwithinor
betweenthedifferentplies,longbeforethecriticalloadingisreachedarerecognisedbyassumingan
effectivesizeofdefectwhichislargerthanthegeometricdimensionsofthenotch.
33.6
33.6.1
General
33.6.1.1
Scope
The nature and extent of analysis or tests on complete structures, or portions of the primary
structure, depend upon applicable previous damagetolerant designs, construction, tests and
operational experience on similar structures. In the absence of experience with similar designs,
approvedstructuraldevelopmenttestsofcomponents,subcomponentsandelementsareperformed.
33.6.1.2
Location
Since there are a large number of locations on each composite structure to be evaluated, it is
impractical to evaluate the damage tolerance at each location by testing. Analysis is therefore
needed.Theanalysisproceduresassociatedwithdamagetoleranceevaluationarebasedonfracture
mechanics,whichincludestressintensity,interlaminarfracturetoughnessandpropagationgrowth
ratesofcracksordelamination.
33.6.1.3
Strength
Analytical calculations are used for residual strength calculations and fatigue analyses under
spectrum loading, which are two major ingredients in damage tolerance evaluation. Sufficient
testingisneededtovalidatetheanalysismethods.Fullscalestructuraltestingoccurstoolatetobe
usefulduringthedesignphase,butitisusedlatertoenableinitialdamagetoleranceevaluationsto
beupdated.
33.6.1.4
Environment
The effects of environment can be accounted for in both the analysis stage of the assessment and
duringthematerialscharacterisationstage.
The effects of moisture diffusion and temperature can be included as an additional loading
conditionintheanalyses.Additionally,theeffectsofmoistureandtemperatureonthedelamination
characterisationpropertiescanbedeterminedbyconductingtestsunderhostileconditionsorafter
ageing(longtermoraccelerated)ofthematerialsconsistentwiththeirapplication.
33.6.1.5
Tests
Aspartofthedamagetoleranceapproach,testsareclearlydefinedandperformed,Ref.[332]:
static testing of structural elements with various modes of damage and various modes of
loadingtoprovideresidualstrengthinformation
cyclic testing of structural elements with various modes of damage and various modes of
loadingtoprovidedamagegrowth(ornogrowth)information
41
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Cyclictestingofimportantfullscalecomponentstoverifythatdamagewouldnotgrowtoa
criticalsizeinthefullscalearticleduringthelifeofthestructure
Static testing of important fullscale components to verify that they would carry required
loadswithanydamagegrowthinflictedfromcyclicloading
Appropriatetestingtovalidateanyanalysesmethodsused
33.6.1.6
Test programme
Theapproachtakenforcompilingatestprogrammefrommaterialsselectiontostructuralvalidation
isknownasthebuildingblockapproach;asshowninFigure33.06.1,[Seealso:33.2].
Theadvantageoftheapproachisthatitenables:
Theapplicationofrealisticserviceloadsandenvironmentsto thetestcouponorsubstructureare
emphasisedwithinthisapproach.
Crippling
Figure33.61Buildingblockapproach:Testprogrammedevelopment
42
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
33.6.1.7
Composites
Fivelevelsoftestsarenecessaryforcomposites;asshowninFigure33.6.2:
Constituent,
Lamina,
Laminate,
Structuralelement,
Structuralsubcomponent.
Figure33.62Buildingblockapproach:Compositematerials
33.6.2
Constituent tests
The individual properties of fibres, fibre forms, matrix materials, and fibrematrix preforms are
evaluated.Thekeypropertiesinclude:
Matrixdensity,
Fibredensity,
Fibretensilestrength,
Fibretensilemodulus.
43
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
33.6.3
Lamina tests
The properties of the fibre and matrix together in the composite material form are evaluated. The
keypropertiesinclude:
Fibrearealweight,
Matrixcontent,
Voidcontent,
Curedplythickness,
Laminatensilestrengthsandmoduli,
Laminacompressivestrengthsandmoduli,
Laminashearstrengthsandmoduli.
33.6.4
Laminate tests
Laminate testing characterises the response of the composite material in a particular laminate
design,suchasquasiisotropic.Thekeypropertiesinclude:
Tensilestrengthsandmoduli,
Compressivestrengthsandmoduli,
Shearstrengthsandmoduli,
Interlaminarfracturetoughness,
Fatigueresistance.
33.6.5
The ability of the material to tolerate common laminate discontinuities is evaluated. The key
propertiesinclude:
Openandfilledholetensilestrengths,
Openandfilledholecompressivestrengths,
Compressionafterimpactstrength,
Jointbearingandbearingbypassstrengths.
33.6.6
Thebehaviourandfailuremodeofincreasinglymorecomplexstructuralassembliesareevaluated.
Theselectionofwhichisstructureandapplicationdependent.
33.6.7
Delamination
33.6.7.1
In-service
Thethreatofdelaminationarisingfrominserviceloadinghasbeenoneofthefactorsinlimitingthe
adoptionoflaminatedcompositematerialsingreatervolumeforprimarystructure.
44
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
While other damage modes such as matrix cracks can occur first, delaminations result in larger
stiffnessdropsandreductioninloadbearingcapabilities.
Delaminations can occur from interlaminar stresses arising from geometric or material
discontinuities from design features, e.g. an edge, a hole, a dropped ply. However, they can also
occur from matrix cracks or from interlaminar stresses caused by structural loading, such as in a
curvedlaminate,orbyforeignbodyimpacts.
A delamination, once initiated, grows under fatigue loads. During delamination growth, the
structuralloadscanberedistributedsuchthatanotherdelaminationoccursinanotherlocation.
The delaminations can continue to grow and accumulate until a structural failure occurs, such as
bucklingorfibrefailure.
Alternatively,thedelaminationcanbearrestedandthestructuremaintainssomelevelofintegrity.
Although delamination does not always cause a total loss of the loadbearing properties of the
component, it is usually a precursor to such an event. Therefore, knowledge of the resistance of a
composite to interlaminar fracture is useful not only for product development and material
screening, but a generic measurement of the interlaminar fracture toughness of the composite is
usefulforestablishingdesignallowablesfordamagetoleranceanalysesofcompositestructures.
33.6.7.2
Interlaminarfracturetestsareperformedbymanufacturingtestsampleswithprecracks.Thetypeof
testisdefinedbasedonthemodeofloadingofthetestsample,i.e.
ModeItestssuchasDCB
ModeIItestssuchas4ENF,ELS,ENF
ModeIIIECT,SCB(modified)
MixedModeI/IItestssuchasMMB,FPS/ADCB,CLS,stabilisedMMB
33.6.7.3
Dynamic loading
In most cases the components experience spectrum fatigue loads rather than constant amplitude
fatigue loads. For Mode I testing, the load needs to remain in tension. Therefore, the parts of the
spectrumwheretheloadcausesthedelaminationtoclosearerepresentedbyzeroloadintheDCB
tests.
With appropriate fixture design, the mode II test specimen can be loaded through zero and thus
fullyrepresentadelaminationinastructurewherethespectrumcontainstensionandcompressive
loads.
When the delamination has compressive loads closing the delamination (equivalent to a negative
GI),theinfluenceoffrictionandsubsequentheatingcanbeanissue.
Forafullcharacterisationforspectrumloads,thedelaminationonsetcurvesandthedelamination
growthcurvesaregeneratedfordifferentRratiosandblocksofloadingtoestablishthesynergistic
effects.
45
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
33.7
33.7.1
Acoustic fatigue
The resistance of the composite structure to noise damage is demonstrated by analysis or test. In
particular,itisdemonstratedthatnogrowthdamageareas,asestablishedinrelationtoquasistatic
loadingcriteria,donotpropagate.
33.7.2
Proof testing
Withinthefracturecontrolrequirements,allcompositestructuresandcomponentsareclassifiedas
potentiallyfracturecriticalitems,PFCI,[See:ECSSEST3201].
33.7.3
Metallic parts
Compositecomponentscancontainmetallicparts,e.g.attachmentfittingsorlargersubstructuresin
areasofhighloadtransfer.
Specialattentionispaidtofracturecriticalitems,FCIs.toinvestigatethetreatmentofareasofhigh
loadtransferinordertoensurethereisnounacceptablelocalyieldingwhendesignultimateloads
aresustained,[See:ECSSEST3201].
33.7.4
Theinterfacewiththecompositestructureandanythermalprotectionsystemistakenintoaccount
intheselectionofFCIs,andrelatedinspectionandmaintenance.
Any interactive effects in relation to local loadings, such as the response to impact loads and
acousticexcitation,arealsoconsidered.
33.7.5
Crashworthinessisdemonstratedbytestorbyanalysissupportedbyteststhat,underrealisticand
survivable conditions, the survival characteristics are commensurate with those achievable with a
conventionalmetallicaircraftstructure.
33.7.6
The properties of materials and processes used in space systems are established according to
normativeECSSstandards.
[See:ECSSQST70;ECSSQ7071]
[See also: ESMAT website for outgassing and flammability data from the ESTEC Materials and
Processesdatabases]
46
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
33.7.7
Lightning protection
It is demonstrated by appropriateanalysis and testthat the structure can dissipate static electrical
charges,providenecessaryelectromagneticprotectionandprovideanacceptablemeansofdiverting
electricalcurrentarisingfromthelightningstrikesothatthevehicleisnotendangered.
A test and inspection procedure is established to ensure satisfactory maintenance of the lightning
protectionsystem.
33.8
33.8.1
General
Changes made to various composite material parameters can cause the notch sensitivity to range
frominsensitivetoverysensitive.Someguidelinesforcreatingtoughlaminatesarepresented,Ref.
[332].
33.8.2
Material-related aspects
33.8.2.1
Fibre-to-matrix bond
Toobtainatoughlaminate,thestrengthoftheinterfacialbondbetweenthefibreandmatrixhasto
beoptimised.Thisisachievedbycorrectsurfacetreatmentofthefibre.Ifthebondistoostrong,the
materialalwaysfailsinabrittlemannerirrespectiveoflayup.
33.8.2.2
Types of fibres
Materials which can store large amounts of strain energy are expected to be tough. Consequently
fibres with high strength, intermediate modulus and high failure strain are expected to be good
candidates for a tough laminate. Hybridisation provides much scope for developing composites
withincreasedtoughness.
33.8.2.3
Plies
Althoughtheinterlaminarfracturetoughnessofalaminatedoesnotappeartovarywithspecimen
thickness,ithasbeenshowntobesensitivetothethicknessofindividualplies.
In general, thick plies delaminate more easily and therefore decrease the interactions between
adjacentcrackedanduncrackedplies,soincreasingthetoughness.However,itisrecognisedthata
compromise can be made for other mechanical properties, such as fatigue and environmental
response.Itisgenerallywidelyrecognisedthatthickerpliesincreasethesusceptibilitytotransverse
crackingbyanincreaseinvolumeofmaterialunderstress.
47
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
33.8.3
Lay-up aspects
33.8.3.1
Stacking sequence
Whiletheeffectsofstackingsequenceonthenotchedstrengthareunclear,ithasbeenshownthat
arranging plies to encourage delaminations between shear cracks in 45 plies and adjacent load
bearing0fibres,e.g.[45,0,0]s,resultsinahighernotchedstrength.
If,however,thedelaminationissuppressed,e.g.[0,45,0]s,thentheshearcracksthatdevelopin
the 45 plies at relatively low stresses have a detrimental effect on the 0 fibres. This results in a
relativelybrittlebehaviourwiththe0fibresfailinginastepwisemanneralongthe45line.
The [45]s layups, although they are relatively weak, are notch insensitive. Large damage zones
developacrosstheentirewidthofatestspecimenresultinginacontrolled,noncatastrophicfailure.
Owing to their relative weakness in the longitudinal directional, [45]slayups are unlikely to be
used to resist tensile loads alone. However, they can be used as crackarrest strips in a laminate
containingfibresintheloadbearingdirection.
33.8.3.2
Reinforcement style
The style of reinforcement has an important effect on the notched strength. In cases where the
formationofadamagezoneislargelysuppressed,arelativelybrittlebehaviouroccurs.Changesin
plyorientationarealsoknowntoaffectthenotchedstrength.
33.9
References
33.9.1
General
[331]
J.Tomblinetal
Reviewofdamagetoleranceforcompositesandwichairframe
structures
August1999
[332]
MILHDBK17:Polymermatrixcomposites
[333]
ESAPSS03207Guidelinesforcarbonandotheradvancedmaterial
prepregprocurementspecifications;nottransferredtotheECSS
documentsystem
[334]
MBB/ERNO
Integritycontrolofcarbonfibrereinforcedplastics(CFRP)structural
elementsExecutivesummary
ESAContract4442/80/NL/AK(SC)
48
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
33.9.2
ECSS documents
[See:ECSSwebsite]
ECSSEST30series:
ECSSEST3208
ECSSEST3201
ECSSQST20
ECSSQST40
ECSSQST70
ECSSQ7071
33.9.3
Mechanical
Materials
Fracturecontrol;previouslyESAPSS
01401.
Qualityassurance
Safety
Materials,mechanicalpartsand
processes;previouslyESAPSS0170
Datafortheselectionofspace
materialsandprocesses;previously
ESAPSS01701
MIL standards
MILHDBK17
Polymermatrixcomposites
49
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34
Inspection and quality assurance
34.1
Introduction
Duringthedesignofstructures,considerationisgivenastohowtheassembliesareinspected
inordertodetectandcharacteriseanysignificantdefectsoranomalieswhichcanoccur.
Providedthatsufficientforethoughtisgiventodamagetolerantdesign,anexampleofanapproach
appliedisultrasonictestingatthepreassemblycomponentlevel,whichisthenfollowedbyvisual
inserviceinspection;aspartofpostqualificationoracceptancetesting.
34.2
34.2.1
Quality assurance
ECSSQST20 and the associated standards give details of the quality assurance system. These
requirementsaimtoguaranteethequalityandreproducibilityofthebasiccompositematerials.
34.2.1.1
Inestablishingaprocurementspecificationforcarbonandotheradvancedfibreprepreg,guidelines
areprovidedinRef.[3439].
Asaminimum,aprocurementspecificationcontains:
Basicfibreproperties,includingtype,numberandfrequencyoftest.
Basicmatrixpropertiesandchemicalcharacterisation,includingtype,numberandfrequency
oftest.
50
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Basiccompositeproperties,includingtype,numberandfrequencyoftest.
Significantparametersofthecurecycle,e.g.time,temperature,pressure.
Curedcomponentproperties,includingtype,numberandfrequencyoftest.
Inspectioncriteria,ateverystage.
Storageandhandlingconditions,throughouttheprocesses.
Thestrictapplicationandcontrolofsuchspecificationsguaranteethequalityandreproducibilityof
theproduct.Nomodificationofthespecificationismadebeforeallofthesubsequenteffectsonthe
qualityofthestructurehavebeenverified.
34.2.1.2
Aspecificqualitycontrolplanforthecompositethatensuresthenecessaryliaisonbetweendesign,
engineering,manufacturingandqualitydisciplinesisestablished.Thisplandefinestheproduction
routeandtheimportanceofanydefectslikelytooccurduringthefabricationprocess.Itisadaptable
to any special engineering requirements that arise with individual composites parts or areas as a
resultof:
Potentialfailuremodes,
Damagetoleranceandflawgrowthrequirements,
Loadings,
Inspectability,and
Localsensitivitiestomanufactureandassembly.
34.3
34.3.1
34.3.1.1
General
Anondestructiveinspection(NDI)programmeisdevelopedthatdefinesthefrequency,extentand
methodsofinspectionforincorporationintorequisitedesigndevelopmentandmaintenanceplans.
Theprogrammeincludes:
Materialprocurement,
Manufacture,[Seealso:Chapter8].
Assembly,
Operation,
Testprogrammes.
[Seealso:ECSSEST30series;ECSSEST3201forfracturecontrol]
51
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34.3.1.2
Programme approval
Thecontentsoftheprogrammearesubjecttoapproval,whichcovers:
Thenature,sizeanddistributionofdefectscoveredbyparticularinspectiontechniques,[See:
33.2fortypicaldefects].
Theabilitytoapplyintendedmethodsforeveryfracturecriticalitem,FCI,configuration.
InitialinspectionofallfinisheditemsbytheNDImethodrelevanttotheassumedinitialdefect
ordamage.NDIisperformedforthetotalitem,eventhoughonlyonelocationisanalysed.
Inspectioncanbenecessaryforlimitedlifeitems.
Verificationofthestructuralredundancyforfailsafeitemsbeforeeachflight.
PosttestNDIforallprooftesteditems.
34.3.2
Repairs
Repair procedures also need analysis and test to demonstrate that they are able to restore the
structuretoaflightworthycondition,[Seealso:Chapter41].
Repairproceduresarealsoaccompaniedbynecessaryinspectionforsubsequentoperationaluse.
34.4
Inspection
34.4.1
Basic considerations
34.4.1.1
Manufacturing
Tolimitthenumberofscrapitems,someinspectionandtestingcanbeperformedatanearlystage
of manufacture. However, some inspection or testing can be performed only on completely
assembledelements,e.g.prooftesting.
34.4.1.2
Damage
Thepossibilityofhumanintroduceddamageduringlateractivities,e.g.integrationandacceptance
testing,alsoneedstoberecognised.Thefactthatdamagecanoccurduringcheckoutandoperation
isagoodreasonfornotreducing,belowacertainlevel,thesizeofdefectsthataredetected.
34.4.1.3
Inspection techniques
Acombinationofdifferentmethodsislikelytobeneededinordertodetectallofthedefectsthatare
identifiedasintolerable,e.g.:
UltrasonicC-scanstodetectdelaminations,and
Xraytodetectgaps,foreignparticlesandseriouslevelsoffibrebreakage.
34.4.1.4
Damage tolerance
Inviewofthedifficultyofdetectingdefects,itisoftenmoreeconomictodesignaCFRPitemtoa
relatively higher damage tolerance than stated initially. This does not necessarily result in higher
52
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
massesifthenotchsensitivityofthematerialandlaminateconfigurationisevaluated,selectedand
controlledaccordingly.
34.4.1.5
Design strategy
The design strategy balances the differing requirements arising from the inevitable conflicts
between,e.g.:
Structuralperformance,
Lowmasses,
Sensitivityofelements,
Economicmanufacturing,
Lowscrap,and
Repairrates.
Nondestructiveinspection(NDI)is,inthisrespect,asynonymforasetofcontrolactivitiestailored
toachievethenecessaryquality.
Thekeyelementsandthelevelofcontrolaredeterminedbythedesigner.
34.5
34.5.1
Procedures
34.5.1.1
General
Theinspectionproceduresaregeneratedandtheirsensitivityverified,Ref.[341].
Generalinspectionproceduresarereviewedwithrespectto:
Theirapplicability,
Theknownconstraints,
Theprovisionsnecessary,
Whetherornottheyneedtobeadaptedtoaparticularelement,
34.5.1.2
Sensitivity
Theexpectedorrequiredsensitivityisestablishedconsidering:
Limitedaccess,e.g.tocavitiesinsidestructures.
Disturbancesoftransducers,e.g.atfreeedges.
34.5.1.3
Calibration
AllNDItechniquesarecalibratedtodefinedstandardsatregularintervals,duringthe:
Verificationprogramme,and
Useofequipment,e.g.testcouponswithknownpositionsandsizesofrepresentativedefect
typesfortheitemsundertest.
53
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34.5.2
Abasicprocedureisproposed,Ref.[341],tosimplifythesituationforthethinlaminatestypically
used in spacecraft, e.g. less than 2 mm thick, such as shells or facings of sandwich panels. This
comprisesof:
a.
Defineadequatemanufacturingprocesscontrols,including:
1.
materialsensitivitytonotches,
2.
accuratelaminateconfiguration,
3.
adequatecuringprocessing.
Design the structure withanallowablestress or strain reflectinga circular hole through the
thicknessof,say,6mmdiameterandacirculardelaminationof,say,12mmdiameter.
c.
Select NDI methods, procedures and criteria capable of reliably detecting defects of the
selectedsizes,evenifsurfacedefectsconsistofscratchesthroughoneplyonlywithalength
oftheassumedhole.
d.
Considertheneedsfortheinspectionofjointsseparately,e.g.holesandadhesivebonds.
e.
Acceptallhardwareinspectedandfoundwithoutindicationsunderthedefinedcondition.
f.
Wheredeviationsarepresent,assessalloccurrenceswhichexceedthesetcriteriacasebycase
byapplyingestablishednonconformanceprocedures.
34.5.3
Thickerlaminates,e.g.greaterthan2mmthick,needspecialconsideration,astheyusuallydonot
complywiththeassumptionofathroughthethicknessholeenvelopingtheactualdefect.
Thick composites imply the presence of high loads and multiple lamina. Inspection techniques
capableofdetectingdefectsatalldepthswithinthecompositeareused.
54
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34.6
34.6.1
Introduction
Nondestructivetesting,NDT,hasanimportantroleintheapplicationofcompositesandadvanced
materials to space structures, Ref. [342], [343]. Initially, the development of NDT techniques was
driven by the need to detect defects and anomalies in new materials, such as CFRP. This was
influenced by uncertainty as to the significance of defects in structures and a wish to detect all
identifiable features. With a better understanding of material capabilities, further development of
NDTtechniquesisaimedatthosedefectsknowntobesignificantinstructuralintegrity.
NDT technologies are closely associated with the demands of aircraft inspection, Ref. [344]. The
spaceindustrybenefitsfromthisbymodifyingtechniquestosuittheneedsofspaceprogrammes,be
itforlaunchers,satellites,spacestationsorspaceplanes,Ref.[345].
Thereisonerulewhichappliestoallaerospaceprojects:
All structures should be designed and manufactured in such a way that they
can be inspected, both during production and once assembled.
34.6.2
Inadamagetolerantapproach,flawsareassumedtoexistinfracturecriticalcomponents.Aspartof
thisapproach,factorstobeevaluatedinclude:
Thecriticalflawsizethatresultsinfailureofacomponentwhensubjectedtoknownservice
stressandtemperatureconditions.
Thegrowthrateofsubcriticalcracksandconsequentlythetimethatacomponentcontaininga
subcriticalflawcanoperatesafelyinservice.
The inspection performed to detect defects before catastrophic failure of the component
occurs.
The assumed initial flaw size is based on the intrinsic material flaw size distribution and the
manufacturinginspectioncapability.Formanufacturing,aninspectionreliabilityof90%probability
ofdetection(POD)atthelowerbound95%confidencelevelisgenerallyacceptedfortheassumed
flaw sizes. These flaw sizes are intended to represent the maximum size of damage that can be
presentinacriticallocationaftermanufactureandinspection,Ref.[342].
34.6.3
Advances in NDT
It is widely accepted that more than one NDT technique is needed to detect all possible defects,
anomaliesanddamagepresentwithinanassembledstructure.
55
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Tocontrolinspectioncosts,itisprudenttousethesmallestnumberofNDTtechniquesnecessaryto
detectcriticaldefects.Greateremphasisisplacedonusingrapid,automatedinspectionsystems.The
moretraditionalultrasonic,radiographicandholographictechniquesarenowbeingcomplemented
bynewertechnologies,suchaslaserbasedultrasonicsorshearographyandcomputertomography.
DevelopmentinNDTisdrivenby:
Availabilityofcheap,powerfulcomputers,
Digitalsignalprocessing,
Imageenhancementtechniques,
Realtimeimageprocessingandpresentation,
Needforlargeareascanningsystems,e.g.forageingaircraft,
Rapidinspectionofaircrafttosavecosts.
Theadvantagesgainedfromthenewdevelopmentsinclude:
Systemautomationandimageprocessing.
Noncontactandnoninvasiveinspection,[Seealso:34.10].
Inspectionofthicksectioncomposites.
Highresolutiontechniquesforpolymer,metalandceramicmatrixcomposites.
Increasedavailabilityofpowerful,portableinspectionsystems.
Automated systems can reduce inspection costs by reducing inspection time and operator
intervention. This applies when the test requirements and sequence has been established and
verifiedforeachitemorstructure,Ref.[3491].
34.6.4
Techniques
34.6.4.1
General
Thereisnowawiderangeofinspectionsystemsbasedonavarietyofprinciples;eachperformsa
differentfunction.Inbroadterms,thetechniquescanbegroupedasbeingapplicableto(someNDT
methodscanbeappliedinbothgroups):
laboratory (L) and production (P) environments for the examination of components and
assembledstructures.
inservice(S)environmentsfortheexaminationoffullyassembledstructures.
34.6.4.2
Forcomponentandassembledstructures,thetechniquesavailableinclude:
C-scanultrasonics,bothconventionalandaircoupled,[See:34.10].
Holography,[See:34.13].
Radiography,[See:34.16].
Computertomography,[See:34.17].
56
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Lasershearography,[See:34.14].
Thermography,[See:34.15].
34.6.4.3
Thetechniquesforfullyassembledstructuresinclude:
Portableconventionalandaircoupledultrasonics,[See:34.10].
Eddycurrents,[See:34.18].
Lasershearography,[See:34.14].
Thermography,[See:34.15].
34.6.4.4
Other techniques
Techniquesthatprovideasupportingroleinclude:
Visualinspection,[See:34.9].
Cointapping,[See:34.9].
Dyepenetrants,[See:34.9].
Resonancebondtesters,[See:34.9].
Acousticflawdetectors,[Seealso:34.20]
Acousticemission,[See:34.11].
34.6.5
Easyaccesstocomputingpowerinitiatedthedevelopmentofinspectionsystemsthatareintegrated
into structures to provide continual monitoring of the thermal and strain responses.Such systems
areequallyapplicabletoinservicedamagedetection.
[Seealso:Chapter92forpotentialspaceapplicationsofsmarttechnologies]
34.7
34.7.1
General
NDIcanbeappliedatanytimetoassesstheconditionofacomponent,assemblyorstructure,Ref.
[346],[347].Factorstoconsiderinclude:
New composite mouldings are assessed against quality standards that aim to establish
acceptance levels for anomalies, such as voidage, resin content, fibre misalignment and
rucking,presenceofforeignbodies,microcrackingandmissingplies.
57
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Sandwich panel constructions and cocuring give rise to greater complexity from a single
mouldingcyclewiththepossibilityforawiderangeofdefectstooccur,includingcoretoskin
disbonds.
Inserviceinspectionismainlyrelatedtoestablishingthepresenceofsignificantdefects,such
asimpactdamage,delaminations,fibrebreakage,disbonds,moistureuptake,waterretention
inhoneycombs.
Inserviceinspectionisonlyappropriatetosomespacestructures.DevelopmentsinNDTaremainly
associatedwithinspectingaircraft.
34.7.2
Missingormisplacedmaterialsandsubcomponents,
Disbondsanddelaminations,
Integrityoffixingpointsaroundfastenersandinserts,
Damagefromlowenergyimpacts,between0.5Jand10.0Jtypically,whichcancausebarely
visibleimpactdamage(BVID),Ref.[348].
Wherefeasible,apreferenceisgiventotheuseofnoncontactNDTtechniquesinsteadofthemore
traditionalmethods,Ref.[349].
34.8
34.8.1
Numeroustechniquesareusedfortheinspectionofmaterials,componentsandstructures,Ref.[34
3],[344],[346],[347],[349].
FactorsinvolvedintheselectionofanappropriateNDTtechniqueinclude:
Application:Laboratory,productionorinservice.
Materialstobeinspected.
Componentorstructuredimensionsandgeometry.
Accessibilitytoareatobeinspected.
Abilitytodetectacertaintypeofdefect.
Sensitivitytodefectsize.
Availabilityofreliableequipmentandresources.
Recordingandunderstandingofresults.
58
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Equipmentcost.
Inspectionspeed,hencecost.
OwingtoalackofstandardisationofNDTtechniques,itiscustomaryforcompositemanufacturers
toselectatechniqueandproveitsacceptabilityforeachcomponentorstructureproduced;provided
thatthedesignhasstipulatedtheinspectionrequirements.
NDI methods which have been applied to aerospace materials and structures are described. The
basic techniques, e.g. ultrasonics, holography and Xray, have been used successfully for many
years. The physical recording media, e.g. film, has evolved to electronic data storage and
manipulation.
34.8.2
Detection of defects
34.8.2.1
General
BasicguidelinesonwhichNDTtechniquescandetectwhichspecifictypeofanomalyordefectare
givenfor:
Manufacturing,assemblyandpayloadintegration,using:
contactmethodsinTable34.8.1
noncontactmethodsinTable34.8.2
Inserviceforlonglifestructures,using:
contactmethodsinTable34.8.3
noncontactmethodsinTable34.8.4
59
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table34.81DetectionofmanufacturingdefectsbycontactNDTtechniques
Defect
Porosity
Prepreg
gaps
Contaminat
ion (solid)
Contaminat
ion
(backing
sheet)
Visual
Inspection
Only
possible on
outer
surface
Successful
on outer
surface
Successful
on outer
surface
Detection
only
possible in
thin
laminates
Tap Test
Ultrasonic
C-Scan
Acoustic
Flaw
Detector
Fokker
Bond
Tester
Eddy
Current
s
Acoustic
Emissio
n
NS
Successful
NS
NS
NS
NS
NS
Successful
NS
NS
NS
NS
NS
Success is
particle size
dependent
NS
NS
Only if
metallic
NS
Detection
only
possible in
thin
laminates
Successful
Successful
Successful
NS
NS
NS
NS
Detection
Possible
NS
Fibre
alignment
lay-up
order
Detection
on outer
surface
NS
Detection of
lay-up order
possible
using pulse
echo
Fibre/resin
ratio
variations
NS
NS
Detection
possible
NS
NS
Detection
Possible
NS
Prepreg
joints
Interply
delaminati
ons
Microcrack
ing
Skin to
core
debonding
Successful
on outer
surface
Possible on
thin
laminates
NS
Detection in
thin
laminates
NS
NS
Detection
Possible
NS
Possible on
thin
laminates
Successful
Good
detection
Good
detection
NS
Detection
Possible
NS
NS
Detection
Possible
NS
NS
NS
Detection
Possible
Outer
surface
disturbance
can be
visible
Successful
for thin
skins
Successful
Good
detection
Good
detection
NS
Detection
Possible
60
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table34.82DetectionofmanufacturingdefectsbynoncontactNDTtechniques
Defect
X-ray
Radiography
Holography
Porosity
Successful
Prepreg gaps
Successful
Contamination (solid)
Successful
NS
Successful,
mainly on
thin
laminates
NS
Contamination (backing
sheet)
Not suitable
Successful
Successful
Detection
possible
Detection
possible
Prepreg joints
Thermography
Laser
Ultrasonics
Air-coupled
Ultrasonics
(1) (2)
Computer
Tomography
Laser
Shearograph
y
NS
NS
NS
Successful(1)
Successful
NS
NS
Detection
Possible(1)
Successful
Detection
possible on
thin laminates
NS
Possible
detection in thin
laminates
NS
? (1)
Successful
NS
Detection
Possible
? (1)
Detection
Probable
Detection
Possible
NS
NS
NS(1)
Successful
Detection
Possible
NS
NS
NS
? (1)
Detection
Possible
NS
Successful
Detection in
thin
laminates
Detection
Possible
NS
? (1)
Successful
Interply delaminations
NS
Successful
Detection
Probable
Detection
Possible
Successful(1)
Detection
Probable
Detection
possible on
thin laminates
Detection
Probable
Microcracking
On edges with
penetrant
enhancement
NS
NS
NS
Detection
Possible(1)
NS
NS
NS
Successful
Detection
Probable
Detection
Possible
Successful(1)
Detection
Probable
Detection
Probable
Fibre alignment
lay-up order
Fibre/resin ratio
variations
61
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table34.83DetectionofinservicedamagebycontactNDTtechniques
Acoustic
Fokker
Visual
Ultrasonic
Defect
Tap Test
Flaw
Bond
Inspection
C-Scan
Detector
Tester
Detection
Matrix Microcracking
NS
NS
NS
NS
Possible
Only on
Possible if
Delaminations
Successful
Successful
Successful
surface
severe
Detection
Only on
Broken Fibres
NS
NS
NS
surface
Possible
Detection
Possible if
Crushed Core
NS
NS
NS
severe
Possible
Possible if
Possible if
Skin:Core Debonding
Successful
Successful
Successful
severe
severe
Possible if
Possible if
Skin Debonding
Successful
Successful
Successful
severe
severe
Water in sandwich
Detection
NS
NS
NS
NS
panels
Possible
Key: NS - Not Successful.
Eddy
Currents
Acoustic
Emission
Only if
Severe
Detection
Possible
Detection
Possible
Detection
Possible
Detection
Possible
NS
NS
NS
NS
NS
Detection
Possible
NS
NS
NS
62
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table34.84DetectionofinservicedamagebynoncontactNDTtechniques
Defect
Matrix
Microcracking
Delaminations
Broken Fibres
X-ray
Radiography
Possible on
edges with
penetrant
Detection
Possible
Detection
Probable
Crushed Core
Successful
Skin:Core
Debonding
Detection
Possible
Detection
Possible
Skin Debonding
Water in Sandwich
Panels
Successful
Holography
Thermography
Laser
Ultrasonics
Air-coupled
Ultrasonics(1)
Computer
Tomography
(if available)
Laser
Shearography
NS
NS
NS
Detection
Possible
NS
NS
Detection
Probable
Detection
Possible
Detection
Possible
Detection
Possible
Detection
Possible
Successful
Detection
Probable
Detection
Possible if severe
NS
Detection
Possible
Successful
Detection
Probable
Detection
Probable
Detection
Possible
Detection
Possible
Successful
NS
Successful
Detection
Possible
Detection
Possible if
severe
Successful
Successful
Detection
Possible
Successful
Successful
Detection
Possible
Detection
Probable
Detection
Probable
Successful
Detection
Probable
Detection
Possible
Detection
Possible if
severe
Detection
Probable
Detection
Probable
Detection
Possible
63
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
The size and shape of defects detectable by a particular technique depend on the nature of the
materials under test, the structural configurations and the equipment used, e.g. probe type, test
frequency, resolution of the scanning mechanism and recording media. It is therefore impossible to
statedefinitedetectionlimitsforaparticularNDItechniquebecauseeachisapplicationdependant.
34.8.2.2
Contact methods are those techniques where there is a physical interaction with the component or
structurebeinginspected.Thisincludes:
Humancontactwiththestructureduringinspection.
Manualoperationofprobes.
Useofwaterorgelcouplants,includingwaterimmersion.
Rollerprobes.
Directmechanicalloading,asinacousticemission.
Applicationofsurfacecoatingsorpenetrantstohighlightdefects.
Any contact with a material introduces the possibility of contamination, which is undesirable for
spacepayloads.Noncontacttechniquestendtolimitcontaminationsources.
Those techniques reliant on manual operation can introduce uncertainties regarding operator
consistency and possible error. If human judgement is used to interpret the significance of a signal
reading,thiscandifferbetweenindividuals.Tolimitanysuchinconsistencies,operatorsareprovided
withtrainingtoparticularindustrystandards.
Automatedsystemsaimtoovercomeanyhumanoperatorrelatedinconsistencies.Theytendtoneed
extensivesetupandfinetuningbyqualifiedengineersinordertoprovidesufficientconfidenceinthe
results produced, especially when compared with manual techniques. It is also not uncommon for
newautomaticsystemstoproducelargenumbersoffalseindicationsduringthesetupphase.
Electronicstorageoftheinformationobtainedduringinspectionenablessignaldataandimagestobe
compared or enhanced when specific features are being addressed. Historical comparisons are also
feasiblebetweencomponentsmadeatdifferenttimes.Suchrequirementstendtofavournoncontact
techniques, where the object can be scanned and rotated during examination to show different
orientations.
[Seealso:34.9Contacttechniques;34.10Ultrasonicaircoupledtechniques]
64
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34.9
34.9.1
General
Eachtechniqueiscodedassuitableforapplicationinthelaboratory[L],duringproduction[P]orin
service[S]duringtheperiodicreexaminationofacomponentorstructure.
34.9.2
Visual inspection
VisualinspectionistheoldestandmosteconomicalformofNDT.Itiswidelyusedforlocatingdefects
anddamageon,ornear,thesurfacesofmaterialsorcomponents.Somelevelofcontactisnecessary,
e.g.bytheinspectortouchingtheitem,althoughnoadditionalchemicalsubstancesareused.
It enables a rapid survey of large areas, or a detailed examination of small areas using optical aids
suchasmagnifyinglenses,borescopesandendoscopes.Visualinspectioncanbefollowedbyanother
typeofNDTinspectiontoquantifythesizeofasubsurfacedefect.
Application:[L,PandS]Contactornoncontact.
34.9.3
Dye penetrant
In this technique a liquid dye is applied to the component surface, and is trapped by any surface
breaking defects. The component is then cleaned, but some of the dye is retained in the defects
present.Thisisthenabsorbedbyadevelopingagenttoproduceacontrastingstainwhichindicates
thepositionofadefect.DyescanbecolouredorfluorescentunderUVlight.
Application:[L,PandS]Contact.
34.9.4
Magnetic particle
A magnetic field is generated in the component. Any surface defects or nearsurface cause field
leakage and preferentially attract the applied magnetic particles. The particles are normally in the
formofasuspensionofmagneticironoxidepowderinahydrocarboncarrierfluid.Themagneticfield
isinducedbymagnetsorappliedfluxorcurrent.Ingeneral,defectsareorientedacrossthemagnetic
field to be detectable, with subsurface defects detectable if their size and position is sufficient to
disturbthefield.
Application:[L,PandS]Contact.
34.9.5
Thetypesoftechniquesthatcanbeclassedasmechanicalresonanceorimpedanceinclude:
Taptestingisoftenconductedalongwithvisualexaminations.Componentsaretappedwitha
coin or special hammer. Variations in sound (resonance) between good and bad areas are
usually detected by the operator hearing the differences. Tap tests have a rather limited
sensitivity, but can detect fairly large delaminations under the right conditions. It is also
difficult to assess which areas have or have not been tested, given a particular area to be
screened.
65
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Bond testers measure mechanical impedance under high frequency oscillation. It compares
goodwithbadareas,providingdataonthecohesive,butnottheadhesive,natureofthebond;
exceptintheextremecaseofnoadhesion,[See:34.20].
Acousticflawdetectorsworkonasimilarprincipletobondtesters.
Application:[L,PandS]Contact.
34.10
Ultrasonic techniques
34.10.1 Introduction
34.10.1.1 General
Therearealargenumberoftechniquesknowngenerallyasultrasonicwhichcanbeappliedinthe
laboratory, in production and inservice. Each has their strengths and weaknesses, so for any given
circumstancesonecanbemoreappropriatethantheothers.
Mosttechniquesinvolvesomecontactwiththecomponentorstructure,butaircoupledsystemsaim
toavoidcontaminationofcomposite,spacedestinedstructuresbywaterorgelbasedcouplants.This
noncontacttechniquewasevaluatedbyAleniaforCFRP,Ref.[3494],andwasselectedbyFokkerto
inspectsolarpanelsubstrates,Ref.[3491].
Ultrasonic testing uses highfrequency sound waves; often in the kHz to MHz range. The sound
energy is reflected or scattered by defects lying within the sound path. The principal relies on
transducers,or probes, toemit and receive sound.The orientation of transducers in relation to both
thestructureandthedefectsdetermineswhichfeaturesaredetectedandresolved.Thepresentationof
signalresponsesinCscanformrepresentsthebaselinemeansofexaminingmaterials.Ithasbecome
theacceptedmeansofinspectingcompositesowingtoitsversatilityindetectingdefects,Ref.[343],
[3410].
ConventionalCscanultrasonicsisbynomeansanidealmethodasitneedsacontactpathbetween
thetransducerandthecomponentundertest,usuallyachievedbyuseofliquidcouplant.Toinspect
largeareas,theprobesaregenerallymovedusingamechanicalscanningdevice.Thiscanbelargeand
complexinordertoinspectcontouredsectionsofaircraftmadefromcomposites,Ref.[3495].
As the name suggests, aircoupled ultrasonics do not use couplants, but rely on air transmission
betweentheprobesandthecomponentundertesttobothsendandreceivetheultrasound.
bulkwaves(planeorspherical),e.g.longitudinalwaves
transversebulkwaves,e.g.shearordistortionalwaves
66
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
surfaceeffectsnearaboundary,e.g.Rayleighwaves.
plateeffects(inamediumwithtwoparallelboundaries,i.e.alaminate),e.g.Lambwaves,Ref.
[3411],[3412].
Throughtransmission(T-T);usingtwotransducersplacedonoppositesidesofthecomponent.
Onetransducersendstheultrasonicpulse,theotherreceivesit.
Pulseecho (P-E); using one transducer placed normally (longitudinal waves) or at a selected
angle (shear waves) on the component surface. This single transducer both sends and then
receivestheultrasonicpulse.Sometechniquesalsouseareflectorplateplacedonthebackface
ofthecomponent.
ThesemodesarethebasisforthewellestablishedandprovenformsofultrasonicNDT.
Acouplantmediumisnormallyusedtoensureagoodacousticpathbetweenthetransducersandthe
component. Alternatively the component and transducers are completely immersed in a suitable
couplingliquid,e.g.water.
A-scan:Asinglepointsignaldescribingtheultrasonicresponseofmaterialimmediatelybeneath
thetransducer.
B-scan:Ascannedlineshowingfeaturesatidentifiabledepths.
C-scan:Anareascanshowingvolumetricdefectsinthematerial.
Imagepresentation:
Lookuptablesandcolourcoding.
Imagereversal.
Greyscalerampingorsawtoothscaling.
Isometricprojection.
3Dimaging.
Binarydisplayimaging.
67
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Imagehistogramevaluation:
Imageenhancement.
Equalisationenhancement.
Logarithmicforcingfunctions.
Windowingandlevelslicing.
Subareaevaluation.
Kernelmultiplications:
Loworhighpassfilteringandsmoothing.
Selectiveorientationfilteringandshadowing.
TwodimensionalFourieranalysis:
Fibreorientationdistribution.
Effectsofpixelsizes.
Imageenlargement.
Maskmultiplicationfiltering.
Fullvolumeimaging:
3Ddatabases.
Peakamplitudeimages.
Integratedamplitudeimages.
Statisticalimaging.
Frequencydomainimaging.
3Dpresentation.
Data processing is not only useful forultrasonics but is equallyapplicable toother NDT techniques
producingdigitaldata.
68
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
XYZscanningframesfor:
smallindividualcomponents
largeaircraftsections,Ref.[3495].
XYscanningframesforflatpanels.
Programmableroboticsforrepetitivetesting.
Thetypesoftransducersusedinclude:
Rollerprobesformainlyflatconstructions.
Waterjetprobesforshapedmouldingswithcutouts,Ref.[3495].
Aircoupled probes for CFRP composites and solar panel substrates, Ref. [3491], [3492], [34
94].
To reduce the time to inspect large areas, such asaircraft, portablescanning systemsarenow being
introduced, Ref. [3415], [3416]. Examples include LACIS large area composite inspection system
andMAUSmobileautomatedultrasonicscanner.Themainfeaturesoftheseare:
Use in pulseecho (depth and amplitude), ultrasonicresonance and eddycurrent modes, i.e.
interchangeable.
Multipletransducers,givingstripcoverageviasimpleoscillatorymotionofeachtransducer.
Portable,wheeledscannerwithautomatictransduceralignmentforcontourfollowing.
Manualoperationofscanner.
Waterdropcoupling.
AutomateddatacollectionandenhancedCscanimagingthroughalaptopcomputer.
Scanratesofupto9m2perhour.
The LACIS or MAUS derivatives are used principally for detecting impact damage and bondline
defects.
34.10.7 Acousto-ultrasonics
Also known as the stresswave factor method (SWF), acoustoultrasonics uses stochastic wave
propagation to detect and quantify defect states, damage conditions and variations of mechanical
propertieswithincomposites,Ref.[3410].
Itisnotnecessarilyintendedtoresolveeachindividualflaw,butinstead,toassessthecollectiveeffect
of diffuse flaw populations. Accordingly, the SWF approach was devised to evaluate the integrated
defect state due to porosity, matrix crazing, fatigue damage, fibre bunching, fibre breaks, resin
richness,poorcuringorpoorfibretomatrixbonding.
69
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
SWF can be described as a generalised approach to ultrasonic testing using two probes (transmitter
and receiver). The received signal is a result of multiple interactions within the material
microstructure,i.e.multiple,reflected,scatteredandmodeconvertedwaves.
Signal interpretationisall important.With sufficient correlation with measured properties from test
coupons,itisindicatedthatSWFiscapableofquantifyingresidualultimatetensilestrengthoffatigue
damagedcomposites,interlaminarshearstressandadhesivebondstrength.
strongsensitivitytothematerialproperties,
thicknessesoftheadherends,
relativeinsensitivitytodefectsatthebondlinelayer.
Embedded modes, which propagate along an embedded layer, are largely insensitive to the
adherends. The dispersion curves show a major improvement in sensitivity to the properties of the
layerandtotheboundaryconditionsbetweenlayerandtheadherends.Thedifficultyistogenerate
thesespecificmodes,socurrentapplicationsarelimitedtohomogeneousandisotropicmaterials,e.g.
adhesive bonding with thin metallic plates or glass. Although attempts have been made with
compositematerials,thetechniqueremainsalaboratoryresearchtool.Asignificanteffortisneededto
modelthephenomenatoaccountforvariationsinmaterialpropertiesinordertomeetindustryneeds.
Conventionalmethodsofexcitinganddetectingguidedwavesincludetheangleincidencetechnique,
interdigitaltransducers(IDTs)andEMATs.
70
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Inthistechnique,accesstothecompositeisonlyneededfromoneface.Forthickcomposites,e.g.30
plyCFRP,itcanbedifficulttoresolvedelaminationsinthefirstfewplies.Byusingatransmitterand
receiver, 10mm apart, it is feasible to detect nearfield, subsurface defects, Ref. [3411]. The basic
equipment used can be the same as that used in normal contact pulseecho mode. This can be a
commercialbroadbandprobewithadigitalultrasonicflawdetector.
The utilisation of Lamb waves is seen as a lowcost means of inspecting large structures for
delaminations,Ref.[3418].Byplacingatransmitterandreceiveradjacenttoeachotheronthesurface
ofacomposite,itisfeasibletodetectdefectsbycomparingoutgoingandreflectedsignals,asshownin
Figure34.10.1,Ref.[3412].Thetransmitterandreceiverarelocatedatapoint,buthavetheabilityto
inspect the surrounding composite when rotated or line scanned. It is possible to detect 20mm
delaminationsatadistanceofupto500mm.
Figure34.101LeakyLambwavetechniqueforcomposites
71
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure34.102Detectionoffibreorientationbybackscatteringmeasurement
General
Transducers, or probes, emit the ultrasonic waves into the subject material or receive the resulting
signal.Insomesystemstheprobescanperformbothfunctions.Theactiveelementwithinaprobeis
usually made of a piezoelectric ceramic or polymer (PVdF). The dimensions of the piezoelectric
elementlargelydefinetheeffectivefrequencyrangeofthetransducer,althoughtheactualoperating
frequency is determined by the signal from the driving electronics. Transducers generally have a
stated frequency value, giving their optimum sensitivity and the centre of their effective frequency
range.
Someofthetransducerandappliedsignalvariableswhichdifferbetweentestingtechniquesinclude:
Focusedorunfocusedprobes.
Ultrasoundfrequency:
selectedwithrespecttomaterial,defectsizeanddefectlocation.
highfrequenciesforbetterdefectresolution.
lowfrequenciesforlowsignalattenuation.
Probealignmenttosurface:
normal,
angled,or
oblique.
Signalpulseprofile:
wavetrain(pulse)duration,
signalenergy.
Modeofoperation,e.g.pulseecho,throughtransmission.
72
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34.10.11.2
Phased-array transducers
Piezocompositematerialshaveprovidedanewultrasoundprobetechnologyforthenondestructive
testing of materials; known as Phasedarray transducers. The probes comprise a large number of
individualelementseachofwhichcanbedrivenindependently.Thetransducerelementsareusually
organisedinlinear,annular,circularormatrixarrays,asshowninFigure34.10.3.
Phasedarray transducers can be used with conventional coupling agents (gel, water) either as a
contactoranimmersionconfiguration.Intheory,alltheapplicationsusingultrasoundtechniquescan
usephasedarrayprobes.
Figure34.103Phasedarraytransducers:Elementconfigurations
The probes are connected to speciallyadapted drive units enabling independent, simultaneous
emissionandreceptiononeachchannel.Theunitsalsoenabledifferentelectronictimedelaysforeach
channelduringbothemissionandreception.Electronicscanning,focusinganddeflectioncanthenbe
carriedout;asshownschematicallyinFigure34.10.4,Ref.[34101].
Theoretically,alltheapplicationsusingultrasoundtechniquescanusephasedarrayprobes.
Incomparisontoclassicalultrasonictechniques,themainadvantagesofphasedarrayprobesarethe
improvementofinspectionperformances,thereductionofinspectiondelays,andthepossibilityofa
completeinspectionofaniteminonescan.Theconventionalmechanicalscanningisreplacedbythe
much faster electronic scanning (advantage for large structures). Electronic scanning in depth can
becomeinterestingforstructuresoflargethickness.Moreover,electronicfocusingenablestheuseofa
single probe for working at different depths. The electronic focussing can be advantageous for
structuresincludingheterogeneitiesofsmalldimensionstoo.Recentinvestigationshaverevealedthe
capabilityofsuchsensorstodetectfibrewaving.
Electronicdeflectionenablestheangleofincidencetobevariedwithasingleprobegivingaccessto
particular,inaccessibleareasandfacilitatinginspectionofstructureswithcomplexshape.
73
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Electronic scanning
Groups of elements are sequentially
activated to move the beam along the
transducer (with electronic delays to
focus the group).
Electronic focusing
Electronic delays are applied to each
element to focus the beam.
Electronic deflection
Electronic delays are applied to each
element to deflect the beam
Figure34.104Phasedarraytransducers:Functionality
Advanced functions of ultrasonic phasedarrays are emerging for the nondestructive testing of
aeronautic parts, increasing further thepotential benefits of the technology, e.g. for emission: multi
beam generation; for reception: differentiated sum of elementary signals, for emissionreception:
iterativeprocess.
Currently available phasedarray transducers are expensive, mainly because MHzorder frequencies
imply tight tolerances and high manufacturing precision. Ongoing work aims to develop cheaper,
lowfrequencyphasedarraysystemsfordamagedetectioninaircraftstructures.
Theinitialapplicationsofultrasonicphasedarrayprobeswereforcomplexshapedstructures(areas
with difficult access) and in the metallurgic field (to reduce control delay by electronic scanning).
NASA,McDonnellDouglasandBoeingSpacehaveusedphasedarraytechnologyfortheinspection
ofweldedspacestructures,e.g.frictionstirwelds(DeltaIVtank)andlaserwelds.Thetechnologyhas
beenappliedsuccessfullytolargeaeronauticstructuresmadeofcompositematerialsandhoneycomb
parts(industrialisationofthephasedarraysystem).
SomeexamplesofthesuccessfulapplicationsofphasedarraytechnologywithintheEuropeinclude
NDToflaserbeamweldingofskinstiffenersforthefuselageofAirbusA318(StNazaire)andforthe
inspectionofcompositepartsofAirbusA380(Nantes).
74
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
General
Theuseofliquidcouplantshastraditionallybeennecessarybecauseofthesoundsignalattenuation
caused by air at high frequencies, e.g. MHzrange. Strong reflections at the interfaces between
transducertoairandairtomaterialundertestproduceveryweaktransmittedsignals.Advancesin
acoustic transducer matchingtoair technology in combination with tone burst excitation offer the
opportunityforaircoupledultrasonics,Ref.[3421],[3492].
Aircoupled ultrasonic techniques have become reliable and useful methods for noncontact non
destructivetesting.
34.10.12.2
Applications
Numerous cases exist where coupling agents, such as water, gels, grease, glycerine, are either
prohibited or not desirable, e.g. green powders, uncured polymers, solar panel sandwich supports,
some thermal protection systems sensitive to water ingress, rough surfaces, nonflat surfaces and
porousmaterials,suchasceramicsandcarbon/carboncomposites.
Noncontact transducers have been used for quantitative and qualitative ultrasonic evaluation of a
wide range of materials, including, Ref. [3496], particulate and fibrous multilayer composites,
includingprepregs;compositehoneycombstructures;ceramics(greenandsintered);metal(powder
based);rubbersandplastics.
34.10.12.3
75
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
TWO-SIDED INSPECTION
Figure34.105Noncontactultrasonics:Aircoupledsensorconfigurations
A broad range of frequencies, typically from 50 kHz to 5 MHz, are possible using different sensor
technologies: piezoceramic, piezocomposite or capacitive transducers, Ref. [3497]. Some of them
provideimprovedfocussingwhichgivesbetterresolution.
Capacitivetype transducers, characterised by high bandwidths, have been used to evaluate
compositesandothermaterials.Theyhavebeensuccessfullyusedforthegenerationanddetectionof
guidedwavesinanisotropicviscoelasticmaterialsinanoncontactmode;asshowninFigure34.10.6,
Ref.[3498].
76
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure34.106Noncontactultrasonics:Capacitivesensorsinplatewave
configurationsetup
Althoughtheapplicationsfornoncontacttransducersatfrequenciesabove3MHzinambientairare
limited, transducers between 200kHz to 3MHz have been used for several applications, including
space,aeronauticalandmedicalindustries.
The availability of various frequencies and digital filters enable an optimisation between high
resolutionforcompositesandhoneycombs,e.g.0.5MHzto1MHz,andhighpenetrationformaterials
suchasfoam,rubberandwood(20kHzto200kHz).
34.10.12.4 Airscansolarpanelsubstrates
Airscan, a commercial system from QMI (USA), operates in throughtransmission or singlesided
inspection (via Lamb waves). It has been evaluated for CFRP structures, some of which contain
highlyattenuativematerials,suchashoneycombsandfoams,Ref.[3494].
Someofthefeaturesofthesysteminclude:
Generaloperatingfrequencyof400kHzor50kHz,Ref.[3492],[3494],comparedwith1MHzor
higherforcontactultrasonictechniques.
Thesignalfrequencycanbealteredforthethicknessofthecomposite.
Awavetrainlikesignalconsistingofupto15sequentialpulses.
Optimisedincidentangleforthetransmittingtransducer.
Superlownoisepreamplificationofreceivedsignals.
TheAirscansystemwasvalidatedbyFokkerasameansofreducingthecostandleadtimeforNDI
ofsolarpanelsubstrates.Figure34.10.7showsaschematicdiagramoftheFokkerfacility,Ref.[3491].
77
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Qualificationtestshavebeenperformedfor:
ARA(advancedrigidarray)forcommercialgeostationarysolararrays,and
FlatpackdevelopedforEnvisat1.
Each of the sandwich panel constructions is different, notably in their aluminium core cellsize and
thickness.EachhasafurthercomplicationintheformofacocuredKaptonfilmononeoftheCFRP
skinsproviding:
Electricalinsulation(betweensolarcellandsandwich),
Protectionagainstatomicoxygen(Flatpackpanels),and
Thermalcontrol.
Skintocoredisbondsweredetectedinbothtypesofsolarpanelsubstrate,[Seealso:Table34.8.2and
Table34.8.4].ThesystemalsodetecteddelaminationsinCFRPpanels.TheresultsarepresentedinC
scanform.
Furtherstudiesaimtoassessthesuitabilityofthetechniquefortheinspectionofotherflatandcurved
items,e.g.aircraftfloorpanels,antennas,centralcylindersandelectroniccircuitboards,Ref.[3491].
Figure34.107Airscan (air-coupledultrasonics)system:NoncontactNDIof
Fokkersolarpanelsubstrates
34.11
Acoustic emission
AE,acousticemission,isacontacttechniquethatreliesonmechanicalstrainingofthecomponentor
structureundertest.AEcanbeappliedinthelaboratory,inproductionandinservice.
AEtechniquesdetectthesoundsproducedbyastructureasaresultofmechanicalloading,Ref.[343],
[3422].Thesearethenidentifiedandrelatedtocriticalevents,suchasmatrixcracking,delaminations
andfibrefailure.
78
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
DevelopmentsofAEhavemainlyconcentratedontheinterpretationofsignalsandthesignificanceof
noise emanating from stressed components and structures. For composites, some broad comments
include:
Composites under progressively increasing load produce acoustic events at strain levels well
belowtheelasticlimit.
Thepointatwhichacousticeventsbegininrelationtopreviousloadingscanbedescribedasthe
Felicityratio.
Approachingtheelasticlimit,acousticeventsoccurincreasinglyinthesequenceof:
randomlocalmatrixcracking,
transverseplyfailure,
interlaminarshearfailure,andlastly
fibrebreakage.
To enable identification of damage events during the testing or inspection of a structure, the
acoustic signature of each type needs to be known. Such signatures are often material and
structuredependent.Computerpatternrecognitionisimportant.
AE can be applied to proofloaded structures, such as pressure vessels, where the proof test is
obligatoryandhistoricaldataisavailablefromtestingnumerousitems.
Whenstructuresaretestedtoultimatefailureload,AEcanbeusedtoidentifylocaldamageoccurring
prior to final failure. Testing is generally easier with components, where the load application is
usuallysimplerandtheAEresponseeasiertointerpret.
Thetechniquehasbeenevaluatedformeasuringdensityandporosityincarboncarboncomponents,
Ref.[3423].
TheimprovedavailabilityofcheapcomputingpowerhasenabledAEtogaingreateracceptancefor
the inspection of structures. Triangulation methods, by comparison of the arrival time of the same
sound event at several different transducers, locate the positions of acoustic emission sources in
assembled structures, such as aircraft. The frequency and amplitude description of the event is
comparedwithreferencedatatodeterminethetypeofdamage.
AEhasbeenevaluatedforconditionmonitoringsystemsforreusablespacevehiclestructures,suchas
tanks,[See:92.3].
34.12
Laser ultrasonics
34.12.1 General
Laserultrasonicsarenoncontacttechniquesthatcanbeappliedinthelaboratory,inproductionand
inservice.
The development of laser ultrasonic systems was largely in response to a need for noncontact NDI
methodsfortheexaminationofassembledstructures,Ref.[3420],[3424],[3425],[3426],[3427].An
exampleofthistypeoftechniqueisLUISlaserultrasonicinspectionsystemfromGeneralDynamics,
Ref.[3427]andLockheed,Ref.[3428].
79
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Ahighpowerlaserpulseisdirectedatthesurfacetobeinspected,typicallyfromaNdYAGor
TEACO2laser.
b.
c.
Figure34.121Laserultrasonictestsystem:Diagrammaticrepresentation
Thebasicmodesofdetectionare,Ref.[3424]:
Optical heterodyning or simple interferometric detection: The wave scattered by the surface
interferes with a reference wave derived directly from the laser.This technique issensitiveto
opticalspeckleandthebestsensitivityisobtainedwhenonespeckleiseffectivelydetected.This
needs a focused beam, enabling the measurement of the ultrasonic displacement over a very
smallspot.
Theultrasoundproducedcanbeoftheusualtypes,i.e.longitudinal,shear,plateandRayleigh,Ref.
[3429]. The nature of the ultrasound generated is principally a function of the laser and material
properties,suchasthe:
Laserpulseduration,wavelengthandpulseenergy,
Laserspotsize,
80
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Thermalpropertiesofthecomposite,
Laserabsorptionpropertiesofthecomposite.
Any inspection system relies ona means of fast optical scanning of the surface to producea Cscan
image. The laser need not be orientated perpendicular to the surface and oblique angles can be
accommodated.
Featuresincompositesthathavebeendetectedusinglaserultrasonicsare,Ref.[3425],[3427]:
Surfacecracks,
Delaminations,
Additionalplies,
Skintocoredisbonds,
Solidcontaminants(backingfilm).
Itisalsopossibletodetectcracksinaluminiumalloysheet,Ref.[3429].
34.12.2.2 Disadvantages
Laserultrasonic techniques generally have a poorer signaltonoise ratio than conventional
ultrasonics,makingdefectdetectionmoreuncertain.Recentimprovementsindigitaldataprocessing
haveaidedthenecessarysignalprocessingandimageenhancementofresults.Prototypefacilitiesare
underdevelopment,Ref.[3428].
34.12.2.3 Applications
Inadditiontotheevaluationofcompositestructure,possibleapplicationsforlaserultrasonicsinclude:
Remoteexaminationforhightemperatureapplications.
Complexshapesandconfinedrecesses.
Remoteanalysisinvacuumandcorrosiveenvironments.
34.13
Holography
34.13.1 Introduction
Holography is a noncontact technique, except for direct vacuum loading that can be applied in the
laboratoryandinproduction.
Itisaprocesswherebyaholographicimageofacomponentissuperimposedonthesamepartwhileit
isstressedslightly.Stressesareinducedbyheating,loadingorvacuumwhichcausedisproportionate
outofplane displacements in defective areas. Discontinuities in the resulting interference fringe
patternscanindicatethepresenceofdefects.
Thetechniquehasbeenappliedtospacestructures,notablysatellites,fromanearlystagebecauseof
its largely noncontact mode of operation. There are now various different versions, which have
benefitedfromtheintroductionofdigitaltechnology,Ref.[3430].Holographycanbeusedtomeasure
accurately small outofplane displacements, to micronlevel resolution, which can be necessary for
antennasundergoingthermaldistortion.
81
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Interferometry,
Moir,and
Specklephotography.
When viewing the stressed object and superimposed unstressed hologram, distortion fringes are
producedwhichdifferwiththeappliedload.Insuchcases,thehologrambehavesinthesamewayas
an interferometer. Controlling the distortion yields a tool that can be used for interferometric
measurements.
The interference fringe patterns can be observed in real time or as a double exposure, where the
featuresofeachcanbesummarisedas:
Realtime:Precisealignmentofanunstressedholographicimagewiththestressedobject.These
interfere, and displacements can be detected of orders of magnitude of the wavelength of the
employedlight.Anychangeinthestateoftheobjectssurfacecausesasimultaneousalteration
ofthefringesystem,hencethetermrealtime,Ref.[3432].Thistechniquedoeshoweverneed
ahighdegreeofprecisionandvibrationcannotbetolerated.
Doubleexposure:Thisissimpler,asasingleholographicplateisusedtomaketwosuccessive
exposuresoftheobject,beforetheplateisdeveloped.Theinterferencefringesarethenfrozen
atasinglestressstateinthecombinedhologram.Theresolutionisexcellentandcanbedownto
0.2m,Ref.[3433].
82
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
AllspecklemethodshavetheadvantageoverMoirtechniquesofnotneedingagridprintedontothe
objectsurface.Electronicspecklepatterninterferometry,ESPI,isbasedonthisprinciple.
Hotairblowers,Ref.[3438].
Infraredheaters,Ref.[3432],[3433].
Itisusualtoheattheobjectandthentomonitorthecoolingstage.Thismethodcanhighlightdefects
as well as offering information on the thermal distortion of structures under simulated space
conditions,Ref. [3432],[3433].
83
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Imageplane holograms are produced by a speckle interferometer using a charge coupled device
CCDTV camera, Ref. [3434]. The information can be stored digitally for automated processing and
colourenhancement.Figure34.13.1showsthebasicconfigurationofanelectronicsystem,Ref.[3434].
Electronicimaginghasbeencriticisedfornotofferingthesameimagequalityasconventionaldouble
exposure plate photography. This is likely to change because of rapid progress of computer
enhancementandtheimprovedresolutionofimagingdevices.Nearsurfacedelaminationsof2.5mm
havebeendetected.
Figure34.131Holographybyelectronicimagingwithrandomvibration
excitation
Shearandcompressiontestsofpanelsusingelectronicspecklepatterninterferometry,ESPI.
Thermaldistortionsofantennas,Ref.[3432],[3433].
Vibrationresponseofpanelsandstructures,Ref.[3439].
34.13.5.2 Limitations
Holographic techniques can be disturbed by mechanical vibration which alters the respective
positions of the object and hologram. Consequently the object needs sufficient isolatation
mechanicallytoinhibitsuchmovement.
84
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Although early holography techniques tended to be time consuming (film technology) and costly,
imagecapture,digitalsignalprocessingandhandlinghaveimprovedgreatly.
34.14
Laser shearography
34.14.1 Introduction
Lasershearographyisanoncontacttechnique,exceptfordirectvacuumloading,thatcanbeapplied
inthelaboratory,inproductionandinservice.
Itisarelativelynewtechnique,whichissimilartoholographyandaimstoprovideameansofrapid,
realtime, largearea inspection. The advent of electronic digital image processing has motivated its
development,Ref.[3440].
Imageshearing speckle pattern interferometry, commonly known as shearography, is a fullfield
laserbased interferometric technique. Shearography measures strain fields on the surface of the
subject, i.e. measurement of outofplane surface displacement (dy/dx) of a body under load.
Measurementsensitivityaslowas0.1straincanbeachieved,Ref.[3441].Shearographybeganasan
electronictechniqueandsoavoidedtheuseofphotographicplates,Ref.[349],[3430],[3440],[3441],
[3442].
Figure34.141Electronicshearographicsystem:Schematicdiagram
Beamsplittingisperformedbytheshearingopticsinsuchawaythatadoubleimageoftheobjectis
formed by the imaging lens (usually a commercial lens) on the CCD sensor. The direction and
magnitudeoftheimageseparation,orshear,isdeterminedbytheorientationoftheshearingoptics.
85
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Thetwowavefronts,labelledasshearedandunsheared,arecoherentlyaddedintheimageplaneto
produceaspeckleinterferencepatternthatrepresentsauniquespatialsignatureofthetopographyof
the surface of the object. Loading techniques, such as thermal, vibration and vacuum pressure, can
thenbeusedtoinducesurfacedisplacement,Ref.[349].
ItcanoperateinC-scanmode.
Bothportableandfixedscanningsystemsarepossible.
Alignmenttosurfaceisnotcritical.
Itisinfluencedbysurfacereflectance.
Thedetectionresolutionbecomespoorerasthefieldofviewexpands.
Itismoreversatilethanholography,butlessaccurate.
Shearography has been used on assembled structures, such as aircraft, Space Shuttle and Atlas
Centaur.
Table34.14.1givesthetypesofdefectsdetected,Ref.[3442].
86
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table34.141Defectdetectionbyshearography
Stressing
Technique
Material
CFRP sheet
Thermal
Honeycomb sandwich
All materials
CFRP sheet
Honeycomb sandwich
Vacuum
Rubber bonded to metal or
composites
Foam core panels
Cork to metal or composites
Vibration
Microwave
34.15
Honeycomb sandwich
Foam to composite or metal
panels
Materials with high dielectric
constant
DefectTypeDetected
Delaminations
Impact damage
Some foreign material
Skin to core debonds
Crushed core
[Thermal expansion]
Impact damage
Delaminations
Porosity
Skin to core and far side
debonds
Sheared core
Crushed core
Debonds
Near surface and deep
debonds
Debonds
Skin to core debonds
Crushed core
Debonds
Entrapped moisture
Thermography
34.15.1 Introduction
Thermographyisanoncontacttechniquethatissuitableforuseinthelaboratory,inproductionand
inservice.
Allthermographytechniquesrelyonthepresenceofadefectdisturbingtheheatflowinacomponent.
Thesurfacethermaldistributionismonitoredbyinfraredcameras.Thedifferentrateatwhichradiant
energyistransmittedordiffusedtothemonitoredsurfaceproducestemperaturevariationswhichcan
indicate the presence of defects. All techniques can now benefit from digital signal processing and
realtime image display. Thermography for detection of defects and discontinuities is principally a
surfaceornearsurfacetechnique.
Thermography is a versatile concept because it is applicable to a wide range of materials and
structures,includingcompositesandmetals.Ithasalsobeenappliedtoceramicmatrixcompositesto
determinetheintegrityofoxidationresistantcoatings,Ref.[3451].Whereverheatflow,conductionor
radiationcanbeinduced,thermographyisapossibleevaluationtool.
87
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34.15.2 Techniques
34.15.2.1 General
Allthermographictechniquesaimtoestablishheatflowpatternsonthesurfacewhichcanberecorded
andexamined,Ref.[3449];byobservationandmeasurementofthethermaldiffusivityandeffusivity,
Ref.[3443].
Some systems can show the presence of significant impact delaminations over large areas, whilst
othersofferbetterresolutionovermorelimitedareas.Figure34.15.1showsthebasictechnique,Ref.
[3444].
Figure34.151Basicthermographictechnique
34.15.2.2 Real-time video thermography
Thisisageneralclassificationforalltechniquesinwhichcontoursofequaltemperature(isotherms)
are mapped over a surface. The assumption is that defects, inhomogeneities, or other undesirable
conditionsoftheobjectundertestappearaslocalhotorcoldspots.Inspectioncanbeundertaken
from one side, where delaminationtype defects appear as hot spots, or throughtransmission by
viewingthebackfacewherecoldspotsoccur.Inpractice,throughthicknessinspectionisrare.
Surface thermal distributions can be detected by contact or noncontact methods. Contact methods
includethermocouples,temperaturesensitivepaintorliquidcrystals,butthesearelessattractivethan
noncontactmethodswhichrelyuponinfraredradiationtodeterminethetemperaturedistributionof
theradiatingsource.
88
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Photoneffect devices, sensitive to the infrared wavelengths generated, are used in realtime video
thermographic camera systems that scan the entire surface very rapidly. The wavelength of the
emitted infrared radiation is related to the temperature of the emitting surface through Plancks
radiationlaw.Differentmaterialshavedifferentsurfaceemissivities.
Two 600 mm xenon flash tubes, each delivering 4 kJ over a discharge period of 6 ms giving
typically0.8J/cm,Ref.[3448].
Four xenon flash tubes (rated to 20 kJ total) in a square illuminating 300 mm x 300 mm of
surface(upto2.5J/cm),withpulseof5ms,scanningat5m/min,Ref.[3446],[3447].
Eightxenonlamps,each6kJ,with2mspulseduration,Ref.[3444].
Thermogramimagescanbetakenatintervalsfrom40msto125ms,i.e.from8persecondto25per
second.
The technology has several distinct advantages as an uptodate, noncontact technique. These
include:
Portableandcompact,withitsowndataacquisitionandimageprocessing.
Appropriate for different materials (polymers, metals and all composites) for detection of
delaminationsanddisbonds.
Capableofdetectingcorrosionofalloysandwithinbondedmetaljoints,Ref.[3443].
Photooptical, which normally have a second laser beam for the detection of thermalwave
effects;asshowninFigure34.15.2,Ref.[3449].
89
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Photothermal, which are generally used for large area inspection; as shown in Figure 34.15.3,
Ref.[3449].
Photoacoustic, which monitor pressure pulses established in closed acoustic cells by the
conduction of heatfrom the surface of the examined object in air; as shownin Figure34.15.4,
Ref.[3449].
Thermalwave techniques can be used to assess the quality of adhesive bonds and the integrity of
coatings on metal substrates. The high resolution possible using thermalwave imaging has been
demonstrated by the detection of 10m nearsurface defects in ceramics. It has also been used in a
microscopemodeforimagingmicrostructures.
Figure34.152Thermalwaveimaging:Photoopticaldetection
90
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure34.153Thermalwaveimaging:Photothermalandpiezoelectricdetection
Figure34.154Thermalwaveimaging:Photoacousticgascell
91
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34.15.2.6 Vibrothermography
This uses mechanical vibrations to setup resonance in damaged areas, leading to locally increased
dissipation of heat. Damage in surface plies is more likely to be detected than subsurface or back
surface damage because of the strong attenuation of heat conducted through the thickness of the
composite.
92
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table34.151Thermography:Summaryofdiameter/depthratiosfromdifferent
studies
Material
Aluminiu
m
Mild Steel
C-C
CFRP
GRP
Delrin
Ratio
(BestExperimental)
Ratio(Best
Quoted)
Numberof
DataPoints
RangeofDepth
ofDataPoints
0.5
1.5
4.0
1.8
-
6
5
3
10
2
4
1.0 - 5.0 mm
1.0 - 2.0 mm
1.0 - 3.2 mm
1.0 - 3.0 mm
5.0 - 7.0 mm
1.0 - 2.2 mm
Key:d=depth
Table34.152Thermography:Detectionlevelsestablishedforflatbottomedholes
(FBH)fromESTECstudy
DepthofFBH
(mm)
Min.Diameter
Detectable(mm)
Diameter/
DepthRatio
PulseRequired
(kJ)
Temperature
Window(C)
1, 2 or 4
4
4
4, 6, 15
4, 6
4
1, 2 or 4
1, 2 or 4
2 or 4
4, 6, 15
4, 6, 15
4, 6
4
4
4
4
4, 6
4
4
4
MildSteel
0.5
1.0
2.0
2.0
2.0
4.0
4.0
2.0
2.0
Aluminium
0.5
1.0
2.0
4.0
4.0
8.0
8.0
4.0
4.0
CarbonCarbon
1.0
2.0
3.0
4.0
4.0
4.0
6.0
6.0
4.0
2.0
2.0
1.5
93
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
airgaps(delaminations)whichhaveverypoorthermalconductivity,whereasasolidinclusion,such
as plastic film, does not respond in an acceptable manner because the local thermal conductivity
remainsfairlyhigh.Forthisreason,flatbottomedholes,FBH,drilledfromthebackfaceareusedto
establishthedetectioncapabilitiesofthermographyfordifferentmaterials.Detectionlevelsarethen
defined by a diameter to depth ratio; where diameter is the hole diameter and depth is the
maximum subsurface distance from the inspection face at which the bottom of the hole can be
detected,Ref.[3443].
When a comparison is made of the results from different studies over a period of 10 years, a
considerabledegreeofscatterisevidentintheclaimsfordetectionlevels,ratiosofdiameter/depth,in
differentmaterials,Ref.[3448].Inconsistenciescanbeattributedtovariationsinmaterials,heatpulse
energyordurationandtheefficiencyofdetectionsystems.
Thermography is continually improving, but a point has been reached where the best techniques
availableneedtobeevaluatedunderrepresentativeconditionstodefinetheirtruecapabilities.
34.16
X-ray radiography
34.16.1 Introduction
34.16.1.1 General
Xrayradiographyisnoncontact,exceptwhenusingcontrastenhancingmedia,andcanbeappliedin
thelaboratory,inproductionandinservice.Itisalongestablishedmeansofinspectingcomponents
and structures. Traditionally, the image was recorded on photographic film, giving high resolution
and good contrast, but was rather time consuming. Film is being replaced by electronic imaging,
enablingrealtimeviewingandimagemanipulationorprocessing.
The ability to image the internal structure and defects within a subject, be it a laminate,
sandwichpanelorassembledstructure.
Differentiationofmaterialphaseswithdifferingdensitiesorthicknesses.
Cleardetectionofthepresenceandorientationofindividualcomponents,e.g.honeycombcore,
pottingcompound,fastenersandsolidcontaminantsorforeignbodies.
Reasonable detection of resin enrichment, porosity, prepreg gaps, fibre alignment and layup
orderincomposites.
ForCFRPcomposites,lowXraytubevoltages(eV)needtobeused,duetothelowatomicnumbersof
carbonandhydrocarbonmatrices,i.e.theyhavealowXraystoppingability.
94
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34.16.1.3 Limitations
ThelimitationsoffilmXradiographyonpolymercompositesinclude:
FilmXraysprovideatwodimensionalimage(shadowgraph)throughthesubject,thereforethe
presenceofananomalycanbedetectedbutthelocationwithrespecttodepthisunknown.
Xrayscannotdetectdisbonds,delaminationsandairgapswhenthesedefectsarenormaltothe
irradiationdirection,e.g.wheninspectingmostlaminatesandsandwichpanels.Theamountof
contrastproducedbyanyneartwodimensionaldefectishighlydependantuponitsorientation
withrespecttotheXraybeam.
FilmXraysaretimeconsuming,bothinexposureandfilmprocessing,andcannotprovidereal
timeimaging.Thereforetheyaredeemedcostlyformanyapplications.
The advent of digital radiography and computer tomography go some way to overcoming these
limitations,[See:34.17].
Theuseofcontrastenhancingmedia,suchastetrabromoethane,TBE,forthedetectionofnearsurface
defects,e.g.cracksanddelaminations,isconsideredrelevantfortestpurposesonly.Penetrationofthe
laminate is needed, albeit small, to enable entry of TBE. This contaminates the composite and the
inspectionbecomesacontactprocess.
Basicradiography,
Microfocus,
Backscattering,
ScatteringAndRefraction,
backscattering.
Materialdensity,
Materialthickness,
Appliedelectronvoltage(XraytubeeV),and
Exposuretime.
It is a powerful tool for nondestructive testing of metal, polymer composite and multimaterial
structures.
95
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34.16.2.4 Backscattering
ThisreliesontheComptoneffect.AfinelycollimatedbeamofXraysisdirectedthroughamaterialat
anobliqueangletothesurface.Someofthephotonsarescatteredbackthroughthesurface.Afinely
collimateddetectorcanthenbeusedtomeasuretheradiationwhichiscomingfromasmallvolumeof
materialattheintersectionoftransmittedandscatteredradiationpaths,Ref.[3452].Thisisineffecta
singlesidedmethod,withaccesstothebackfacenotrequired.
Thebackscatteringtechniquehasbeenusedforthicknessanddensitymeasurementofcarboncarbon
materials,Ref.[3452].Cscanimagescanalsobeconstructed.
Scanningdiffractometry,Ref.[3453].
Scanningtopometry,Ref.[3453].
Diffractionscanningmicroscopy,Ref.[3453].
Xrayrefractometry,Ref.[3453],[3454].
34.16.2.6 - backscattering
ThisisasimilartechniquetoXrayscattering,butusingelectrons.
96
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure34.161Typicaldigitalradiographysystems
97
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Longimageacquisitiontimes,
LowXraybeamutilisationefficiency,resultinginhighXraytubeloading.
In most systems the detector consists of an Xray phosphor in direct contact with a semiconductor
photodiodearray.Thecrystalsaredicedintothick,highlyXrayabsorbingpiecesandbecomediscrete
pixelsinthesystem.
An advantage of linear array systems is that a collimated fan beam and detection system has
significantlyreducedXrayscattercomparedwithnoncollimatedbeams,soproducingveryaccurate
images;henceitsuseinCTcomputerisedtomographysystems.
98
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Singlesidedinspectionusingbackscatteringtechniques,asneededforassembledstructures.
Highresolutionmethodsforceramicmatrixandcarboncarboncomposites,andforindividual
components.
34.17
Computer tomography
34.17.1 Introduction
Computertomographyisanoncontactmethodthatcanbeusedinthelaboratoryandinproduction.
ThreedimensionalXrayimagingispossibleusingcomputeraidedtomography,CAT,whichbuilds
upsuccessivecrosssectionsofthecomponent,Ref.[3410],[3457].Thismethodisalsodescribedas
computertomography,CT.
Initially a medical technique, it has been used to examine highvalue or critical items with complex
materials and geometries. The equipment is large, nonportable and expensive, but can produce
excellent results with components otherwise difficult to inspect reliably. It is also applicable to
structurescontainingavarietyofmaterialtypes,e.g.:
Metalmatrixcomposites,Ref.[3456],
Ceramicbasedmaterials,Ref.[3458],
Rocketmotorormissileparts,
Turbineblades,and
Highlycontouredcarbonfibrebasedcompositecomponents.
99
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure34.171Computertomographyfacility
The 2D and 3Dimage reconstruction overcome two of the main deficiencies of conventional
radiographybydefiningthelocation(depth)ofadefectandvisualisingdefectsnearnormaltotheX
rays,asinplanardelaminations,Ref.[3461].
CT can be applied to quality acceptance inspection, product development and failure analysis. It
providesaccuratequantitativedataonmaterialdensitydistribution,presenceofconstituentpartsand
dimensions.
Compositesandwichwingleadingedgesandairfoilsections,Ref.[3456],[3460],[3462].
Pottedtransformers,Ref.[3459].
CFRPJandZstiffeners,Ref.[3460].
BondedTspars,Ref.[3462].
Metalcastings,Ref.[3459].
Titaniumcomponentsmadebysuperplasticforminganddiffusionbonding(SPF-DB),Ref.[34
63].
Helicopterrotorblades,Ref.[3464].
AnindicationofthequantitativeaccuracyofCTscanningcanbestatedas:
Measurementofmaterialdensityvariationsintherange0.1%to1.0%,Ref.[3463].
Typical measurement accuracy in the range 0.05 mm to 0.25 mm (50 m to 250 m), for
components0.05mto0.5minsize.
100
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Delaminations,
Coretoskindisbonds,
Misplacedmaterials,and
Foreignbodies
34.17.3.2 Limitations
ThefundamentallimitationsofCTare:
Expensiveequipment.
Notportable.
Limitationofcomponentsize;usuallylessthan1m,buttypically500mm.
Facilities for inspecting large structures, up to 1.8 m and eventually 3.8 m in diameter have been
reported.Theseareintendedtobeusedfortheinspectionofsolidrocketmotors,Ref.[3465].
34.17.4 Micro-tomography
With the right equipment, CT can be applied to the examination of material microstructures with
spatialresolutiondownto20m;termednoninvasivemicroscopy,Ref.[3463],[3466].Thepixelsize
setbythedetectordeterminesthelevelofresolutionwhichcanbeachieved.
Thistechniquecanbeusefulforexaminingcomplexmaterialssuchasceramicmatrixcomposites,Ref.
[3458],orassembliesforreusablespacevehicles,suchasCSiCairintakeramps.
34.18
Eddy currents
34.18.1 Introduction
Eddycurrenttechniquescanbeclassedaseithercontact(byhand)ornoncontact,whenautomated
scanningisused.Itcanbeappliedinthelaboratory,inproductionandinservice.
Inthistechniquecurrentlooppaths,eddycurrents,areinducedinaconductivematerial,bypassing
analternatingcurrentthroughacoilcontainingprobe,Ref.[3467].Theprobeisplacedonornearthe
conductivesurfaceofthecomponent.Defectsaredetectedbymonitoringdisturbancesintheinduced
magneticfields.
101
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Itisprimarilyusedforconductivity,crackandcorrosiondetectioninmetals,andiswidelyusedfor
manualorautomatedaircraftinspection,Ref.[3469].Eddycurrenttechniquesformetalsworkinthe
10 kHz to 1 MHz range. It is particularly appropriate for examining bolt and rivet holes to locate
cracks.
Sufficient electrical conductivity for eddy currents to be induced can also be found in CFRP (> 40%
volume fibre), carboncarbon, Ref. [3470], CSiC and metal matrix composites. Practical inspection
systemsarethereforefeasible,Ref.[3410].Automatedinspectionhasbeencarriedoutofsolidrocket
motor casings, forgings and segments, Ref. [3468], in conjunction with electromagnetic acoustic
transducers(EMAT).
Highfrequenciesareneeded,Ref.[3472],e.g.:
10MHzto500MHzforUDCFRP,and
1MHzto30MHzforwovenCFRPlaminates.
Eddycurrentsareaffectedbylaminateedges,soperipheraldefectscanbedifficulttoresolve.
Coilprobedesignisinimportantinrelationtothelaminateconstruction.Thenumberofcoils,
their shape (horseshoe, pancake elliptical) and width should be optimised in relation to the
laminatethickness,Ref.[3470],[3472].
EddycurrentprobescanbeoperatedtoproduceCscanimages.
Inducededdycurrentstendtobeconcentratednearthesurfaceofthematerialadjacenttothe
coil, although some control of the penetration depth can be achieved by varying the
characteristicsoftheappliedsignal.
Eddycurrenttechniqueslookpromisingforthelocatingof:
Brokencarbonfibres.
Changesincarbonfibrevolumefraction.
Changesincarbonfibrelayupandorientation,Ref.[3410].
Detectingdisbondsbetweenmetalsheetandcompositelaminate,Ref.[3473].
34.18.2.2 Limitations
Delaminationsaredifficulttodetectunlesstheinterlaminardamageisfairlysevere(plyseparation).
Thedetectionofdelaminationsisimprovedif:
Morethan20%ofinterfacialplycontactislost,or
Fibreshavebeenbroken,toatleast8%ofthethickness,Ref.[3472].
102
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table 34.18.1 gives the results of a test programme to compare the detection capability of an eddy
currenttechniquewiththatofultrasonics,Ref.[3472].
Table34.181Detectionofdamagebyeddycurrentandultrasonics
Construction
ImpactEnergy
(J)
Sandwich:
0.5 mm
skins
6.8 mm core
Sandwich:
2.0 mm
skins
6.8 mm core
Laminate:
7.2 mm
CFRP
0.69
1.33
2.39
2.83
5.59
9.12
17.5
5.72
10.7
27.3
37.5
41.7
EddyCurrent
Image
UltrasonicImage
SpotDiameter
(mm)
Visible
Damage
Not visible
Halo
Halo
11 - 15
16 - 20
20 - 26
Not visible
Dent, BF
Hole
BV halo
Halo
Halo
Halo
Not visible
BV dark spot
Dark spot,
halo
Halo
Light spot
18 - 22
37
33
41
15
22
29
33
41
Not visible
Dent
Dent
Hole
BV dent
Dent, CM
Dent, CM
Dent, CM
Dent, CM
Key:
SkinswovenCFRP;Corealuminium.
BVBarelyvisible;BFBrokenfibres;CMCrackedmatrix.
Scanningsystemsforassembledstructureswithmultiplematerials.
ImproveddefectdetectionforCFRPandcarboncarbon.
Conditionmonitoringofalloystructuresandfasteners.
34.19
34.19.1 General
There are other techniques which can be used for inspection, but they are not common and tend to
havespecialisedroles.Thetechniquesdescribedare:
Microwave
Electrical impedance
103
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Acoustic microscopy
Neutron radiography
Gamma radiography
34.19.2 Microwave
Microwavetechniquesarenoncontactandcanbeappliedinthelaboratoryandinproduction.
Any disruption in microwave throughtransmission in composites indicates the presence of
discontinuities, or variations in dielectric material properties, Ref. [3410]. Changes in amplitude or
phasecanbeobserved,enablingthedetectionofdefects,thicknessanddegreeofresincure.
Thetechniquehasbeenappliedtofilamentwoundstructures,andalsoforsinglesidedexamination
ofsandwichpanels,Ref.[3474].Typicaldefects,suchasdelaminationsandskintocoredisbonds,can
bedetectedwhentheequipmentisscannedoverthesurfaceandoperatedintheXbandrangewith
frequenciesbetween8.2GHzand12.4Hzandat24GHz.
Scanning laser acoustic microscope (SLAM), which provides realtime images in transmission
modethroughoutthethicknessoftheobject.
Scanning acoustic microscope (SAM), which provides highresolution images of surface and
nearsurfacewhenrasterscannedandoperatedinreflectionmode.
104
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
These techniques are only appropriate to polymer composite structures under exceptional
circumstances,butaremorelikelytobeofvalueforceramicmatrixcomposites.
Detectionofmoistureincomposites.
Curingandthicknessofadhesivebonds.
Assessmentoftheadhesivelinerbetweenpropellantandinsulatorinsolidrocketmotors,Ref.
[3477].
Composites:
fibrealignment,
moisture,
resinoradhesivebuildup.
Bondedjoints:
bondlinecorrosion.
Neutron radiation computer tomography can also be undertaken on gas turbine engine blades and
aluminiumforgings,Ref.[3478].
105
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure34.191DsightDiffractosightschematic
TheretroreflectivescreenisthecriticalopticalelementinDsight.Itreturnslightfallingonitssurface
efficientlybackalongtheincidentdirection;unlikeamirrororaprojectionscreen.Thelightreturned
by the retroreflector is slightly dispersed owing to the physical and optical characteristics of the
microbeadsmakingupthescreensurface,butmostofthelightreturnswithina1cone.
Whenthesurfacetobeinspectedisilluminatedbythelightsourceatalowgrazingangle,anylocal
curvaturevariationsonthissurfaceactasafocusordispersethelightontotheretroreflectivescreen.
Adistinctpatternoflightintensitiesthendescribestheviewedsurfaceandhighlightsanyanomalies,
suchasthoseassociatedwithimpactdamageandnearsurfacedelaminations.
Thetechniquehasbeendevelopedforinspectingaircraftandislimitedtodetectingsurfaceandnear
surfacedamage.
34.20
34.20.1 General
Themainclassesofdefectthatoccurinadhesivejointsare,Ref.[3481]:
Completedisbonds,voidsorporosityintheadhesivelayer.
Pooradhesion,i.e.aweakinterfacebetweentheadhesivelayerandoneorbothadherends.
Poorcohesion,i.e.aweakadhesivelayer.
106
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Suchdefectscanseriouslyimpairbondperformancebutcanbedetectedby:
Conventionalwatercoupledultrasonics:Sensitivetodisbonds,delaminationsandporosity.
Ultrasonicbondtesters:Fordisbondsanddelaminations,butnotporosity:
100kHzto1MHz.
Bondascope,whichmeasuresmagnitudeandphaseoftheultrasonicimpedance.
Fokker bond tester II, using a spectroscopic approach monitoring frequency and
amplitudechangesinthefirsttwomodesofthroughthicknessvibration.
Sonicvibrationandmechanicalimpedance:Forlargedefects.
Thermography,Ref.[3415],[3445],[3484],holographyandshearography:Forthelargernear
surface,airgapdefects.
Eddycurrents:Possiblefordisbondsbetweencompositeandmetal,Ref.[3485].
34.21
34.21.1 Introduction
The number of NDT techniques available has increased considerably within 20 years. They are still
evolvingintheareasof:
Noncontactinspection.
Digitalsignalmanipulationandimagepresentation.
Automationforrapidinspectionandrealtimeimaging.
Itiswidelyacceptedthatmorethanonetechniqueisusuallynecessarytodetectallpossibledefectsor
anomalies that can occur in composite constructions. However, critical defect types are usually
107
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
identifiedforaparticulardesignandmethodofconstructionandthisenablesNDTtechniquestobe
selectedbytheirdetectioncapabilities.
Thedetectionofgrossdefectsremainsamainrequirementfordamagetolerantdesigns.Suchdefects
canbeclassifiedasmissingormisalignedmaterial,delaminations,disbondsandimpactdamage.
Conventional Cscan ultrasonics and Xray examination remain the most powerful techniques for
comprehensivedefectandanomalydetection.
Sandwichconstructionsbynoncontacttechniques,Ref.[3421],[3427],[3430],[3432],[3433],
[3474].
Assembled structures by noncontact techniques, Ref. [349], [3412], [3415], [3416], [3437],
[3441],[3443],[3447],[3464],[3469],[3479],[3480],[3488].
Detection of impact delaminations in polymer composites, Ref. [348], [3438], [3446], [3461],
[3475],[3476].
Integrityofadhesivebonds,Ref.[3445],[3481],[3482],[3483],[3484],[3485].
Rocketmotorcasings,Ref.[3465],[3468],[3477].
Integritycontrolofhightemperaturestructures,Ref.[3490].
Aircoupledultrasonicinspection,Ref.[3421].
Microstructuralexaminationofceramiccomposites,Ref.[3419],[3451],[3459],[3490].
NDEoftitaniumMMCringsbyultrasonicsandcomputertomography,Ref.[3487].
[See:Chapter76forintegritycontrolaspectsofhightemperaturestructures]
[See:Chapter80forNDTofmetalandceramicbasedmaterialsandassemblies]
108
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table34.211SummaryofNDTtechniquesforpolymercompositespace
structures
Technique
Comments
[NC]noncontactmethod.
109
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34.22
Rupture tests
34.22.1 Application
34.22.1.1 General
Sincemanyloadcaseshavelowmarginsofsafety,itisnotpossibletoperformrupturetestsunderall
circumstances.
Theenvelopeshouldbedefinedatanearlystageoftheproject
Thisenvelopeloadbecomesadimensioningloadcase,whichcanleadtomasspenalties
Theinteractionbetweenloadsisnotwellknownnearrupture
Itdoesnotgivetherealmarginsofsafetyofthestructure.
Thetestisdoneattheendofthetestsequencebutthestructurebecomesunavailableforfurther
eventualtests.
Massbudgets,
Degreeofsafety,
Degreeofabilitytocarryhigherloads,
Costeffects(numberofqualificationspecimens).
For composite structures, rupture often occurs suddenly because no plasticity exists. Hence, it is
difficult to know from a test how far the structure is from rupture. To improve the situation, the
structureisinstrumentwith:
Straingauges(many)tocorrelatemodels.Theoutputenablesreferencetodevelopmentrupture
testsonsmallerparts.
Acousticemissiondeviceswhichcanindicateoftheinternalstateofdamage.
110
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34.23
34.23.1 General
Anoverviewoftestrelateditemsispresented,whichdescribestheinfluenceofeachitemofthetest
andtheirrelationshiptoeachother.
Failuremodesofthestructureoranypartofthestructure,e.g.:
matrixcracking,
ruptureoffibres,
buckling.
Controlsatanyphaseofthetestofthestructureoranypartofthestructure,e.g.:
deformationmeasurement,
visualinspection,
acousticemission.
Relevantareasofthestructure,e.g.:
locallyloadedareas,
stiffeneredges,
holes.
Typeofloadsthestructurecanpossiblyexperienceduringitslifeorduringtests,e.g.:
static,
dynamic,
acoustic,
impactloads.
Typeoftestsappliedduringallphasesoftheproduct,e.g.:
development,
qualificationtest.
TheinterrelationshipbetweentheseitemsisshowninTable34.23.1.
111
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table34.231Interrelationshipofitemsinfluencingthetest
Failure
Modes
Controls
Areas
Loads
Tests
Failure
Modes
Controls
Areas
Loads
Tests
X
X
X
X
O
X
O
O
X
O
X
X
O
X
X
X
O
X
X
O
0:Notapplicable
Effectsoflocalmodeoffailureontheglobalbehaviourofthestructureareassessed;asgivenin
Table 34.23.2.
Testinstrumentationenablesthedetectionofanymodeoffailureduringtests;asgiveninTable
34.23.3.
Localanalysisliststhepossiblemodesoffailureforeachareaofthestructure.Criticalpointsare
studiedduringtests;asgiveninTable34.23.4.
Effectsofeachtypeofloadsaswellascombinationsareassessed;associatedmodesoffailure
arelisted;asgiveninTable34.23.5.
Effectofeachmodeoffailureareanalysedthroughtheappropriatestagesduringthelifeofthe
project;asgiveninTable 34.23.6.
Each particular area of the structure is instrumented with respect to its probable mode of
failure;asgiveninTable34.23.7.
Each particular area is analysed and, if necessary, tested with respect to load presumed to be
dangerous;asgiveninTable 34.23.8.
Particularareasaretestedatappropriatestagesoftheproject;asgiveninTable34.23.9.
Inrelevantcases,loadcombinationsareusedfortests;asgiveninTable 34.23.10.
Relevanttypesofloadcasesaretestedatrelevantstepsoftheproject;asgiveninTable34.23.11.
112
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table34.232Effectsoflocalfailuremodesonglobalbehaviourofthestructure
Global
Matrix
Fibre
Cracks
Delamination Rigidity Loss Melting Debonding
Cracking
Rupture
Local
Matrix Cracking
Fibre Rupture
Cracks
Rupture
DX
PX
Delamination
Buckling
X
PX
Rigidity Loss
Melting
Debonding
Buckling
PX
X
X
X
Rupture
Key:
Propagation
D Dispersion
If local phenomena arise at given load, effects should be analysed and taken into account. The analysis should be based
on development tests and verified during qualification tests.
113
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Failure
Table34.233Detectionoftechniquestovariousfailuresoccurringduringtest
Test Means
Stress
Def.
Visual
ThermoEndoscopy
X-ray
C-Scan
AE.
Meas.
Meas.
Inspec.
graphy
Noise
Residual
Stress
Matrix Cracking
Destr.
Destr.
Fibre Rupture
Destr.
Destr.
Cracks
Delamination
Rigidity Loss
Melting
Debonding
Buckling
Burst
Rupture
Key:
114
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Failure
Table34.234Interrelationbetweenfailuremodesandtheirpossiblelocations
Location
Running
Sandwich
Stiffener
Local Load
Frame
Hole
Section
Edge
Edge
Reinforced Connection
Door
Parts
Matrix Cracking
Fibre Rupture
Cracks
Delamination
Rigidity Loss
Melting
Debonding
Buckling
Burst
Rupture
: Possible locations of failure should be specifically instrumented to allow the study of the phenomena.
115
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Failure
Matrix Cracking
Table34.235Interrelationbetweentypeofloadingandpossiblefailuremodes
Load
Residual
Acoustic
Static
Thermal
Dynamic
Fatigue
Stresses
Fibre Rupture
Cracks
Delamination
Rigidity Loss
Melting
Debonding
Impacts
Load History
Buckling
Burst
Rupture
116
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table34.236Failuremodeswhichhavetobecoveredbythespecifictests
Test
Failure
DVPT
Qualif. Rupture Procurement Fabrication Proof*
Tests
Tests
Tests
Tests
Tests
Tests
Matrix Cracking
Fibre Rupture
Cracks
Delamination
Rigidity Loss
Useless
Melting
Debonding
Buckling
Burst
Rupture
Proof tests should not develop matrix cracking and if it is the case, the
Key:
effect should be taken into account in the dimensioning of the structure
and in the damage tolerance analysis.
Should be studied during development.
* Proof test necessity should be discussed.
117
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Instrumentation
Table34.237Appropriateinstrumentationofparticularareasofthestructure
Location
Reinforced
Pressurised
Stiffener
Frames
Holes
Local Load
Section
Edge
Doors
Stress Measurement
Definition Measurement
Connect
Parts
Visual Impact
Endoscopy
X-ray
C-Scan
Thermography
Acoustic Emission
Moir Method
Residual Stresses
118
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table34.238Interrelationbetweenparticularareasofthestructuresandpossibledangerousloads
Load
Location
Residual
AE
Static
Thermal
Dynamic
Fatigue
Impact
Stresses
Running Section
Local Load
Sandwich Edge
Stiffener Edge
Frames
Holes
Reinforced Doors
Connection Parts
Load
History
119
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Location
Table34.239Testingofparticularareasofthestructure
Test
Procurement
DVPT Tests
Qualif. Tests
Rupture Tests
Tests
Running Section
Fabrication
Tests
Local Load
If possible
Sandwich Edge
Stiffener Edge
Frames
Holes
Reinforced Doors
Connection Parts
Proof Tests
120
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Load
Table34.2310Loadcombinationsfortherelevantcases
Load
Residual
Acoustic
Static
Thermal
Dynamic
Stresses
Residual Stresses
Acoustic
Static
Thermal
Fatigue
Impact
Dynamic
Fatigue
Impact
121
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Load
DVPT Tests
Table34.2311Testingdifferentloadcases
Test
Procurement
Qualif. Tests
Rupture Tests
Tests
Residual Stresses
Acoustic
If MS low
Static
Thermal
If MS low
Impact
Load History
Key:
Proof Tests
Dynamic
Fatigue
Fabrication
Tests
If any
If any
If any
In some sense
122
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34.24
Theguidelinesindicatewhatcanreasonablybeexpectedtoappearinastructuralreport.
Theitemsincludedare:
Titlesheet:
distributionlist,
issue,
date.
Alterationsheet:
toincludeasummaryofchanges
Contentslist:
sectionnumber,
title,
issuenumber.
Summarypage
References:
applicablepapers.
Introduction:
structure,
purpose,
scope,
project.
Structuredescription
Designrequirements:
general,
specific,
uniquetoproject.
Materialslist:
propertyvalues,
sources,
qualities.
Analysismethods,forthoseusedinthereport.
FEMmodeldescription:Thisshouldbeclearandunambiguous.Ifnecessary,breakthemodel
into major subassemblies. Use FEM grids and structure or component drawings together as
superimposedorexplodedviews.
123
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Assumptions: Those made affecting the idealisations of the structure, e.g. load application,
modelling,staticanddynamicanalysis.
Results:Wherecomputerresults(e.g.FEM)areincluded,presentonlythosethathaveactually
beenused,orappearinsubsequentcalculations.
Analyses:
static,
dynamic.
Reservefactors(R.F.)ormarginofsafety(M.S.):Asummaryincludes:
drawing,partnumberortitle,
material,type,specificationnumberorgrade,
loadingcase,
load,momentandstresswithtype,appliedandallowableplusunits,
actualR.ForM.Svalue,
anyappropriateremarks,
locationwithinreportofassociatedcalculation,i.e.sectionorpagenumber.
Strengthanddynamicresponse:compliancestatementandconclusion.
Loadingcases:
list,
descriptions.
numberingsequence
Units:Statethoseusedinreport;preferablythesamethroughout.
Coordinatesystems,e.g.:
orientation,
locationoforigins,
Appendicesorannexes.
34.25
124
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Adescriptionoftheanalysisandtestperformed.Areferencetothestressreport.
Theloadingspectrumandhowithasbeenderived.
Materialdataandhowtheyhavebeenderived.
Environmentalconditionsandtheireffects.
Inthedemonstrationofnogrowthbehaviour,anylowstraincriterionusedarefullydescribed
andjustifiedwithappropriatesupportingtestevidence.
Demonstrationthattheintervalbetweenthetimeanydamagebecomesdetectabletothetimeat
which the extent of damage reaches the stated limits for the required residual strength
capabilityisatleastfourtimesthescheduledinspectionintervalintheapprovedmaintenance
plan.
Summaryofthesignificantresults.
Adescriptionoftheitem;aspersafelifeitems,
Failuremodesassumed,
Stressanalysiswithnewloadingdistribution,
Fatigueanalysisofthemostcriticalitem,
Summaryofthesignificantresults.
Velocityorenergyoftheitemasitstrikesthecontainingitem(shell),withworstcasesharpness
assumption,
Elasticorplasticshelldeformation,
Stressesintheshell,attachments,brackets,orothersimilaritemsduringimpact.
125
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
34.26
References
34.26.1 General
[341]
C.N.E.S.
HSG110CNES,10.06.1988
[342]
J.D.Achenbach
Introduction:ThescienceandtechnologyofNDE
Chapter1,Flightvehiclematerials,structures,anddynamics
assessmentandfuturedirections
Vol.4TribologicalMaterialsandNDE
ASMEPublication,1992,ISBN0791806626
[343]
I.M.Daniel
NDEofcompositematerials
Chapter11,Flightvehiclematerials,structures,anddynamics
assessmentandfuturedirections
Vol.4TribologicalMaterialsandNDE
ASMEPublication,1992,ISBN0791806626
[344]
A.L.Siedl
InspectionofcompositestructuresParts1&2
Part1,SAMPEJnl,Vol.30,No.4,July/August1994,p3844
Part2,SAMPEJnl,Vol.31,No.1,January/February1995,p4248
[345]
0.Forli
Inorbitinserviceinspection
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonSpaceApplicationsof
AdvancedStructuralMaterials.March1990
ESASP303,p157162
[346]
S.K.Burkeetal
Nondestructivecharacterisationofadvancedcompositematerials
MaterialsForum(1994)18,p85109
[347]
R.Smith&C.Hobbs
TheneedforNDTofadvancedmaterials
14thInternationalEuropeanSAMPEConference,October1993
ISBN3952047708,p2534
[348]
X.E.Gros
ReviewofNDTtechniquesfordetectionoflowenergyimpactsincarbon
reinforcements
SAMPEJournal,Vol.31,No.2,March/April1995,p2934
[349]
H.Tretoutetal
ReviewofadvancedNDTmethodsforcompositesaerospacestructures
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures94,March1994
ESAWPP070,p629634
126
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[3410]
J.Summerscales,Editor
NondestructivetestingoffibrereinforcedplasticscompositesVolume
2
ElsevierAppliedScience,ISBN1851664688,1990
[3411]
B.S.Wongetal
Ultrasonictestingofsolidfiberreinforcedcompositeplates
SAMPEJournal,Vol.30,No.6,November/December1994
p3640
[3412]
P.Cawley
Therapidnondestructiveinspectionoflargecompositestructures
Composites,Vol.25,No.5,1994,p351357
[3413]
G.R.Tillacketal
Inspectionperformanceinultrasonictesting
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures94,March1994
ESAWPP070,p639644
[3414]
G.Bennettetal
Developmentofrealtimelowcosthighperformancescanningsystems
foradvancedultrasonicimaging
39thInternationalSAMPESymposium,April1114,1994
p13441355
[3415]
N.Wood
Largeareacompositeinspectionsystem(LACIS)automationof
traditionalinspectiontechniques
39thInternationalSAMPESymposium,April1114,1994
p13751390
[3416]
MightyMAUS
AerospaceAmerica,November1991,p4647
[3417]
Y.BarCohenetal
Compositematerialpropertynondestructivecharacterisationusing
obliquelyinsonifiedultrasonicwaves
39thInternationalSAMPESymposium,April1114,1994
p13161329
[3418]
N.Guo&P.Cawley
LambwavesfortheNDEofcompositelaminates
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Volume11B,1992,PlenumPress,ISBN030644206X
p14431450
[3419]
M.Bashyam&J.L.Rose
Surfaceacousticwavetechniquesforceramicmatrixcompositematerials
characterization
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Volume11B,1992,PlenumPress,ISBN030644206X
127
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
p14831490
[3420]
B.R.Tittmann
ExperimentaltechniquesinultrasonicsforNDEandmaterial
characterization
Chapter3,FlightVehicleMaterials,Structures,andDynamics
AssessmentandFutureDirections
Vol.4TribologicalMaterialsandNDE
ASMEPublication,1992,ISBN0791806626
[3421]
W.A.Grandia
Advancesinnondestructivetestingnoncontactultrasonicinspectionof
composites
39thInternationalSAMPESymposium,April1114,1994
p13081315
[3422]
W.Sachse&M.R.Gorman
Acousticemissionmeasurementsofaerospacematerialsandstructures
Chapter8,FlightVehicleMaterials,Structures,andDynamics
AssessmentandFutureDirections
Vol.4TribologicalMaterialsandNDE
ASMEPublication,1992,ISBN0791806626
[3423]
G.M.Butyrin&A.V.Demin
Nondestructiveevaluationofdensityandporosityinporousmaterials
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures94,March1994
ESAWPP070,p673676
[3424]
JP.Monchalin
Laserultrasonics
Chapter4,FlightVehicleMaterials,Structures,andDynamics
AssessmentandFutureDirections
Vol.4TribologicalMaterialsandNDE
ASMEPublication,1992,ISBN0791806626
[3425]
JP.Monchalin
Progresstowardstheapplicationoflaserultrasonicsinindustry
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Vol.12A,p495506,1993,PlenumPress,ISBN0306444836
[3426]
A.D.W.McKie&R.C.Addison
Rapidinspectionofcompositesusinglaserbasedultrasound
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Vol.12A,p507516,1993,PlenumPress,ISBN0306444836
128
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[3427]
F.H.Changetal
Laserultrasonicinspectionofhoneycombaircraftstructures
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Vol.12A,p611616,1993,PlenumPress,ISBN0306444836
[3428]
T.E.Drake
Laserultrasonictestingofaerospacematerials
39thInternationalSAMPESymposium,April1114,1994
p725739
[3429]
C.M.Scalaetal
Laserultrasonics:emergingtechnologyforaircraftNDE
NonDestructiveTestingAustralia
Vol.31,No.4,July/August1994,p9092
[3430]
J.F.Clarady&M.Summers
ElectronicholographyandshearographyNDEforinspectionofmodern
materialsandstructures
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Vol.12A,p381386,1993,PlenumPress,ISBN0306444836
[3431]
G.DiChirico
Opticalmethodsfornondestructiveinspectionofstructural
components
TestingofMetalsforStructures,Naples,Italy,2931May,1990
p337343
[3432]
I.Cabezaetal
Thermaldistortionmeasurementonantennareflectorsbyrealtime
holographicinterferometryinambientpressure
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonEnvironmentalTesting
forSpaceProgrammesTestFacilities&Methods
ESTEC,2629June1990,ESASP304,p403407
[3433]
H.U.Frey
HolographyAsuccessfultoolfordistortionmeasurementsonantennas
underspacesimulationconditions
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonEnvironmentalTesting
forSpaceProgrammesTestFacilities&Methods
ESTEC,2629June1990,ESASP304,p395402
[3434]
J.F.Clarady
ElectronicholographicNDE
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Volume9,1990,PlenumPress,p10311038
[3435]
M.V.Raoetal
Dualvacuumstressingtechniqueforholographicnondestructive
testingofhoneycombsandwichpanels
NDTInternational,Vol.23,No.5,October1990,p267270
129
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[3436]
T.E.Tayetal
Applicationofholographicinterferometryinthedetectionofflawsin
compositeplates
AdvancedComposites93,InternationalConferenceonAdvanced
CompositeMaterials
Wollongong,Australia,1519Feb,1993,p683686
[3437]
P.Ferraroetal
Holographicinterferometryasinspectiontechniqueonaerospace
compositestructure
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonSpaceApplicationsof
AdvancedStructuralMaterials.March1990
ESASP303,p151156
[3438]
G.Cavaccinietal
Detectionofimpactdamageincompositesbyholographic
interferometry
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonSpaceApplicationsof
AdvancedStructuralMaterials.March1990
ESASP303,p145150
[3439]
G.B.Chaietal
Vibrationanalysisoflaminatedcompositeplates:TVholographyand
finiteelementmethod
CompositeStructures23(1993),p273283
[3440]
J.B.Deaton&R.S.Rogowski
Electronicshearography:currentcapabilities,potentiallimitations,and
futurepossibilitiesforindustrialnondestructiveinspection
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Vol.12A,p395402,1993,PlenumPress,ISBN0306444836
[3441]
J.W.Newman
Productionandfieldinspectionofcompositeaerospacestructureswith
advancedshearography
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Vol.10B,p212921331991,PlenumPress
ISBN0306439034
[3442]
J.W.Newman
Testcompositeswithlasers
MaterialsEngineering,July1992,p1011
[3443]
C.Hobbs
Theinspectionofaeronauticalstructuresusingtransientthermography
ProceedingsoftheNDTforCorrosioninAerospaceStructures
Conference,12Feb1992,6,1to6.10,ISBN0903409992
[3444]
T.Ahmedatal
Infraredthermalwavestudiesofcomposites
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Vol.10B,p217321791991,PlenumPress
130
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
ISBN0306439034
[3445]
W.P.Winfree
ThermalQNDEdetectionofairframedisbonds
NASACP3160,1991,p249260
[3446]
T.Jones&H.Berger
Thermographicdetectionofimpactdamageingraphiteepoxy
composites
MaterialsEvaluation,December1992,p14461453
[3447]
R.Danjouxetal
MECIR:AnewApparatusforthecontrolofmaterialsbyinfrared
thermography
SPIEVol1320InfraredTechnologyandApplications,1990
p282291
[3448]
C.P.Hobbsetal
Theapplicationoftransientthermographyforthenondestructive
testingandevaluationofaerospacematerials
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures94,March1994
ESAWPP070,p645654
[3449]
E.G.Henneke&B.S.Tang
ThermalmethodsofNDEandqualitycontrol
Chapter6,FlightVehicleMaterials,Structures,andDynamics
AssessmentandFutureDirections
Vol.4TribologicalMaterialsandNDE
ASMEPublication,1992,ISBN0791806626
[3450]
J.Webber
NDTofCFRPstructures:evaluationofanewmethod
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonSpaceApplicationsof
AdvancedStructuralMaterials.March1990
ESASP303,p163170
[3451]
S.Abbeetal
Suivideleffetdeviellissementenmilieuoxydantdematriaux
compositesC/SiCpardestechniquesnondestructives
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures94,March1994
ESAWPP070,p687692
131
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[3452]
J.Bouteyreetal
Thicknessanddensitymeasurementofcarboncarbonmaterialsbyusing
backscatteringofXrays
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures94,March1994
ESAWPP070,p655660
[3453]
M.P.Hentscheletal
NewXrayscanningtopographicapproachestonondestructive
evaluation
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures,March1992
ESASP336,p229232
[3454]
M.P.Hentscheletal
NewXrayrefractographyfornondestructiveinvestigations
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures94,March1994
ESAWPP070,p661664
[3455]
R.A.Buchananetal
Digitalradiographyintheaerospaceindustry
Chapter7,FlightVehicleMaterials,Structures,andDynamics
AssessmentandFutureDirections
Vol.4TribologicalMaterialsandNDE
ASMEPublication,1992,ISBN0791806626
[3456]
C.Buenoetal
Highresolutiondigitalradiographyand3Dcomputedtomographyof
compositematerials
39thInternationalSAMPESymposium,April1114,1994
p766778
[3457]
L.Castaldelloetal
Advancedmaterialsnondestructivetestingusinghighresolutiondual
energytomography
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures94,March1994
ESAWPP070,p635638
[3458]
D.Ekenhorstetal
Nondestructiveinspectionofceramicmatrixcompositescomponentsby
computerisedtomography
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures94,March1994
ESAWPP070,p665672
[3459]
R.H.Bossietal
Xraycomputedtomographyfortheaircraft/aerospaceindustry
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Vol.10B,1991,PlenumPress,ISBN0306439034,p21212127
132
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[3460]
R.H.Bossietal
Xraycomputedtomographyofcomposites
26thInternationalSAMPESymposium,April1518,1991
p224238
[3461]
E.A.Birtetal
Imagingofimpactdamageingraphiteepoxycomposites
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Vol.12A,p897904,1993,PlenumPress,ISBN0306444836
[3462]
R.H.Bossi&G.E.Georgeson
Appliedcomputedtomographyformaterials&processesdevelopment
39thInternationalSAMPESymposium,April1114,1994
p740753
[3463]
G.GeorgesonandR.Bossi
Xraycomputedtomographyforadvancedmaterialsandprocesses
InDevelopmentsinCeramicandMetalMatrixComposites
TheMinerals,Metals,&MaterialsSociety,1991,p143155
[3464]
R.Oster
Computedtomography(CT)asanondestructivetestmethodusedfor
compositehelicoptercomponents
Proceedingsofthe17thEuropeanRotorcraftForum
2427Sept1991,PaperERF9187
[3465]
P.D.Tonner&J.H.Stanley
Supervoltagecomputedtomographyforlargeaerospacestructures
MaterialsEvaluation,December1992,p14341445
[3466]
C.Bathiasetal
ApplicationofXraytomographytothenondestructivetestingofhigh
performancepolymercomposite.
ECCM6,Sept1993
WoodheadPublishing,ISBN1855731428,p617622
[3467]
B.A.Auld
ElectromagneticmethodsinNDE
Chapter5,FlightVehicleMaterials,Structures,andDynamics
AssessmentandFutureDirections
Vol.4TribologicalMaterialsandNDE
ASMEPublication,1992,ISBN0791806626
[3468]
G.E.McNeelege&C.Sarantos
RoboticNDEInspectionofadvancedsolidrocketmotorcasings
AIAA941222CP,p354366
[3469]
M.W.Siegel
Automationfornondestructiveinspectionofaircraft
AIAA941223CP,p367377
133
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[3470]
R.Frankle&R.Menich
Eddycurrentinspectionofcompositematerials
39thInternationalSAMPESymposium,April1114,1994
p24512462
[3471]
X.E.Gros
Eddycurrenttesting:inspectingcompositematerials
MaterialsWorld,April1995,p180181
[3472]
M.P.DeGoeje&K.E.D.Wapenaar
Nondestructiveispectionofcarbonfibrereinforcedplasticsusing
eddycurrentmethods
Composites,Volume23,No.3,May1992,p147157
[3473]
D.W.Lowdenetal
Visualisingdefectgeometryincompositematerials
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures94,March1994
ESAWPP070,p683686
[3474]
S.I.Ganchevetal
Microwavenondestructiveevaluationofthicksandwichcomposites
MaterialsEvaluation,April1995,p463467
[3475]
C.Wlfingeretal
Damagedetectionincompositematerialsbymonitoringelectrical
impedance
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures94,March1994
ESAWPP070,p677682
[3476]
A.C.Wey&L.W.Kessler
Quantitativemeasurementofdelaminationareainlowvelocity
impactedcompositesusingacousticmicroscopy
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Volume11B,1992,
PlenumPress,ISBN030644206X,p15631568
[3477]
L.J.Burnettetal
SolidrocketmotorNDEusingnuclearmagneticresonance
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Vol.12A,1993,PlenumPress,ISBN0306444836,p663670
[3478]
G.Pfisteretal
Nondestructivetestingofmaterialsandcomponentsbycomputerized
tomographywithfastandthermalreactorneutrons
NuclearScienceandEngineering:110,p303315(1992)
[3479]
J.P.Komorowskietal
InspectionofaircraftstructuresusingDsight
39thInternationalSAMPESymposium
April1114,1994,p754765
134
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[3480]
J.P.Komorowskietal
ApplicationofDiffractosighttothenondestructiveinspectionof
aircraftstructures
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Vol.12A,1993,PlenumPress,ISBN0306444836,p449455
[3481]
P.Cawley
NDTofadhesivebonds
Chapter13,FlightVehicleMaterials,Structures,andDynamics
AssessmentandFutureDirections
Vol.4TribologicalMaterialsandNDE
ASMEPublication,1992,ISBN0791806626
[3482]
T.Pialucha&P.Cawley
Thedetectionofaweakadhesive/adherendinterfaceinbondedjointsby
ultrasonicreflectionmeasurements
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Volume11B,1992
PlenumPress,ISBN030644206X,p12611266
[3483]
P.N.Dewen&P.Cawley
Anultrasonicscanningtechniqueforthequantitativedeterminationof
thecohesivepropertiesofadhesivejoints
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Volume11B,1992
PlenumPress,ISBN030644206X,p12531260
[3484]
D.R.Prabhu&W.P.Winfree
Automationofdisbonddetectioninaircraftfuselagethroughthermal
imageprocessing
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluation
Volume11B,1992
PlenumPress,ISBN030644206X,p13231330
[3485]
D.W.Lowden
Quantifyingdisbondarea
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures,March1992
ESASP336,p223228
[3486]
P.Plotard&C.LeFloch
Nondestructiveinspectionofcarboncarbonwithadaptedcoatingfor
oxidation
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonSpaceApplicationsof
AdvancedStructuralMaterials.March1990
ESASP303,p171180
135
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[3487]
G.Y.Baaklinietal
NDEoftitaniumalloyMMCringsforgasturbineengines
DEVol.55,Reliability,StressAnalysis,andFailurePrevention
ASME1993,ISBN079181172250,p239250
[3488]
H.Trtoutetal
Infraredthermographydevelopmentformaterialevaluationofhermes
spaceplanecomponents
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonSpaceApplicationsof
AdvancedStructuralMaterials.March1990
ESASP303,p181186
[3489]
G.Salaetal
Specialproblemsof3DultrasonicQNDItechniquesandapplicationsto
compositeaerospacestructures
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures,March1992
ESASP336,p209216
[3490]
Integritycontrolforhightemperaturestructuralapplications
DaimlerBenzAerospaceDornierReports
PhaseIFinalReport,November1993
PhaseIIFinalReport,February1995
ESTECContract9907/90/NL/PP(SC)
[3491]
R.W.AvanderVen&H.Bolks:Fokker,NL.
AircoupledultrasonicCscan(AIRSCAN)fornondestructive
inspection
ESAConferenceonSpacecraftStructures,Materials&Mechanical
Testing,March1996.Abstracts,p94
[3492]
W.A.Grandia&C.M.Fortunko:QMI/NIST,USA
NDEapplicationsofaircoupledultrasonictransducers
IEEEInternationalUltrasonicsSymposium,Seattle,710November,1995
[3493]
ESAPSS03207Guidelinesforcarbonandotheradvancedmaterial
prepregprocurementspecifications.
[3494]
J.O.Strycek&H.Loertscher:QMIInc.,USA.
Ultrasonicaircoupledinspectionofadvancedmaterial
NDTNet.Vol.4No.12,December1999.
[3495]
UltrasonicSciencesLtd.,UK
Multiaxisautomaticultrasonicinspectionsystemsforadvanced
compositeaircraftstructures.
Privatecommunication2003.
[3496]
M.C.Bhardwaj&GFStead
Phenomenaladvancementsinnoncontactultrasoundforcomposites
characterisation
46thInternationalSAMPESymposiumMay610,2001
136
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[3497]
J.S.McIntoshetal.,
Thecharacterisationofcapacitivemicromachinedultrasonictransducers
inair
Ultrasonics40(2002)p477483.
[3498]
M.Castaings&B.Hosten
TheuseofElectrostatic,Ultrasonic,AircoupledTransducerstoGenerate
andReceiveLambWavesinAnisotropic,ViscoelasticPlates
Ultrasonics,v.36,p361365(1998).
[3499]
E.Bloomeetal.
RecentobservationswithaircoupledNDEinthefrequencyrangeof650
kHzto1.2MHz
Ultrasonics40(2002)p153157.
[34100] R.Stoesseletal.
Aircoupledultrasoundinspectionofvariousmaterials
Ultrasonics40(2002)p159163
[34101] J.Poguetetal.
Phasedarraytechnology:Concepts,probesandapplications,8th
EuropeanCongressonNondestructivetesting,June1721,Barcelona,
Spain.2002
[34102] Mahautetal.
Developmentofphasedarraytechniquestoimprovecharacterisationof
defectlocatedinacomponentofcomplexgeometry
Ultrasonics40(2002)p165169
[34103] J.Penaetal.
Lowcost,lowfrequencyphasedarraysystemfordamagedetectionin
panels
Proceedingsofthe2ndEuropeanworkshoponstructuralhealth
monitoring,2004
[34104] M.J.S.LoweandP.Cawley
TheApplicabilityofPlateWaveTechniquesfortheInspectionof
AdhesiveandDiffusionBondedJoints
JournalofDestructiveEvaluation,Vol13,No4,1994
[34105] R.Seifried,L.J.Jacobs&J.Qu
CharacterizationofadhesivebondpropertieswithLambWaves
ReviewofProgressinQuantitativeNondestructiveEvaluationVol.20,
EditedbyD.O.ThompsonandDEChimenti
[34106] P.B.Nagy&L.Adler
Nondestructiveevaluationofadhesivejointsbyguidedwaves
JApplPhys.66(10),15november1989
[34107] M.Lemistre&D.Balageas
StructuralhealthmonitoringsystembasedondiffractedLambwave
analysisbymultiresolutionprocessing
137
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
SmartMaterialsandStructures10(2001)p504511
[34108] P.Frommeetal.
Aguidedwavearrayforstructuralhealthmonitoring
Proceedingsofthe2ndEuropeanworkshoponstructuralhealth
monitoring2004
ECSSQST20
ECSSEST30series
ECSSEST3201
SpaceproductassuranceQualityassurance;
previouslyESAPSS0120
SpaceengineeringMechanical
Fracturecontrol;previouslyESAPSS01401
138
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
35
Objective of verification
35.1
Introduction
35.1.1
General
Theobjectiveofverificationisstatedalongwiththoseadditionalfactorswhicharetobeconsidered
for structures manufactured from fibrereinforced composite materials compared with metal
structures.
35.1.2
Composite structures
35.1.2.1
Key factors
Toverifyacompositestructure,itemswhichareconsideredare:
Adequacyofdesign,
Manufacturing,and
Testing.
35.1.3
Composite materials
35.1.3.1
Additional factors
Inadditiontotherequirementsofametallicdesign,thefactorsspecifictocompositesare:
Procurementspecification:Adetailedspecificationforalltherawmaterial(s),e.g.
prepregs,
resins.
Incomingcontrol:Procedureforallrawmaterials
Design allowables:Philosophyofassessment.
Tests:Tosupportthecompositedesign.
139
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Manufacturing:
Procedureforallparts.
Curingprocessprocedure.
Assembly:Procedurefortheassemblyofthestructure.
35.1.3.2
Verification procedure
Theverificationprocedurecomprisesof:
Hardware,and
Software,e.g.assessmentofdesignallowables.
35.1.3.3
Verification guidelines
A general verification procedure for composite structures can be derived from the guidelines given
for:
Rawmaterials,[See:Chapter36].
Design allowables,[See:Chapter37].
Theguidelinesprovidethefundamentalsforagivenprocedure.
140
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
36
Procurement specifications for raw
materials
36.1
Introduction
36.1.1
Guidelines
The guidelines presented contain information to assist in the preparation of specifications for the
procurement of advanced composite constituents and prepregs. Also described are the parameters
thatitisnecessarytocontrolormonitorforqualificationandbatchcontrol.
The guidelines are not intended to be definitive specifications. In many cases, it is not necessary to
specify all the parameters outlined. It remains the judgement of those preparing a specification to
includeonlywhatisreallynecessary,therebyavoidinganexcessivelycomplexspecificationandthe
undulyhighcostofcomplyingwiththem.
36.2
Specification methods
36.2.1
36.2.1.1
General
141
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
36.2.1.2
Master document
The fichesheet structure needs the creation of a master document in which items are defined,
including:
Ordering,
Delivery,
Qualification,
Acceptance,
Batchrelease,and
Testmethodprocedures.
Itdoesnotincludespecificnumericalpropertydatarequirements.
36.2.1.3
Fiche sheet
Aseparatedocumentthefichesheetisissuedasasupplementtothemasterdocumentandlists
therequiredpropertydataforaspecificmaterial.
36.2.2
Owing to problems identified with the fichesheet principle, most materials are still ordered to a
specific material specification, which is established by the manufacturer and customer in
collaboration.
36.3
36.3.1
Scope
The guideline gives information on the preparation of a specification for the procurement of a
particularresinsystem.
The main items which are needed for the identification of requirements for batch control and the
qualificationofaresinsystemarelisted.
142
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
36.3.2
36.3.2.1
Introduction
Whereconstituentitemsareorderedseparately,theassociatedinformationissuppliedforeachitem,
i.e.:
General;asshowninTable 36.3.1.
Hardener;asshowninTable 36.3.3.
Catalyst;asshowninTable 36.3.4.
Modifier;asshowninTable 36.3.5.
Solvent;asshowninTable 36.3.6.
Blend;asshowninTable36.3.7.
Thesupplieralsoconfirmsthatthematerialisfreefromcontamination.
Alltheinformationrequirementsdescribedarefortheapprovalofthematerial.Allthosemarkedwith
an asterisk are needed for batch control. If one or more of the mentioned parameters is out of
specification,certainretestingcanberequired.
36.3.2.2
General
All the information described in Table 36.3.1 are for the approval of the material. All those marked
withanasteriskareneededforbatchcontrol.
Table36.31Resinprocurement:GeneralInformation
Information
Batch
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*Necessaryaspartofabatchtest
143
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
36.3.2.3
Base resin
All the information described in Table 36.3.2 are for the approval of the material. All those marked
withanasteriskareneededforbatchcontrol.
Table36.32Resinprocurement:Baseresin
Information
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Key:
ifapplicable
*Necessaryaspartofabatchtest
Batch
*
*
*
*
*
36.3.2.4
Hardener
All the information described in Table 36.3.3 are for the approval of the material. All those marked
withanasteriskareneededforbatchcontrol.
Table36.33Resinprocurement:Hardener
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Information
Batch
*
*
*
*
*
*Necessaryaspartofabatchtest
144
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
36.3.2.5
Catalyst
All the information described in Table 36.3.4 are for the approval of the material. All those marked
withanasteriskareneededforbatchcontrol.
Table36.34Resinprocurement:Catalyst
Information
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Key:
ifapplicable
*Necessaryaspartofabatchtest
Batch
*
*
*
*
36.3.2.6
Modifier
All the information described in Table 36.3.5 are for the approval of the material. All those marked
withanasteriskareneededforbatchcontrol.
Table36.35Resinprocurement:Modifier
1.
2.
3.
4.
Information
I.R. Spectrum
Density
Viscosity or melting point
Refractive index (only for liquids)
Batch
*
*
*
*Necessaryaspartofabatchtest
36.3.2.7
Solvent
All the information described in Table 36.3.6 are for the approval of the material. All those marked
withanasteriskareneededforbatchcontrol.
Table36.36Resinprocurement:Solvent
1.
2.
3.
Information
Density
I.R. Spectrum
Refractive index
Batch
*
*
*Necessaryaspartofabatchtest
145
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
36.3.2.8
Blend
All the information described in Table 36.3.7 are for the approval of the material. All those marked
withanasteriskareneededforbatchcontrol.
Table36.37Resinprocurement:Blend
Information
Batch
Uncured
(priortoreleaseforproductionuse)
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
*
*
*
Cured
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
*Necessaryaspartofabatchtest
36.3.2.9
Thedeterminedpropertiesare:
Compressionstrength.
Compressionmodulus.
Tensilestrength.
Tensilemodulus.
Elongation.
Impactstrength.
Poissonsratio.
Hardness.
Density.
Coefficientofthermalexpansion,CTE.
Shearmodulusversustemperature.
146
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Thesupplierindicates:
thetypesoftestingusedtoestablishtheproperties,and
theirtypicalvalues,and
thelikelypropertyvariationthatcanbeexpected.
36.4
36.4.1
Scope
36.4.1.1
General
Theguidelinesdescribetheparameterswhicharenecessarytocontrolormonitorprepreginorderfor
validationandbatchcontrol..
Fordetailedinformation,refertoESAPSS03207.
36.4.1.2
The guidelines are intended as a general guide for organisations preparing specifications for the
procurementofparticularthermosettingresinimpregnatedreinforcingfibresystems(prepreg).
36.4.1.3
Thermoplastic matrix
Whilst the guidelines concentrate on the procurement of thermosetting resin prepreg they are, in
manyrespects,alsoapplicabletothermoplasticmatrixprepreg.
36.4.2
36.4.2.1
Fibre type
Theguidelinesareaimedprimarilyatpurchasersofprepregcontainingcarbonfibres.However,many
oftheparametersdescribedareapplicabletoprepregsofothercontinuousreinforcingfibres,suchas
glass,boron,aramids,siliconcarbideandalumina.
Hybrid prepregs, containing a mixture of reinforcing fibres, such as glass and carbon, also need
similarspecificationcontrol.
36.4.2.2
Prepreg type
The most common type of prepreg is the unidirectional (UD) variety. A unidirectional prepreg
contains a parallel planararray offibres,usually several fibres thick, suitably preimpregnated with
eitherapartiallycuredoranuncuredspecifiedthermosettingresin.
Prepregs incorporating woven arrays of reinforcing fibres, i.e. fabrics, are an important group of
materials.Thepropertiesofthefibreandresinconstituentsoftheprepregcanbedefinedbyreference
toappropriatespecificationsfortheseconstituents.
147
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
36.4.2.3
Resin type
[See:36.3forguidelinesonproducingaresinprocurementspecification]
36.4.2.4
Prepreg classification
Laminationofprepregpliesandcuringunderdefinedconditionsoftemperature,pressureandtimein
amouldingpressorautoclaveproducecomponentswithrequiredstrengthorstiffnesscharacteristics.
Theclassificationofaprepregcanbeintermsof:
Therequiredmechanicalpropertiesofacuredlaminate,frequentlyspecifiedtobethoseatthe
operatingtemperatureandhumidityofacomponent,or
Thetypeofresinorfibrecanbeusedasabasisforprepregclassifications.
In either case, the material supplier provides guidelines on the range of applicability of a particular
prepreganditsconstituents.
36.4.2.5
Thesearesuppliedinunidirectionalandfabricformsbutdonotpossessthesameintrinsicphysical
characteristicsofthermosetprepregs.Thermoplasticprepregstendtohave:
Poordrape,and
Notack.
Aprocurementspecificationofthermoplasticmatrixprepregscontainsfewerrequirementsthanthose
forthermosetprepregs.Factorsrelatingtomaterialcontentanddistributionareimportantbutthose
relatingtomatrixchemistryarelesscritical.
36.4.3
36.4.3.1
Specification
Itisenvisagedthatallthecharacteristicsdescribedsatisfytheapprovalofaprepregtoaspecification.
Many of the requirements are necessary for batch release to a specification. It is usually the
responsibility of the user to define a schedule of acceptance tests to ensure that released material
complieswiththespecificationtowhichitisreleased.
Itisfurtherenvisagedthattheconstituentresinandfibresystemintheprepreghavebeenvalidated,
batchreleasedandacceptedaccordingtoappropriatespecifications.
Aprocurementspecificationdefinesalltheitems.
36.4.3.2
A specification usually defines the way in which a consignment of prepreg is identified by the
manufacturer.Therequirementsforreeledprepregtapeandcutunidirectionalprepregsheetareoften
slightlydifferent.
148
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
36.4.3.3
Release documentation
It is usual practice for information additional to that set out in Identification and Marking to be
suppliedasreleasedocumentationaccompanyingeachbatchorshipment(whicheveristhesmaller)
ofmaterialreleasedtoaspecification.
36.4.3.4
Packaging
Bothfacesofaprepregareprotectedbynonmigratory,noncontaminatingbackingmaterials.
36.4.3.5
Prepreg construction
Theconstructionparametersofaprepregthatarecommonlyspecifiedare:
Thickness
Cohesion
Gapsandslits
Splicing
Dimensions:
width,
length.
Resincontent
Fibrecontent
Prepregmass
Volatilecontent
Tack
Edges
Flammability,toxicityandsafety
Shelflifeandshoplife
Fabricparameters:
weavetype
arealweight
warpandweftcharacteristics
Characteristicsasprovidedby:
HPLC
DSC
DMA
149
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
36.4.3.6
Prepregmaterialassuppliedinevitablyexhibitssomedefects.
Thedefinitionofdefectivematerialisasignificantareaderivedbyagreementbetweenmanufacturer
andcustomer,andcaninclude:
Discontinuoustows(excludingallowabletowsplices),
Prepregsplices,
Curedorhardenedresinparticles,
Fibrestarvedareas,
Resinvariations:
excessresin,or
resinstarvedareas,
Gapsorslits(inexcessofthosedefined),
Whorls,
Fuzzballs,
Anyimperfectioninfibrealignmentduetotowslackness:
kinks,
waves,or
twistedfibres.
Foreignmaterial,
Contamination,and
Anyotherfeaturesthatadverselyaffectitsperformance.
36.4.3.7
Itemstobedefinedare:
Testparameters,
Batchacceptanceandrejectioncriteria,and
Retestconditions.
36.4.3.8
It is common practice for a user to check incoming material by retesting for some or all the batch
acceptancerequirements.
Retestingisattheusersdiscretionandisnotnormallyincorporatedintoaprocurementspecification.
150
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
36.4.4
Laminate Characteristics
36.4.4.1
Minimum properties
Itisusualpracticetospecifyminimumphysicalandmechanicalpropertiesforalaminateproduced
fromtheprepregbymeansofadefinedcureschedule.
36.4.4.2
Cure schedule
The defined cure schedule is for specification purposes and need not correspond to the component
production cure; it is, however, within acceptable temperature limits. A number of curing cycle
repetitionshavingnoadverseinfluenceonthelaminatemechanicalpropertiescanbeincorporated,if
necessary.
Parametersandtheirinterrelationshipstobedefinedare:
Curetime(withallowablerange);
Curetemperature(withallowablerange);
Permissiblerangeofheatupandcooldownrates;
Curepressurerangeorcycling;
Preandpostcuredwellphasesandtheirpurpose.
36.4.4.3
Manufacturing factors
Ifsodesired,itemsforthepreparationoftestlaminatescanallbespecified,e.g.:
Tooling,
Prepregstackingsequence,
Releaseandbleedclothlayers,and
Stackassemblyforpreparingtestlaminates.
Thesamplecuttingpatternfromthelaminatecanalsobespecified.Itistheconventionalpracticeto
manufactureunidirectionallyreinforcedlaminatesforspecificationtestingpurposes.Specialtestscan
benecessaryinthecaseofwovenfibreprepreg.
36.4.4.4
Qualification testing
Various mechanical and physical properties are determined at ambient temperature and humidity
againstdefinedteststandardsagreedbetweenthesupplierandpurchaser.Theseinclude:
Longitudinaltensilestrength
Longitudinaltensilemodulus
Longitudinalcompressivestrength
Longitudinalcompressivemodulus
Transversetensilestrengthandmodulus
Transversecompressivestrength
Longitudinalflexuralstrengthandmodulus
151
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Transverseflexuralstrengthandmodulus
Shortbeamshearstrength(interlaminarshearstrength)
Fibrevolumefractionandvoidcontent
Laminatedensity
Laminateoutgassingandoffgassingperformance
Flammability
Toxicity
Ifnecessary,additionalelevatedtemperatureorhumidityconditionscanbeprescribed.
36.4.4.5
Guidelinesaresuggestedasapracticalminimumforrealisticqualitycontroltestingofaprepreg,for
approval,batchandincomingacceptancepurposes.
Other laminate tests can be defined to reflect the service conditions, e.g. compression or elevated
temperaturetests.
Usually,aminimumoffiveindividualtestsforeachpropertyarecarriedout,theindividualresults
arerecordedaspartofthereleasedocumentation.
Fibrevolumefraction:Tobewithinaspecifiedtolerance,usuallyabout3%ofadefinedfigure
intherange60to65%.
Thevaluesquotedaretypicalforcarbonfibreprepreg.
36.4.5
Test methods
Unfortunately, it is not feasible to give fully explicit guidance on applicable test methods for
incorporation into specifications. Practices vary considerably from country to country and from one
compositehardwareconstructortothenext.
Probably the most comprehensive range of applicable test methods is that published by ASTM and
ANSI,buteventhisisnotexhaustive.
For some properties, e.g. prepreg tack, no national standard test methods have been published: the
nonstandardonesthatdoexisthaveoftenbeenwrittenespeciallyforspecificationpurposes.
[Seealso:Chapter7fortestmethods;ESAPSS03207Appendix2]
152
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
36.5
References
36.5.1
ECSS documents
[See:ECSSwebsite]
ECSSEST3208
ECSSQST70
ECSSQ7071
Materials
Materials,mechanicalpartsandprocesses
Datafortheselectionofspacematerialsand
processes
36.5.2
ESA publications
ThedocumentscitedhavenotyetbeentransferredtotheECSSdocumentationsystem.
ESAPSS03207
Guidelineforcarbonandotheradvancedfibre
prepregprocurementspecification
153
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
37
Philosophy of assessment of design
allowables
37.1
Introduction
Design allowables are defined, [See: 37.3], and a procedure for the generation of allowable data for
developmentpurposesisprovided,[See:37.4].
Testdataforacarbonfibre/epoxycompositeisincluded,[See:37.5].
37.2
37.2.1
Design values
37.2.1.1
General
Strengthisverifiedbyanalysisunderusageofmaterialdatawhichisachievedwithaprobabilityof
99%onaconfidencelevelof95%,i.e.Avalues.
MILHDBK5,Ref.[372],givesinformationonhowthosedesignvaluescanbegeneratedwithbatch
tobatchvariationanddeliveriesfromdifferentsuppliers.Thenecessaryinformationinthisrespectis
notavailableandconsequentlytheapproachofMILHDBKcannotbeformallyapplied.Furthermore,
the extension to different suppliersis considered asnot justified if a materialis used onlyfrom one
source.
37.2.1.2
Procedure
ToovercometheproblemshighlightedwithrespecttoMILHDBK5,aprocedureisoutlinedonhow
to generate design allowables for unidirectional CFRP elements, manufactured from 914C/HM, 0.1
mmthickprepregs.
TheprocedureintentionallycoversthevariabilityofCFRPmaterialanddefinesdesignvalueswhich
can be achieved also in future manufacture, provided that the defined quality assurance provisions
aretaken.
154
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
37.3
37.3.1
At least 99% of the population of values is expected to equal or exceed the A basis mechanical
propertyallowable,withaconfidenceof95%.
37.3.2
At least 90% of the population of values is expected to equal or exceed the B basis mechanical
propertyallowable,withaconfidenceof95%.
37.4
Development procedure
Mechanical properties, relevant for an actual application, are often not tested during incoming
inspection. If they are, the values obtained from a few samples do not enable the generation of A
basisdesignallowables,[Seealso:37.3].
Inordertoobtaindatawhichcanbeusedduringthedevelopment,thepolicytobeimplementedis:
Theminimumacceptancevalueofasmallsampleisconsideredasthelowestaveragevalueof
anybatchaccepted.
Based upon present knowledge, the minimum values (99% probability of exceedance) are
estimatedunderindividualconsiderationoftheirtypicalscatterwithonebatch.
ThedataofamediumsizesampleareconsideredasnormallyhavingaGaussiandistribution.A
slightreservefactorcoveringuncertaineffectsonscatterofapproximately5%hasbeenapplied
additionally,butwhichcanberemovedifenoughstatisticaldatabecomeavailableintime.
Thedesignallowablesarenotjustifiedbythesupplier.Thisresultsinhighcostandpossibly
delaysindelivery.Testing,wherenecessary,istheresponsibilityoftheuser.Therefore:
Receiving inspection is based on low sample numbers against acceptance values which
needtobeexceededbyallthespecimensinsmallsamplesize;6specimens.
Thecustomerperformsadditionalmaterialtestingtoestablishthestatisticaldistribution.
Thiscanenableacceptanceofabatchwhichdoesnotmeettheacceptancerequirement,
butcanshowlowerscatterwithinthebatch.
37.5
Test data
37.5.1
Material
Thetestdatapresentedareforthehighmodulus,HM,carbonfibre/epoxysystem:
Prepreg914CMS440:batch75/51487
FibrechargeE2M352.
155
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
37.5.2
Data
37.5.2.1
General
Table37.5.1givesthepropertiesofthematerialobtainedfromtests.Thestatisticalbasedprobability
ofexceedancedataforthesamebatchofmaterialaregivenfor:
TensilestrengthUD0inFigure37.5.1.
TensilestrengthUD90inFigure37.5.2.
CompressionstrengthUD0inFigure37.5.3.
InterlaminarshearstrengthUD45inFigure37.5.4.
Table37.51TestdataforHMcarbon/epoxyspecimen
Tensile:
UD 0
Tensile:
UD 90
Compression:
UD 0
Interlaminar
shear strength:
0/45
SD
(mmxmm)
(N/mm2)
(N/mm2)
1x7
1121
122
738
45.6
5.8
27.3
898
45
756
64.5
7.8
40.0
SpecimenCross
section
R1tu
R1cu
Cross-section at
Failure
Facing
0.2 x 25
R13su (0/45
2.3 x 10
R2tu
Key:
Fourpointsandwichbending.
Values,excludingILS,relateto60%byvolumefibrecontent.
99%/95%
Values
(N/mm2)
156
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
37.5.2.2
Figure37.51Probabilityofexceedance:Tensilestrength0
157
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
37.5.2.3
Figure37.52Probabilityofexceedance:Tensilestrength90
158
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
37.5.2.4
Figure37.53Probabilityofexceedance:Compressivestrength90
159
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
37.5.2.5
Figure37.54Probabilityofexceedance:Interlaminarshearstrength
37.6
References
37.6.1
General
[371]
MBB/ERNO
Unpublishedwork
[372]
MILHDBK5F:Metallicmaterialsandelementsforaerospacevehicle
structures
November,1990
160
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38
Manufacturing techniques
38.1
Introduction
38.1.1
Processing techniques
Fibrereinforcedplasticscanbeprocessedbyanumberofmethods,Ref.[381],[382].
The majority of composite space structures are assembled from prepreg configurations, which are
laidupbyhandandthenmouldedinanautoclave,[See:38.4].
Filament winding, [See: 38.5], is also used, mainly for cylindrical configurations, [See also: Chapter
29].Variantsofthesewidelyacceptedprocessmethodsaredescribed.
Supportingprocesstechnologiesarealsodescribed.Theseinclude:
Resintransfermoulding,[See:38.7].
Pultrusion,[See:38.8].
Pressureforming,[See:38.10].
Information is also provided on developing technologies which have a possible future use, such as
radiationcuring,[See:38.12].
38.1.2
Process selection
Theselectionofasuitableprocessisinfluencedbyavariousfactors,including:
Designofstructure,
Materialsselection,
Equipmentavailability,
Componentconfiguration,
Unitnumbers,and
Costtomasstradeoffs.
The selection of a manufacturing route is often the result of a tradeoff between a minimum mass
designandacceptablecost.
[Seealso:ECSSQST70;ECSSQ7071]
161
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.2
Theselectionofaprocessis,intheory,determinedbyidentifyingthemostcosteffectivesolutionfor
thedesiredstructuralconfiguration.Thisisanidealisedassumptionwhichisbasedontheexpectation
thatthereisalsoanoptimumtechnicaldesignsolutionfortheapplication.
Inreality,anumberofdesignsareusuallyabletofulfiltheperformancespecification,Ref.[383].
Forexample,acceptabledesignconfigurationsforthrustcylindershavebeenproducedby:
Sandwichconstructionswithcompositefaceskinsandlightalloyhoneycombcores,
RibstiffenedmonolithicCFRPdesigns,and
FilamentwoundCFRParrangements,Ref.[384],[385].
Theselectionofaprocessisdrivenbyanumberofconsiderations,ofwhichthemainonesare:
Canpreviousdesignsandmanufacturingexperiencebeusedtofindasolution?
Foranewdesignconcept,isthereaccesstoappropriatemanufacturingfacilities?
Doestheprocessenableanoptimumfibreorientationandfibrevolumefractiontobeachieved?
Doestheprocessachievethedesiredcomponentshapeanddimensionaltolerances?
Whatisthepartcountfortheidentifiedprocessroute?
Whatarethesubsequentmachiningandfinishingoperationsaftercomponentprocessing?
Cantheprocessaccommodateloadintroductionpointsincomponents?
For design and quality control purposes, what material property data from the process route
needstobeobtained?
What are the cost implications with respect to manhours, tooling, consumable materials and
processtimes?[Seealso:Chapter40]
The selection of a manufacturing route is often based on tradeoffs between competing designs to
minimisemassandacceptablecosts.
38.3
Hand lay-up
38.3.1
General
Fibrereinforcedplasticsprocessinghastraditionallyinvolvedthemanuallayupofmaterials.Thisis
oftentheonlyroutepossiblewhenlownumbersofitemsaremadetoanyonedesign.Whenthescale
of manufacturing operations increases, the amount of manual involvement can be reduced by
automation. The aim is to reduce costs and improve product consistency. Automated and
programmableprepregcuttingsystemswereintroducedonthisbasis.
Manuallayupisusedin:
wet laminating,and
prepreg lay-up,priortoautoclaving.
162
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.3.2
Wet lamination
38.3.2.1
General
Wetlayupbyhandisamethodofmouldingcomponentsatroomtemperatureusingthermosetting
polyester and epoxy resins, usually with mat or woven roving reinforcements. A chemical reaction,
initiatedintheresinbyacatalyticagent,produceshardeningoftheresininthefinishedpart.
38.3.2.2
Process
Themouldandthegelcoveringareproperlyprepared.Choppedstrandmat,clothorwovenrovings
are cut to shape from reels using a utility razor knife, large scissors or an electric clothcutting
machine.
Measuredamountsofresinandcatalystarethenthoroughlymixedtogether.Theresinmixturecanbe
appliedtothereinforcementeitheroutsidethemouldorinsideit.Toensurecompleteremovalofair
and wetout of the fibres, the resin is applied first and the reinforcement is placed on top. Brushes,
squeezersandrollersareusedtocompactthematerialagainstthemouldsurfaceandtoremoveany
entrappedair,asshowninFigure38.3.1.
Figure38.31Handlayupprocessformatorcloth
Additional layers of mat or woven roving can then be applied until the total thickness has been
achieved. Layers of mat and woven roving are usually alternated to ensure good interlaminar
bonding,toavoidairentrapmentandtoensurethehigheststrength.
Fibrevolumecontentsvarywiththereinforcementtypeused,typicalvaluesare:
Allmatlaminate:25%to35%.
Matandwovenrovinglaminate:35%to45%.
Allclothmoulding:50%.
163
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table 38.3.1, Ref. [382], describes factors to be considered when selecting the wet layup process. It
detailswhatispossiblewithahandlayuptechnique.Someoftheselectionfactorsassociatedwiththe
wetlayuproutearegiveninTable38.3.2,Ref.[381].
Wetlaminationsarerarelyusedinspacestructureconfigurations.Somelaunchercomponentscanbe
appropriate, if low cost takes precedence over massefficient designs. Allcloth mouldings are
preferred because they offer acceptable massefficiency. Low numbers of complex shapes, such as
ducting,canbemadebythisprocess.
164
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table38.31Wetlayupandlaminating:Troubleshootingguide
Problem
Cause
Solution
Keep mixing containers clean and free of previously catalysed gel coat. Use
throw-away mixing containers.
Pre-gelling.
More uniform application of gel coat and better mixing with catalyst. Prevent
accidental or injuring blows.
Cure laminate in steps: use lower exotherm resin. Put more mat in front of
woven roving. Best solution is application of an intermediate layer of more
rigid resin-containing Vitro-Strand fibres.
Add 0.2% green pigment to lay-up resin to see voids. Work lay-up more freely
with brushes, squeegees, or serrated rollers. If possible, apply a liberal
quantity of resin onto work before applying reinforcement, so that the resin
forces air out from the bottom.
Select more highly wettable or soluble mat or woven roving. Use loose-mixed
putty to caulk small radii curvatures prior to lay-up. Redesign mould.
Correct placement and cutting errors. Lay in patches to correct thin spots
prior to removal from mould. Try pre-wetting of reinforcement by resin prior
to placement in mould.
For finish layer, apply woven fabric, woven roving, or veil mat on inside. After
cure, sand and apply splatter paint.
Introduce more thixotropic agent into resin. Continue to squeegee excess
resin out of collection points until gelling occurs. Add additional
reinforcement.
Use symmetric lay-up. Design slight radius in surface,
Allow full cure in mould.
Hard spot.
Bubbles.
Thin areas.
Environment changes.
Too close to gel time: styrene evaporation; rolling too
fast.
Use bag moulding, more woven roving, roving, use stiffener or sandwich
construction.
Adjust catalyst to weather changes.
Adjust gel time; adjust fans; dip roller in styrene or fresh resin; more
deliberate rolling.
165
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table38.32Handwetlayup:Selectionfactors
Characteristic
TypicalLimits
6.4 mm
Large
Yes
Yes
2 (0.035 rad)
0.76 mm
Virtually unlimited
0. 50 mm
As desired
Yes
Yes
Mould size
Yes
Yes
Difficult
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Random or directional
25 to 65 wt. %
38.3.3
Prepreg lay-up
38.3.3.1
General
Fabricationofadvancedcompositestructuresneedstheaccurateplacementofthereinforcingfibres,
withinamatrix,inanorientationthatprovidestheengineeringpropertiesspecifiedinthedesign.
PrepregmaterialsaresuppliedinaBstagecondition,inwhichthethermosettingresinhasalevelof
tack.Thermoplasticprepregsdonothavethisinherentfeature,[Seealso:6.36forprocessingmethods
forthermoplasticbasedcomposites].
38.3.3.2
Basic processes
LayerafterlayerofUDprepregtapes,orprepregfabrics,areplacedinaprescribedorientation,by:
Directlayup,wherepliesarelaidupdirectlyonply,withoutseparatetemplates,asshownin
Figure38.3.2.
Indirectlayup,whereseparateplytemplateswithsubsequentstackingoftheplies,asshownin
Figure38.3.3.
166
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Itiscommonpracticetopreassemblepliesonspecialplastictemplates.Thisprocedureisperformed
inacontrolledenvironment.
Table38.3.3showsthedetailedprocessstepsforprepreglayup.
Figure38.32Prepreg:Directlayup
Figure38.33Prepreg:Indirectlayup
167
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table38.33Processstepsforprepreglayup
Stage
Preparationofindividualplies
ProcessSteps
(1)AllowsealedprepregpackagetowarmtoRTbeforeopening;toavoidmoisturecondensation.
(2)Recordreel/sheet/batchnumbersasitisused.
(3)Wipeexposedtemplateswithsolventoncleanlintfreecloth,airdry.
(4)Unrollsufficientprepregforonestrip.
(5)Cuttorequiredlengthusingcleanscissorsorsharpknife.
(6)Placeprepregontemplate.
(7)Repeat(4)to(6)ensuringnogapsoccurbetweenadjacentstripswithintheply(layer).
(8)Workprepregagainsttemplatetoinsuregoodcontact.
(9)Removeseparatorstrip(backingfilm).
(10)Inspecteachplyfor:
fibredamage,
overlapsorgaps,
foreignmattercontamination.
(11)Repeat(4)to(10)forallplies.
(12)Storefinishedlayupflatinclean,moistureprooffilm.
Caution:MinimisethetimeprepregsarekeptatRT.
Preparationofmould
(1)Clean,toremoveallforeignmaterial.
(2)Polish,tocreatesmoothsurface.
(3)Solventwipeandairdry.
(4)Applyrelease(parting)agent.
(5)Applynonporouscoatedfabric,ifpartisnottobecuredincontactwithmould.
168
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Stage
Transferlayuptomould
ProcessSteps
(1)Applypeelply,ifrequired.(Foradhesivebondingorpainting).
(2)Aligntemplateontool,notingfibreorientation.
(3)Removeairtrappedbetweenplies,withrollerorsqueegee.
(4)Removetemplate,takingcareifprepregsareverytacky.
(5)Inspectfordamageandcontamination.
(6)Repeat(1)to(5)untilallpliesareassembled.
Caution:Documenteachplyset.
Preparationforcure
(1)Coverlayupwithperforatedreleasematerial.Donotextendoveredges.
(2)Assembleandsealboundarysupports(dams)aroundedges.
169
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.4
Autoclave moulding
38.4.1
Use
Consolidationofstackedthermosettingprepregsbyautoclavecuringisthemostwidelyusedmeans
ofpreparingcompositeswithahighfibrevolumefraction.Withautoclavechambersavailableupto4
m diameter, there are few size limitations on manufacturing composite sections for satellites and
launchers.
Thecapitalinvestmentinanautoclavefacilityishighandprocessingtimesarelong.Therefore,access
to an optimumsized autoclave (from a cost perspective) can be a major criterion in a successful
project.
38.4.2
Basic process
Bstageprepregsareheatedgraduallytoinduceacontrolledresinflowandassistintheeliminationof
entrapped air and volatiles. Pressure is applied over a bag membrane to induce full consolidation
beforeresingellingoccurs.Fullcuringisachievedbymaintainingthebagunderpressureatelevated
temperature.
There are a number of variations to the basic process. These are often represented by plots of time
againstappliedpressureandtemperature.
Thepossiblevariableswithintheprocessinclude:
Debulking,
Heating(ramp)rates,
Typeofmouldmaterial,
Applicationofpositiveorvacuumpressuretothebaggedmoulding,
Dwellperiods,
Controlledbleedorzero-bleedprepregsystems,
Peel Plies,
Co-Curing,
Coolingratesandpressurerelease.
Postcuringofthelaminatedcomponentcanbeundertakenafterthepartisremovedfromthemould.
170
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.4.3
38.4.3.1
General
Bagmoulded fibre reinforced resinmatrix composites and bonded structures can comply with the
differentstandardsofqualityfordifferentdesigncriteria.Thebagmouldingprocesscanbeadapted
andoptimisedtoproducecompositeswhichperformadequately,andcompetewithalternativetypes
ofconstruction.
Innovativeadaptationsofbagmouldingprocessesareoftenmadetocreatesingle,complex,composite
structures,ratherthanseveralseparatepartswhichthenneedjoiningtogether,i.e.reducedpartcount.
38.4.3.2
Autoclave process
A prepreg stack, with all of the necessary release layers, is draped over a mould. A polymer
membraneisthensealedtothemouldsurface,awayfromtheprepreg,toformthebag.
In the autoclave chamber, the bag is placed under vacuum, so that the bag and prepreg are pulled
downagainstthemouldsurface.Positiveexternalpressureisappliedtothemouldingbypressurising
theautoclavechamber.Theadvantageofanautoclaveistheabilitytoapplya0.69MPaorabout6bar
(100 psi) positive pressure to augment the 0.1 MPa (15 psi) from the vacuum. This enables low
voidage composites to be made from high fibre volume fraction prepregs, without the need for
matcheddie,pressuretooling.
38.4.3.3
Modified processes
Bag moulding can be modified to enable a positive pressure to be applied during consolidation
withoutuseofanautoclave.Someoftheprocessmodificationsinclude:
Mouldingwithoutanadditionalexternalpressure,i.e.withonlythe1bar(15psi)atmospheric
pressure from the vacuum as the consolidating force. This relies on good resin flow and bled
prepregstoensuretheeliminationofvoidage.Fibrevolumefractionscanbelowerthanbyfull
pressureconsolidation.
Usingthemouldaspartofthepressurecontainment,or
Modifyingaplatenpresstoenablegaspressurisation.
Thevariousprocessesillustratedare:
VacuumbaginFigure 38.4.1,Ref.[382].
AutoclavemouldinginFigure 38.4.4,Ref.[382].
InFigure38.4.1andFigure38.4.4,thearrangementsshownareforpreparingflatlaminates.
Forcomplexshapesproducedbythesemethods,theuseofrigidcaulplatesisoftennotfeasible.
171
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure38.41Vacuumbagmouldingmethod,withverticalbleeder
Figure38.42Pressurebagmoulding
172
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure38.43Pressurebagmoulding:Pressmodifications
Figure38.44Autoclavemouldingmethod,withverticalbleeder
173
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.4.4
38.4.4.1
Bags
Bags are thin, flexible membranes or silicone rubber shapes, which separate the lay up from the
pressurising gases during the composite cure. Consolidation and densification of the layup is
achievedbytheresultingpressuredifferentialsacrossthebagcontents.Thevarioustypesare:
Vacuum bags: Consolidation and densification of vacuum bag mouldings can be achieved by
atmospheric pressure alone as the bagged lay ups are evacuated during the cure cycles.
Vacuumbagmouldingistheleastlimitedastothesizewhichcanbeprocessed.
Pressure bags: Pressure baggedandautoclave cured composites are pressurised by hot gases.
Ventstotheatmosphere,orvacuum,providefortheescapeofvolatilereactionbyproductsand
theentrappedairfromthecuringcomposites.
Autoclavebags:Thebaggedlayupsinautoclavesareusuallyventedtoapressurelowerthan
thatappliedtothebag.
NOTE
38.4.4.2
Thesearesimilartopressurebags.
Consolidation
Consolidation is achieved when the separate prepreg plies within the lay ups, together with other
adherends(ifpresent),arebondedtogether.
38.4.4.3
Densification
Densificationresultsindiminutionofvoids,andremovalofexcessresin,ifappropriate.
38.4.4.4
Cure
Although vacuum bag moulded composites can be cured at room temperature, most are cured at
elevatedtemperaturestoimprovetheproperties.Thetypesofcurecanbegroupedas:
Thermal cures: These are best attained in circulating air ovens, but can be achieved using
infraredheatedorpassiveconvectionovens.
Alternativecuringmethods,[Seealso:38.12]:
Induction,
Dielectric,
Microwave,
Xenonflash,
Ultraviolet,
Electronbeam,and
Gammaradiation.
38.4.4.5
Other features
Duringcure,thevariousbagmouldingmethods:
Preventblisteringinthecomposites,
174
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Controlpressureandheatapplication,and
Controltheratiooffibretoresin.
38.4.5
Bagging techniques
38.4.5.1
Debulking
Debulking reduces the possibility of porosity in critical areas. It can be necessary when preparing
prepreg stacks with a large number of individual plies, or when complex shapes are involved. The
process involves placing some of the uncured plies in the mould and forming them to the mould
surfaceusingavacuumbag.Thebagisthenremovedandfurtherpliesaddedtothemouldstack.If
necessary,itisrepeatedseveraltimesespeciallyforthicklaminates.
38.4.5.2
The bags form a membrane enabling the air to be evacuated from the laminate and to generate the
atmosphericpressurenecessaryforcompactionagainstthemould.
38.4.5.3
The bags serve to apply the compacting gas pressure to the construction during the cure. The
atmospherewithinthebagisventedtoalowerpressuretoenableremovaloftrappedairandreaction
products.
38.4.5.4
Theneedforableedsystemdependsontheprepregresinformulation,where:
Zerobleedprepregsystemshavegainedwideracceptanceasameansofproducingcomposites
withpredeterminedfibrevolumefractions.Theseprepregshaveresinswithoptimisedviscosity
andgelationcharacteristicstoavoidexcessiveresinflowtoeliminatevoidage.
Controlledbleedprepregsremainandareusedasameansofassistingconsolidation.
Bleedoutsystemsaredesignedtomaintainthereducedpressureswithinthebag.Ifthisisnotdone,
gaspressurewithinthebagpreventsconsolidation.
Thecorrectapplicationofpressureachieves:
Consolidationofthesuccessiveplies,
Completionoftheresinimpregnationofthefibre,
Eliminationof:
voidcreatingvolatiles,
reactionbyproducts,and
entrappedair.
reductionoftheexcessresininthelayup.
Thebaggedlayupincludesthebleedoffsystemdesignedforthecompositepart.Baggedlayupscan
beverticallyoredgebled.
175
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Theclassicaldifferencesbetweenthetwoareillustratedfor:
Verticalbleed,[See:Figure38.4.4].
EdgebleedinFigure38.4.5,Ref.[382].
Verticalbleedisusuallymoreefficientthanedgebleed.
Figure38.45Bagmoulding:Edgebleedoutsystem
38.4.6
Tool materials
38.4.6.1
General
Variousmouldortoolingmaterialsareused,notablysteel,aluminium,compositesandInvar.
Eachhasitsownmeritsandthechoiceisusuallyinfluencedbyacombinationofthe:
Mouldcost,e.g.material,shape,precision.
Thermalconductivity,
Thermalexpansion:matchingCTE(toolmaterial)withCTE(mouldingmaterial),
Durability(reuse).
The merits of various tool materials are shown in Table 38.4.1. The comments apply to CFRP
mouldings.
176
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table38.41Toolingforcomposites:RelativemeritsofvarioustypesforCFRP
Factor
Steel
Aluminium
CFRP
Invar
Cost
Low
Medium
High
Thermal
Conductivity
Thermal
Expansivity
Mould mass
Durability
Medium
High
Medium/Hig
h
Medium/Low
Medium
Medium
High
Low
Low
High
Good
Medium
Reasonable
Low
Reasonable
High
Reasonable
38.4.6.2
Steel
Steel moulds are used because it is a lowcost material, easily machined and durable. For
manufacturingaccuratelydimensionedCFRPcomponents,theCTEdifferencebetweensteel(+15x10
6/C)andCFRP(from1to+3x106/C)canbetoogreat.Steelexpandsappreciablyduringheatingto
thecuretemperatureandthencontracttoagreaterextentthanthemouldingoncooling.
38.4.6.3
Aluminium
Aluminium has good thermal conductivity, which assists in obtaining an even temperature
distribution. However, its thermal expansion is very high (+23 x 106 /C). It is also more easily
damagedthansteelandcansufferthermaldistortionwithrepeatedheatingandcoolingupto180C;a
typicalprocessingtemperatureforthermosettingCFRP.
38.4.6.4
Composite (CFRP)
By using CFRP for the mould tool, a close CTE match can be achieved with the moulding.
Consequently,thedimensionsofthemouldchangelittleduringtheprocessingcycle.AsCFRPtools
cannotbemachinedfromstockmaterial,theyaremouldedfromamaster.Thisinturnisachievedby
machining a replica of the final component surface and preparing a mould from it. The replica is
usually steel or machinable ceramic. The tool can be made using low temperature curing epoxy
prepreg,whichispostcuredtogiveatoolingCFRPwithahighglasstransitiontemperature.CFRP
toolingshouldbecarefullystoredandhandledtopreventdistortionordamage.Thereisoftenalimit
onthenumberofelevatedtemperaturemouldingswhichcanbetakenfromasingleCFRPtool.
38.4.6.5
Invar
TheCTEofInvaris0.9x106/C,whichissimilartothatofCFRPcomponents.Thehighmaterialcost
andlowthermalconductivitydetractfromitswidescaleusage.
38.4.6.6
Othermaterialsareoccasionallyused,including:
Graphite
Castceramic
Thesecanbeeasilyshapedbutarenotparticularlydurable.Theycanbeusedforprototypemoulds.
177
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.4.7
Cure schedules
AtypicalcurescheduleforthemouldingofthermosettingCFRPisgiveninFigure38.4.6.
Cure schedules are usually recommended by prepreg manufacturers, based on the preparation of
simple,flatlaminates.
For complexshaped mouldings, it can be necessary to modify the recommended cure schedule to
produceacceptablequalitylaminates.Thiscanbeachievedthroughexperienceofaparticularprepreg
orbyevaluationstudiesforanewprepregsystem.
The critical aspect of any cure schedule is the total time. This is determined by establishing the
optimumconditionsforconsolidatingtheprepregtoproducevoidfreecompositesofthecorrectfibre
volumefraction.Thetotalcurecyclecannotbetoolongortooshort.
Comments:
Forpressuredcurecycleapplypressurefromstart.
Forvacuumcuredthicksections(>3.2mm),insertionofa60minutedwellat100Cis
recommended.
Figure38.46Typicalcurescheduleforautoclavedprepregs
Featuresofthecurescheduleare:
Temperatureramprate,usuallyvariesbetween1and6C/min.Itisdeterminedbythe:
gelcharacteristicsoftheresin,
resinviscosity(zerobleedorcontrolledbleedsystems),
thermalinertiaoftheautoclave,assembledtoolingandmoulding.
Dwell periods, which are used to eliminate voidage by enabling resin flow prior to gelation.
Thereisanincentivetoreduceoravoiddwellperiodsinordertoreducethetotalelapsedtime.
178
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Cooldownrate,whichislargelydictatedbyhowquicklytheautoclaveandtoolingassembly
canbecooledtothepointwherehandlingthemouldingispossible,takingintoaccountthat:
unevencoolingofamouldingiscancausedistortion.
vacuum is maintained on the moulding during cooling and possibly some positive
overpressureonthebag.
Although reducing the maximum temperature in the autoclave can reduce residual stresses in the
curedmoulding,itoftenresultsinanextendedcurecycleinordertoobtainthesamecrosslinkdensity
inthecuredresin.
38.5
Filament winding
38.5.1
Basic process
Filament winding was one of the earliest techniques used to produce composite materialstructures.
This process uses continuous strands of glass, carbon or aramid fibres which are continuously
impregnatedwithalowflowresin.Thestrandsarethenwoundontoamandrel,whichprovidesthe
finalgeometry.
38.5.2
Applications
Variousstructurescanbefabricatedusingthistechnique,including:
Cylindricaltubes;themostcommonapplication,Ref.[384].
Containersforfluids,gasesorsolids.Thesecanhaveopeningsattheirpoles.
Flatpanels,byfirstwindingonamandrel,thencuttingthefinishedlayupalongthelengthof
themandrel,flatteningandcuringunderpressure.
Geodesiclatticestructures.
Filamentwindingprovidesanefficientmeansofobtainingoptimisedpressurevesselstructures,[See
also:Chapter29].
Dependingontheappliedloads,weightsavingscanbeobtainedbychangesto:
fibreangle,or
thicknessoflayup.
Modernwindingmachines,knownaswindingrobots,canproduceverycomplexgeometrypartsby
usingnonlinearwindingprograms.
179
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.5.3
Winding process
Themainprocessstepsconsistof:
Fibrepreparation:Afterthechoiceoftheappropriatefibre,giventhedefinedrequirementsfor
thestructure,fibrebatchesare:
dried,inanovenatabout130Cforseveralhours.
stored,at60Cforsomedays.
Fibreimpregnation,bycontinuouslypullingfibresthroughabathofresin,asshowninFigure
38.5.1. To control the resin content, the impregnated fibres are squeezed through a pair of
rollers.
Tensioning:Theimpregnatedstrandpassesthroughrollerstoprovideacertainpretensionin
thefibre.
Strandguidance:Thestrandsarepassedthroughaguide,andthentothemandrel.
Winding,ofthestructure.
Precure:Thefinalfilamentwoundstructureisthenheatedbyinfraredlighttoabout80Cin
ordertoprecuretheresin.
Finalcure:Afterprecure,thestructureisplacedinanautoclavetoperformthefinalcuringat
normally130Cforseveralhours.Thecuretemperaturedependsontheparticularresinsystem.
Removemandrel:Dependingonthetype,[Seealso:Mandrels]:
Reusableareextractedfromthestructure,or
Lostarebrokenandremoved.
Postcure,ifnecessary.
Figure38.51Filamentwinding:Impregnationoffibres
180
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.5.4
Mandrels
38.5.4.1
General
Geometry and quality of the inner surface of the filamentwound structure depend on the material
andonthesurfaceofthemandrelused.Factorstobeconsideredinclude:
extraction,
material,
surfacepreparation,and
componentshrinkage.
38.5.4.2
Reusable
For wound tubes,a mandrel of polished or chromeplated steel is commonlyused. Other materials,
e.g. aluminium, need more effort concerning release agents. A collapsing mandrel is another
possibilitytoenableitsreleasefromthestructure.
38.5.4.3
Lost
Forspheres,ellipsoidorcylindricalcontainershavingawoundend,normallylostmandrelsareused.
Thesecanbemadefrom:
Sandinasolublebinder,
Gypsum,
Foam,or
Lowmeltingpointmaterials.
Thesemandrelsneedafinalsurfacetreatmenttoprovidegoodrelease.
38.5.4.4
Integral
Forapplicationsthatneedaninnerlinertopreventleakageordamagetothecompositestructure,e.g.
pressure vessels. The mandrel can form part of the finished structure. This is also called over
wrapping,i.e.wherethelinerisusedasthemandrel.
38.5.4.5
Component shrinkage
Mostresinsystems,andthereforethereinforcedstructures,tendtoshrinkaftercuring.Thiscanmake
themandreldifficulttoremove.Amandrelwithahighercoefficientofthermalexpansion,relativeto
thecompositestructure,canbeheatedduringthewindingsothatoncoolingdownitcontractsaway
fromthecomponent,soaidingitsremoval.
38.5.5
Sandwich constructions
Windingofinnerskinontomandrel,
Bondingofhoneycombcoreontoinnerskin,
Overwindingouterskintocompletethecylinder.
181
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.5.6
Tape winding
Narrow, continuous widths of Bstage prepreg can be used instead of fibres wetted with uncured
resin. The width of prepreg tape is limited when winding complex shapes to ensure that the fibres
conform to the mould in an acceptable manner. This route is suited to winding cylinders, but not
necessarilyfordirectwindingontohoneycombcorematerial.
Tapewindingisalsoapplicabletothermoplastics,Ref.[386].
[Seealso:6.26]
38.6
Filament-winding machines
38.6.1
General
Machines,designedtoperformwindingprocesses,arecommonlyeither:
polarplanar,or
helical.
Allmachinesareavailableinseveralvariants,whichaddversatilityandcompensatesforsomeoftheir
weaknesses.
The development of computercontrolled, filamentwinding robots has made complex winding
patternsforlargestructuresfeasible,[See:29.2].
38.6.2
Polar winding
Polar machines are generally used for the production of containers with diametertolength ratios
greaterthan0.5.
Vertical mandrel: Polar winding machines normally have the mandrel mounted in a vertical
position, which enables a simpler construction of the rotating arm because deflection of the
mandreliseliminated;asshowninFigure38.6.1.Thisarrangementislimitedtostructuresof
moderatesize.
Horizontalmandrel:Forlargewindings,themandrelissupportedinahorizontalpositionand
therotatingthreadguideplacesthefibresonthemandrel,asshowninFigure38.6.2.
Tumbler:Avariationofthenormalpolarwindingsystemisthetumblingprocessinwhichthe
thread guide remains stationary while the mandrel rotates or tumbles in a near horizontal
plane,asshowninFigure38.63.Theinclinationofthemandreltothehorizontaldeterminesthe
windingangle.
182
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure38.61Filamentwinding:Polarvertical
Figure38.62Filamentwinding:Polarhorizontal
183
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure38.63Filamentwinding:Polartumbling
38.6.3
Helical winding
Helicalwindingmachinesconsistofarotatingmandrelandareciprocatingthreadguidancecarrier,as
showninFigure38.6.4.
Inadditionathirdmotionperpendiculartothemandrelaxisisappliedtoimprovethefibreplacement
overtheenddomes.
To achieve optimum placement of the fibres on a geodesic path, sophisticated control of the thread
guidanceisnecessary.Thewindingangleisdeterminedbytheratioofmandrelrotationtothespeed
ofthethreadcarrier.
Figure38.64Filamentwinding:Helical
184
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.7
38.7.1
General
Resintransfermoulding,RTM,isalowercostcomponentproductionprocessthanprepreglayupand
autoclavecuring.CertaincomplexshapescanbemorereadilymadebyRTMthanbyothermoulding
routes,Ref.[387],[388].
38.7.2
Basic process
A fibre preform, formed to the intended component shape, is placed in a matched mould, which is
thenclosed.Alowviscosityresinisinjectedintothemouldandallthefibreswettedthroughuntilthe
mould is filled. The resin is injected under pressures of about 0.69MPa (100 psi), with or without
vacuum assistance in the mould cavity. A heated curing cycle is applied. The cure conditions are
dependentontheresinused.
ThesimilaritiesbetweenRTMandresininjectionmoulding,RIM,canmakeitdifficulttodistinguish
betweenthem.
TheRTMprocessisasimpleconcept,asshowninFigure38.7.1.However,theprocessingparameters
shouldbecarefullycontrolledtoensurehighqualitynetshapecomponents.
Proprietary technology packages are becoming available which match the resin and fibre preform
technology.AnexampleistheInjectexsystemfromBrochierCibaGeigy.
Figure38.71Resintransfermoulding(RTM):Process
185
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.7.3
Applications
Within industry generally, RTM is applied where the component production numbers are high;
typically measured in hundreds or thousands per year. This is not normally the case with space
structure manufacturing which rarely exceeds ten units in total, except for launchers, e.g. Ariane
series,orforelementsinlatticestructures.
The attraction of the process for space applications is closely linked with the need for complicated
componentshapes,i.e.thosewhichcannotbereadilyproducedbyothercompositemouldingroutes.
Someexamplesofsuchcomponentsinclude:
nosecones,
radomes,
integrallystiffenedpanels,
complexshapedducting,
CFRPadapterrings;asforArianelaunchers,Ref.[389],
J,T,C,andIstructuralshapes,Ref.[3810],
braidedringsandtubes,Ref.[3811],
nozzlecomponents,Ref.[3812].
RTMismostpracticalforthicknessesintherangeof2mmto12mmandnotforverythinsections.
Tolerances on wall thickness depend on the accuracy and stiffness of the mould tooling. Typically
wallthicknesscanhaveatoleranceof0.25mm.Fibrevolumefractionsareusuallyslightlylowerthan
thoseachievedwithpressureconsolidatedprepregs.
Polymer composite mouldings made by RTM are used for preparing hightemperature composites.
Using pyrolysis, the moulding (green part) can be converted to carboncarbon or SiCbased
constructions. These preforms are subsequently densified by further infiltration methods, e.g. CVD,
CVIorfurtherresinadditions.
[See:Chapter88formanufacturingtechniquesusedforhightemperaturecompositecomponents]
38.7.4
Fibre preforms
38.7.4.1
General
The development of versatile and costeffective fibre placement technology is central to RTM
manufacturingasachievehighproductivity.
Theuseofmachinerytocreateanetshapepreformwithallthefibresinthedesiredorientationsand
quantitiesisessentialtoavoidcostlymanuallabour.Preformscanbeproducedfrom:
Wovenfabrics,
Tubularorflatbraiding,
Stitchedlayers,
Multidirectionalweavings,
Knittedsections.
Fibre volume fractions can be varied between 30%and 70% by volume, but50 volume % is typical.
Bothcarbonandglassfibresareused.
186
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.7.4.2
Binders
A polymeric binder is often used to hold the preform together. Such binders have to be compatible
withthematrixresinandassistresinimpregnation.
38.7.4.3
Cores
Foamcorescanbeincorporatedwiththefibrepreformtoprovidesupportforthinwallconstructions.
38.7.5
Resin injection
38.7.5.1
General
Anewgenerationofthermosettingresinsareformulatedspecificallywithoptimumviscosityandcure
characteristicsforRTMprocessing.Theseinclude:
Epoxies,
Bismaleimides,
Others,including:cyanateesters,phenolicsandsilicones.
38.7.5.2
Epoxies
ExamplesofepoxyresinsformulatedforRTMprocessinginclude:
ShellRSL1895/W,Ref.[3813],[3814]andDPL862/RSC763(twopartliquidepoxies),
ShellEpon9400/9450and9405/9470,Ref.[3811],
HerculesHBRF311andHBRF314,
3MPR500(hotmelt),
DowPlasticDER300(hotmelt)andTactix123,
BPE905L,Ref.[3814],
CibaGeigyXUMY722/RD91103,Ref.[3815].
38.7.5.3
Bismaleimides
ExamplesofbismaleimideresinsformulatedforRTMprocessinginclude:
X20644(DowUnitedTechnologies)basedonBASF52504prepregresin(hotmelt),
ModifiedMatrimid5292(CibaGeigy),Ref.[3816],
Compimide65FWR(Technochemie/Shell),Ref.[3817],
XNF650(Hexcel).
38.7.5.4
Others
OtherchemicalgroupsofresinsforRTMprocessinginclude:
Cyanateesters,e.g.DowXU71787,Ref.[3818],[Seealso:6.35].
Phenolics,Ref.[3812],
Silicones,Ref.[3812].
187
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.7.6
Process variables
38.7.6.1
General
Theprocessvariablescanbesummarisedas,Ref.[3819]:
Resinviscosity(initially25cpsto50cps)dependingon:
temperature,
potlife.
Dryfibrepreformandbinderhavetobewettablebyliquidresin,e.g.Injectexsystem.
Applicationofpressureandvacuumtocontrolresininfiltration.
Positionandnumberofinletandoutletports.
Initialdegassingofresin.
Evacuationofairfrompreform.
Toolingmaterialformatchedmaleandfemalemouldparts.
Mouldclampingandsealing.
Mouldtemperatureandpostcure.
38.7.6.2
Resins
The resin can be either a onepart system (hotmelt, similar to prepreg formulation) or twopart
(liquids mixed at the point of use). Onepart systems are normally used for aerospace components,
Ref.[3820],becausethisenables:
greaterconfidenceinchemicalcompositionfromtheresinsystemsupplier,
similarcuredresinperformancetothatachievablebyprepregs,
roomtemperaturestorageforupto6months.
38.7.6.3
Forsuccessfulmouldings,theflowofresinintothemouldcavityandpreformshouldbeoptimised,
Ref.[3821],[3822].Problemstoavoidare:
Gellingoftheresinbeforethepreformiscompletelyfilled.
Incompleteresinflow,leavingtrappedairandhencevoidage.
Suchdefectsarelimited,largelybytrialanderror,ifalargeproductionrunisanticipated.Forvery
limited unit production numbers, the process needs to be optimised at the planning stage to avoid
unsuccessful prototypes. Consequently, computeraided design tools are often used to model the
process,Ref.[3821].
38.7.7
Process advantages
TheindividualprocessadvantagesofRTMarenotnecessarilyunique.Buttakenasawhole,RTMcan
beappropriateforsomecomponentdesigns.ThecharacteristicsofRTMinclude:
Preformsenablemultidirectionalreinforcementplacementtoimprovedamagetolerance.
Goodsurfacedetailandaccuracy.
188
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Complexshapes,withintegralstiffening,canbemadeinasinglemoulding.
Nearnetshapepartsneedingminimummachining.
Reinforcementlayupisdryinsteadoftackyprepreg.
Refrigeratedshippingandstorageisnotalwaysnecessary.
Closeprocesscontrolcanreducetheneedfornondestructiveinspection.
Sectionshavingvariablethicknessarepossible.
Totalprocesstimesarereducedcomparedwithautoclaving.
38.8
Pultrusion
38.8.1
Use
Tubesforlargelatticestructures,
Profilesforconstantsectionribstiffeners,
Ducting,whereofftheshelfpultrudedsectionsaresuitable.
Continuous sections up to 1m wide can be made by pultrusion, including integral stiffeners and
doubleskinconstructions.
Intheearly1980s,NASAexaminedthepossibilityofusinganinorbitpultrusionfacilitytoproduce
thermoplastic composite sections in space rather than transporting formed lengths from Earth. The
sectionswerethentohavebeenassembledtoformthemainstructuralelementsofaspacestation.
38.8.2
Basic process
38.8.2.1
Thermosetting resins
ThebasicprocessisshowndiagrammaticallyinFigure38.8.1.Theprocessstepsare:
Spoolsoffibres(sufficientfortheproductionrun)arepurchasedandarrangedtomakeupthe
necessaryfibrefractioninthefinalcompositesection.
Fibretowsaregatheredanddrawnthrougharesinbathandimpregnated.
Impregnated fibres are continuously drawn (maximum 1m/min) through a heated die of the
desiredcrosssectiontoshapethecomposite.
Alongdieisused,whichincorporatesappropriateheatingelements.
Thetotalelapsedtimewithintheheateddieregionissufficienttofullycuretheresin.
189
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
NOTE
Hauloffequipmenttakesthefinishedproductawayfromthedie,andthepultrusioniscutto
specifiedormanageablelengths.
Figure38.81Pultrusion:Basicprocess
Thestartupcostscanbehigh,becauseofthe:
Complexheated,shapeddie,and
Procuring sufficient spools of fibre for the crosssectional area of pultrusion to be made; cost
dependsonthetypeofcarbonfibresspecified.
38.8.3
Pull-forming
38.8.3.1
General
Thisisamodifiedpultrusionprocessincorporatingdirectshapemoulding.
38.8.3.2
Process
Fibre and resin are combined by drawing them through a shaped die to the desired length. That
length is then enclosed in a mould and formed to the final shape by application of direct heat and
pressure.Thefibresarecutasthemouldcloses.Thismethodenableschangesinsectiontobemadein
themoulding.Ahighdegreeofautomationisretainedbecausethecontinuousdrawingprocesscan
beoperatedusinganumberofmoulds.
190
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.9
Table rolling
38.9.1
Tubular sections
Tablerollingcanbeusedforproducingfinitelengthsofcylindricalorfinetaperedtubularsections.
Theprocesscanbeappliedto:
unidirectionalthermosettingfibreprepregsforsmalldiametersections,
fabricprepregsforlargerdiameters.
Prepregisrolledontoasteelmandrelformerandbaggedforautoclavemoulding.Theprocessneeds
careful control to prevent ply rucking on small diameter sections. This can occur during the
consolidationastherolledprepregcompactstothefinaldiameter.
Thewallthicknessofthesectionsproducedcanvarybecausetheprepregendsareoverlapped.
38.10
38.10.1 General
Consolidated laminates of some typesof compositematerials can be shaped by plastic deformation,
i.e.pressureormechanicalforming.Thematerialsthiscanbeappliedtoare:
FMLfibremetallaminates,[See:46.1.5formaterials]
Thermoplasticmatrixcomposites,[See:6.26].
Variationsofthebasicpressureformingtechniqueareusedforthesemaintypesofmaterials.
Theamountofplasticdeformationisrestrictedbythe:
Limitedretentionoflaminateintegrity.
Controlofreductioninthickness.
Shapecomplexity,i.e.multiplecurvaturesanddeeprecesses.
Rollforming,
Brakepressbending,
Rubberbackedbending,
Stretchforming,and
Rubberpadforming.
191
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Pressclaving,
Diaphragmmoulding,
Hotorcoldforming,and
Deepdrawing.
[See:6.26forprocessdescriptions]
Diaphragm moulding, in conjunction with a modified autoclave, has produced parts with complex
curvatures,Ref.[3823].Forexample:PEEKAPC2aircraftspoilersections,upto2.2mlong,havebeen
madewithin20minutes.
[Seealso:38.11formouldingofshortfibrereinforcedthermoplasticcomposites]
38.11
Injection moulding
38.11.1 General
Injection moulded is usually associated with the highvolume manufacture of industrial and
consumer products, i.e. large number of identical parts. Occasionally, injectionmoulded,
thermoplastic components are used in space applications, but the high mould costs need to be
justified. It can be feasible for small attachments, where other composite processing routes are not
practical.
[See:6.17forfurtherinformationonthermoplasticmatrices]
192
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Theitemstargetedforinjectionmouldingwere:
Highflowlatchbracket,
Cantileverpipesupport,
Pyrovalve,
Pressuretransducer,
Fillanddrainvalve,
Pipesupport,and
Liquidfilter.
38.12
Radiation curing
Sterilisationoffoodormedicaldevices,
Crosslinkingofthermoplasticbasedmaterial,
Dryingofcoatingsandinks.
38.12.1.2 Composites
Theuseofheatinelevatedtemperatureprocessesistheacceptedmethodforcrosslinking(curing)of
thermosettingresinformulations.
Withtheoverallaimofimprovingprocessefficiency,thereisanincreasinginterestinusingdifferent
formsofelectromagneticenergyinordertoobtaincrosslinking,Ref.[3825]to[3834].
Resinsareformulatedtobereceptivetoradiationenergyandsoachieveefficientcrosslinking.
Using energy sources, other than heat, within industrial processes for composites is a fairly recent
innovation,soequipmentwithaprovencapabilityisuncommon.
Thebroadcategoriesofradiationappliedtocompositeresincuringare:
Electronbeam,EB.
Microwave.
Ultravioletlight,UV.
Reducedprocesstimes,i.e.rapidcure,
Reducedenergyconsumption,
193
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Lowerprocesstemperatures,
Reducedinternalstressesinthecuredcomposite,
Improvedpolymerisation,
Reducedretentionofvolatiles.
EBtechniquesofferthecapabilityofcuringverylargestructuresoutofautoclave,usinglow
energybeamscoupledwithwindingmachines.
Complexshapesandassembliescanbeprocessedeasily
Thermalgradientsinthickcompositepartsaremoremanageable.
Toolingislessexpensiveduetothelowertemperaturesthattheyexperience.
Shelflifeofmostcurableformulationsisveryadvantageous.
VOCemissionsarereduced.
Processingtimesareshorter.
Energycostsarereduced.
Polymerisation,
Crosslinking,
Materialdegradationbychainscission.
Radical:mainly(meth)acrylatebasedformulations,
Cationic:epoxyresins.
TypicaladvantagesanddrawbacksofbothsystemsaresummarisedinTable38.12.1.
194
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table38.121EBcuring:Advantagesanddrawbacksofepoxyandacrylateresins
CharacteristicsofEBcuringformulations,bypolymerisationmode
Process
stage
Freeradical(Acrylates)
Advantages
Cationic(Epoxy)
Drawbacks
Advantages
Drawbacks
Poor initiator
compatibility
Low stability
Pre-cure
propertie
s
Low cost
chemicals
Shelf
stability
Compatibility
with
thermoplastic
additives
During
cure
No initiator
needed
Easier
control of the
reaction
Sensitivity to
oxygen
High volume
contraction
Insensitivity to
oxygen
Low volume
contraction
Sensitivity to
bases and
nucleophiles
(water)
Brittleness
Current carbon
sizing not
adapted
No termination
Post-cure
propertie
s
Thecuringmechanisms,theinfluenceofformulation,dose,doserate,doseapplicationsequenceand
temperatureonthecuringprocess,reactionkineticsandnetworkpropertiesarewellknown,Ref.[38
40].
Forsomeacrylatebasedsystems,thepolymerisationrateisproportionaltothesquarerootofthedose
rateattheverybeginningofthepolymerisation.Theterminationreactionisbimolecular,i.e.reaction
oftworadicals,atpolymerisationfromtheliquidtogelstate.Then,thereactionisdiffusioncontrolled
withthereactionrateproportionaltothedoserate.Temperaturethusinfluencesboththereactionrate
andtheultimatecuringlevel.
The dose and dose rate application in large composite structures can be modelled, as well as the
reactionkinetics.Hence,thepropertiesofthecompositematerialsintermsofextentofcuringcanbe
accurately predicted with regard to the processing conditions. Consequently, the process is
predictable,controllableandreliableforindustrialapplications,Ref.[3841],[3842].
AgeingofEBcuredcompositestructureshasalsobeenstudiedandnoparticularsensitivityoftheEB
cured systems was observed. The toughness of EBcured formulations has been improved and is
similar to that of heatcuring resin systems. The mechanical performance of the materials has
increasedand is suitablefor very highperformance applications, Ref. [3843],[3844], [3845]. When
agedinwater,EBcuredresinshavethesamebehaviourasheatcuredresinsystems.
SometypicalmatricesbeingusedforEBcuringarepresentedinTable38.12.2.
195
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table38.122EBcuring:Mechanicalpropertiesofsomeacrylateandepoxyresins
Resinsystem
Fracturetoughness(1)K1C
(MPa.m1/2)
Glasstransitiontemperature(2)Tg
(tan)C
0.6
0.6
1.5
170
210
140
0.9
205
Acrylate:
EP-AC
EAR2
EB600-BPaPx
Epoxy:
CR2 (epoxy)
Key:
(1)FracturetoughnessmeasuredaccordingtostandardIGC0426680;
(2)GlasstransitiontemperaturesmeasuredbyDMA,resonantmode,5C/min
38.12.2.3 Properties
PropertiesofEBcuredunidirectionalcompositearegiveninTable38.12.3.
Table38.123EBcuring:TypicalmechanicalpropertiesofunidirectionalIM
carbonfibre/acrylateresin
IMcarbonfibre/EPACacrylateresin
UDproperties,at23C
(65%fibrevolumefraction)
Tg (C )
Longitudinal tensile properties:
Strength (MPa)
Youngs modulus (GPa)
Longitudinal compression
properties:
Strength (MPa)
Youngs modulus (GPa)
Longitudinal bending properties:
Strength (MPa)
Youngs modulus (GPa)
Interlaminar shear properties:
Strength (MPa)
170
2600
174
1000
141
1600
150
80
ThefirstgenerationofEBcuredcompositesshowedthatthegenericmechanicalpropertiesarevery
similartothefirstgenerationofheatcuredepoxyresinsusedforaeronauticapplications.
Themajorweaknessescomparedwithnewercompositeswithtoughresins,suchasIM7/9772,arethe
lowerinterlaminarandtransversetensilestrengths.
196
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Resin characteristics:
Tg: 170C
Resin characteristics:
BMI resin
Tg: 268C
Tg: 107C
Figure38.121EBcuring:Examplesofpartsandstructures
More recently Boeing designed and built an Electron Beam CureontheFly automated tape
placementmachine.Thistechniqueusesalowenergyelectronbeam,i.e.<500keV.Itisintendedfor
the fabrication of large structures without incurring the large capital and tooling expenditures
inherentinautoclavecuring,Ref.[3846],[3847].Thetechniqueisveryattractiveforproducinglarge
compositesstructuresenvisagedforadvancedaerospacestructures.
InEurope,LabenProelTecnologieDivision,partoftheFinmeccanicaGroup,isinvolvedincomposite
EBcuringusingalayerbylayerlowenergyelectronbeamtechnology,Ref.[3848].
197
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.12.2.6 Facilities
EBprocessingfacilitiesarelargeandexpensive.IndustrialEBunitsareusedforprocessesinvolving
crosslinking of electrical insulation cables, thermoplastic products, rubbers, coatings and adhesives.
Theyarerarelyappliedforthecuringofcomposites.
Organisationswithfacilitiesknowntobecapableofcompositecuringare:
EADSSpaceTransportation,StMdardenJalles,France.
LABENProelTechnologieS.p.A,Firenze,Italy.
AcsionIndustry,Canada.
BoeingwithNASALaRC,USA
38.12.3 Microwave
38.12.3.1 General
Theuseofmicrowavesforcuringboththermosettingcompositesandadhesiveshasbeenstudied,Ref.
[3825], [3830], [3833]. The curing process relies on the generation of temperatures equivalent to
conventional thermal processing. However, the heating effect is localised within the composite and
avoidsthethermalinertiaandheatingofthesurroundingequipment.
38.12.3.2 Composites
In terms of energy consumption, the temperature of the composite can be raised quickly and
efficiently. The consolidation of prepregs relies on pressure applied using vacuum bagging and
autoclaving,[See:38.4].
Curing occurs in a tuneable microwave cavity or a resonant microwave chamber; typically at 2.45
GHz.Theconclusionsmadeinearlyworkwerethat:
Theprocesshadtobeoptimisedtoavoidareasof:
undercuring,or
thermaldegradation(overheating).
Rapidgellingresultedinunacceptablelevelsofporosity.
Combiningthermalheatingandmicrowaveheatingreducedsomeoftheporosityproblems.
Conventional offtheshelf prepregs were not ideally suited to microwave processing, due to
theirresinviscosityandgellingcharacteristics.
Theattractionofthetechniqueisthatthecureprocessingtimeisreduced.Itdoeshoweversufferfrom
thepossibleneedfor:
Specialisedprepregsandadhesives.
Consumables materials and moulds should avoid interfering with the microwave coupling
process.
198
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.12.3.3 Adhesives
Results of the microwave curing of conventional AF1632K, EA9689 and EA9391 adhesives showed
that,Ref.[3825]:
Lapshearstrengthswerebetween52%and90%ofthoseachievedbyconventionalthermalcure
cycles.
Thelowervalueswereattributedtothepresenceofvoidagefromtrappedvolatiles.
Totalprocesstimeswerereducedbytwothirdscomparedwithconventionalthermalcuring.
38.12.4 UV curing
TheUVcuringprocessreliesontheuncuredresinbeinginanexposedpositiononthesurfacebeing
irradiated. It has been demonstrated for wet layup configurations containing polyester resins
receptivetoUV.
ThereisnopublishedworkdescribingtheapplicationofUVcuringtohighperformancethermosets,
suchasepoxies,sotheprocessappearstobeoflimitedinterestforspacestructures.
38.13
Preform technology
38.13.1 General
Apreformisanassemblyoffibresinthedesirednetshapeofafinalmoulding,whichcanbeusedin
boththemanufactureof:
polymerbasedcomposites,[See:6.31],and
nonpolymerbasedcompositematerials,[See:Chapter88].
Thedevelopmentofvariouspreformtechnologieshasbeendrivenbyfactorssuchas:
Awishtoreduceoreliminatemanuallabourcostsinassemblingalayupofmaterialpriorto
moulding.
Aneedtointroduce3Dreinforcementtoavoidtheinterlaminar,throughthicknessweaknesses
ofconventionallaminatedplies.
Theuseofautomatedequipmenttocreatecomplexshapesandchangesinsectionnotfeasible
byusingplystacks.
Theuseofperformsisthereforeconsiderednecessaryinsomeapplications,becauseofinadequaciesin
conventionallaminateconstructions,Ref.[3835].
Developments in RTM, resin transfer moulding, [See: 38.7], are providing the greatest incentive to
develop efficient means of preparing fibre preforms. This is primarilyaimed at reducing processing
costs.
199
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.13.2 Braids
Braidsareparticularlysuitableforproducingtubularsections,[See:6.31].Theirusein4mstrutshas
beenproposedforlargetrussstructures,Ref.[3811].
The manufacture of tubes by RTM is claimed to improve tolerance to both low and hypervelocity
impactdamageandalsoresistancetomicrocracking,comparedwithUDprepregorfilamentwound
constructions.
Aircraftstructures,examplesofitemsevaluatedare,Ref.[3836]:
Yspars:AS4(6K)/PEEK150g.
Commingledangleinterlock0/90wovenpreformswithstitched45plies;asshownin
Figure38.13.1,Ref.[3836].
Autoclaveconsolidated,withgraphitetooling.
50%higherstraincapacitythan2Dlaminates.
CommingledAS4/PPS0/90Ibeams.
Potentialspaceapplications,Ref.[3837]:
commingledthermoplasticfibresandUHMcarbonfibres.
200
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure38.131Preformtechnology:Architectureofwovencommingled
AS4/PEEK150g0/90
38.14
Fibre placement
38.14.1 Introduction
FP Fibre placement is an advanced computerautomated production technology for creating CFRP
carbonfibre aerospace structures. The computercontrolled system places carbonfibre layers onto a
mandrel using a direct interface to a CADCAM design system, such as CATIA. This enables direct
informationtransferfromthedrawingtothepart.
Thesystemhastwomainelements:
Head, which has sixdegreeoffreedom feed and roller system to lay CFRP bands onto the
mandrel.Itiscapableofproducingaverywidevarietyofcomplexcurvatureshapes.
Mandrel,whichprovidesasurfaceonwhichtobuildupthefinalshapedpart.
201
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Thesystem,shownschematicallyinFigure38.14.1,isveryadaptableandimposesfewrestrictionson
thecomponentsthatcanbemade.Inparticular,partsdonotneedanysymmetryofrevolution.
The FP system installed at EADSCASA Espacio can handle thirtytwo 3 mm wide CFRP tows
simultaneously, combining them through a collimator and onto the mandrel. The head can place a
CFRPbandupto100mmwidthatthesametime.
Figure38.141Fibreplacement:Schematicviewofthesystem
Itispossibletostopandrestartplacementofanyoftheindividualtowsandsochangethetotalwidth
of the applied band. This provides a great deal of flexibility in a continuous layup operation, e.g.
whenimplementingholesoraddinglocalreinforcements.
The collimated band is applied to the mandrel by means of a compaction roller. The compaction
pressureiscontrolledautomaticallytoenableplacementofevenlayersoverlighthoneycombcores.
202
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Thefibrestockmaterialiskeptinacontrolledenvironmentat18Ctopreventtheresinfromstarting
to cure before layup. As the band is placed on the mandrel, the fibres are heated to achieve the
necessary resin viscosity for compaction by the rollers. Figure 38.14.2 shows the main arm and
placementhead,Figure38.14.3showsageneralviewoftheworkingarea.
Figure38.142Fibreplacement:Head
Figure38.143Fibreplacement:Generalviewofworkingarea
203
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
38.14.2 Advantages
38.14.2.1 Productivity
Increasesinproductivityresultfrom:
Reductioninscrapmaterialfrom30%to50%inconventionalprocessingcomparedwith2%to
7%withfibreplacement.
Increasedlayupspeed.
Reductioninthenumberofprecuringoperations,e.g.intermediatedebulking,manualcutting,
positioningoflayers.
Figure38.144Fibreplacement:Complexcurvature
38.14.2.3 Single shot lay-up of large structures
Ifmanuallayupisusedforlargestructures,thetimetakenformaterialplacementcanresultinpartial
curing before completion and hence reduction in properties. The higher speed of FP technology
avoidsthisproblem.
204
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Fibreplacementenablestheincorporationofpurelyaxialplies
Figure38.145Fibreplacement:Specificorientations
205
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure38.146Fibreplacement:Complextrajectories
38.14.3.3 Variable width of band
Variationsinlaminatethicknesscanoccurwheretheoveralldimensionsofacomponentvaryalong
its main axis. For example, in the case of a simple conical shape, if the width of the applied band
remainsconstantitproducesanincreasingfinallaminatethicknessalongthecone(duetoincreased
overlappingatthesmallerendofthecone).
Topreventthiseffect,theFPsystemcanalterthewidthoftheappliedband,hencekeepingtheoverall
thicknessconstantalongthecomponent.Thisisachievedbyincreasinganddecreasingthenumberof
individualtowsmakinguptheband,asshowninFigure38.14.7.
Figure38.147Fibreplacement:Variationofbandwidth
206
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure38.148Fibreplacement:Mixedmateriallayup
Lowercost:
higherlayupspeed(filamentbyfilamentcomparedwithbandbyband).
less manufacturing operations (holes and reinforcements made as part of the layup
process)
Betterperformance:
optimumfibreorientation(0and90).
complexshapes(conetocylindertransitionwithoutrings).
optimumreinforcementlayers(materialsandorientations).
Betterquality:
moreaccuratetolerances.
lessmaufacturingdeviations.
Flexibledesign:
noshapelimitations.
nosymmetryofrevolutionrequired.
Lowercost:
higherlayupspeed(manualvs.automatic).
less manufacturing operations (holes and reinforcements made as part of the layup
process).
directdatatransferfromdrawingtopart.
lessscrapmaterial.
nointermediatecompaction.
Betterperformance,improvedtolerances(positionandorientation).
207
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Betterquality:
moreaccuratetolerances(lessmaufacturingdeviations).
betterrepeatability.
Flexibledesign:
largestructurespossibleinasingleprocess.
noshapelimitations.
Ariane5ISS
Cylinder:5.5mdiameter,2.9mheight.
Core:aluminiumalloyhoneycombwithseveralcoredensities.
Skins:differentthicknessesandtransitionsfromsandwichtomonolithic.
Ariane5Adapter1194FP
Cone:2.6mto1.2mdiameter,0.9mheight.
Core:aluminiumalloyhoneycombwithseveralcoredensities
Skins:differentthicknesses.
Ariane5VEBATVOutercylinder
Cylinder:5.5mdiameter,1.2mheight.
Core:aluminiumalloyhoneycombwithseveralcoredensities.
Skins:differentthicknesses.
Ariane5VEBATVInnercone
Cone:5.4mto3.9mdiameter,0.8mheight.
Core:aluminiumalloyhoneycombwithseveralcoredensities.
Skins:differentthicknesses.
38.14.6.2 Monolithic
Ariane5Adapter1194H
Cone:2.6mto1.2mdiameter,0.9mheight.
Skins:differentskinthicknesses,withintegratedCFRPinterfacelowerring.
Ariane5Cone3936
Cone:3.9mto2.6mdiameter,0.8mheight.
Skins:differentthicknesses,withintegratedCFRPinterfaceupperandlowerrings.
Eurostar3000LXCentralTube,Ref.[38-39].
208
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Coneandcylinderinonecompositepart:1.2mto0.8mconediameter,0.6mconeheight,
0.8mcylinderdiameter,2.1mcylinderheight,2.7mtotalheight,
Skins:differentthicknesses.
38.15
Out of autoclave
38.15.1 Introduction
ThetermOOAoutofautoclaveisusedtodescribeanumberofcompositemanufacturingprocesses
that do not need an autoclave to achieve proper consolidation and cure. These processes can be
broadlygroupedas:
ovencuringofvacuumbaggedprepreglayups.
liquid resin infiltration of fibre preforms, such as RTM, [See: 38.7]; vacuumassisted, e.g.
VARTM;otherderivativeproprietaryprocesses,e.g.SQRTMinfiltrationofprepreglayup,Ref.
[3849].
resinfilminfusion(RFI),aGKNAerospaceprocess,whichinvolveslayingupofdrymultiaxial
fabricinterleavedwithresinfilmthatisthencuredinanovenoronheatedtools,Ref.[3850].
nonthermal cure processes, e.g. EB electron beam, Ref. [3851], microwave, UV cure, [See:
38.12].
otherproprietaryprocesses,e.g.Quickstepmouldingtechnology,whichusesafluidasaheat
transfermediaratherthanagas,[3852],[3853].
reducedprocessingtimes.
reducedprocessingcosts.
Savings can result because resins have lower cure temperatures. Reduced tooling costs are also
possiblebecauseofthelowerpressurescomparedwithautoclaving.
ForRTMtypeprocesses,matchedmouldtoolsarenecessary.Somederivativeprocessesforlargethin
partsusetoolingthatincorporatestheresininjectionandventingsystem.Inthesecasestoolingcosts
aresignificantandusuallyneedtobeamortisedoveraseriesofidenticalparts.
209
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
However, there are some concerns regarding OOA compared with traditional autoclaved parts,
including:
Overall quality of OOA parts, e.g. higher void content, lower fibre volume fractions, reduced
mechanical properties, because of the lower consolidation pressures. Some OOA processes
claim fibre volume fractions only about 2% lower than autoclaved parts, with void contents
stated from nearzero to <1%. However, the precise values are both process and component
shapedependent.
Geometryofparts:Componentswithdeepdraught,abruptchangesinsectionorsharpcorners
cansufferlocalporosityfrompoorconsolidationandpoorsurfacefinish.Thisusuallyapplies
toprepreglayupsratherthanRTMtypeprocesses.
QualificationismorecomplicatedforRTMtypeprocessesthatcanbeadaptedforaparticular
component. As a result, the final component properties vary with the process parameters.
Considerableeffortisbeingplacedongeneratingdatabasesofmaterialproperties,Ref.[3858].
RTMprocessing of large, thin parts (such as aerodynamic surfaces) need additional vents to
ensureescapeofvolatilesandair.
HexPlyM34,EF01,M9.1F/M9.6F,M10Hexcel.
38.15.3.2 Resins
Thetemperatureviscositycharacteristicsoftheresinareimportanttoensureflowandimpregnation
ofthepreformundertheinjectionpressure(oftenfrom0.7MPato1.4MPa).
Epoxies, bismaleimidesand cyanate ester resins are commerciallyavailablefor RTMtype processes.
They are often onepart systems that become less viscous when heated, e.g. HexFlow from Hexcel,
MVRfromACG,CYCOMRTMrangefromCytec.
38.15.4 Tooling
38.15.4.1 Types
AvarietyoftoolingsolutionsarebeingproposedforOOA,including:
ACTsadvancedcompositetools,usuallycarbonfibrebasedcomposites,Ref.[3857].
carbonfoams,Ref.[3854],[3857].
ceramics,Ref.[3855]
210
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
The characteristics for OOA tooling are effectively the same as for autoclave tools, i.e. lowno CTE,
low mass, ease of machining, ease ofincorporatingsystems (heating, venting),resistance tothermal
cyclingoverprocessingtemperatures,longlife.
Carbon foams tools can be used in ovens, Ref. [3857], or made to be selfheating by passing an
electriccurrentthroughthetoolbody,therebyheatingonlythetoolandpartthusavoidingtheneed
foranoven,Ref.[3854].
Heated ceramic tooling, developed under ESAfunding by ire Composites, successfully
demonstratedmouldingflatcarbonfibre/PEEKthermoplasticlaminates,Ref.[3855].
ThetoolcomprisedaPyromeralceramic,Ref.[3856],reinforcedwithcarbonfibrestoprovidethermal
degradationresistance,strengthandlowthermalexpansion.
The properties of laminates made using the Pyromeral tool were determined by mechanical testing
(tensile, compression, inplane shear); bolt bearing; NDT (Cscan), fractography and void analysis,
outgassing, degree of crystallinity (by DSC) and compared favourably with those produced by
autoclave,Ref.[3855].
38.16
References
38.16.1 General
[381]
M.M.Schwartz
Compositematerialshandbook
McGrawHill,1984,ISBN0070557438
[382]
G.Lubin
Handbookofcomposites
VanNostrandReinhold,1982,ISBN0442248970
[383]
M.J.Robinsonetal
Advancedcompositestructuresforlaunchvehicles
SAMPEQuarterly,January1991,p2637
[384]
G.M.Teare
Filamentwindingofsatellitestructures
InternationalSymposium:SpaceApplicationsofAdvancedStructural
Materials,ESTEC
2123March1990,ESASP303,p257260
[385]
C.A.L.Kemperetal
Designandmanufacturingoffilamentwoundthrustcylinder
InternationalSymposium:AdvancedMaterialsforLightweight
Structures,ESTEC,2527March1992
ESASP336,p5156
[386]
K.Lhteenkorvaetal
Tapewindingofthermoplasticcomposites
211
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
InternationalSymposium:AdvancedMaterialsforLightweight
Structures,ESTEC,2527March1992
ESASP336,p203206
[387]
M.Wadsworth
Resintransfermoldingofcompositeaircraftstructures
SAETechnicalPaper891042,April1989
[388]
I.Marchbank
AutomatedR.T.M.foranairframecomponent
MaterialsandProcessingMoveintothe90s
EditedbyS.Bensonetal.EuropeanSAMPEConference1989
ElsevierSciencePublishers.p7586
[389]
A.Jiminezetal
DesignandmanufacturingofCFRPringsbyRTM
InternationalSymposium:AdvancedMaterialsforLightweight
Structures,ESTEC,2527March1992
ESASP336,p143148
[3810]
G.C.Sharpless
Advancementofbraiding/resintransfermoldingfromcommercialto
aerospaceapplications
SMETechnicalPaperEM91217,1991
[3811]
A.K.Munjaletal
Designandfabricationofhighqualitygraphite/epoxybraidedcomposite
tubesforspacestructures
35thInternationalSAMPESymposium
April251990,p19541967
[3812]
C.W.Dietrich&D.C.Giedt
Resintransfermoldingandcompressionmoldingprocessingofnozzle
componentsasalowcostalternativetotapewrapping
AIAAPaper932011
[3813]
E.B.Starketal
Anewhighperformanceresinsystemforresintransfermoldingof
aerospacestructures
37thInternationalSAMPESymposium
March9121992,p14211431
[3814]
A.Falconeetal
Resintransfermoldingoftextilecomposites
BoeingDefenceandSpaceGroup,NASACR191505
July1993,139pages
[3815]
A.Wangetal
AnewhightemperatureepoxysystemforRTMapplication
37thInternationalSAMPESymposium
March9121992,p482492
212
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[3816]
K.A.Barrettetal
Injectablebismaleimidesystems
35thInternationalSAMPESymposium
April251990,p10071020
[3817]
E.B.Starketal
Resintransfermolding(RTM)ofhighperformanceresins
35thInternationalSAMPESymposium,April25,1990,p782795
[3818]
J.E.Stockton
Structuralresintransfermoldingofhightemperaturecomposites
34thInternationalSAMPESymposium
May811,1989,p10321040
[3819]
M.CY.Niu
Compositeairframestructures
PublishedbyCommlitPressLtd,January1992
ISBN9627128066
[3820]
G.J.Sundsrud
Advantagesofaonepartresinsystemforprocessingaerospacepartsby
resintransfermoulding(RTM)
Proceedingsofthe14thInternationalEuropeanChapterConferenceof
SAMPE:BroadeningHorizonswithAdvancedMaterials&Processes,
Birmingham,October1993,p.251258,ISBN3952047708
[3821]
F.N.Scott&A.Koorevaar
Computeraidedengineeringoftheresintransfermoulding(RTM)
process
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures,ESTEC
March1994,ESAWPP070,p335340
[3822]
V.M.Karbharietal
Effectofmaterial,process,andequipmentvariablesontheperformance
ofresintransfermouldedparts
CompositesManufacturing,Vol.3,No.3,1992,p143152
[3823]
W.Werner&G.Ziegmann
Developmentoftechniquesforpolymericdiaphragmformingof
continuousfibrereinforcedthermoplastics
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumonAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures,ESTEC
March1994,ESAWPP070,p367371
[3824]
G.H.F.Nayler
Vectrainsulativesupportstructureswithinspacecraft
InternationalSymposium:AdvancedMaterialsforLightweight
Structures
ESTEC,2527March1992,ESASP336,p291298
213
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[3825]
G.B.Gaskinetal
Electromagneticcuringofepoxyadhesivesystems
38thInternationalSAMPESymposium,May10131993
p380390
[3826]
C.B.Saundersetal
Electroncuringoffiberreinforcedcomposites;recentdevelopments
38thInternationalSAMPESymposium,May10131993
p16811691
[3827]
D.Beziersetal
Electronbeamcuringofcomposites
ECCM4,1990,p7378
[3828]
A.B.Strong
Crosslinkingofthermoplasticcompositesusingelectronbeamradiation
SAMPEQuarterly,July1991,p4554
[3829]
C.B.Saundersetal
Recentdevelopmentsintheelectronbeamcuringoffiberreinforced
composites
37thInternationalSAMPESymposium,March9121992
p944954
[3830]
F.Y.C.Boey
Techniquesinthemicrowaveprocessingofthermosetcompositeusinga
highpressureautoclave
23rdInternationalSAMPETechnicalConference
October2124,1991,p1524
[3831]
C.B.Saundersetal
Radiationcurablecarbonfiberprepregcomposites
PolymerComposites,December1988,Vol.9,No.6,p389394
[3832]
C.B.Saundersetal
Radiationcurableprepregcomposites
AtomicEnergyofCanadaLimitedReportAECL9560,1988
[3833]
J.Weietal
Microwaveprocessingofcrossplycontinuousgraphitefiber/epoxy
composites
SAMPEJournal,Vol.27,No.1,Jan./Feb.1991,p3339
[3834]
J.P.Fouassier&J.F.Rabek
Radiationcuringinpolymerscienceandtechnology,1993
Vol.I:FundamentalsandMethods,ISBN1851669299
Vol.II:PhotoinitiatingSystems,ISBN1851669337
Vol.III:PolymerizationMechanisms,ISBN1851669345
Vol.IV:PracticalAspectsandApplications,ISBN1851669388
PublishedbyChapman&Hall,London
214
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[3835]
J.Brandtetal
Theapplicationofthreedimensionalfibrepreformsforaerospace
compositestructures
InternationalSymposium:SpaceApplicationsofAdvancedStructural
Materials,ESTEC,2123March1990,ESASP303p7177
[3836]
J.Suarez&J.Mahon
Consolidationofgraphite/thermoplastictextilepreformsforprimary
aircraftstructure
TheFirstNASAAdvancedCompositesTechnologyConference,Part1,
p293338(N9330439)
[3837]
C.Blair&G.A.Jensen
Processdevelopmentandcharacterisationofultrahighmodulus,
drapablegraphite/thermoplasticcompositesforspaceapplications
37thInternationalSAMPESymposium,March912,1992
p115127
[3838]
J.Pascual&J.Trigo:EADSCASAEspacio(E)
ApplicationofNewTechnologiesforEurostarCentralTube
Paper161:ESASP581:ProceedingsofEuropeanConferenceon
SpacecraftStructures,MaterialsandMechanicalTesting,ESTEC,
Noordwijk(NL)1012May2005
[3839]
J.Pascual&J.Trigo:EADSCASAEspacio(E)
ApplicationofNewTechnologiesforEurostarCentralTube
ESASP581:ProceedingsofEuropeanConferenceonSpacecraft
Structures,MaterialsandMechanicalTesting,ESTEC,Noordwijk(NL)
1012May2005
[3840]
B.Defoortetal.:EADSST(Bordeaux,F)
Electronbeampolymerizationofacrylatecompositions6:Influenceof
processingparametersonthecuringkineticsofanepoxyacrylateblend
Macromol.Chem.Phys.,202,16,pp31493156,(2001)
[3841]
B.Defoortetal:EADSST(Bordeaux,F)
ModellingoftheEBcuringoffibrereinforcedcompositematerialsfor
aerospaceapplications
Presentation23rdMeetingoftheAdhesionSociety,February2000,
MyrtleBeachSC,USA,pp392394
[3842]
B.Defoorteta:.EADSST(Bordeaux,F)
ElectronBeamcuringofacrylateresinsforcomposites:Modelling
reactionkinetics
45thInternationalSAMPESymposium,May2125,2000,LongBeachCA,
USA,pp22232234
[3843]
B.Defoortetal:EADSST(Bordeaux,F)
InvestigationstoimprovethepropertiesofEBcuredcomposites:A
statusreport
47thInternationalSAMPESymposium,May2002
215
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[3844]
B.Defoort&L.T.Drzal:EADSST(Bordeaux,F)
AdhesionbetweenCarbonfibresandCationicmatricesinElectronBeam
CuringProcessedComposites
46thInternationalSAMPESymposium,610May,2001,LongBeachCA,
USA,pp20632075
[3845]
B.Defoort&L.T.Drzal:EADSST(Bordeaux,F)
InfluenceofThermalPostcuringonElectronBeamCuredComposites
46thInternationalSAMPESymposium,610Mai,2001,LongBeachCA,
USA,pp25502562
[3846]
DLGoodmanetal.
AutomatedTapePlacementwithinsituElectronBeamCure
InternationalSAMPESymposiumandExhibition,May2327,1999,Long
Beach,CA
[3847]
J.W.Burgessetal:BoeingCompany/NASALangley(USA)
DevelopmentofaCureontheflyAutomatedTapePlacementMachine
forElectronBeamCurablePrepregs
46thInternationalSAMPESymposiumandExhibition,May610,1999,
LongBeach,CA;SAMPE2001LongBeach,CAMay610,2001
[3848]
F.Guasti:LABENProelTechnologie(I)
PressureVessels:APossibleApplicationoflowEnergyEBeamcuring
44thInternationalSAMPESymposiumandExhibition,May2327,1999,
LongBeach,CA
[3849]
K.Mason
AutoclaveQualityOutsidetheAutoclave?
HighPerformanceComposites(2006)
http://www.compositesworld.com/articles/autoclavequalityoutsidethe
autoclave.aspx
[3850]
GKNAerospaceDevelopsManufacturingProcessesforComplex
CompositeStructures
http://www.azom.com/news.asp?newsID=6054
[3851]
C.A.Byrne:ScienceResearchLabInc,Ma,(USA)
NonAutoclaveMaterialsforLargeCompositeStructures
ReportNo.A897483(November2000)
Abstract:http://www.stormingmedia.us/89/8974/A897483.html
[3852]
M.Kaiseretal:Inst.frFlugzeugbau,Uni.Stuttgart/EurocopterGmbH
(D)
OutOfAutoclaveManufactureofStructuralAerospaceComposite
Materials
http://www.quickstep.com.au/files/document/165_Out_of_Autoclave_Pr
ocessing_via_Quickstep.pdf
[3853]
QuickstepTechnologiesPtyLtd(Australia)
http://www.quickstep.com.au/
216
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[3854]
TRLTouchstoneResearchLaboratoryLtd(USA)
CarbonFoamSelfheatedToolingforOutofAutoclaveComposites
Manufacturing
ProposalNo.081X4.069473,NASASBIR2008Solicitation
http://sbir.nasa.gov/SBIR/abstracts/08/sbir/phase1/SBIR081X4.06
9473.html?solicitationId=SBIR_08_P1
[3855]
A.Murtagh:ireCompositesTeo(ire)
ApplicationofThermoplasticCompositeOutofAutoclaveVacuum
ProcessingTechnologytoNonSpaceStructures
EC4706020RPTAFinalReport(October2008),
ESTECContractNo.19729/06/NL/PA
[3856]
Pyromeralhttp://www.pyromeral.com/index.htm
[3857]
ACGAdvancedCompositesGroup(UK)
TechnicalReportNewToolingDevelopments,(March2008)
http://www.advancedcomposites.co.uk/
PSG_Electronic_Files/Tooling_PSG_Files/PDFs/Technical%20Report%20
New%20Tooling%20Developments%20A1
%2016th%20March%202009.pdf
[3858]
ACGAdvancedCompositesGroup(UK)
OutofAutoclaveProcessablePrepregsandResinFilms:AnOverviewof
RecentDevelopmentsandSharedDatabases(2006),Abstract
http://www.sae.org/technical/papers/2006013164
ECSSQST70
ECSSQ7071
Materials,mechanicalpartsandprocesses
Datafortheselectionofspacematerialsand
processes
217
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
39
Machining techniques
39.1
Introduction
The various techniques used to machine composites are described and the precautions necessary to
preventdamagingthecomponents.
Thetechniquesusedcanvarywiththeparticularcompositematerial.Aramidcompositesoftenneed
differenttoolsfromthoseusedforcarbonandglassreinforcedmaterials.
Special drill bits are available for composites to overcome the problems of using drills designed for
metals,[See:39.9].
[Seealso:ECSSEHB3221formachiningoperationsrelatedtoadhesivebonding;ECSSEHB3222
formachiningpracticesforinsertsinsandwichpanels;ECSSEHB3223formachiningpracticesfor
boltedjoints]
39.2
Basic rules
39.2.1
General
Themachiningofcompositematerialsshouldmeetthebasiccriteriaof:
Nofraying.
Nodelaminationofthecuredcompositeedge.
39.2.2
Equipment
Standardmachiningequipmentwithsmallmodificationsisoftenused.Thecuttingspeedsandfeeds
useddependupon:
thethicknessofthecomposite,
thetypeofcuttingmethod.
Variouscuttingtoolsareusedforthemachiningoperations,including:
countersink,
cutoffwheels,
218
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
routerbits,
bandsawblades,
highspeedsteeldrills,
reamers.
It is particularly important to keep all the tools sharp, in order to provide good quality cuts and to
minimisethepossibilityofdelamination.
Sufficient backup support of the part to be machined is essential to reduce chipping and
delamination,e.g.byusingaluminium.
Insomecasesmachiningofpolymermatrixcompositescancauselocaloverheatinganddestructionof
properties.Inthesesituationscoolingmethodsshouldbeused.
39.3
Routing
39.3.1
Carbon/epoxy composites
Generally,routingwithahighertorquebutlowspeedrouterworksbest.Diamondcutcarbidebitsare
preferable because of higher feed rates at less operator effort than with a six flute configuration. To
extendthetoollifeandtoincreasethecuttingforce,asuitablecoolantisused(noeffectoncutedge
quality).
39.3.2
Aramid/epoxy composites
ThecuttershowninFigure39.3.1,Ref.[391],achievessatisfactoryresults.
Routingwithaconventionalaircrafttoolsteelroutercanbedifficult,whereastheopposedhelixrouter
canbeusedfor:
Cuttinglaminatesintosections.
Cuttingslotsandnotches.
Trimminghoneycombsandwichpanels.
An opposed helix cutter enables laminates up to 6.4 mm thick to be trimmed without problems. A
conventionalrouterneedsmuchmoreeffortforcompositematerialthickerthan3.2mm.
219
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure39.31Router:Opposedhelixforaramid/epoxy
39.3.3
39.3.3.1
Trimmingandbevellingwithaconventionalrouteragainstaguidecanbeusedsuccessfully.
39.3.3.2
Aramid/epoxy
Thequalityofaramid/epoxytrimmededgescanbeimprovedbyusingarouter,asshowninFigure
39.3.2,Ref.[391].
Trimmededgesofaramid/epoxycanalsobeimprovedbysanding.
With diamond cut carbide type router bits, good cuts can be made up to a composite thickness of
about6.9mm.
220
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure39.32Routerfortrimmingaramid/epoxycomposites
39.4
Sanding
39.4.1
General
Thereareseveralimportantpointstobenotedwhensandingcompositelaminates.Thesepointsrelate
tosandingprocessesfor:
Fit or trim,and
Adhesive bonding.
39.4.2
Fit or trim
Guidelinesforsandingcompositescorrectlyinclude:
Usetoolscorrectly;asshowninFigure 39.4.1,Ref.[391].
Usearightanglesanderof20,000rpmorgreater.
Bulkremoval(dry):Use50mmaluminiumoxidedisks.
221
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Edgedeburring(water):Use50mm240gritto320grit,siliconcarbide.
Addressedgesatproperangle.
Duringsandingoperations:
Donottrytoremoveanydefectsonsurfacesofpartsbysanding.
Donotoversandbeyondtrimareas.
Donotdeburrholes;countersinkholeswithsanders.
Figure39.41Sandingofcomposites
39.4.3
Bonding
Guidelinesforsandingcompositescorrectlypriortoadhesivebondinginclude:
Layouttheareatobesanded.
Use240grit.
Usetoolsof20,000rpmorgreater.
[See:ECSSEHB3223forfurtherguidanceonthesurfacepreparationforbondedjoints]
222
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
39.4.4
Aramid/epoxy composites
Wet paper is used for sanding of aramid/epoxy laminates to provide cooling and also to prevent
buildupofwastebetweenabrasiveparticles.Thepreferredgritsizesare120and240.
39.5
Sawing
39.5.1
Basic rules
Sawingofcuredlaminatescanbesuccessfullyperformedwith:
Band saws,
Circular saws,or
Sabre saws.
The composite is clamped to eliminate vibration that can cause delamination. Saws need frequent
checkingtomaintainsharpness.
39.5.2
Bandsawing
39.5.2.1
General
Normally a fine, offset, highstrengthsteelstaggertooth blade is used. As a general rule, the saw
bladepitchisselectedbythelaminatethicknesstobecutcorrespondingtotheheightofthreesaw
teeth. This cutting method uses the heel rather than the hook of the cutting tooth blade for cleaner
cuts.Thecuttingbladeisalwayssharpenedbeforecutting.
Surfacespeedintherangeof22.9m/sto33m/sareused;with30.5m/spreferred.Thebestfeedrates
arefrom3mm/sto5mm/s.
39.5.2.2
Aramid/epoxy composites
Bandsawcuttingofaramid/epoxyisusuallyperformedwithafinetoothblade,preferablyusingwater
asacoolant.Thebandsawisruninreverse,sothattheheelofthetoothentersthecompositefirst;as
showninFigure39.5.1,Ref.[391].
223
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure39.51Reversebandsawingaramid/epoxylaminates
39.5.3
Circular sawing
39.5.3.1
General
Diamondbladesarepreferredformostcompositematerials.Cuttingspeedsforcompositesnormally
varybetweenabout10m/sto50m/s.
39.5.3.2
Carbon/epoxy composites
A 6.4 mm carbon/epoxy laminate is best cut with acarbidetipped blade andspeed between 10 m/s
and20m/s.
Figure39.5.2showsthat1.3mm/smaximumfeedrateisidealforallpartsupto2.5mmthick,Ref.[39
1].Thickerpartsarecutatproportionatelylowerfeedrates.
224
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure39.52Circularsawing:Feedrateversusthicknessofcompositematerials
39.5.3.3
Aramid/epoxy composites
Aramid/epoxycanbecutsuccessfullyusingacircularmetalslittingsaw.
39.5.4
Sabre sawing
39.5.4.1
Aramid/epoxy composite
SabresawsnormallyusethebladeshowninFigure39.5.3,Ref.[391],tocutaramid/epoxy,whichcuts
the outermost fibres on both sides of the laminate toward the interior. This type of blade has
alternating sets of five teeth in opposed directions. Blade speeds of 2500 strokes per minute are
advisable.
Bladespeedandfeedratesvarywithmaterialthickness.
225
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure39.53Sabresawing:Alternatingtoothbladeforaramid/epoxy
39.6
Countersinking
39.6.1
General
Carbide,highstrengthsteel,diamondplatecountersinkscanbeuseddependingonthecomposite.
39.6.2
Carbide countersinks have shown good results with optimum combinations of speed and relief
angles.Conventionalcountersinkingtoolsfrom1750rpmto6000rpmhavebeenusedsuccessfully.
39.6.3
Aramid/epoxy composites
Figure39.6.1showsacountersinkusedforaramid/epoxycomposite,Ref.[391].
226
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure39.61Countersinkforaramid/epoxycomposite
39.7
Counterboring
Carbon, aramid and glass reinforced epoxy composites are normally counterbored using carbide
cuttingtools.
Ingeneral,onlyafewcounterborescanbemadepertool,becausetheentirecuttingedgebearsonthe
workpiecematerialduringtheoperation.
Compared with countersinking of carbon/epoxy, [See also: 39.6], counterboring torque and thrust
forcesaregenerally3timeshigher.
227
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
39.8
Milling
39.8.1
Basic Rules
39.8.1.1
General
Toproduceasurfacecutthatextendspasttheedgeofacompositelaminate,theedgeofthelaminate
ismilledfirsttopreventdelamination,asshowninFigure39.8.1.
Theuseoffluorocarboncoolantisadvisablebecauseofitscoolingefficiency.Thecoolantisappliedas
a spray mist during machining; the distance between the spray applicator and cutter is adjusted so
thatfrostformsonthecutter.
Figure39.81Propermillingtechnique
39.8.1.2
Cutter types
Guidelinesfortheselectionanduseofcuttersare:
Ensurethatcuttersaresharp;dullonescausedelamination.
Alwaysusehighspeedsteelcuttersofthefourflute,positiveraketype.
Usecarbidemillingcuttersofapositiveraketype,withchiploadsof0.10mmto0.15mmper
tooth.
Radiusedendmillslastlongerthansquarecorneredones.
39.8.1.3
Carbon/epoxy composites
Highspeedsteelendmillsorcarbidecutterscanbeusedprovidedthattheyaremultifluted.Four
fluteendmillsareadvisableforefficiencyandtoreducethecuttingforcestoapointwherethereis
lesschanceofdelamination.
39.8.1.4
Aramid/epoxy composites
Conventionalflutedcuttersareusedsatisfactorilyatspeedsof0.4m/sandafeedrateof5mm/s.
39.8.2
Plunge-cut milling
Plungecut milling is not recommended, unless there is sufficient backup support to prevent
delamination.
228
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
39.9
Drilling
39.9.1
Basic problems
39.9.1.1
General
Metal working drill bits were not designed for cutting composites and their use can provoke
significantdamagetoacompositearisingfrom:
Abrasivity: Glass/epoxy and carbon/epoxy are so abrasive that only tungsten carbide tooling
candrillthroughthem.
Heating: For metalworking, the tip heats the metal to provide the plastic flow needed for
efficientcutting.Sincecompositescannottoleratethisheat,thecuttingspeedissloweddownto
ensurethattheheatisaslowaspossible.
Rake: Drill designers had to abandon cutting tips with neutral and negative rakes and wide
chisel points because a drill with a neutral rake scrapes the material and causes it to resist
penetration by the drill tip. The operator exerts pressure to drill the hole, and this pressure
causestheheatbuildup.
Pressure:Neutralrakealsotendstopushthereinforcingfibresoutinfront,needingagreatdeal
of pressure to penetrate the piece. This pressure causes the fibres to bend, resulting in furry,
undersizedholes.
Thepressurealsoproducesexcessiveheat,whichcausesgallingandchipdoggingintheresin.
Feed: The release of pressure as the tool bit breaks through the part causes a sudden and
momentary increase in feed rate. As the tool plunges through the last few fibres, the cutter
shaft,notthecuttingedge,removestheremainingmaterial.Theresultischippingandcracking.
Chipformation:Thebestwaytoanalyseadrillingoperationistoexaminethechips.Theideal
chipformforacompositeisadry,easilymovedchipthatlookslikeconfectionerssugar.
Ifthespeedofthecuttingtoolistoohigh,heatmakestheresinstickyandproducesalumpychip;if
the cutting edge is scraping and not cutting the plastic, the chips are large and flaky. Either type
eventuallyclogsanevacuationsystem.
39.9.1.2
Factorsinthedesignoftoolsforcompositesinclude:
Positive rake: The reinforcing fibres are pulled into the workpiece where they are sheared or
broken between the cutting edge and the uncut material. Positive rake on the cutting edge
removes more material per unit of time and per unit of pressure than negative rake, but the
morepositivetherake,themoresensitiveandfragilethecuttingedgebecomes.
Chiseledge:Asmallchiseledgeimprovesthepenetrationrate,whichincreasesthenumberof
machiningoperationsperhour.Theoptimumchiseledgeforcompositesisasclosetoapointas
possible.
Chiphandling:Thechipsareproducedandthenremovedimmediatelyabovetheentranceof
the hole. From this point a properly designed vacuum system can dispose of the chips in
conformancewithsafetyandenvironmentalstandards.
229
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
39.9.2
39.9.2.1
General
Tooling has developed that improves greatly the drilling of glass, carbon and aramidepoxy
compositesandtheirhybrids.Sometoolbitsaremadeoftungstencarbideparticlesoflessthan1m.
Figure39.9.1showsexamplesofdrillbitsforcomposites,Ref.[391],where:
Solidshankdrillsareusedinautomaticdrillingequipment.
Twistdrillsareusedinautomaticdrillingequipment.
Drillguidesystemsaredesignedforusewithanairorelectricdrillingmotor.
(a)Solidshankdrill,(b)Drillguidesystem,(c)Flutedtwistdrill
Figure39.91Drillbitsforcomposites
Fittedwithasocketadapter,drillsizesfrom3mmto25.4mmcanbeusedwiththedrillguidesystem.
The internal compression control spring regulator withdraws the tool after drilling. Its pressure
control compensates at breakthrough, where a sudden increase in feed rate occurs as the tool bit
breaksthroughthelastfewfibres.
Partiallydrilledholesareavoidedbecausetheoperatordepressestheunitcompletelyeachtime;no
changeinpressureisfeltastheholenearscompletion.Thedrillsspeedsarebetween1.5m/sto3m/s;
asrecommended.
39.9.2.2
Aramid/epoxy composites
Guidelinesfordrillbitssuitableforaramidcompositeinclude:
Spadedrillsarebestfordrillingaramid/epoxyleavingverylittlefuzzandfrayingattheedges
ofholes.Likecarbidedrills,thesedrillshaveatendencytoburnunderprolongeduses.
230
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Conventionaldrillscanalsobeusedifafirmsacrificialbackingisusedontheexitsurface.
Twistandflatendedhighspeedsteeldrillsperformquitewell,especiallywithafirmbackupof
thecompositetoeliminatefuzzinganddelaminationattheexithole.
Backup can be provided by leaving the glass peel ply on both sides of the composite during
drilling.A0.08mmlayeroffibreglassonthesurfacesofthecompositeproducescleanentrance
andexitholes.
Drillspeedsrangefrom25,000rpmto35,000rpm.Thehighspeedsteeldrillresemblesatwist
drillflutedontheend.
39.9.2.3
Glass/epoxy composites
Drillswithtitaniumdiboridecoatingimprovethetoollifeintheorderof9times.
39.9.2.4
Carbon/epoxy composites
Guidelinesfordrillbitssuitableforcarboncompositeinclude:
Tungsten carbide drills, shaped like a standard twist drill, can be used successfully; with a
backingplate.Theycanbeusedfor50to60holesbeforeitneedsresharpening.Standarddrills
needresharpeningafterfor5to6holes,typically.
Various types of coolants have been evaluated to prevent drills from breaking, dulling or
burning.AlubricantcalledBoelubehasperformedwell,butwateristhebest.
Toreducesurfacedelaminationduringdrilling,itisadvisabletohavealayerofwovenglassof
0.08mmonbothsidesofthelaminate.
39.9.2.5
Theperformanceofthistypeofdrillbitcanbesummarisedas:
Quitesuccessful,producingacleanholewithlittleornobreakout.
Drillinghasbeenachievedwithoutusingbackupmaterial.
Sincethedaggardrillmaintainsthetoleranceofthehole,noreamingisnecessary.
Daggerdrillsaresuitableforuseinboth:
handheldunits,asshowninFigure39.9.2.
afixedmachineusingairfeed.
Goodresultsareachievedfor
handfedunitsat900rpm.
airfeedunitsat2100rpmwitha1.3mm/sfeedrate.
Drilling carbon/epoxy and metal simultaneously has produced high quality holes and
countersinks.
231
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure39.92Daggardrillinhandfeedunits
39.10
Orbital drilling
39.10.1 Introduction
Orbitaldrillingisineffectthemillingofcircularholes.Thecuttingtoolrotatesintheusualwaybut,at
thesametime,thetoolaxisismovedaroundacircularpathaboutthedesiredholecentreandthetool
isfedintothematerial,asshowninFigure39.10.1.
Figure39.101Orbitaldrillingprinciple
Different hole sizes can be machined using the same tool by altering the diameter of the orbital
movement.Thefinalholediameterisequivalenttothecuttingtooldiameterplustheorbitaldiameter.
232
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
39.10.2 Advantages
Orbital drilling offers a number of advantages compared with conventional machining techniques,
including:
Tighttoleranceholes.
Burrlessholesinmetals.
Delaminationfreeholesincomposites.
Variousholesizesusingasingletool.
Singleoperation,usingonetoolinonesetup.
Goodsurfacefinish.
Toolrotationspeed,
Orbitalrotationspeed,
Feedspeed.
The correct setting of each of these parameters is essential to optimise the machining and to avoid
unwantedeffects.Eachsettingisestablishedbytestingtheprocessonrepresentativesamples.
39.10.4 Equipment
Figure39.10.2showsaTwinspinorbitaldrillingheadfromNovatorAB(Sweden)mountedtoajig.In
thiscasetheequipmentisbeingusedforcompositemachiningbySaabEricssonSpace.
Figure39.102Orbitaldrilling:Equipmentmountedonajig
233
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure39.103Orbitaldrilling:Applicationexamples
234
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
39.11
References
39.11.1 General
[391]
M.M.Schwartz
Compositematerialshandbook
McGrawHill,1984
ECSSEHB3221
ECSSEHB3222
ECSSEHB3223
Adhesivebondinghandbook;
previouslyESAPSS03210
Insertdesignhandbook;previouslyESA
PSS031202.
Threadedfastenershandbook;
previouslyESAPSS03208
235
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
40
Manufacturing costs
40.1
Introduction
The selection of materials and appropriate manufacturing processes has important implications
concerning the costs within projects. Composites are used because they offer a range of benefits, of
which masssaving is the most prominent, Ref. [401], [402], [403]. There are often a number of
designs and configurations that fulfil adequately a particular structural configuration. Some of the
competing designs can involve a choice between lightalloys and composites. A part of all design
selectionapproachesistoestablishanacceptablebalancebetweenthe:
totalcostofmanufacture,and
efficiencyofthestructuretomeetitsfunctionalrole.
Thefactorscontributingtothemanufacturingandfabricationcostsofstructuresaredescribed,[See:
40.2].Theitemsconsideredcontributetothedirectaccumulatedmanufacturingcost,i.e.:
materials,
consumables,
processtimes,
capitalequipment,
labour.
Quantifying and allocating manufacturing costs to individual space composite structures and
componentsisdifficultbecause:
designandprocessdevelopmentcostsareveryhigh,
numbersofunitsproducedisoftenverylow,e.g.nomorethanfiveforsatellites,typically,
structuralverificationandqualificationcostsarehigh.
Consequently,withinaproject,itisnoteasytoestablishthetruemanufacturingcostsforindividual
componentsandassemblies.
There is always a strong incentive to retain proven materials and associated manufacturing
technologiesbecausedevelopmentandverificationactivitiesoftenrepresentalargepartofthecosts.
236
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
40.2
Cost drivers
40.2.1
General
Comparedwithaircraftconstruction,thespaceindustryusesfairlysmalltotalquantitiesofcomposite
materials.Itisadvisabletousematerialswithaclearcommercialfuture,i.e.thoseprocuredbymore
thanoneindustrialsector.Wherespecialist,lowvolumeprepregsareconcerned,e.g.UHMCFRP,the
materialcostisveryhighandthechoicelimited.Thesameappliestoothermaterials,e.g.aluminium
lithiumalloys,metalmatrixandceramicmatrixcomposites.
Theissuesthatcontributesignificantlytotheaccumulatedmanufacturedcostare:
Projectcosts,
Massforcostbudget,
Materialsselection,
Designformanufacturing,
Manufacturing,
Toolingandconsumables,
Processingtimes,
Labourcosts,
Partcount,
Unitnumbers,
Productlifeandsourcing.
40.2.2
Bygeneralconsensus,thesefactorsare,Ref.[404]:
Specificationenvelope:
massbudget,and
materialsselection.
Qualificationphilosophy.
Standardisation:conflictsbetweenmassandcost.
Methodology:toreducetimeforindividualtasksorprocesses.
40.2.3
Achievingthemasstargetsorbudgetsisfundamentaltothesuccessofspacestructures.Ifthemass
budgetistoorestrictive,thenmoreexpensivematerialtechnologiescanbeneeded.
40.2.4
Materials selection
Thisisinfluencedbythekeyfactors:
Existingknowledgebase,and
Massbudget:degreeofdifficulty.
237
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
The selection process reflects the naturally conservative philosophy of obtaining the maximum
capabilityfromanexistingtechnologybeforeapplyinganewone.
40.2.5
Aclassicalerrormadeintheearlyyearsofcompositedevelopmentwastoapplyanexistingmetallic
designtothecompositeequivalent.Thisdidnottakeaccountoftheadvantagesofferedbycomposites
and the means of manufacture. Components were not optimised for mass and were invariably
expensive.
40.2.6
Manufacturing expertise
Theexistingavailabilityofmanufacturingfacilitiesandproductionexpertiseisastrongincentiveto
useexistingmanufacturingprocesses.Itenablescoststobemoreaccuratelypredictedbeforemaking
commitmentstoanewcomponentdesign.
Whereanewmanufacturingrouteisnecessary,itisappropriatetoconsiderthe:
Useofasubcontractorwhoalreadyhasthefacilitiesandskillsforthatmanufacturingroute.
Development costs of using a new process, and whether these can be amortised over future
productionorotherprojects.
40.2.7
Toolingis generallya oneoff, nonrecurring cost.For low production runs, cost of tooling is a very
significantcontributoryfactortounitcosts.
Someprocesses,suchasautoclaving,uselargequantitiesofconsumables,suchas:
Baggingmaterials,
Breatherplies,
Peel Plies,
Releasefilms.
Consumablesarerecurringcostsbecausethematerialscannotbereused.Othermanufacturingroutes,
suchasfilamentwinding,usemuchlessconsumablematerial.
40.2.8
Processing times
Whilst a short processing time is desirable, it is not always essential and largely depends on the
componentorassembly,i.e.:
Largecomplexassemblies:Alongcurescheduleneednotbeasignificantcostfactorifonlya
fewunitsarebeingmade.
Smallercomponents(producedinlargernumbers):Reductionofprocesstimesisamajorcost
driver.
238
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
40.2.9
Labour costs
40.2.9.1
General
This remains one of the most difficult items to quantify, because organisations calculating it on a
differentbasis.
40.2.9.2
Direct costs
Thedirectcostsassociatedwiththeactualmanufactureofcomponents,include:
Materialandtoolpreparation,
Lay-Up,
Equipmentoperation,
Demoulding,
Machiningandtrimming,and
Inspection.
Thecostofdesignandtestingisaddedtothesetogiveanoverallfigure.
40.2.10.2 Light-alloy
Complexconstructionsinlightalloysareoftenmadeupoftensofindividualcomponents.Theseare
thenfastenedorbondedtogether.Thematerialcostcanbelowbutthefabricationcostshigh.
40.2.10.3 Composites
The aim is to produce a small number of composite components for subsequent assembly. In some
cases, a single part can be feasible, e.g. by cocuring. Whilst the material and consumable costs can
thereforebehigh,subsequentfabricationcostscanbereduced.
design,and
tooling.
239
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Additionalsavingscanbemadewithin:
Inspectionandtesting.
Improvedconsistentquality.
Somemanufacturingroutesoffergreatercostsavingsthanothers.
40.3
Cost optimisation
40.3.1
Load-carrying structures
40.3.1.1
AsummaryofthepointsarisingfromaBAestudyforESTECoftheEurostargenericsatellitebusare
described,whichconsidereditsfirstcommercialderivativetomeettheInmarsat2mission,Ref.[404].
It demonstrates the use of composites within the context of an overall project and the cost
optimisationofacommunicationssatellite.
Thecommonfeatureswhichenableonesatellitetobeassessedagainstanotherare:
Firstcost,
Directoperatingcost,
Operatinglife,and
Operationalcapability.
Whilst first cost savings can be made at the expense of other features, cost optimisation through
improvementsinefficiencycanbeachievedwhichdonotadverselyimpactontheotherkeyfactors.
Thefundamentaltradeoffthroughoutanyoptimisationisthatofmassforcost.
40.3.1.2
Themaincomponentscontributingtothemassandcostofthesatellitebuswere:
Centralthruststructure,
Payloadandequipmentpanels,
Struts,
Bracketsandcleats.
240
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Thesegroupswerechosentosimplifythecomparativeanalysisbycombiningelementswithcommon
designdrivers.
Table40.3.1liststherangeofcandidatematerialschosenforanalysis,Ref.[404].
Table40.31Costoptimisation:EurostarBus/Inmarsat2study
Material
Specific
Modulus
CTE
Thermal
Conductivity
Costperkg
Al Alloy
AL-Li Alloy
Titanium
Beryllium
HM CFRP
APC 2
MMCp
MMCf
Low
Low
Low
High
High
Medium
Low/medium
High
High
High
Medium
Medium
Low
Low
Medium
Low
High
Medium
Medium
High
Low
Low
Medium
Low/medium
3-5
15-20
15-20
>800
>125
>125
>150
>5000
Key:Procuredmaterialscostsin1989.
For each candidate material, at least two configurations for each of the components were designed;
representing a minimum mass and a minimum cost philosophy. In some cases a midpoint
configurationwasavailablewheretheexistingEurostarbaselinewasnotconsideredtobeminimum
mass.
Figure40.3.1showstherelationshipbetweenmassandcostforthecentralthruststructure,Ref.[404].
Eachlinehasthreepoints;theseare(fromlefttoright):
Minimummass,
Midpointmass,
Minimumcost.
Formassreduction,curveshavingshallowslopesresultinagreatermassreductionperunitincrease
incost.
For cost reduction, curves with the steepest slopes offer greater cost reductions for unit increase in
mass.
241
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure40.31Mass/costsensitivityforcentralthruststructure
Figure40.3.2showsthenextstepoftheentirestructurewithaccumulatedmasscostprofiles,Ref.[40
4].Thisillustratesthat,overall,therearenosignificantwinnersandlosers.Indeed,thedifferencesare
generallyinsignificantcomparedwiththebasicmaterialcapabilitiesintermsofmassandcost.
242
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure40.32Mass/costsensitivityforcompletestructure
Thematerialselectionphilosophiesconsideredwere,Ref.[404]:
minimummassscenario,or
minimumcostscenario.
AsseeninFigure40.3.2,Ref.[404]:
Minimum mass scenario reflects a typical design policy to use existing materials up to their
minimummasslimitpriortoselectingnewmoreefficientmaterials.
Minimum cost scenario is an approach where the most efficient materials are used with a
minimumcostdesignphilosophy.
Thecurrentdesignphilosophy,ortheMin.massscenariohasprovidedagenerallyoptimisedmass
tocosttradeoffbyshowingthatthecostimpactofmaterialswithahigherstructuralefficiencycannot
besupportedinaminimumcostdesign.
243
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure40.33Masstocostenvelopeformaterialimprovements
40.3.1.3
General guidelines
Thesecanbesummarisedas:
Maximiseavailablemassbudget.
Maximisequalificationbysimilarity.
Maximisestandardisationof:
parts,
materials,
methods,and
sources.
Standardfeaturesoritemsarelikelytobethosewhich:
donotimpactonexternalinterfaces,
haveasmallmassimpact,
applytoatleastonethirdofprogrammes.
Usemethodsthatenableautomationandintegrationofprocessesandtasks.
Useexistingmaterialsuptotheirminimummasscapabilitybeforeselectingmorestructurally
efficientoptions.
Theuseofcommongeometryisessential.
244
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
40.4
40.4.1
Material costs
Historically,compositeshavebeenconsideredtobeexpensiveincomparisonwithestablishedlight
alloys,suchasaluminium.Thedirectmaterialpurchasecostsperkilogramareverydifferent,insome
cases,byordersofmagnitude.
40.4.2
Manufacturing costs
The material costs are typically in the range of 10 % to 25 % of the total manufacturing cost.
Compositesofferopportunitiestoreducecostsonotheraspectsofmanufacturingandfabrication.
Inordertocontrolthetotalmanufacturedcostofacomponentorassembly,theadvantagesoffered
bycompositesthatneedtobeproperlyexploitedare:
Alowerpartcountcomparedwithmetallicdesigns.
Fewerfastenerscomparedwithmetallicdesigns.
Lowermaterialwastagecomparedwithmachinedmetaldesigns.
Reducedmachiningcostsbynetshapeforming.
Cocuringofparts.
UseofpreformsandbroadgoodsinsteadofUDprepregs.
Thereductionandcontroloflabourcostsduringthefabricationstagesalsoshouldbeaddressed.
40.5
Historically, composite satellite thrust cylinders for European space programmes, [See also: 29.12],
havebeenmadebyavarietyofconstructionmethods,including:
Autoclaved,lightalloyhoneycombsandwich.
RibstiffenedCFRPdesigns.
FilamentwoundCFRP.
Thecylindersaremanufacturedbydifferentcontractorsinsmallnumbersforeachprogramme.There
appears to be no general consensus as to which is the most costeffective route for producing a
commonstructuralconfiguration.Itisassumedthatthedirectcostofmanufacturingeachcylinderisa
small proportion of the total programme cost. The dominant factors are the identity of the prime
contractor and the preferred technology within that organisation. The design selection process is
thereforenotdrivenbyimmediatetechnicaloreconomicconsiderationsbecausethereisnotanopen
choice of method of construction. The effective use of existing inhouse technology dominates the
controlofdevelopmentandverificationcostsforaparticularprogramme.
245
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
40.6
40.6.1
General
AstudybyMDSSCMcDonnellDouglasSpaceSystemsCo.investigatedtheconstructionoptionsfor
averylargelauncherfairing,withforebody(ogive)andintertank(ALS),Ref.[405].
The aim of the design tradeoff study was to establish the total system cost sensitivity to structural
mass,andifheavy,butlowercost,monocoquedesignswerefeasible.
Thekeyfactorsconsideredinthetradeoffwere:
cost,
structuralloads,
minimumgaugeconsiderations,
separationsystems,
acousticandthermalprotection.
damagetoleranceto:
hail,and
lightningstrikes.
Allofthesefactorscontributedtotheoverallmassoftheconstructions.
Thegeneralsystemrequirementswere:
Fairingplusadaptermassallocation:15000kg.
Intertankmassallocation:4500kg.
Cylindergeometry:10.8mdiameter.
Costamortisedover120unitsover10years.
40.6.2
40.6.2.1
General
ThedimensionsandprospectiveconstructionsareshowninFigure40.6.1,Ref.[405].Informationis
presentedforthefairingcylinderandcoversthedirectfindingsonly.
246
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Informationispresentedforthefairingcylinderandcoversthedirectfindingsonly.
Figure40.61Candidatefairingandintertankconstructions
40.6.2.2
Mass-cost analysis
The mass and cost of respective fairing constructions are shown in Table 40.6.1, Ref. [405]. A
breakdownofthecontributorycostsforthedifferentdesignsisshowninFigure40.6.2,Ref.[405].
Table40.61Launcherfairingconstructions:Massandcostofvariousdesigns
Constructions
UnitMass(kg)
UnitCost($x1000)
GRP Monocoque
CFRP Monocoque
Al-Li Isogrid
GRP Sandwich
CFRP Isogrid
CFRP Sandwich
CFRP Corrugated
CFRP Skin/Stringer
26360
15225
7725
6910
5090
5020
4865
4455
6800
15100
8300
11800
11300
Key:designsfordetailedexamination.
247
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Comments:
Miscellaneous Support, includes:
design engineering,
planning,
operations support,
QA,
business management,
shipping.
Figure40.62Fairingcylindercostsfordifferentdesigns(lifecyclecostsperunit)
Basedonlowerproductioncosts(fromcostbreakdowns),theoptionsselectedfordetailedevaluation
were:
CFRPmonocoque,and
CFRPsandwich.
A key to producing lowcost structures is to minimise the part count. This reduces design analysis,
development and tooling costs. Failing to achieve it accounts for the high miscellaneous support
costsseenwiththeisogrid,corrugatedandskin/stringerconcepts.
40.6.2.3
Design-construction trade-off
In addition to cost analysis, a decision analysis process was used to screen options against several
weightedcriteria;showninTable40.6.2,Ref.[405].Thesecriteriadefinethetotalevaluationscores.
248
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table40.62Launcherfairings:KepnerTregoetradestudyevaluationcriteria
Criteria
Non-recurring
cost
Recurring cost
Definition
Weighting
Factor
4
9
10
8
7
4
5
4
4
ThefairingcylindersectionscoresareshowninFigure40.6.3,Ref.[405],wherealowscoreindicatesa
highmassorahighcost.
The criteria weights and scores were reached by consensus between the MDSSC and Hercules
concurrentengineeringteams.
The CFRP monocoque and sandwich constructions achieved the highest scores and underwent
evaluationintheprocesstradeandcostanalysisrefinements.
249
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure40.63Launcherfairingcylinder:KepnerTregoeevaluationscoresforthe
sectiondesigns
40.6.3
Selection of designs
40.6.3.1
Fairing cylinder
The CFRP sandwich was considered the best candidate for the fairing cylinder, with CFRP
monocoqueasthefirstalternative,because:
Thesystemcostsensitivitytomassforthemonocoquewasunknownandpossiblyhigh.
Themassmarginapplied,ifnecessary,addeddurabilitytothelightweightsandwichdesign.
Themonocoquedevelopmentofferedlittlebenefitforimprovementoftheexistingvehicle.
250
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
40.6.3.2
Intertank
Thedatawereevenmoreconclusivelyinfavourofasandwichconstruction.
40.6.3.3
Forebody
Thethermal,lightningstrike,erosionresistancemadethesemimonocoquedesignwithringstiffeners
moreappropriate.
40.6.4
40.6.4.1
General
Variousoptionsforfabricatinglargecompositesectionswerestudied.Automationhadahighpriority
inordertoavoidthehighcostsofhandlayup.Alsoincludedwere:
Ancillarystructures:
stiffeners:longitudinalandcircumferential,
separationrails.
Materials:
fibres,
resins,
adhesives,and
corematerials.
NDTtechniques.
40.6.4.2
Sandwich fairing
TheaccumulatedcostsforthedifferingprocessesappliedtoasandwichfairingareshowninFigure
40.6.4,Ref.[405].Itillustratesthatthechoiceofprocesshasasmalleffectonfinalcost.Thehighest
andlowestcosttotalsdifferbyonly10%.Thisismainlybecausethecompositelayupprocesssimply
generates a large panel and most of the cost of the fairing is incurred later during assembly and
generalsupportactivities.
Anaccurateassessmentofprocessreliability,producibility,riskminimisationandothercriteriafrom
theKepnerTregoeevaluationareimportant;asshowninFigure40.6.5,Ref.[405].
Basedontheprocessingassessmentasawhole,thebestoptionscanbesummarisedas:
Fairingcylinderandintertank:Broadgoodsdispensingandfilamentwinding.
Forebody:Filamentwindingandfibreplacement.
40.6.4.3
Materials selection
Forthesandwichconstructions,anintermediatemodulus,IM,carbonfibreCFRPwithanaluminium
honeycombcorewaspreferred.
251
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure40.64Launcherfairing:Unitlifecyclecostsforsandwichfairingcylinder
designsfordifferentfabricationprocesses
252
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure40.65Launcherfairing:KepnerTregoeevaluationscoresforprocessesto
fabricatethemonocoqueandsandwichcylinder
40.7
40.7.1
General
Within the composites industry, claims are made that the manufacturing costs for continuous fibre
reinforced thermoplastic composites components are lower than the equivalent thermoset versions.
The potential savings are associated with the shorter processing times for thermoplastics compared
with thermosets. This invites questions as to why thermosets still dominate aerospace applications,
and why thermoplastic composites are virtually absent from space structures and programmes,
particularlyinEurope.
253
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
ThepositionofEuropeanspacecontractorscanbesummarisedas:
Theproductionrunsforthemajorityofsatelliteconstructionsaresmallanddonotwarrantthe
useofthermoplastics.
The range of commercial thermoplastic materials available, especially with higher modulus
fibres,issmallincomparisonwiththermosetprepregs.
Thermoplasticprepregsaremoreexpensivetopurchasethantheirthermosetequivalents.
Opportunitiesareidentifiedwherethermoplasticscanbeappropriate,solelyonthegroundsoflower
total manufactured costs compared with thermosets. Other technical benefits associated with
thermoplasticsarenotconsideredhere.
[Seealso:6.16fortechnicalaspects;6.27foreconomicrelatedfactors]
40.7.2
40.7.2.1
General
A cost study by TRW Space and Technology Group, USA, identified some opportunities for
thermoplastics,Ref.[406].Thestudypremisewasacommercialdemandforsmall,lightweight,low
costsatellitesinthefuture,whichneedslargescaleproductionofcomponents(exceeding1000units)
withalowcostperunit.
40.7.2.2
Processes
Processeswerecomparedwithautoclavingofathermosetdesign;thoseevaluatedwere:
Superplasticdiaphragmforming.
Hottransferpressmoulding.
Filamentwinding.
40.7.2.3
Components
Thecommonbaselineconfigurationsstudiedwere:
Cchannel(diagonalbrace):
Dimensions:380mmx25mm.
Mass:36g.
Angletab(topreventbucklinginbeams):
Dimensions:190mmx19mm.
Mass:10g.
Antennamastsupportstruttube:
Dimensions:2.4mlong,57mminternaldiameter,1.27mm.wallthickness
Mass:1150g.
254
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
40.7.2.4
Unit costs
Unitcostsweredeterminedforproductionnumbersof1,10and100units.
Theeconomicbasedassumptionsincluded:
Labourcostsincludedbothdirectandindirectcosts,
An85%learningcurveforfabricationprocesses,
Vendorsuppliedcompositematerialcostsatproductionvolumes,
Developmental startup costs for thermoplastic processes not included in the manufacturing
costperpart,
Labourcostsbasedon:
partcycletime,
learningcurve,and
degreeofskillrequired,
Typicalfabricationoperationsincludedinlabourcosts:
plycutting,
layup,
bagging,
consolidation,
trim,and
inspection.
Costestimatesforcomponentsconsistedof:
nonrecurringtoolingcosts,i.e.design,fabricationandmaterials,
diaphragmformingcageassemblydepreciation,
recurring material costs and recurring fabrication labour costs derived from the cycle
times.
Itemsnotincluded:
autoclavedepreciation,
equipmentpurchasecostsforthethermoplasticprocessing(smallcomparedwiththecost
ofoperatinganautoclave).
The relative costs for the selected components were calculated and showed that cost reductions are
possibleforthermoplasticswhenunitnumbersexceed10;asgiveninTable40.7.1,Ref.[406].
For1unitorfor100units,thecostimplicationsareverydifferentforeachcomponent,asshownin
Figure40.7.1,Ref.[406].Itillustratesthatthermoplasticsarenotattractiveuntilacertainnumberof
unitsaremade,e.g.atleast10forCchannelandangletabs.Whereasfilamentwoundstrutsmadeof
thermoplasticsarefavourableforanynumberofunitscomparedwithautoclaving.Thisisalsotruefor
filamentwoundthermosetwhencomparedwithautoclaving(notincludedinthestudy).
255
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table40.71Selectedthermoplasticcomponent:Cost/producibilitytradeoff
analysis
T300/934Epoxy
IM7/PEEKThermoplastic
Fabrication
Method
Total
Fabrication
(hrs/part)(2)
Fabrication
Method
Manufacturing
CostReduction
perPart(1)
TotalFabrication
(hrs/part)(2)
10
100
off
off
32%
49%
0.35
20%
43%
20(3)
40%
43%
Cchannel
Autoclave
16.5
Superplastic
diaphragm
forming
AngleTabs(4)
Autoclave
1.1
Hot transfer
press moulding
AntennaMast
Autoclave
34
Filament
winding
Key:
(1)Includesnonrecurringtoolingandrecurringfabricationcosts.
(2)Actualfabricationtime(doesnotincludetrim/inspectiontime)
(3)Includescomputerprogrammingtimeforwindingpattern
(4)Basedonshipsetsofsixparts
256
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure40.71Thermoplasticcomponents:Manufacturingunitcostsasafunction
ofproductionvolumes
Table40.7.2liststhemajorcostcontributorsforproducinglownumbersofunits,i.e.from1to5,Ref.
[406].Thisshowscoststobedominatedbytooling.
Whenhigherunitnumbersaremade,labourcostspredominate.Thisiswherethermoplasticsofferthe
highestbenefits.
257
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table40.72Selectedthermoplasticcomponents:Relativemanufacturingcosts
andmajorcontributorstocost
Methodof
Manufacture
Relative
Costof1
Unit
Relative
Costof100 MajorCostItems
Units
MajorCostItems
100
Tooling:71%
Labour:26%
100
Labour:95%
99
Tooling:71%
Labour:26%
96
Labour:93%
51
Labour:84%
100
Labour:93%
CChannel
Autoclave
thermoset
Autoclave
thermoplasti
c
SDF
thermoplasti
c
Autoclave
thermoset
114
100
Tooling:64%
Equipment:23%
Labour:11%
Labour:70%
Tooling:25%
Angletab
Autoclave
thermoplasti
c
H-TPF
thermoplasti
c
Autoclave
thermoset
98
Labour:69%
Tooling:25%
92
Labour:90%
250
Tooling:85%
Labour:13%
57
Labour:74%
Materials:16%
100
Labour:52%
Tooling:37%
Materials:11%
100
Labour:81%
Materials:16%
102
Labour:75%
Materials:22%
58
Labour:48%
Materials:46%
Strut
Autoclave
thermoplasti
c
FW
thermoplasti
c
110
87
Labour:45%
Tooling:41%
Materials:14%
Labour:41%
Tooling:36%
Materials:23%
Key::largestcontributorfirst
258
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
40.7.3
BothFokker(NL)andDornierLuftfahrt(D)usethermoplasticpartsinproductioncomponents,e.g.:
Fokker50iceprotectionplates:
CetexPEI.
Dornier328iceprotectionplatesandlandingflapribs:
CetexPEI/T300(fromTenCate).
Ref.[407]givesinformationofthecostofthelandingflapribs.
The components are relatively simple shapes, with typical dimensions of 375 mm x 140 mm. The
preferredmanufacturingrouteisbyhotpressing.
Thepossibleconstructionscostedwere:
Aluminium(Al3.1364),
ThermoplasticCetexPEI/T300,
ThermoplasticICIPEEKAPC2/AS4,
UDEpoxyCFRP(6376/HTA7),and
FabricEpoxyCFRP(W3T28242/F593).
Thethermoplasticvariantswerecostedforboth1and3ribspercycleanda20%reductioninmaterial
prices.Figure40.7.2showsabreakdownoftherelativepartcosts,Ref.[407].
Itwasconcludedthatthethermoplasticvariantwascosteffectivecomparedwiththermosets,butnot
withaluminiumunlessthreepartsweremadesimultaneouslyineachcycle.
ThehighmaterialcostofPEEKAPC2isadisadvantagecomparedwiththecheaperCetexPEI.
259
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Key:
Calculation basis: Landing flap rib thickness: 1.25 mm in CFRP, 1.0 mm in Al.
Area: 0.11 m. Mass: 220g (CFRP), 300g (Al). For 400a/c, all costs in 1991,
numbersincludequalitycostsandmaterialsurcharges.
Figure40.72Relativepartcostsforthermoplasticaircraftcomponents:Dornier
328landingflaprib
260
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
40.7.4
Conclusions
Someconclusionsonthecostviabilityofthermoplasticcompositesinclude:
Autoclave moulded thermoplastic composites do not offer any costsavings over autoclaved
mouldedthermosets.
Smalltomediumsized,simpleshapescanbemadeatlowercostinthermoplasticscompared
withthermoplastics,providingthatrapidformingtechniquesareused.
Unitproductionneedstoexceedacertainnumberbeforeitisattractivetousethermoplastics.
For complex shapes, the cost difference between thermoset and thermoplastics reduces
considerably.
The use of thermoplastic composites in space structures can be considered where unit
productionnumbersarerelativelyhigh,suchasfor:
launchers
commonsatellitestructures,e.g.withinseriesofcommunicationandmicrosatellites.
40.8
Automation
Automated composite processing is only of value if it achieves costsavings, compared with labour
intensiveactivities,whichexceedthecapitalequipmentcost.
Thebasicareaswherethiscanbethecaseare:
Cuttingandstackingofprepregs,i.e.lay-up.
Highnumbersofunitsproduced.
Giventhelimitedconsumptionofmaterialsforsatelliteconstructions,automationcanbedifficultto
justify.Themarketforlaunchersisdifferentbecauseunitnumbersarehigherandalargeramountof
materialishandledandprocessed.
Fordesignersofautomatedsystems,thecosteffectivenessisanimportantdesignparameterfromthe
originaldesignconceptstage.Alargerpercentageofthefinalcostofapartisdeterminedintheearly
phasesofthelifecycleofaproduct,i.e.atthedesignphaseasopposedtoproductionphase.
Astudyontheopportunitiesforautomationconcludedthat,Ref.[408]:
Thecosteffectivenessofamanufacturingprocessisatradeoffbetweenrawmaterialcostsand
downstreammanufacturingcostsdeterminedbythatmaterial.
High cost, valueadded materials are most costeffective since they need the least amount of
labour during processing. i.e. 3D constructions, broadgoods, preforms, braids and fabrics as
opposedtoUDtape.
Automatedtechniqueswhichreducelabourcanuselowcostmaterialseffectively,e.g.:
automatedtapelayup,and
filamentwinding.
261
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
40.9
Severalattemptshavebeenmadetodevisemethodsforquantifyingthecostofproducingcomposite
componentsbydifferentmanufacturingroutes,Ref.[406],[408],[409],[4010],[4011].
Generally, such exercises are only of value where the number of component units produced is
reasonablyhigh.
The analysis methods attempt to compare different processes that often produce subtly different
components. The methods often make assumptions and can only produce valid results if there is
agreementon:
Costingoflabourandoverheadrates.
Equipmentcosts.
Allocationofdevelopmentcosts.
40.10
References
40.10.1 General
[401]
UniversityofDelaware
Compositedesignguide
Issue9,1983
[402]
G.Lubin
Handbookofcomposites
VanNostrandReinhold,1982
[403]
V.M.Karbhari&D.J.Wilkins
Selectingmaterials,processes&shapes:gettingitrightthefirsttime
37thInternationalSAMPESymposium
March912,1992,p13791391
[404]
B.A.Reid&A.Pradier
Costoptimisationofloadcarryingstructures
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumSpaceApplicationsof
AdvancedStructuralMaterials
ESTEC,TheNetherlands,2123March1990,ESASP303,p397402
BAe TP8598 - Cost optimisation of load carrying structures, Phase 1
Final Report, ESTEC Contract No. 7529/88/NL/PH
BAe TP8673 - Cost optimisation of load carrying structures, Phase 2
Final Report, ESTEC Contract No. 7529/88/NL/PH
BAe TP8683 Cost optimisation of load carrying structures
guidelines, Phase 1 Final Report, ESTEC Contract No.
7529/88/NL/PH
[405]
M.J.Robinsonetal
Advancedcompositestructuresforlaunchvehicles
SAMPEQuarterly,January1991,p2637
262
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[406]
E.M.Silverman&W.C.Forbes
Costanalysisofthermoplasticcompositesprocessingmethodsfor
spacecraftstructures
SAMPEJournal,Vol.26,No.6,November/December1990,p915
[407]
W.Werner
Costeffectivenessofstructuralapplicationsoffibrereinforced
thermoplastics
ProceedingsoftheInternationalSymposiumAdvancedMaterialsfor
LightweightStructures,ESTEC,TheNetherlands
2527March1992,ESASP336,p185190
[408]
M.F.Foley&E.Bernardon
Thermoplasticcompositemanufacturingcostanalysisforthedesignof
costeffectiveautomatedsystems
SAMPEJournal,Vol.26,No.4,July/August1990
[409]
M.F.Foley
Technoeconomicautomatedcompositemanufacturingtechniques
SAMPEQuarterly,January1991,p6268
[4010]
E.Wang&T.Gutowski
Costcomparisonbetweenthermoplastic&thermosetcomposites
SAMPEJournalVol.26No.6,Nov/Dec1990,p1926
[4011]
T.Gutowskietal
Developmentofatheoreticalcostmodelforadvancedcomposite
fabrication
CompositesManufacturing,Vol.5,No.4,1994,p231239
263
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
41
Repair of composites
41.1
Introduction
Damage to composite structures has been studied, and the types of damage categorised, [See: 41.2].
Repairconceptshavebeendevelopedforlaminatesandsandwichstructures.
Themeansofcategorisingtypesofdamagearedescribed.Thevariousrepairconceptsdevelopedto
restorethepropertiesofthestructurearepresented,[See:41.4].
41.2
Damage classification
41.2.1
NASA and prime aircraft contractors have compiled life histories of composite structures. This
showedthatnearlyalltypesofdamagetostructuresoccurfrom:
groundhandlingduringassembly,or
maintenance,and
impactofforeignobject.
[See:41.3forallthetypesofdamagethatneedtoberepaired]
41.2.2
Each of the accidental damage types are assessed using various inspection techniques and then
classified regarding their criticality. The inspection techniques commonly used, either singularly or
combined,are,[Seealso:Chapter34]:
Visualexamination.
Tappingtest.
Ultrasonicexamination.
Xrayexamination.
264
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
41.2.3
Repair zones
41.2.3.1
General
The aircraft industry usually divides a structure into repair zones, and determines the allowable
damageforeachzone,Ref.[413].Thestructuralcomponentscanbeclassifiedas:
Structural components(safelifedesign)
Primarystructuralcomponents(failsafedesign)
41.2.3.2
Such parts are classified as those whose failure can result in a significant loss of structural
performance,i.e.launcher,satelliteorspacestructure.
The repair concept should meet all the aspects of a safelife design. If it cannot, the whole part is
scrappedandreplaced.
41.2.3.3
Failure of a primary component can have serious consequences on the operation of a structure, e.g.
reducing the performance of a safelife component under cyclic loading. All such components are
subjecttofurtherinspection.
A repair to a damaged primary structure parts has to guarantee the original strength and stiffness
throughouttheinspectioninterval.
41.2.3.4
Failurehasnodirectorimmediateeffectsonthesafeoperationofsecondarystructuralparts.
Repairsarenormallyforcosmeticreasonsandreconstitutethecomponentprofile.
41.3
Damage categories
41.3.1
The types of damage which lead to the failures, [See: 41.2], are usually classified by their impact
energylevel,i.e.:
Lowenergyimpactatmoderatespeed,e.g.:
handlingincidents,
droppingatoolduringassemblyormaintenance.
Highenergyimpactathighspeed,e.g.:
hail,
smallstonesfromtherunway.
Highenergyimpactatveryhighspeed,e.g.:
Inorbitdebris,
meteoroids.
265
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
41.3.2
Damage types
41.3.2.1
General
The damage produced by each type of impact is categorised and a suitable repair procedure
considered,[411],[412],[413].
41.3.2.2
Scratches
Thedamagehasnoeffectonthestructuralstrength,butisrepairedinordertopreventasubsequent
attackofthepartbyhumidity,UV,particleradiationoratomicoxygen.
Figure41.31Damagecategories:Scratch
41.3.2.3
Notches
The damage does not extend through the full thickness of the part. The effects on the mechanical
performancedependonthedepthofthenotchrelativetothecomponentthickness.
Figure41.32Damagecategories:Notch
266
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
41.3.2.4
Chipping
Thisisalocalfracturewithseparationofthesurfaceplies.Theeffectonthemechanicalperformance
depends on the thickness of the part. Repair is necessary to prevent the structure from subsequent
attackbyexternalagents,e.g.humidity,radiation,atomicoxygen.
Figure41.33Damagecategories:Chipping
41.3.2.5
Debonding
An example is the separation of sandwich skin and the core. The effects depend on the size of the
separatedarea.Repairofthedamagezoneisnecessaryiftheseparatedareaisgreaterthanaspecified
value.
Figure41.34Damagecategories:Debonding
267
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
41.3.2.6
Thisoccursduetotheseparationorfromalackofadherencebetweentwopliesofalaminate.Itisof
major importance, especially in thin compressionloaded panels (stability failure) or in thick panels
subjected to interlaminar shear loading. Delaminations are repaired to retain the mechanical
performance.
The combination of delamination and debonding dents often occurs after an impact on the
structure.Dependingontheenergyleveloftheimpact,thefibresorthepliescanbebroken.
Figure41.35Damagecategories:Delamination
41.3.2.7
Perforation
Dependingontheimpactenergy,aperforationcanaffectpartorallofthecomponentthickness.Ithas
majoreffectsonthecompressionpropertiesofastructuralcomponent.Perforationalsocausesleaksin
tanksorpressurisedstructures.
Figure41.36Damagecategories:Perforation
268
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
41.4
41.4.1
General
Therepairprinciplesoftheaircraftindustry,whicharebasedontheFAAregulations,statethat:
Aftertherepairtoastructuralpartmadeofcompositematerials,thereshouldbenodegradationin
theultimatedesignstrengthofthepartforitsremainingservicelife.
41.4.2
Repairsareusuallymadebyreinforcingthedamagedcomponentwithametalorcompositepatch.
Theprincipalmethodsare:
Flushrepairs,wherepatchesarebondedorcuredinplace,[See:41.5].
Externalrepairs,wherepatchesare:
bonded,[See:41.6].
bolted,[See:41.7].
TypicalrepairconceptsareshownschematicallyinFigure41.4.1,Ref.[411].
41.4.3
Repair selection
Thegeneralapproachwithintheaircraftindustryisthatthechoiceofarepairconceptisdefinedinthe
appropriatestructuralrepairmanuals,anddependsonthe:
typeofdamage,[See:41.3].
criticalityofthedamagerelatedtotheimportanceofthestructuralcomponent,[See:41.2].
269
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure41.41Basicrepairconcepts
270
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
41.5
41.5.1
Applications
Flushbonded patches of composites can be necessary to rebuild the originally smooth surface of a
damagedstructuralcomponent.
41.5.2
Post-repair properties
Testresults,Ref.[414],showthatflushrepairsprovidethemosteffectiverestorationoftheoriginal
strength,i.e.withoutdefect.
Thestrengthrecoveryisabout60%forthicklaminates,whichishigherthanthetypicallystated40%
to60%ofultimatestrength(designultimatestrength).
41.5.3
Design
Thepossibledesignsofaflushrepairare,Ref.[415]:
Theremovedmaterialisreplacedinthesameorientationandthesamestackingorderthatused
intheoriginalcomponent;asshowninFigure 41.5.1.
Theremovedmaterialisreplacedparalleltothesurface;asshowninFigure41.5.2.
TheparallelmethodisusedbyAirbusIndustrieandprovidesthemaximumbondstrengthbetween
thecomponentandthepatch.Thisconceptisalsocheaperthantheothermethodtoimplement.
41.5.4
Manufacture
Both types of repairs are cured in place using heatblankets and special types of vacuum bags.
Additional cover plies and the use of an adhesive film between the component and the patch are
advised;asshowninFigure41.5.3.
Ifthecomponenthasalreadybeeninservice,thelaminateisdriedinordertorecoverythemaximum
strength.
Figure41.51Typicalflushrepair
271
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure41.52Flushrepair,usedbyAirbusIndustrie
Figure41.53Flushrepairwithadhesivefilmandcoverplies
41.6
41.6.1
Applications
An external patch offers an intermediate level of complexity and cost. It is usually used for lightly
loaded,thinlaminates.
41.6.2
Post-repair properties
The strength recovery is typically between 25 % and 60% of the original strength, Ref. [414]. This
indicates that the design strength (typically 40 to 60% of the ultimate strength without defects) is
possible.
The curing process is a significant parameter regarding strength recovery; the higher the curing
temperature,thehigherthestrengthofarepairedcomponent.
41.6.3
Design
Thedesignvariesdependingonwhetherthepliesareprecuredorcuredinplace,[See:Manufacture].
272
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
41.6.4
Manufacture
Patchesareeither:
Precured;asshowninFigure41.6.1,or
Curedinplace;asshowninFigure41.6.2.
Ifthecomponenthasalreadybeeninservice,therepairareaisdriedbeforethepatchesarebondedin
ordertomaximisestrengthrecovery.
Figure41.61Externalrepair:Precuredpatches
Figure41.62Externalrepair:Curedinplace
41.7
41.7.1
Applications
Boltedrepairsarenormallyusedfor:
Delaminationinsignificantcomponents,e.g.skin/stringerstructures,
Preventionofpeelingwithinabondedexternalpatch.
Lightlyloaded,structuralcomponentsorsecondarypartscanberepairedbythismethod.
273
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
41.7.2
Post-repair properties
For structural parts, the repair has to restore at least the ultimate design strength; typically 40 % to
60%oftheundisturbedultimatestrength.
41.7.3
Design
Thedesignvariesdependingonthe:
Location
Useofametalpatch,or
Useofaprecuredcompositepatch;asshowninFigure41.7.1.
Special care is taken when drilling the holes for fasteners to prevent additional delamination of the
laminate.
A sealant is used between the CFRP component and the metal patches to inhibit galvanic corrosion
problems.
Oftenblindfastenersareusedbecausetheaccesstobothsidesofastructuralcomponentisreduced.
Blindfastenershavelowpulloutstrength;thistypeofrepairisnormallyusedfortemporaryrepairs
only.
41.7.4
Manufacture
Repairstoadamagedcomponentaremadebyusingmetalorcompositepatcheswhicharesecured
by:
Boltingonly.
Bondingandbolting.
[Seealso:Design]
Figure41.71Boltedandbondedrepairusingacompositepatch
274
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
41.8
41.8.1
No core damage
Whenthehoneycomborfoamcoreofasandwichstructureisintact,therepairschemeisthesameas
forathinlaminatedcomponentaccessiblefromonlyoneside,[See:41.6and41.7].
41.8.2
Core damage
Whenthecoreiscrushedseverely,itshouldbereplaced.Otherwisethespaceisfilledwithamixture
ofresinandmicroballoons.
41.8.3
Manufacture
The repairsequence fora sandwich panel with a damaged coredepends onwhether it isaccessible
from:
Oneside,or
Bothsides.
Ifthesandwichpanelisaccessiblefromonesideonly,theareaofdamagedcoreisremovedandapre
curedcompositeplate,bondedtoahoneycombplug,isthenfitted.Theskinisthenclosedbyatypical
flushrepair.
Figure41.8.1showsanexampleofasandwichpanelrepair.
275
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure41.81Sandwichrepair
41.9
References
41.9.1
General
[411]
M.Torres&B.Plissonneau
Repairofhelicoptercompositestructuretechniquesand
substantiations
AGARDConferenceProceedingsNo.402
[412]
Th.Thiele
RepairprocedureforcompositepartsontheAlphaJet
AGARDConferenceProceedingsNo.402
276
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[413]
AirbusIndustrie
A320:Structuralrepairmanual
[414]
R.H.Stone
Developmentofrepairprocedureforgraphite/epoxystructureson
commercialtransports
SAMPEMonographNo.1CompositeRepairs
[415]
G.Lubin
Handbookofcomposites
VanNostrandReinholdCompany,1982
[416]
J.F.Knauss&R.H.Stone
Demonstrationofrepairabilityandrepairqualityongraphite/epoxy
structuralsubelements
SAMPEMonographNo.1CompositeRepairs
277
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
42
Basic characteristics of new advanced
materials
42.1
Introduction
The basic characteristics of the various groups of new advanced materials in ECSSEHB3220 are
described.Itservestohighlightreasonsforthedevelopmentofthedifferentgroupsofmaterialsand
the problems encountered in doing so. Information is presented and discussed in further detail in
subsequentchapters,including:
MetalsandMMCs
Technicalceramicsandceramicbasedtextiles
CMCs
Carboncarbon
Design aspects of the various material groups are given, along with examples of their actual or
intendedapplicationinspacestructures.
The majority of information is related to their hightemperature performance, gained from various
reusablevehicleconcepts.
Smarttechnologiesandthevarioussmartmaterialsarealsopresentedforspaceapplications
42.2
Material groups
42.2.1
Metallic materials
Information on more conventional and welldeveloped materials such as aluminium and titanium
alloysisnotgivenindetail.Theresumoftheircharacteristicsisusedasastartingpointforthenewer
developments,including:
Aluminium-lithium alloys,[See:Chapter46].
Dispersion strengthening
Superplasticalloys(SPF/DB)
Metalmatrixcomposites:
278
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Referenceismadetosourcedocumentsfortheestablishedalloysinaerospaceapplications.
[See:Chapter46foraluminium;Chapter47fortitanium]
42.2.2
Ceramic materials
42.2.2.1
General
Ceramicscanbebroadlygroupedas:
Reinforcingfibres,[See:42.6]
Monolithic, which is a large family of different materials also known as technical ceramics.
Theseareoftenproducedfrompowders,[See:Chapter43].
Fibrereinforcedcomposite,whicharethenclassedbythematrixphase,e.g.
siliconcarbide,[See:Chapter52]
glassandglassceramic,[See:Chapter53].
carbon,[See:Chapter54]
42.2.2.2
Fibrereinforced ceramic composites and carboncarbon materials offer attributes for use in high
temperature applications; notably in propulsion and thermal protection systems. Significant studies
relatingtomaterialsdevelopmentandevaluationoccurredduringreusablespaceplaneprogrammes.
42.2.2.3
Thelowthermalexpansioncharacteristicsofferedbymonolithicceramics,variousCMCsandcarbon
carbon composites have led to their evaluation for structures needing dimensional stability over a
widerangeoftemperaturesfromcryogenicupwards,e.g.supportsforopticalequipment,mirrorsfor
spacebasedtelescopes.
42.2.3
Material classification
42.2.3.1
Materialscanbeclassifiedbygenerictype,e.g.polymer,metallicorceramicbased,[See:Chapter1],or
bytemperaturecapability,e.g.thoseofferingcapabilitiesabove600Candultimatelytowards2000C.
Figure42.2.1providesabroadindicationofultimatetemperaturecapabilities,whichcanbedefinedto
apointwherethematerialsareessentiallystable.Beyondthispointdegradationaccumulatesandthe
materialsresidualpropertiescanonlybeusefulforarestrictedduration.
279
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Temperature(C)
Figure42.21Classificationofadvancedmetallicandceramicmaterialswith
temperature
Figure 42.2.2 shows specific strength against increasing temperature for different materials. Other
thancarboncarboncomposites,whichshowincreasingstrengthwithtemperature,thetrendisfora
gradualstrengthreductionastemperatureincreasesandthematerialoptionsbecomemorelimited.
280
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure42.22Specificstrengthagainsttemperatureforadvancedmaterials
42.3
42.3.1
Structural alloys
Theprincipalmetalalloysofstructuralinterestarealuminium,titaniumandthesuperalloys,notably
nickelbased. Supporting roles are provided by magnesium, copper, beryllium, intermetallics and
refractorymetals,Ref.[421],[422].
Alloys generally have a main constituent with additional alloying elements in varying proportions.
The alloy composition, its production route and its heat treatment and mechanical working history
determinethemechanicalproperties.
Examplesofcommonaerospacealloysinclude:
Aluminium[Seealso:Chapter46]:
2XXXSeries,e.g.2024(Copperprincipalalloyingelement)
7XXXSeries,e.g.7050(Zincprincipalalloyingelement)
Titanium[Seealso:Chapter47]:
Intermediatealphabeta,e.g.Ti6Al4V
281
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
42.3.2
Properties
These alloys have good mechanical properties in their own right and are wellestablished, well
characterised materials which fulfil structural needs. However, the aerospace industries are always
seeking greater efficiency and longevity in structures from improved materials. This provides an
incentivetodevelopmetalalloysbeyondprecipitationandmechanicalhardening.
The material properties in which improvements are sought include, Ref. [423], [424], [425], [426],
[427]:
Greaterstrength,notably:
ultimatetensilestrength(UTS)
yieldstrength(YS)
Greaterstiffness
Highertemperaturecapability:
creepresistance
Betterfracturetoughness
Betterfatigueresistance
Bettercorrosionresistance
Optimisedthermalcharacteristics,e.g.
conductivity,
heatcapacity,and
dimensionalstability.
Therequirementsareusuallyapplicationdrivenandmaybeonlyafewselectedparametersfromthe
abovelistcanbeaddressedatonetime,itisimpossibletoimproveallsimultaneously.Whenattempts
are made to improve some parameters, there is a strong possibility that others are sacrificed or
reduced.
Allalloysareoptimisedtoenhancecertaincharacteristicsandabalanceorcompromiseisreachedon
arangeofengineeringproperties.
42.3.3
Material developments
Themeansofimprovingalloysorpreparingcompositesare:
Fineparticledispersions:
particlesize:submicrometre(<1m).
particletype:e.g.oxides.
particlevolumefractions:1%to9%,typically.
usuallyclassifiedas:
o
dispersionstrengthened(DS),or
mechanicallyalloyed(MA).
Discontinuousorparticulate reinforcedComposites(MMCs):
particlesize:Micrometrerange(1to50m).
282
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
reinforcementisachievedbytheadditionofceramicparticles,e.g.:
o
siliconcarbide,
alumina,
boroncarbide.
ParticlefractionswithinMMCs:10%to20%,typically.
Continuousfibreorfilamentreinforcedcomposites(MMCs):
Fibrediameter:8mto200m.
Analogous to fibre reinforced plastics but with a metal matrix providing significant
strengthandstiffness.
FibrevolumefractionswithinMMCs:30%to50%,typically.
42.3.4
Effects of reinforcements
Theadditionofparticlesandfibreshasadisruptingeffectonconventionalalloymicrostructuresand
theusualprecipitationandgraincharacteristicsofsolidifyingmetalmelts.Asthevolumetriccontent
of reinforcement increases, the disruption becomes more acute and the chance of deleterious effects
increases. As reinforcement contents increase, the most obvious property to diminish is overall
materialductilityintermsofplasticdeformation,elongationtofailureandreductioninarea.Thiscan
presentuncertaintytodesignersandengineerswhoexpectoranticipatemetalstohavehighductility.
Dispersionstrengthened and particlereinforced metals are treated as isotropic materials. Fibre
reinforced MMCs are anisotropic and are considered as a group of materials in their own right
possessing property characteristics different from those of both metal alloys and fibrereinforced
plastics.
Low strains to failure (<1%) and lack of ductility are features of CFRP, MMC, intermetallic and
ceramic materials. As the number of applications of these materials increases, design experience is
beingaccumulatedwithlowstraintofailurematerials.
42.3.5
Processing
In preparing metal matrix composites, a wide range of reinforcing materials has been tried with an
equally large number of matrices. Only a small proportion of these have reached commercial
maturity.Thetwomainareasrequiringattentionare:
Costeffective production techniques for combining molten matrix with the reinforcement to
giveacontrollableandreproduciblecompositeproduct.
Optimum compatibility between matrix and reinforcement to ensure that both function in
unisontogiveacompositewithenhancedproperties.
The combining of molten metal with a large volume fraction of reinforcement is not without
difficulties. The interface between the two phases has considerable importance and a balance is
reachedoninterfacialbonding.
Verygoodbondingusuallyresultsfromadirectchemicalreactionproducing:
fibredegradation,
brittlefracturecharacteristics,and
283
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
modestcompositestrength.
Verypoorbondingleadsto:
lowinterfacialshearstrengths,
42.4
42.4.1
Features
42.4.1.1
High temperature
For some space applications there is a need for materials which can provide a load bearing and
structuralfunctionathightemperatures,i.e.800Cto>2000C.
42.4.1.2
Materials
The materials are principally inorganic (nonmetallic) and ceramic compositions. In view of the
structuralimplications,materialswithbenignandprogressivefracturecharacteristicsarepreferredto
monolithic,brittlematerials,[See:Chapter43forconventionalmonolithicceramics].
Theconcentrationisonfibrereinforcedmaterialswithamatrixofeither:
Glass,
Glass-ceramic,or
Ceramic.
Carboncarboncompositesalsooffersomeuniquecapabilities.
42.4.1.3
Fracture
Composites achieve their benign fracture characteristics by ensuring that the matrix is decoupled
fromthefibres.Thisprovidesalargeinterfaceareawhichactsasacrackstoppingmediumandallows
fibre slippage and pullout. In many respects the composites can be viewed as rigidised fibre
(insulation) materials where sufficient integrity is provided for the composite to be classified as an
engineeringmaterial.
Themicrostructuresofthesecompositesarecomplexandthematrixatanytimecontainsasignificant
population of microcracks and microvoids. An optimised composite gives an element of pseudo
ductilityandfailswithnoticeablefibrepullout.
A monolithic ceramic has a nominal fracture toughness of approximately 4MPam1/2, a good
compositeisusuallyinexcessof15MPam1/2andpreferably30MPam1/2.
Thetermgoodcompositeindicatesamaterialwhichshowstolerancetothermalshockandthermal
cyclingandcansustainmicrocrackingandminorimpactdamagewithoutcatastrophicfailure.
284
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
42.4.2
Properties
Mechanical strengths are modest (100MPa to 400MPa), but these are retained at high temperatures.
Ultimatefailurestrainscanbeintherangeof0.4%to1.0%,comparedwith0.2%orlessformonolithic
ceramics. Carbon fibrereinforced carbon possesses characteristics which are suited to high
temperature applications. Its excellent thermal stability is retained at temperatures approaching
2000C and is unique in that strength increases as the temperature rises. This is found in both the
pyrolysedmatrixandthefibres.
42.4.3
High-temperature use
42.4.3.1
Oxidation
Carboncarbon composite would be ideal for most applications were it not for its poor oxidation
resistance at temperatures exceeding 500C. For prolonged use in oxidising environments, elaborate
coatings and protection systems are used to give high thermal stability and hightemperature
synthesis,withprocesstemperaturesbetween1500Cand2000C,isnecessary.
Otherceramicmatrixcompositesofferhightemperaturestabilitywithouttheoxidationproblemsor
theveryhighsynthesistemperatures.Inthistherearevaryingdegreesofsuccess,influencedbythe
followingfacts:
Allceramicoxidationresistantfibres,suchassilicon carbideoralumina,showincreasingthermal
degradationandperformancelossattemperaturesbeyond1200C.
The most successful decoupling interface material between fibre and matrix is carbon which
performsthemechanicalrequirementsbutispronetooxidisation.
Progressively reducing the process temperatures, e.g. from ceramic (silicon nitride, 1500C) to
glassceramic (LAS, 1100C) to glass (borosilicate, 800C) equally reduces the maximum use
temperature.
Avoiding mechanical damage of the fibres during processing favours lowpressure, reactive
consolidationtechniques,butthesetendtoleaveresidualporosity(approximately10%).
Highpressureconsolidationeliminatesporositybutposesseverelimitationsoncomponentsize
andcomplexity.
42.4.3.2
Prolonged exposure
Above1000C,thecompositionandmicrostructureofceramiccompositescanundergochemicaland
diffusionreactions.Timeandtemperaturearethedeterminingparametersfordeleteriouscomposition
changestoreachsignificantproportionsanddegradethematerialbeyondanacceptablepoint.
285
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
42.5
42.5.1
42.5.1.1
In fibrereinforced plastics, the fibres are stable and inert at the processing and operating
temperatures. It is only the polymer matrix that chemically responds to its environment; it cannot
chemicallyreactwiththefibres.
Formetalsandceramicstheprocessingandoperatingtemperaturesarefarhigher,greatlypromoting
chemical reactions. Molten metalsare aggressiveand the largesurfacearea of fibre is susceptible to
damage. Therefore processing with molten metals needs to be accomplished as quickly as possible.
Ceramic processing also involves chemical reactions and diffusion mechanisms for matrix
consolidation,e.g.:
Sintering,
Polymerpyrolysis,or
Chemicalvapourdeposition,(CVD).
Allofthesemethodsrelyoncontrollingthedesiredreactionsandlimitingthedeleteriousones.Some
exampleswheredeleteriousreactionshaveneededcontrollingare:
Carbonfibrereinforcedaluminiumalloys:Ifmoltenaluminiumremainsincontactwithcarbon
fortoolong,thebrittlecarbide,Al3C4,forms.Thisoccursonthefibresurface,severelydegrades
the fibre, and causes a brittle interface. Carbon and aluminium also have an electrochemical
potentialdifferencewhichcancauseinternalgalvaniccorrosionunderhotwetconditions.
Silicon carbide Fibre Reinforced Aluminium Alloys: Very severe fibre degradation occurs if
molten aluminium is kept in contact for too long, i.e. more than a few minutes. The SiC is
convertedtoaluminiumcarbide.AmorecompatiblechoiceforaluminiumisAlumina(Al2O3).
Siliconcarbidefibreorfilamentreinforcedtitaniumalloys:Placingsiliconcarbideintomolten
titaniumleadstotitaniumcarbideformationproducingfibredegradationandabrittleinterface.
Only large diameter filaments can survive this, and then only if the fibres are coated with
titaniumdiboride(TiB2)orfibreswithacarbonrichsurface.
Tungstenfibrereinforcednickelsuperalloys:Tungstenissolubleinmoltennickelgivingbrittle
interfaces. A coating of thorium oxide (ThO2) acts as a diffusion barrier to control the
degradation.
42.5.1.2
Intermetallics
As confidence grows in using brittle materials, attention has been given to some which have
traditionallybeenclassifiedasundesirablewhenunintentionallypresentinconventionalalloys.These
include the intermetallics, notably titanium aluminide (Ti3Al) and nickel aluminide (Ni3Al). In their
pureform,theyarenotusableowingtobrittleness.
Bydopingandmicroalloying,greatimprovementscanbemadeto:
Ambientductility,
Hightemperaturestrengthretention,
286
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Reductionofoxidationembrittlement,and
Improvementofcreepresistance.
This effectively creates a new group of materials and can be taken a step further by using
intermetallicsasthematricesforcomposites.
The reinforcement of Ti3Al with niobium (Nb) coated silicon carbide fibres has been studied. The
niobium is selected as the interface to prevent a chemical reaction between the matrix and fibre.
EquallyitisadesirablemicroalloyingelementwithTi3Alforimprovingductility,soitsdiffusioninto
thematrixshouldnotbeahindrance.
42.5.2
High-temperature applications
42.5.2.1
Hydrogen-containing environments
Inhightemperatureapplications,notablypropulsionandthermalprotectionsystems,thepresenceof
hydrogenoxygen fuel in the former and oxygen in the latter pose problems. The small size of
hydrogenions,atomsandmoleculesmakesdiffusionrelativelyeasywithinmaterials,notablymetals,
manifesting itself as unacceptable material embrittlement. This causes concern for the integrity and
longevityoffueltanks,pipelines,pumpsandmotors.
42.5.2.2
Oxygen-containing environments
The presence of oxygen at high temperatures always causes concern because there is a natural
inclinationforallmetalstoformoxides.Insomecases,thisisadesirablemechanismforpassivating
thesurfaceofmaterialstorenderfurtheroxidationimpossible.Classicexamplesinclude:
AlAl2O3,
SiCSiO2
AlNAl2O3
Forexposedcarboncarboncomposites,oxidationisprogressiveandultimatelycatastrophic.
Given that materials oxidise, it is usually the case that oxidation should be controlled or inhibited.
Thisisusuallydoneby:
Carefulmaterialselection,
Avoidingmaterialconstructionswhich,underthermalcycling,produce:
spalling,
porosity,
cracking,or
delamination.
useofprotectivecoatings,ifnecessary.
287
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
42.5.2.3
Temperature variations
Athightemperaturesmaterialsarerarelyusedunderisothermalconditions,i.e.therearealwayssome
heating and cooling cycles. Three phenomena contribute in determining the life expectancy of
materialsundernonisothermalconditions:
Thermal fatigueorthermalcycling:Cycliceventshaveacumulativeeffect.Materialexpansionis
similartomechanicalloading(fatigue)causinginitiationandpropagationofdamage.
Thermal shock: Heating rate and localised temperature rises affect materials. Uneven heating
givesrisetointernalstressesduetodifferencesinexpansion.
Coefficient of thermal expansion and material matching: Within a composite material, different
phasescanhavedifferingexpansioncoefficients.Differentmaterialswithinajointoracoating
and substrate can have different expansion coefficients. If these are heated over a wide
temperature range, the internal stresses can become very high. Stress relief usually occurs
through microcracking, spalling or even total fracture. Therefore, close CTE matching is
beneficialifalargetemperaturerangeisexpected.
42.6
42.6.1
Introduction
42.6.1.1
General
Refractoryandceramicfibrescanbeusedas:
Reinforcementsincomposites,e.g.:
Carbon(rayon,pitchorpan),[See:Chapter52;Chapter54]
Siliconcarbide
Alumina
Boron
Thermalinsulation,[See:Chapter99].
Numerous types of fibres have been considered for reinforcing various metal and ceramic matrix
phases. Those types which have been studied, primarily during the development of composites for
hightemperature applications, are summarised. The majority are continuous fibres, although some
whiskerreinforcementshavealsobeenconsidered.
Notallthetypesoffibresdescribedarecommerciallyavailableorhavebeensuccessfulincomposite
manufacture.
42.6.2
Table42.6.1identifiesrefractoryandceramicfibreswhichcansustaintemperaturesof1000Cormore
andindicatestheiruseincomposites.
288
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
42.6.3
Use in composites
Themajorityofsuccessfulcompositedevelopmenthascentredon:
Highstrengthcarbonfibres
NicalonSiCfibres
Allcommerciallyavailablereinforcingfibres,exceptcarbon,tendtodegradeprogressivelyintermsof
strengthattemperaturesbeyond1200Cto1300C.Propertiesarethenamatterofassessingresidual
strengthsandwhetherthesearesufficienttobeuseful.
Table42.61Reinforcingfibresavailableforuseininorganiccomposites
Fibre
Status
HST300
Nicalon
Tyranno
SCSfilaments
Derivatives:
MPDZ
HPZ
MPS
Fiberamic
Comments
Carbon
Excellentmechanicalproperties[See:Chapter2],withstabilityto
2000C+,butwilloxidise.
SiliconCarbide
Basedonfibrepyrolysis.Goodhandleability&tensilestrength.
Significantpropertylossabove1200to1300C.
Goodthermalstability,butavoidedasdifficulttoprocess.
LessthermallystablethanNicalon/Tyranno.Goodhandleability.
Applicabletoalimitednumberofmatrixmaterials,mainlyglass
ceramics.
Underdevelopment,notyetavailable.
Alumina
FiberFP
Safimax
Saffil
ALMAX
Sumitoma
DENKA
Nextel312
Nextel440
Nextel480
PRD166
ZicarZYF100
Aluminafibreswithgoodthermalstability,butbrittlewithmodest
strength.Usefulpropertiesto1500C.
Modifiedaluminafibreswithbettertensilestrengththanhigh
alumina,butwithreducedthermalstability~1400C.
Littleknown
Boron
Boron
Borsic
Goodthermalstability,butavoidedasdifficulttoprocess.
Key:
Widelyused
Gaininguseinceramicandglassceramicmatrixcomposites
289
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
42.6.4
Thermal stability
42.6.4.1
General
Thermalstabilityisoftengainedattheexpenseoftensilestrength,asinthecaseofalumina(Al2O3)
compared with silicon carbide (SiC). Table 42.6.2 gives details of the commercial fibres and some
underdevelopment.
290
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table42.62ContinuousfibreandfilamentreinforcementsusedinMMCsandCMCs
Specific
Grade
Chemical
Composition
(%)
[Manufacturer]
CARBON
High Strength
grade.
e.g. Toray T300
> 99C
Density
(kgm-3)
1760
Fibre or
Filament
Diameter
(m)
Tensile
Modulus
at RT
(GPa)
235
Tensile
Strength
at RT
(MPa)
3500
Tensile
Strain to
Failure %
Product Forms
and
Availability
Comments
1.5
3 grades of yarn
available.
Limited standard
fabrics.
SILICON CARBIDE
Nicalon
(Nippon Carbon)
2550
15
196
2740
1.4
SCS Filaments
(AVCO, USA)
3300
140
427
3450 +
0.81
Si-Ti-C-O:
44.2Si, 24.5C, 11.0Ti,
12.3 O
(-SiC + TiC)
2300
8-12
200-220
2800-3000
1.4-1.5
2300
2350
2600 2700
10-15
10
10-15
175-210
140-175
175-210
1750-2100
2100-2450
1050-1400
0.8-1.2
1.2-1.7
0.5-0.8
15
220
1800
>99 -AI203
3950
20
380
85AI203.15SiO2
3200
9-17
95 -AI203
3300
96-97AI203
3300
Tyranno
(UBE, Japan)
MPDZ
HPZ
MPS
(Dow Corning/
Celanese, USA)
Fiberamic (RhonePoulenc, France)
ALUMINA
Fiber FP
(Du Pont)
Alumina
(Sumitomo, Japan)
Safimax SD
Saffil RF/RG (ICI)
Continuous filament.
Cannot be woven.
Development product.
1.2
Development fibre
Not yet available.
1380
0.4
Yarn from Du
Pont(USA). Special
fabrics possible.
210-250
1800-2600
0.7-1.2
300
2000
0.67
Uncertain
300
2000
0.67
Little known.
291
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Specific
Grade
[Manufacturer]
ALMAX
[Mitsu mining Co.
Japan]
Specific
Grade
Chemical
Composition
(%)
99.5AI203
-alumina
Chemical
Composition
(%)
[Manufacturer]
ALUMINA - continued
DENKA (Japan)
80AI203, 20Si02
Continuous
Alumina
80 -AI203 20 stabilised
PRD-166
(Du Pont)
ZrO2
ALUMINA-BORIA-SILICA
Density
(kgm-3)
Fibre or
Filament
Diameter
(m)
Tensile
Modulus
at RT
(GPa)
Tensile
Strength
at RT
(MPa)
3900
10
330
1800
Density
(kgm-3)
Fibre or
Filament
Diameter
(m)
Tensile
Modulus
at RT
(GPa)
Tensile
Strength
at RT
(MPa)
3100
10
170
1700
1.0
4200
20
380
2070
0.6
2700
3050
3100
12
12
12
152
186
220
1720
2000
1900
1.13
1.07
0.86
Little known.
Tensile
Strain to
Failure %
Product Forms
and
Availability
Comments
Nextel 312
Nextel 440
Nextel 480 (3M)
62AI203,14B203, 24Si02
70 AI203, 2 B203, 28Si02
70 AI203, 2 B203, 28Si02
ZIRCONIA
Zircan
ZYF-100 (USA)
5600 5900
4-6
2470 2580
101-203
400
3500
0.88
Continuous filament.
Cannot be woven
2380 2610
101-203
400-414
2760
0.66-0.69
Continuous filament.
Cannot be woven
BORON
Boron Filaments
(AVCO)
BORSIC
Borsic Filaments
(USA)
292
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
42.6.4.2
Figure42.6.1,Figure42.6.2andFigure42.6.3showthefibretensilestrengthatvarioustemperatures,
fortwogradesofNicalonfibre,Ref.[4210].
Afterheattreatmentsinflowingwetairfurnaceenvironment(12hoursoak)
Figure42.61SiCNicalonfibretensilestrengthatelevatedtemperature
293
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Afterheattreatmentinflowingargonfurnaceenvironment(12hoursoak)
Figure42.62SiCNicalonstandardgradefibretensilestrengthatelevated
temperature
294
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
After12hourfurnacesoakinflowingargon
Figure42.63SiCNicalonceramicgradefibre:tensilestrengthatelevated
temperature
295
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
The tensile strength of Nicalon fibres after prolonged exposure at various temperatures is shown in
Figure42.6.4andFigure42.6.5,Ref.[4211].
Figure42.64SiCNicalonfibre:tensilestrengthafterhightemperatureexposure
inair
Figure42.65SiCNicalonfibre:tensilestrengthafterhightemperatureexposure
inargon
296
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
ThehightemperaturetensilestrengthandstiffnessofTyrannoandNicalonSiCfibresarecomparedin
Figure42.6.6andFigure42.6.7,Ref.[4212].
Figure42.66SiCfibresNicalonandTyranno:tensilestrengthatelevated
temperature
297
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure42.67SiCfibresNicalonandTyranno:modulusatelevatedtemperature
42.6.4.3
Alumina-based fibres
Figure42.6.8andFigure42.6.9comparethetensilestrengthandmodulusofthreegradesoffibreat
elevatedtemperatures,Ref.[4212].
Figure42.68Aluminafibres:tensilestrengthatelevatedtemperature
298
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure42.69Aluminafibres:modulusatelevatedtemperature
TheeffectofahightemperaturetreatmentisshowninFigure42.6.10foraluminabasedfibresPRD
166 and FiberFP. The stability of the two fibres after exposure to high temperatures is shown in
Figure42.6.11,Ref.[4213].
Figure42.610Aluminafibres:tensilestrengthagainstexposuretoelevated
temperature
299
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure42.611Aluminafibres:tensilestrengthagainstexposuretime
Figure 42.6.12 and Figure 42.6.13 show the hightemperature strengthstiffness stability of Alumina
BoriaSilicaNextelsinglefilaments,Ref.[4214].
Figure42.612Aluminaboriasilicasinglefilament:tensilestrengthatelevated
temperatureinair
300
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure42.613Aluminaboriasilicasinglefilament:tensilemodulusatelevated
temperatureinair
42.6.4.4
Whisker reinforcements
Combinedhighthermalstabilityandhighstrengthhastoanextentbeenachievedwithwhiskers,e.g.
high purity, stoichiometric, SiC whiskers. The problem is then to keep this good combination in a
composite. To date, this has been far from successful because chemical reactions degrade the very
smalldiameter(~1m)whiskers.
42.6.4.5
Thermal expansion
301
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure42.614Modulusforvariousfibresandmatrixmaterials
302
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure42.615Coefficientsofthermalexpansionforvariousfibresandmatrix
materials
42.7
References
42.7.1
General
[421]
NOTE
MILHDBK5F:MetallicMaterialsandElementsforAerospaceVehicle
Structures.November1990
ReplacedbyMMPDS01,Ref.[4215]
[422]
MetalHandbook
ASMInternational,10th.Edition,Volume2
ISBN0871703785(V.2),1990
[423]
M.Taya&R.J.Arsenault
MetalMatrixCompositesThermomechanicalBehaviour
PergamonPress.ISBN0080369839,1989
[424]
W.S.Johnson
MetalsMatrixCompositesTesting,AnalysisandFailureModes
ASTMSTP1032,ISBN083011270X.1989
303
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[425]
J.Fulleretal
DevelopmentsintheScienceandTechnologyofCompositeMaterials
ECCM4,September2528,1990,ISBN1851665625
[426]
SymposiumonHighTemperatureComposites
ProceedingsoftheAmericanSocietyforComposites.June1989
TechnomaticPublishingCompany.ISBN877627002
[427]
S.G.Fishman&A.K.Dhingra
CastReinforcedMetalComposites
ConferenceProceedings.ASMInternational,September1988
ISBN0871703394
[428]
AnnualConferencesonCompositesandAdvancedCeramicMaterials
PublishedbyAmericanCeramicSociety
11th.AnnualConference,January1823,1987.ISBN01966219
[429]
K.S.Mazdiyasui
FibreReinforcedCeramicCompositesMaterials,Processingand
Technology
NoyesPublication,1990
[4210]
T.J.Clarketal
ThermalDegradationofNicalonSiCFibres
Proceedingsof9thAnnualConferenceonCompositesandAdvanced
Ceramics,p576588,1985,ACSpublication
[4211]
T.Ishikawaetal
Strength&StructureofSiCFiberafterHighTemperatureExposure
ProceedingsoftheSymposiumonHighTemperatureMaterials
ChemistryIV,theElectrochemicalSociety,Vol.885,p205217
[4212]
D.J.Pyscheretal
StrengthsofCeramicFibersatElevatedTemperatures
J.Am.Cer.Soc.Vol.72,No.2.p284288.(1989)
[4213]
J.C.Romine
NewHighTemperatureCeramicFiber
Ceram.Eng.Sci.Proc.,8[78]p755765(1987)
[4214]
A.R.Holtz&M.F.Grether
HighTemperaturePropertiesofThreeNextelCeramicFibers
32ndInternationalSAMPESymposium,April69,1987,p245256
[4215]
R.C.Riceetal.
MetallicMaterialsPropertiesDevelopmentandStandardization
(MMPDS)
DOT/FAA/ARMMPDS01,January2003
Website:www.hdbk5.battelle.org/milhdbk2.htm
304
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43
Technical ceramics
43.1
Introduction
43.1.1
General
43.1.1.1
Characteristics
Ceramic describes a large group of material compositions having diverse characteristics and
properties. Ceramics are available in a variety of forms, e.g. powders for consolidation, fibres and
whiskers of variouslengths and diameters, preconsolidated shapes (tubesand plates), andcustom
shapeditems.
[Seealso:42.6forceramicreinforcingfibresforcomposites]
Manytypesofceramicsaresuccessfullyusedinindustryforaverywidevarietyofapplications.They
aretypicallyemployedfortheirelectricalandthermalinsulation;electricalandthermalconductivity;
thermal stability; corrosion and wearresistance, or a combination of one or more properties. Some
types of ceramics are used for applications that make us of their characteristics, such as bearing,
friction and high stiffness. For extreme lowtemperature applications, low thermal expansion
encouragedevaluationofsomeceramicsforapplicationsdemandinghighdimensionalstability.
43.1.1.2
Terminology
Within the context of this handbook, technical ceramicsare monolithic materials, without deliberate
additions of fibrereinforcement, hence excluding ceramic matrix composites, [See: 52]. Another
means of distinguishing between monolithic and composite is that the mechanical properties of
technicalceramicsareusuallystatedonastatisticalbasis,i.e.Weibull.
Overtheyears,technicalceramicshavealsobeenknownas:
advancedtechnicalceramic,whichwasadoptedafterextensiveresearchanddevelopmentinto
somenewmaterialslargelydestinedforaeroengines.
Althoughthetermsfineceramicoradvancedtechnicalceramicarestillusedinsomeorganisations,
technicalceramicisnowmorecommon,Ref.[431],[432].
305
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
In addition to those types of monolithic technical ceramics used for industrial or engineering
applications,theotherdivisionsofceramicscommonlymadeare:
Electronictechnicalceramics:Althoughconstitutingalargeproportionofthetechnicalceramic
market,theyarenotconsideredasstructuralmaterials,e.g.chipcarriersanddevicesubstrates.
Coatings:Althoughmanytypesofceramicsareusedascoatingsappliedtosubstratematerials,
thesearenotincludedhere.Ceramiccoatingsareverycomplexmixtures,whicharetailoredto
provide protection of the substrate against a number of environments, e.g. hot corrosion,
chemical attack, erosion. Where ceramicbased coatings have been applied to substrate
materials described in this handbook, they are mentioned in that chapter, e.g. thermal barrier
coatingsonSuperalloys.
Functional ceramics are not included here, i.e. dielectric, piezo or pyroelectrical grades used
forelectronicdevicessuchassensorsandigniters.Somefunctionalceramicsareusedinsensor
systemsandactuatingdevicesforsmarttechnologies,[See:Chapter90].
Opticaldevices:Materialsusedsolelyforopticaldevicesarenotincluded,e.g.lenses,windows,
fibre optics, because their selection is usually made on their optical performance rather than
loadcarryingability.Someexamplesofmaterialsthatofferacombinationofopticalandload
bearingpropertiesaredescribedasspecialitymaterials,[See:43.16;43.17].
43.1.2
43.1.2.1
Materials
Thebasictechnicalceramicmaterialfamiliesofprimeinterestforspacestructuresare,[See:43.2]:
oxides,
carbides,
nitrides,
carbon(elementalcarbon)
glassceramics,alsoconsideredasstructuralglasses,e.g.commerciallyavailableproductssuch
asZerodurandULE.
43.1.2.2
Application examples
Until recently, monolithic ceramic materials were of low interest within the space community for
structural applications. In general, ceramics have the reputation of being brittle and intolerant of
shockandvibrationalloads.This,inpart,ledtothedevelopmentofCMCsforreusablespaceplane
technologies.
Low thermal expansion properties coupled with other inherent characteristics (electrical, optical or
environmental resistance) have provoked a new interest in the potential use of some technical
ceramicsinspace,particularlytomeetthedimensionalstabilitydemandsofsystemsoperatingatvery
highfrequency.
Massremainsadesigndriverforallspacecraft,leadingtointerestinlightweightceramicforms,such
asfoams,alongwithinnovativemassoptimiseddesigns,[See:43.18;43.19]
The wider use of ceramics is encouraged by a growing knowledgebase from applications in other
industrysectorsandalsobytheincreasingnumberofinternationallyrecognisedstandardsavailable,
e.g.fortesting.
306
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.2
Material groups
43.2.1
Composition
Oxides
Carbides
Nitrides
Elemental,suchascarbon.
Each of the composition groups contains a variety of materials of different formulation. Some are
highpurity, single constituent grades whereas others are complex blends or chemical compounds.
Within a single family, materials provide a range of mechanical or physical properties for use in a
varietyofapplications.
Commercialceramicproductsaredescribedinanumberofways,i.e.:
Mineralorigin,e.g.steatite,
Chemicalformulation,e.g.magnesiumsilicate,
Molecularformula,e.g.MgOSiO2,
Manufacturersproductname.
Manufacturers usually offer several grades of the same basic ceramic, often classed by purity or
composition.
Forcompleteness,allcommontypesofcommercialtechnicalceramicsarelistedintablesbytheirbasic
chemical composition. Those with greyed backgrounds are of less interest for structural space
applicationsandarenotdiscussedfurther.
43.2.2
Oxides
Table 43.2.1 introduces some of the general features of common commerciallyavailable oxide
technicalceramics.Ofthese,materialsthatprovideausefulcombinationofmechanical,electricaland
thermal characteristicsare of interest for aerospace engineeringapplications,e.g. grades ofalumina,
silicaandzirconia.
307
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.21Technicalceramics:Oxidesgeneralfeatures
OxideType
Alumina
Aluminium
oxide
Al2O3 [See:
43.6]
Features
High stiffness.
Hard and brittle.
Properties retained to about 800C,
but reduce significantly above
1000C.
Chemical resistance to both acid and
alkalis (except HF).
Excellent electrical insulation.
Medium shock and thermal cycling
resistance.
Beryllia
Beryllium oxide
BeO [See:
43.16]
Cordierite
Magnesium
aluminosilicate
Magnesia
Magnesium
oxide
MgO
Moderate strength.
Good electrical insulation.
Low thermal expansion.
Moderate mechanical properties.
Poor thermal shock resistance.
High chemical resistance, including
molten metals.
Mullite
3Al2O32SiO2
Silica
Silicon dioxide
SiO2 [See:
43.11]
Steatite
Magnesium
silicate
MgOSiO2
Titania
Titanium
dioxide
TiO2
Zirconia
Zirconium
dioxide
ZrO2 [See:
43.14]
Key:
Comments
Zirconia additions (ZTA) improve
toughness and strength.
Synthetic sapphire is a single
crystal form of alumina; often used
for optical applications.
Translucent alumina is used for
high-temperature, optical
applications, e.g. lighting.
Alumina fibres are used as
reinforcement phase in metals and
ceramics.
Alumina-titanium carbide is used
for cutting tools.
Toxic.
Thermal management in
electronics-electrical.
Microwave applications, e.g.
windows and radomes.
Nuclear industry.
Porous types for catalyst supports.
Impervious types for electrical uses.
High-temperature refractory uses
(up to 2400C).
Single crystal forms for optical
uses.
Refractory material.
Toughness can be improved by
formulation and processing.
Fused quartz or vitreous silica for
optical uses.
Fused silica for thermal shock
resistance.
Grinding-cutting media.
Electronic-electrical uses.
Electronic applications.
Semiconducting type used as
electrodes or to discharge static
(process industries).
Fully stabilised materials are used
as refractories.
PSZ for thermal resistance. TZP for
high strength and TTZ for
engineering uses.
At high temperatures PSZ becomes
electrically conductive.
Greybackground:lessofinterestforspacestructuralapplications
308
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.2.3
Carbides
Table43.2.2givessomegeneralfeaturesofcommerciallyavailablecarbidetechnicalceramics.Whilst
boroncarbidecanbeconsideredforparticularapplications,siliconcarbidehasarangeofpropertiesof
mostinterestforspaceapplications,[Seealso:43.12].
Table43.22Technicalceramics:Carbidesgeneralfeatures
CarbideType
Boroncarbide
B4C[See:43.8]
Siliconcarbide
SiC[See:43.12]
Features
Comments
Extremelyhard.
Lightweight.
Relativelygoodfracture
toughness.
Wearresistanceuses.
Impactresistance(armour).
Neutronabsorption.
Mechanicalpropertiesvarywith
theprocessingrouteused.
Thermalstabilitytoveryhigh
temperatures(2200Cto2800C,
dependingontype).
Hard.
Goodoxidationandhotcorrosion
resistance,dependingonpurity.
Impactresistance(armour).
Wearresistance.
Moderatethermalconductivity.
Moderateelectricalconductivity.
Variousprocessingmethodsused
togivearangeofmaterials(from
refractoriestoengineering
materials).
Usedfordimensionallystable
structuresinspacebasedand
terrestrialtelescopes.
43.2.4
Nitrides
Table43.2.3providessomegeneralfeaturesofcommerciallyavailablenitridetechnicalceramics.The
characteristicsofdifferentgradesarelargelyduetotheirprocessingmethods.
309
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.23Technicalceramics:Nitridesgeneralfeatures
Nitridetype
Features
Highthermalconductivity.
Aluminiumnitride Goodelectricalinsulation.
AlN[See:43.7]
Powderspronetomoistureuptake
affectingelectricalproperties.
Comments
Thermalandelectricalproperties
dependonpurity.
Heatmanagementinelectronic
applications.
Windowsforvisibletoinfrared
systems.
Hexagonal(powders)usedas
hightemperaturesolidlubricant.
Densifiedshapesforinsulators
andhightemperaturerefractories
ininertatmospheres.
Cubicformusedforabrasives.
Boronnitride
BN[See:43.9]
Microstructuredeterminesproperties:
Hexagonalformsimilartographite.
Propertiesareanisotropic.Oxidisesin
airabove800C.
Cubicformisextremelyhard.
Siliconnitride
Si3N4[See:43.13]
Goodcreepresistance.
Goodthermalshockresistance.
Highstiffness.
Lowthermalexpansion.
Notelectricallyconductive(pure).
Hightemperaturestrength(1500Cin
vacuum;disassociatesat1850Cin
nitrogen)dependsonprocessingused:
RBSNreactionbondedsiliconnitride
orreactionsintered:porous,
moderatestrengthbuthighthermal
shockresistance.Modifiedprocessing
forfine,evenporositytoimprove
strength.
Hotpressedorhotisostaticpressed
materials:veryhighstrengths,good
fracturetoughnessandoxidation
resistance(to1200C).Creepresistance
dependsonsecondary,glassyphases.
Sinteredmaterials:strengthscan
approachhotpressedvariants.
Modifiedcompositionscanincrease
toughnessattheexpenseofstrength.
Strengthpropertiesdependon
processingmethod.
RBSNvariantsareusedfor
refractorytypeapplications.Non
wettingbymoltenmetalsenables
usesinmetalandprocess
industries.
Hotpressedorisostaticpressed
areusedforhightemperature
engineeringcomponents,e.g.gas
turbineandengineparts.
Sinteringenablesproductionof
shapedpartsnotpossiblebyhot
pressing,butcancompromisea
levelofmechanicalperformance.
Highstrength.
Goodfractureresistance.
Excellentwearresistance.
Goodthermalshockresistance.
Hightemperaturewear
applications,e.g.engines
(combinedmechanicalproperties
andhardness).Alsousedfor
cuttingtoolsandweldingjigs.
Conductivesialonsareblended
withcompoundssuchastitanium
carbide.
Sialon
Siliconaluminium
oxynitride
Key:
Greybackground:lessofinterestforspacestructuralapplications
310
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.2.5
Elemental
43.2.5.1
Carbon
Carbonisusedinitselementalformsandcanbeclassedasatechnicalceramic.
CarbonmaterialsareerroneouslyknownasgraphiteintheUSA.Inthecontextofthishandbook,the
termgraphiteisusedonlyforthesoft,hexagonallycrystallised,allotropeofcarbon.
Carboncanhaveawiderangeofpropertiesdependingonitsstructure,fromtheextremehardnessof
diamond(naturalorsynthetic)toglassyamorphousformsandsoftgraphites,[See:43.10].
Comparedwithothertechnicalceramicgroups,carbonshave:
Goodelectricalconductivity,
Moderatethermalconductivity,
Goodthermalshockresistance.
Table43.2.4summarisessomefeaturesofcommerciallyavailablecarbontechnicalceramics.
Themajorityofcarbonbasedstructuralcomponentswithinspacevehiclesarecomposites,however,
somediscretecomponentsmadefromcarbontechnicalceramicshaveflown,e.g.componentsinSpace
ShuttleandISS,suchassealsandbearings,Ref.[433].
Foams destined for structural roles are a recent innovation, e.g for spacecraft thermal management
systems,[See:43.10]
311
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.24Technicalceramics:Carbonsgeneralfeatures
CarbonType
Features
Solid:
Soft, weak material.
Self-lubricating properties.
Anisotropic properties.
High temperature and corrosion
resistance.
Porous:
Exfoliated (graphite foil in USA).
Foams.
Vitreous carbon
Carbon-Graphites
(mechanical carbons)
[See: 43.10]
Pyrolytic carbon
[See: 43.10]
Siliconised carbon
Fibres
[See: Chapter 2;
42.6]
Diamond
[See: 43.17]
Extremely hard.
Abrasion and wear resistant.
Developments in synthetic
process techniques now enable
large, simple shapes to be
manufactured rather than just
thin films or coatings deposited
on substrates.
Key:
Comments
Lubricants for high or low
temperatures.
Anisotropy can be controlled by
processing.
Refractories and process
industries.
Flexible sheet for gaskets and
seals.
Thermal management systems.
Constituent of refractories, used
as a binder matrix phase for other
materials, e.g. carbon, graphite
and SiC; especially carbongraphites (mechanical carbons).
Specialist uses only, e.g.
laboratory equipment.
Materials can be created to
achieve a balance of properties,
i.e. range of mechanical carbon
materials for a variety of wearresistant uses, e.g. bearings,
seals, pumps.
Produced by deposition onto
substrates, often from chemical
vapours, e.g. CVD process.
Silicon carbide surface layer
formed by liquid or vapour
infiltration processes. Processes
adapted and improved for ceramic
composite manufacture, [See also:
Chapter 89].
Wide variety of fibre properties
and characteristics depending on
processing methods and
treatments.
Abrasives and cutting tool
industries.
Wear protection (coatings and
films).
Optical applications.
Thermal management.
knownassiliconizedgraphiteintheUSA;Greybackground:lessofinterestforspace
structuralapplications
312
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.2.6
Glass-ceramics
Highstrength.
Lowthermalexpansion.
Goodthermalshockresistance.
Goodcorrosionresistance.
Goodwearresistance.
Electricalinsulation.
Gooddielectricproperties.
43.2.7
Sources
There are numerous manufacturers and suppliers of technical ceramics worldwide. Manufacturers
usuallyofferacomprehensiverangeofmaterialtypesandawiderangeofgradesforanyparticular
material.Theyusuallyalsoprovideacomprehensivedesigndevelopmentandprocessingservicefor
theirmaterials.Ingeneral,commercialproductshaveevolvedovermanyyearsasapplicationsmoved
from refractories to electronics and structural engineering applications. In recent years, some of the
largercompanieshavebeenactiveinacquiringorcreatinglicensingordistributionagreementswith
other organisations to enhance their product ranges, e.g. Boostec and CoorTek for silicon carbide in
spaceapplications.
Technical ceramics continue to be used mainly for some combination of their hightemperature,
corrosion resistance and electrical characteristics, so available property data corresponds to these
prime markets. For example, it is rare to have data on lowtemperature performance from
manufacturers.
Speciality materials, such as optical grade materials and glasses, tend not to be supplied by
mainstreamtechnicalceramiccompanies.
Table 43.2.5 summarises some examples of sources of commercial materials, including those
providing specialist product forms, e.g. foams, [See also: Chapter 26 for foam cores in sandwich
panels].
313
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.25Technicalceramics:Sourcesexamples
Boostec (F)
Bettini (I)
Carbon Lorraine (F)
Carpenter (USA)
Ceradyne
CeramTech
ECM (D)
GE Advanced Ceramics
Graphite Metallizing
(USA)
HITCO (USA)
Kubota
Kyocera
Schunk (D)
SGL (D)
Speciality
Corning Corp.
Dynamic Ceramic (UK)
Glass
ceramics
Zirconia
Silicon
carbide
Silicon
nitride
Silica
Carbon
Boron
carbide
Boron
nitride
Cercom
CoorsTek
Aluminium
nitride
Source(4)
Alumina
Typesoftechnicalceramics
(1)St.GobainincludesformerproductsofNorton,AnnaWerk,Cesiwid,Carborundum;(2)Morgan
groupincludesMorganAdvancedCeramics,MorganAdvancedMaterials&Technology,
Haldenwanger,MorganPerformanceMaterials;(3)FormerlyDeBeers;(4)Sourcesare
indicativeonlyandnotanexhaustivelist.
314
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.3
Design aspects
43.3.1
Guidelines
43.3.1.1
General
Compared with conventional engineering materials, ceramics are brittle and this inherent feature
should be taken into account in the design approach used, [See also: 43.15 design with glass
ceramics].
Historically, selection of technical ceramics for engineering applications was based on thermal or
electrical performance needs first and then the ability to resist any mechanical loads arising. In
demanding hightemperature environments, this meant that technical ceramics were only applied
beyondthecapabilitiesofconventionalmaterials.Forelectricalinsulationapplications,useofmetals
isimpossible,soceramicswereusedwhereplastics(wheninvented)lackedadequateperformance.
Overrecentyears,agrowingimpetusfortheuseoftechnicalceramicsinmainstreamapplicationshas
helpedincreasetheirknowledgebase,e.g.standardsforpropertyevaluation,morereliableproperty
data, improved processing and availability of design tools. These can now be applied to the more
demanding,highperformanceindustrysectors,suchasaerospace.
43.3.1.2
Theirinherentbrittlefracturebehaviour,andtheconsequencesofthisfailuremode,makethespace
industrywaryofceramicsandglasses.Therefore,allaspectsofselection,designandverificationare
subjecttoreviewandapprovalbythefinalcustomer,[See:ECSSQ7071].
Other than applications in equipment and electronics, proposed structural uses within European
projects mainly exploited the extreme hightemperature performance of ceramicbased materials for
passive TPS thermal protection systems and thermostructural designs in reusable vehicles, [See:
Chapter70;Chapter71].
The emphasis on ceramics has now changed to dimensionally stable structures, exploiting the low
CTE and electrical characteristics. Although confidence in extreme high temperature performance is
not an issue for such intended applications, lessons learnt in obtaining reliable property data and
analysistechniquesremainappropriate.Likewise,experiencefromotherindustrysectorscanalsobe
applicable.
43.3.1.3
Component design
Thedesignandmanufactureoftechnicalceramiccomponentsissimilartothatofcompositesinthat
they are difficult to machine to final form. Therefore, technical ceramic nearnet shape components
tendtobedesigned,manufacturedandsuppliedbycompanieswiththeexpertise.Althoughtechnical
ceramicscompaniesdoprovidesomestockshapes,themajorityoftheirbusinessisprovidingcustom
components for particular applications. Some general examples include: seals, feedthroughs, wear
componentsinprocessindustries,cuttingtools,heaterelements,rollers,kilnfurniture,heatsinksand
refractoriessuchascruciblesandboats.Thereforemanufacturersandsuppliersoftechnicalceramics
tend to work together with the engineers considering such materials for highperformance
applications.
Good design of ceramic components, as with any other material, aims to exploit the beneficial
characteristicswhilstavoidingthebad,Ref.[4330].
315
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Thevariousfactorstoconsiderduringcomponentdesigncanbesummarisedas:
Mechanicalloads,[Seealso:43.15designofglassceramics]:
Usecompressiveloadingandavoidtensileorshearloads.
Somematerialsareanisotropic,whereasothersarenot.
Pointloadingisdetrimental,sodistributeloadsasevenlyaspossible.
Physical:
Somematerialsarethermallyconductive,whereasotherarenot.
Thermal expansion is generally much less for ceramics than other materials. In mixed
materialcombinationsthermalexpansionmismatchneedsconsideration.
Someceramicsareelectricallyconductive,othersarenot(insulators).
Some materials become electrically conductive under certain conditions, e.g. high
temperature(zirconia,siliconcarbide).
Shape:
Poorsurfacefinishandfeaturessuchasnotches,sharpcorners,slotsandcutoutsactsas
stressraisersandneedtobeavoidedbyusinggenerousradii.
Largeorsuddenchangesinsectioncanpromotehighthermalstressesandtemperature
gradients.
Joints between ceramics and other materials need careful consideration, e.g. limiting
thermalexpansionmismatchorpointloads.
Holesizes,shapesandpositionneedconsideration.
Nearnet shapes help avoid extensive postmanufacture machining operations that are
difficultorexpensiveandcandamagehard,brittlematerials.
Processing:
Processesneedoptimisationtoavoidrepeatedhightemperaturefiringwhichcaninduce
damagebythermalgradientsormismatch.
43.3.2
43.3.2.1
Anextensivedevelopmentexercisehasresultedinmethodsofdeterminingthepropertiesoftechnical
ceramicsforengineeringapplications,[See:Testmethods].
Development of models that predict the performance of ceramics (both monolithic and composite)
undervariousconditionsaidsdesignandanalysis.AnexampleistheNASACARESsoftwaresuite,
whichhasbeenappliedtoceramicsdestinedforspaceapplications,Ref.[434].
OriginallyaccesstotheNASAsuiteofsoftwareprogramswasrestrictedtoorganisationswithinthe
USA.Providingthatcertaincriteriaaremet,applicationsfromEuropeanbasedorganisationsarenow
welcomed,Ref.[4349].
316
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.3.2.2
DevelopedbyNASA,CARESceramicsanalysisandreliabilityevaluationofstructuresisasuiteof
integrated design software tools that provide a means to optimise the design of brittle material
components using probabilistic analysis techniques. It incorporates fundamental mechanics theory
and associated computational approaches for component design using isotropic brittle materials.
CAREScanbegenerallyappliedtodesignsinvolvingtheuseofbrittlematerials(monolithicstructural
ceramics,glasses,intermetallics,andceramicmatrixcomposites)inawiderangeofindustrysectors
and can be used in conjunction with commerciallyavailable FEA packages, e.g. ANSYS and
ABAQUS.
Thesuiteofprogramsincludes,Ref.[434]:
CARESLife, which was developed to predict the reliability and life of structures made from
advancedceramicsandotherbrittlematerials,e.g.glass,carbonsandintermetallics.
CARESCreep, which is an integrated design program for predicting the lifetime of structural
ceramiccomponentssubjectedtomultiaxialcreeploads.Ittakesintoaccountthetimevarying
creepstressdistribution(stressrelaxation).
Composite CARES (C/CARES), which was developed to address aerospace design issues
relating to CMC ceramic matrix composites. The aim is to predict the timeindependent
reliabilityofalaminatedstructuralcomponentsubjectedtomultiaxialloadconditions.
43.3.2.3
Test methods
Traditionally, test methods for technical ceramics were adapted from those used in the refractory,
electricaloropticalindustries,i.e.themainconsumers.Internationalstandardsnowcoveraspectsof
highperformance technical ceramics for engineering applications. These are summarised in Table
43.3.1withdraftstandardslistedinTable43.3.2,Ref.[435],[436].
317
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.31Technicalceramics:ISOstandardssummary
Number
Date(1)
Title
ISOFineceramics(advancedceramics,advancedtechnicalceramics)(2)
Sample preparation for the determination of particle size
ISO 14703
Mar-2000
distribution of ceramic powders
Test method for flexural strength of monolithic ceramics at
Aug-2000
room temperature
ISO 14704
Jan-2004
ISO 14704 - Technical Corrigendum 1.
Test method for hardness of monolithic ceramics at room
ISO 14705
Mar-2000
temperature.
ISO 15165
Oct-2001
Classification system.
Test method for tensile strength of monolithic ceramics at
ISO 15490
Jul-2000
room temperature.
Test method for fracture toughness of monolithic ceramics
at room temperature by single edge precracked beam
ISO 15732
Oct-2003
(SEPB) method.
Test method for tensile stress-strain behaviour of
ISO 15733
Feb-2001
continuous, fibre-reinforced composites at room
temperature.
Test method for elastic moduli of monolithic ceramics at
ISO 17561
Mar-2002
room temperature by sonic resonance.
Test method for linear thermal expansion of monolithic
ISO 17562
Oct-2001
ceramics by push-rod technique.
Method for flexural strength of monolithic ceramics at
ISO 17565
Dec-2003
elevated temperature.
Determination of absolute density of ceramic powders by
ISO 18753
Aug-2004
pyknometer.
ISO 18754
Aug-2003 Determination of density and apparent porosity.
Determination of thermal diffusivity of monolithic ceramics
ISO 18755
Mar-2005
by laser flash method.
Determination of fracture toughness of monolithic ceramics
ISO 18756
Dec-2003
at room temperature by the surface crack in flexure (SCF)
method.
Determination of specific surface area of ceramic powders by
ISO 18757
Dec-2003
gas adsorption using the BET method.
ISO 20501
Dec-2003
Weibull statistics for strength data.
Determination of adhesion of ceramic coatings by scratch
ISO 20502
Apr-2005
testing.
ISO 20507
Dec-2003
Vocabulary.
Determination of light transmittance of ceramic films with
ISO 20508
Dec-2003
transparent substrate.
Determination of oxidation resistance of non-oxide
ISO 20509
Dec-2003
monolithic ceramics.
Determination of friction and wear characteristics of
ISO 20808
Feb-2004
monolithic ceramics by ball-on-disc method.
Test method for fracture toughness of monolithic ceramics
at room temperature by chevron-notched beam (CNB)
ISO 24370
2005
method.
Key:
(1)Alwaysconfirmwithstandardsorganisationstheversionofastandardiscurrent.
(2)ISOfineceramicsstandardsthatcoverfibrereinforcedcompositesarenotincluded.
318
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.32Technicalceramics:ISOstandardsdrafts
Number(2)
Date(1)
Title
DraftstandardsFineceramics(advancedceramics,advancedtechnicalceramics)(3)
Test method for air purification performance of
ISO/CD
semiconducting photocatalytic materials -- Part 1:
22197-1
Removal of nitric oxide.
Determination of particle size distribution of ceramic
ISO/CD 24235 powders by laser diffraction method.
ISO/DIS
Determination of thickness of ceramics films by contact18452
probe profilometer.
ISO/DIS
Test method for cyclic bending fatigue of monolithic
Nov-2004
22214
ceramics at room temperature.
ISO/DIS
Test method for tensile creep of monolithic ceramics.
Nov-2004
22215
ISO/DIS
Determination of content of coarse particles in ceramic
Feb-2004
24369
powders by wet sieving method.
Test method for fracture toughness of monolithic
ISO/DIS
Jan-2004
ceramics at room temperature by chevron notched beam
24370
(CNB) method.
ISO/FDIS
Determination of content of coarse particles in ceramic
24369
powders by wet sieving method.
ISO/PRF
Determination of corrosion resistance of monolithic
17092
ceramics in acid and alkaline solutions.
ISO/WD
Determination of tap density of ceramic powders.
23145
Test methods for determination of fracture toughness of
ISO/WD
monolithic ceramics- Single edge V-notch beam (SEVNB)
23146
method.
Key:
(1)Dateincludedforguidanceonly.Alwaysconfirmwithstandardsorganisationstheversionofa
standardiscurrent.
(2)ISOabbreviations:FDIS:Finaldraftinternationalstandard;DIS:Draftinternationalstandard;PRF:
Proofofinternationalstandard;CD:Committeedraft;WD:Workingdocument.
(3)ISOfineceramicsstandardsthatcoverfibrereinforcedcompositesarenotincluded.
43.4
Processing aspects
43.4.1
Manufacturing processes
Owingtothehighmeltingpoint,mosttechnicalceramicmaterialsareproducedbyconsolidatingthe
rawmaterialsintheformofpowders.
Afewofthematerialscanbeproducedbydepositionfromavapourphase.
Ceramicpowdersareavailableinarangeofpurities,particlesizesandsizedistributions,adaptedto
various processing techniques. Additives are used to aid blending (mixing) and as binders to aid
shaperetentioninthegreenformpriortomachiningandfiring.Somepowderstockisblendedwet,
thenspraydriedpriortoprocessingintoagreenshape.
319
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Various methods of producing shapes have evolved and there can be several variants of the same
basicprocess.Processselectiondependsonsizeandshapeofthecomponentandonproductionrates.
Somemoresophisticatedshapingprocessesincludethedensificationstep.
Figure43.04.1showsaschematicofthepowderprocessingsequence,Ref.[431].
Ceramic powder(s)
Additives
BLEND
SHAPE
(green)
MACHINE
(green)
BAKE
(binder removal)
DENSIFICATION
(firing)
MACHINE
(final)
Figure43.41Technicalceramics:Manufacturingprocesses
43.4.2
Some materials have known toxicological occupational health effects, e.g. beryllia and some man
made vitreous silicate fibres; nanosized materials are also under investigation. Material suppliers
provide material safety sheets that stipulate the necessary handling procedures and protection
measures.
Ceramicprocessinginvolvesworkingwithfinepowdersthatcaneasilybecomedispersed,carriedin
theairandingested.Ingeneral,precautionsarenecessarytocontrolthelevelsofairbornematerials
andalsodebrisresultingfrommachining.
Standardsorganisationsandoccupationalhealthauthoritiesprovideguidanceonthemonitoringand
exposurelevelsforpersonnelworkingwithceramics,Ref.[4341].
43.4.3
Green shapes
43.4.3.1
General
Greenshapesarepartsinanintermediatestatefollowinginitialconsolidationofblendedpowdersbut
priortohighpressureand/ortemperatureprocessesthatgivethedesiredmechanicalproperties.
320
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Processmethodscanbegroupedbywhethertheblendedpowdersareuseddryorwet.Wetshaping
processesuseavarietyofliquids,suchaswaterorsolvents.These,alongwithvariousadditives,aim
to producean even suspension of ceramic particleswithin a slurry or slip. The liquids areremoved
before firing. Depending on the process, this can involve: evaporation, absorption by the mould
substrate or a drying process applied to the green shape. Common processes for producing green
shapesaresummarisedinTable43.4.1,Ref.[431].
Dry
casting
Slip
SolGel
Extrusion
casting
Tape
moulding
(1)
Wet
Key:
Injection
compaction
Roll
Drypressing
Table43.41Technicalceramics:greenshapeprocesses
(1)Althoughfeedstockiswettoenableinjection,thegreenshapeisdryonejection.
43.4.3.2
Dry pressing
Green shapes are made from dry powders that are placed in a mould and pressed. Variants on the
basictechniqueare:
Uniaxial compaction is a technique that uses a rigid mould and a punch to apply the
compactionpressure.Productionratescanbehighforbothsimpleandcomplexshapes.Using
two punches operating in opposite directions on the same axis with a floating mould aids
compactionandgreencompactremoval.
Wetbag cold isostatic pressing, in which the powder is held in a rubber bag mould and
submerged in a liquid. Consolidation is achieved by pressure transmitted through the liquid.
Thisprocessisfairlyslowandusedforlargeitems.
Drybag cold isostatic pressing, similar to wetbag in that powder in a rubber mould is
pressurised via a liquid, but the rubber mould is integrated into the equipment. This enables
automationandsmallcomponentscanbeproducedathighproductionrates.
43.4.3.3
Roll compaction
Spraydried powders, containing about 5% to 10% of binders and plasticisers, are continuously fed
betweentworotatingrollers.Astherollscometogether,thehighpressurecompactsthepowder.The
tape produced possesses uniform high density and sufficient green strength and flexibility to be
spooled.
43.4.3.4
Injection moulding
A granulated mixture of ceramic and organic binders is charged into the machine and the air
removed. A heated charge is then injected into a cold die cavity, where it cools slightly prior to
ejection.
Usuallyformakingsmall,complexshapedgreencomponents,injectionmouldinghasalsobeenused
forprototypingcomplexengineparts,suchasrotorsandturbinesinturbochargers.
321
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.4.3.5
Tape casting
Tape casting is based on the patented Park process and is also known as doctor blade or knife
casting.
A slurry or slip is produced from a suspension of ceramic powder in a liquid along with additives
appropriatetothematerialsanddensificationprocess,e.g.binders,plasticisersanddeflocculants.The
slipisthenfedontoapolymersheetthatpassesunderablade.Theheightofthebladecontrolsthe
thickness of the ascast sheet or tape. After drying, to remove the solvent, the green tape is then
spooled.
Theprocessisusedformakingcontinuousthinsheetsortapesofceramic,oftenusedassubstratesfor
electronicdevices.
43.4.3.6
Extrusion
Aslurryisproducedfromceramicpowdermixedwithwater,anorganicsolventorsometimespitch.
A variety of additives are used to adjust the flow characteristics of the mix and to ensure sufficient
greenstrengthafterextrusion.
The slurry is then forced through the extrusion die to form continuous green compacts of constant
crosssection,e.g.tube,rod,channelandhoneycombsections.
43.4.3.7
Sol-Gel
The Sol is a liquid colloidal solution containing dissolved metallic salts or organic compounds. A
rigid Gel is formed from the solution and is then dried prior to densification (firing). The basic
technique has many variables, enabling a wide range of compositions and products, including:
shapes,films,fibresandverylowdensity,porous,aerogels
The process is used for exceptionally fine, pure ceramics, e.g. ultra fine grained alumina and some
specialitycompositionsforfunctionalelectronicdevices.
Owingtothereactivenatureoftheceramicproduced,thesinteringtemperaturesarelowerthanthose
necessaryforconventionallyproducedmaterials.
SolGels are also used in the manufacture of ceramic matrix composites, where the Sol is infiltrated
intoafibrepreformwhichactsasadepositionsubstrate,[Seealso:88.16].
43.4.3.8
Slip casting
Slip (or slurry) is a liquid suspension of ceramic particles, usually in water, containing various
additives to aid processing. This is poured into or over a porous mould (usually plaster), which
absorbs some of the water near the interface. Excess liquid slip is then removed leaving the green
shapeincontactwiththemould.Themouldedthicknesscanbecontrolledbyprocessparameterssuch
astheliquidcontentofthesliportimeincontactwiththemould.Thegreenshapeisremovedfrom
themouldanddriedpriortofiring.
Slip casting is a widelyused traditional processing technique within the ceramics industry. It can
producelarge,complexshapeditems.
322
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.4.4
Densification
43.4.4.1
General
Following a drying process, the majority of green shapes are densified by sintering (firing).
Dependingonthematerialcompositionandtemperature,thedensificationprocessisdifferent.
43.4.4.2
Liquid-phase sintering
At the sintering temperature a small quantity of liquid phase forms, less than needed to fill all the
voids. The remaining solid phase is soluble in the liquid and fills the voids by a combination of
diffusion,dissolutionandredeposition.
43.4.4.3
Viscous-flow sintering
Part of the material melts at the sintering temperature and flows by capillary action into the voids.
Aftercooling,thisphasecanbecrystallineorglassy.
43.4.4.4
Solid-state sintering
During sintering no liquid phase forms and consolidation is by solidstate diffusion only. Fine
powdersandhightemperaturesarenecessaryforthisprocess.
43.4.4.5
Reaction bonding
Mixtures of suitable ceramic powders are subjected to conditions that enable a chemical reaction
between the constituents, forming a densified product, e.g. high temperatures and reactive gaseous
atmospheres.Reactionscanoccurinthesolid,liquidorgaseousstates.
Siliconcarbideandaluminiumnitridecanbothbeproducedbythesemethods,e.g.C+SiSiC;2Al+
N22AlN.
43.4.5
43.4.5.1
Hot pressing
Powders are enclosed in a die, often made from graphite to enable induction heating. Heat and
pressurearethenapplied.Dependingonthematerialcompositionandtemperature,densificationcan
beliquidphaseorsolidstate.
Hotpressingislimitedtofairlysimpleshapes.Machiningofdensifiedshapesneedsveryhardtools.
43.4.5.2
TheceramicpowdersaresealedintoametalorglasscapsuleandthenloadedintotheHIPpressure
vessel. Highpressure gas, usually argon, compacts the powder at high temperature. The sintering
processcanbeliquidphaseorsolidstate.Theconsolidatedmaterialscanapproachfulltheoretical(i.e.
voidless)density.
HIP is also used as a final or remedial process to close voids and increase the density of materials
processedbyothertechniques.
Complex shapes can be consolidated effectively by HIP, but the capacity of the HIP pressure vessel
limitsthesizeofcomponents.Machiningofthedensifiedshapeneedsveryhardtools.
323
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.4.6
Vapour-phase techniques
43.4.6.1
General
There are several processes in which ceramic materials are deposited from a chemical atmosphere
ontoasubstrateathightemperatures.Thesizeandshapeofcomponentsproducedarelimitedbythe
processvesseldimensions.
Vapourphase processes are also used for the manufacture of ceramic matrix composites, where the
fibrepreformactsasthedepositionsubstrate,[Seealso:Chapter88].
43.4.6.2
Thedecompositionofagasmixturecontainedinapressurevesselathightemperaturedepositshigh
puritymaterialontoasubstratesurface.Materialpropertiestendtobeanisotropic.
CVDisnormallyusedtocreatethinwalledshapesorcoatings.Processtimesareusuallyquitelong,
but can be decreased by a modified technique using a plasma around the substrate; known as
PACVD, plasmaassisted CVD. CVI chemical vapour infiltration is a CVD technique in which the
materialisdepositedonandbetweenthefibresofapreformtocreateaceramicmatrixcomposite.
CVDisusedtoproducesyntheticdiamondmaterialsandshapesforavarietyofwearparts,thermal
managementandopticaluses,Ref.[438];[Seealso:43.17].
43.4.6.3
One or more materials transform from the solid state into a vapour phase under vacuum and then
condenses onto a substrate. PAPDV, plasmaassisted PVD, enables virtually any material to be
depositedasacoatingontoanonporoussubstrate.
43.4.7
Machining
Althoughcomprisingofcompactedabrasivepowders,thestrengthofgreenshapes(greenstrength)is
sufficient to enable them to be machined fairly easily without the need for expensive, hard cutting
tools. The majority of features tend to be moulded into the shape rather than machined. Where
necessary, machining is used in the green stage to reduce as far as possible the need to machine
componentsafterfiring.
Densified materials are much more difficult to machine due to their hard, brittle nature. Machining
operationsareusuallylimitedtofinishingsurfacesusingveryhardgrindingmedia.
43.4.8
Joining
43.4.8.1
General
Techniquesforjoiningceramicscanbeclassedasthoseusedtoassemblegreenshapes,priortofiring,
orthoseusedtoassemblefullydensifiedmaterials(postfiring).
Somerecentnoveltechniquesinvolvediffusionbonding,theuseofcompatibleinterlayersandlocal
infiltration to produce joints. Processes using microwave heating and ultrasonics are also under
developmentforceramics,Ref.[4348].
324
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.4.8.2
Largeitems,oftenofcomplexshape,canbeproducedasaseriesofsubcomponentswhicharethen
joinedpriortofiring.Dependingonthematerialandtheprocesstechniqueusedtocreatethegreen
part,aslipofthesame,oracompatiblematerial,canbeusedasadhesive.Afterbakingtoremove
moistureorsolvent,thepartisfiredandtheslipformsabond.
Some ceramicbased adhesives can be used instead of slip provided that their firing temperature is
compatiblewiththecomponentdensificationtemperature.
43.4.8.3
Fully-densified materials
The choice of assembly method largely depends on the application and service environment. The
main problems to consider are avoiding point or uneven loads and thermal mismatch between the
ceramicandadjacentparts;bothofwhichcancausefractureinceramics,Ref.[4348].
Ceramic parts can beretained withinmetal components byshrinkfitting. Thisrelies on the thermal
expansion differences between metals and ceramics to produce a compressiontype joint when the
mixedmaterial component has cooled. This process is widelyused for locally increasing the wear
resistance ofengineeringparts,suchas thread guides in process machineryand for the assembly of
sparkplugs.
Mechanical fastening can be used providing that point and uneven loads are avoided. Mechanical
seals are used to position and retain ceramic parts between other materials, e.g. Oring seals to
positionequipmentwindows.
Bondedjointsarelimitedbytheworkingtemperaturerangeoftheadhesive.Ceramicbasedadhesives
can be used for bonded assemblies in hightemperature applications. These adhesives usually need
firing,butthiscanbeatalowertemperaturethanthedensificationprocess.Conventionaladhesives
canalsobeusedprovidingthattheytoleratethethermalconditions,adheretothesurfacesandhave
sufficientmechanicalperformance.
Some ceramics are assembled by brazing, where the metalbased filler is used as the adhesive, e.g.
assemblyofceramictipsandinsertsontometaltoolsupports.Toensurethequalityofbrazedjoints,
the surfaces of ceramic parts are metallised with a thin metalrich coating in order to improve
adhesion with the braze filler. Thermal gradients created during brazing need to be minimised to
avoid possible failures. To limit thermal gradients, assemblies are often heated prior to brazing and
cooledslowlyandevenlyafterwards.
43.5
Applications
43.5.1
Industrial
Technical ceramics have proven success in many diverse applications covering a wide range of
industry sectors, e.g. from aggressive environments in the petrochemical process industries to
prostheticbiomedicalimplants.
325
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.5.2
Aerospace
43.5.2.1
General
Withintheaerospaceindustryasawholemonolithictechnicalceramicsarewidelyusedinequipment
andpayloads.Someapplicationsarebasedsolelyonelectricaloropticalperformance,e.g.electrical
electronic components and assemblies, sensors or optics; whereas others are, to some extent, load
bearing.Theseareoftenstaticloadsbutareincreasinglybeingusedindynamicsituations,e.g.pump
parts,suchasbearings,valvesorseals;withincombustionchambers;turbochargers;discsinbraking
systems.
Ceramicsarenowusedforthemirrorsandstructuresofscientificspaceinstrumentsthatneedhigh
stiffnessandstability.Ceramicsalsoofferinterestingpropertiesforcryogenicapplications.
43.5.2.2
Environment components
Technicalceramicsareselectedtoresisttheworkingenvironmentthroughouttheservicetemperature
range for the intended service life. Depending on the aerospace application, the environment for
technical ceramic engineering components can range from high to low temperatures, and include
contactwithgases,fluidsorsolids,e.g.nozzles,pumpparts,seals.
43.5.2.3
Environment structures
Forstructuralapplications,theenvironmentscomprise:
Earth, during manufacture and storage. Ceramics are rarely 100% densified, so retain some
level of residual porosity. If not properly controlled, moisture and contaminant uptake is
possible unless exposed surfaces are sealed. Sealing is an established process for technical
ceramics in direct exposure to chemical environments. A bakeout process is often used to
removecontaminantsbeforeoraftersealing.
Launch; where conditions are largey dictated by the launch vehicle, e.g. vibration levels. For
ceramictype materials, the effects of dynamic loads need evaluation as do any interfaces
betweentheceramicsandadjacentmaterials.
Spaceenvironment(missionrelated).
43.5.2.4
Environment space
Although levels are missiondependent, the general effects of the space environment on technical
ceramicsaresummarisedas,[Seealso:ECSSQ7071]:
Radiation:levelsinspacehavenoknowneffectsonthecharacteristicsofceramics.
Temperature:Hightemperatureperformanceisamainreasonforselectingceramics.However,
the upper working temperature varies for different groups of materials, especially when
combinedwithanaggressivechemicalenvironment,e.g.carbonbasedmaterialsinoxygenrich
environments.
Thermalcycling:cancausecrackinginceramicsduetoshapeeffectsandthermalgradients.
Atomicoxygen:hasnoknowneffectonceramics.
326
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.5.3
Materials
43.5.3.1
General
Whilst some materials are used for many different applications, others tend to be more limited to
exploitaparticularcharacteristic,e.g.IR,microwaveorradartransparency.
Excludingtheabrasiveandcuttingtoolssector,manufacturersandstandardsorganisationsalike,tend
togrouptechnicalceramicsbytheirusualtypeofapplications,Ref.[435],e.g.:
mechanicalcomponents,
thermomechanicalcomponents,
chemical components, include items used in industrial processing which are often in very
aggressive environments (acids, alkalis, chemical slurries, liquid metals, abrasive). Corrosion,
oftenathightemperatures,orwearresistancearethemainselectionfactors.
electricalinsulators,asdefinedinIEC672EN606721,Ref.[437].
electricalconductors,usedinfuelcells,batteries,heatingelements,gassensorsandelectrodes;
staticdischarge.
magneticmaterials.
Whilstalloftheseapplicationsexisttosomeextentwithintheaerospaceindustry,onlythosewhich
usually provide some degree of loadbearing capability combined with the specialist properties of
ceramicsarepresentedhere.Materialsconsideredfordimensionallystableandopticalstructuresare
alsoincluded.
43.5.3.2
Mechanical components
Some technical ceramics commonly used for discrete, often simplyshaped, mechanical components
are summarised in Table 43.5.1. These items usually provide a level of loadbearing combined with
wearorcorrosionresistance.
327
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Bearings*
Injectorpins(fuel)
Pumps*
(1)
Seals*(shaft)
(1)
Seals*(mechanical)
(1)
Valves(ball)
Valves(pneumatic)
Valves(trains)
Key:
Glassceramics
Zirconia
(1)
Bearings(ballroller)
Bearings(sleeve)
Siliconnitride
Siliconcarbide
Silicas
Diamond(CVD)
Carbons
Boronnitride
Boroncarbide
Aluminas
Aluminiumnitride
Table43.51Technicalceramics:Materialsmechanicalcomponents
*wearresistance;primarymaterial;secondarymaterial;(1)carbongraphites
43.5.3.3
Thermomechanical components
Technical ceramics for hightemperature technologies are summarised in Table 43.5.2. These can be
relativelylarge,complexshapeditemsoperatingathightemperaturesinhostileenvironmentsunder
dynamic or static load conditions. Carboncarbon and ceramic matrix composites have also been
evaluatedforsomeoftheseapplications,[See:SectionXII].
328
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.52Technicalceramics:Materialsthermomechanicalcomponents
Combustionchambers
(diesel)
(1)
Jetengine(combustors)
Jetengine(petals)
Rocketnozzles
(1)
Turbocharger(housings)
Turbocharger(rotors)
Valves(reciprocating
engines)
Key:
TPS(active)
TPS(passive)
CMC(3)
CarbonCarbon(2)
Glassceramics
Zirconia
Siliconnitride
Brakediscs
Gasturbines
Siliconcarbide
Silicas
Diamond(CVD)
Carbons
Boronnitride
Boroncarbide
Aluminiumnitride
Aluminas
TPSthermalprotectionsystem;primarymaterial;secondarymaterial;
(1)carbongraphites;(2)[See:Chapter54];(3)[See:Chapter52]
43.5.3.4
Electrical
Theprimarycriterioninselectingtechnicalceramicsforelectricalandelectronicusesistheinsulating
or electrical conductivity behaviour. Service temperature can affect this, e.g. zirconia becomes
conductiveathightemperatures.
Table43.5.3summarisessomeofthosetechnicalceramicswhichareusedasinsulatorsorconductors.
Onlyafewexamplesareprovidedforelectricalandelectronicapplicationsfromthosethatconstitute
alargeproportionofthetechnicalceramicmarket.
329
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.53Technicalceramics:Materialselectrical
INSULATORS(1)
Electronicdevices
(3)
Glassceramics
(2)
Electrodes
Heatingelements
Key:
Zirconia
CONDUCTORS
Fuelcells
Machinable
Batteries
(2)
(3)
Highstrength
Radomes
Siliconnitride
Siliconcarbide
Silicas
Diamond(CVD)
Carbons
Boronnitride
Boroncarbide
Aluminiumnitride
Aluminas
(1)Foracomprehensivelistofinsulators,See:IEC672EN606721:Definitionsandclassifications;
(2)Zirconiaisconductiveathightemperatures;
(3)highthermalconductivity;
primarymaterial;secondarymaterial
43.5.3.5
Technicalceramicsforopticalapplicationscanbegroupedas:
optical devices and components, which are transparent to particular wave lengths, e.g.
windows,lasercomponents.
mirrors and support structures for optical systems; providing highly stabilty and minimising
thermal expansion problems which can affect system performance, e.g. telescopes, mirrors,
antennas.
Excluding glasses, Table 43.5.4 gives examples of technical ceramics that are considered for some
opticalapplications,[Seealso:Casestudies43.18;43.19].
330
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.54Technicalceramics:Materialsopticalanddimensionallystable
structures
Lasercomponents
(1)
(2)
Mirrors(Xray)
Optical(support
structures)
Telescopes
(1)
Glassceramics
Zirconia
Mirrors
Windows(visible
andinfrared)
Siliconnitride
Siliconcarbide
Silicas
Diamond(CVD)
Carbons
Boronnitride
Boroncarbide
Aluminiumnitride
Aluminas
Key:primarymaterial;secondarymaterial;(1)rubyorsapphire;(2)mirrorsfortelescopes
43.6
43.6.1
Typical characteristics
43.6.1.1
Standard grades
Commerciallyavailablealuminamaterialsaregenerallygroupedby:
Form,e.g.powders,granulesorpellets,shapesorcomponents.
PurityandcompositionusuallystatedasthepercentageoftheAl2O3content.Somegradesalso
giveacompositionifanadditionofanothermaterialisincluded,e.g.alumina+zirconia.Trace
elements,orimpurities,arerarelystated.
Crystalsize,inthemicronrange.
The majority of engineering grades are opaque white, although pinks and browns also exist. Some
gradesaretranslucent,[See:Specialgrades].
Thepurityandcrystalsizeaffectthepropertiesofthedensifiedmaterials.
331
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Basicfeaturesofaluminamaterialsinclude:
Mechanical: high stiffness, hard and brittle; toughness and strength improved by Zirconia
additions(ZTAgrades).
Thermomechanical:propertiesaregenerallyretainedtoabout800C,butreducesignificantly
above1000C;mediumshockandthermalcyclingresistance.
Electrical:nonconductive;excellentelectricalinsulation.
Environment:chemicalresistancetobothacidandalkalis(exceptHF).
43.6.1.2
ZTAishigherinstrengthandtoughnessthanconventionalaluminagrades.Thisresultfromastress
inducedtransformationtougheningeffectachievedbyincorporatingabout10%to20%finezirconia
particlesuniformlythroughoutthealumina.
Typicalcharacteristicsinclude:
Strength,
Toughness,
Wearresistance,
Hightemperaturestability,
Corrosionresistance.
ZTAgradesareusedinmechanicalapplications,suchaswearparts,valveseats,pumpcomponents,
bearings,bushes.
43.6.1.3
Special grades
Translucentaluminaisusedforhighertemperature,opticaluses,suchaslighting.
Syntheticsapphireisasinglecrystalformofalumina,whichisusedinopticalapplications,e.g.laser
systemsandwindowsforimagingsystems[Seealso:43.16].
43.6.2
Typical properties
43.6.2.1
General
The properties stated by manufacturers of alumina materials depend on the form in which the
materials are supplied and also their main applications. It is unusual to have a complete set of
mechanical,thermomechanical,physicalandelectricalpropertiesforanyparticulargradeofmaterial.
43.6.2.2
Powders
Powderpropertiesoftenstateanaveragepowdersize,althoughsomegiveparticlesizedistributions.
Density values can be for loose powder, tamped or green state (compacted but not fired). Some
suppliersgiveanindicativebulkdensityforadensified(fired)material.
332
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.6.2.3
Density values are given along with a typical porosity level, which can be stated as % apparent or
open(interconnectingpores)or%closedandinterconnectingpores.
For some applications, porous alumina grades are needed, e.g. thermal insulation and catalytic
supports.
Commonlystatedmechanicalpropertiesaresomecombinationof:
Hardness(onvariousscales),
Compressiveproperties(strengthandmodulus),
Flexuralstrength,
Fracturetoughness.
Tensilepropertiesarelesscommonbecausesuppliersassumethatapplicationsavoidusingceramics
undertensileorbendingloads.
Thermalcharacteristicsoftenstatedareacoefficientofthermalexpansion,thermalconductivityanda
maximumusetemperature,usuallyinair.Somealsoprovideathermalshockvalue.
Electrical characteristics stated can include dielectric properties and volume resistivity at various
temperatures.
Table43.6.1summarisesthepropertiesofsomeexamplesofdensifiedcommercialaluminamaterials,
[4312].
The grades presented, taken from a much wider range of alumina products, are all used in load
bearing,mechanicalapplicationsratherthanforelectricalorthermalcharacteristicsalone.
The large number of grades available has evolved over the years to meet particular applications in
various industry sectors. In general, this is to achieve a balance between the wear, chemical,
mechanicalandothercharacteristics.Gradeshavealsobeendevelopedforspecialistapplications,e.g.
ballisticprotection.
Althoughthematerialscitedallcomefromonesource,italsoillustratestherangeofmaterialsthatare
availablefromothermajortechnicalceramicssuppliers.
333
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.61Technicalceramics:aluminatypicalproperties
HILOX 961
MAC-A960S
HILOX 882
MAC-A840S
SINTOX FL
MAC-A950R-6
SINTOX FF
MAC-A950R-5
SINTOX FC
MAC-A950R-4
SINTOX AL
MAC-A997R
DERANOX 975
MAC-A975R
95
96
95
99.7
97.5
2.8
3900
3790
3880
3530
3720
3700
3720
3200
3800
0
86
0
83
0
84
0
76.4
0
14.6
-
0 (4)
12.5
78
0
14.6
20(3)
-
0
15
85
2100
1800
2500
2000
2500
2500
370
283
376
271
325
320
325
150
350
336
354
250
330
325
330
340
5.9
4.5 (2)
5.9
3.6
21
15
20
21
20
24
8.2
8.2
8.2
7.5
7.5
7.5
9.0
8.1
Laser reflectors
Applications(examples)
99
HILOX 965
MAC-A955S
84
HILOX 991
MAC-A990S
Property
Key:
96
95 96
-
Examplesofcommerciallyavailablealuminagrades
SINTOX,HYLOXandDERANOXaretrademarksofMorganAdvancedCeramics.(1)
3pointbend(ASTMC1161),20C;(2)K1C(SENB);(3)Porousgradeforlaser
reflectors;pumpingchambers;(4)Nonoutgassingforaerospaceapplications;
(5)Fullydense.
334
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.6.2.4
Table43.62Technicalceramics:ZTAzirconiatoughenedaluminatypical
properties
Property
Composition
Zirconia content (%, typical)
Grain size (m)
Bulk density (fired) (kg/m3)
Porosity apparent (%)
Hardness, Knoop (GPa, 1000g)
Rockwell (R45N)
Compressive strength (MPa)
Flexural strength (1) (MPa)
Flexural strength (2) (MOR, MPa)
Youngs modulus (GPa)
Fracture toughness (MPa m1/2)
Thermal conductivity
(WmK, 20C)
Coefficient of thermal expansion, 20C
to 1000C (10-6 /C)
Key:
Comparisonofcommerciallyavailablegradesof
aluminawithZTA
ZTA
HILOX 965
Zirconia-toughened
Alumina
alumina
0
not stated
2
3790
4050
0
14.4
83
85
2900
450
283
336
360
5 to 6
-
27
8.2
8.3
ZTACoorsTekproduct;HILOXisatradenameofMorganAdvancedCeramics;(1)3
pointbend(ASTMC1161),20C;(2)ASTMF417
43.7
Aluminium nitride
43.7.1
Typical characteristics
Generalfeaturesofaluminiumnitrideceramicsinclude:
highthermalconductivity
goodelectricalinsulation.
Thethermalandelectricalpropertiesdependonpurity.Powderformsarepronetomoistureuptake
that can affect electrical properties. Some typical applications include uses in the semiconductor
processingindustry,heatmanagementinelectronicsandwindowsforvisibletoinfraredsystems.
335
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.7.2
Typical properties
43.7.2.1
General
Table 43.7.1 summarises properties for some examples of commerciallyavailable aluminium nitride
materials,Ref.[4314],[4315].
43.7.2.2
ShapalisproducedbyTokuyama,JapanbutisavailableinEuropefromdistributors.TheShapal
grades are highpurity, machinable aluminium nitrides, which offer strength and thermal
conductivity.ShapalMisamachinablegradeandShapalSH15istranslucenttovisibleandIR
light.
Thethermalconductivityisnotashighasstandardaluminiumnitride,butisabout50timesgreater
thanthatofmachinableglassceramics,[Seealso:43.15]
TheabilitytomachineShapalwithconventionalcarbidetoolsmeansthatmorecomplexshapescan
bemadecomparedwithstandardaluminiumnitrideceramics.
Applications are similar to standard grades, e.g. substrates for semiconductors; heat sinks and
insulating parts for highpower electronics; window materials for infrared and radar applications;
refractories(moltenmetals).
336
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.71Technicalceramics:Aluminiumnitridetypicalproperties
Key:
3300
3260
1110
1000
1100
200
320
200
320
3.0
330
320
340
0
10.
8
290
320
340
0
10.
4
310
320
340
0
10.
4
310
320
220
310
3.0
2.5
170
170
80
150
160
150
67
6.2
5.6
4.9
AN 2000
AN 216A
3300
AN 217
99.8
4
AN 215
CERALLOY
13701E
99.0
10
99.9 (2)
3200
-
5.4
5.4(
5.3(
(1)
1)
1)
5.2(1)
11.2
Applications(examples)
CERALLOY
1370CS
Rockwell (R45N)
Compressive strength (MPa)
Flexural strength (MPa)
Youngs modulus (GPa)
Fracture toughness (MPa
m1/2)
Thermal conductivity
(WmK, 20C)
Coefficient of thermal
expansion, 20C to 1000C
(10-6/C)
98.0
10
Property
CERALLOY
1370DP
Examplesofcommerciallyavailable
aluminiumnitridegrades
CERALLOYisatradenameofCeradyneInc.,ANgradesarefromKyoceraCorp.;(1)
CTE40Cto800C;(2)Highpuritygrade.
337
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.8
Boron carbide
43.8.1
Typical characteristics
Boroncarbidehasalowdensity(2500kg/m3)andahardnessapproachingthatofdiamond.
Generalfeaturesofdensifiedboroncarbideinclude:
Lowdensity.
Highmodulus.
Extremelyhard.
Susceptibletothermalshock.
Excludingabrasives,typicalapplicationsareforwearresistance,e.g.nozzles(processingequipment),
dies, precision engineering parts. It also has some specialist applications such as impact resistance
(ballisticarmour)andinnuclearshielding(neutronabsorption).
Boroncarbidecanbeprocessedinapowderformorproducedbyvapourphasetechniques.
43.8.2
Typical properties
Table 43.8.1 summarises the properties of some examples of commerciallyavailable boron carbide
materials,Ref.[4314].
338
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.81Technicalceramics:boroncarbidetypicalproperties
Key:
CERALLOY
546-3E (1)
CERALLOY
546-4E
98.5
15
99.5
15
2500
2500
2500
3200
410
460
2800
410
460
3200
410
460
2.5
2.5
2.5
90
90
90
5.6
5.6
5.6
Hot pressed; ballistic armour;
semiconductor processing; wear
parts.
Applications(examples)
98.5
15
CERALLOY
546
Property
Examplesofcommerciallyavailableboron
carbidegrades
CERALLOYisatradenameofCeradyneInc.;(1)Highpurity,singlephase,lowporosity
grade.
339
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.9
Boron nitride
43.9.1
Typical characteristics
43.9.1.1
General
Boronnitrideiscommerciallyavailableas:
ThecharacteristicsofHBNandCBN,dictatedbytheircrystalstructures,aretotallydifferent.
43.9.1.2
HBN has a graphitelike crystal structure. The lattice layers and platelike structure provide good
lubricatingproperties.HBNisusuallyformedbyhotpressingbecauseofitsresistancetosintering.
FeaturesofHBNinclude:
Hotpressedblankscanbemachined,usingconventionaltechniques,tomakecomplexshaped
parts,
Anisotropicproperties,whenproducedbyhotpressing,
Goodelectricalproperties(dielectricstrength;resistivity).
Highchemicalresistance(resistanttomostmoltenmetals,glasses,salts),
Excellentlubricatingproperties,
Excludinglubricants,HBNisusedforshapedpartsinmaterialsprocessingindustries,includingHIP
produced ceramics, due to its nonwetting capability; hightemperature electrical insulators (about
850Cinairduetoitstendencytooxidise;about1350Cininertorreducingatmospheres).
43.9.1.3
ThestructureofCBNisthesameasdiamondanditscharacteristicsareverysimilar.Generalfeatures
ofCBNinclude:
Hardnessapproachingthatofdiamond,
Excellentwearresistance,
Highthermalconductivity,
Goodchemicalinertness.
Excludingabrasives,CBNisusedforcuttingtools,wearresistantparts,coatingsandsubstratesfor
highpowerelectronicdevices.
340
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.9.1.4
PBNisahighpurity,pyrolyticmaterialformedbyavapourdepositionprocess.Thestructureofthe
depositedPBNishexagonal,asshowninFigure43.9.1,Ref.[4317].
Figure43.91Technicalceramics:pyroliticboronnitridestructure
AswithHBN,PBNishighlyanisotropicinitselectricalandmechanicalproperties,butveryresistant
tothermalshock.Itisalsoaverygoodelectricalinsulatorandhasveryhighthermalconductivity.The
material is stable in inert and reducing atmospheres up to 2800C, but only to 850C in oxidising
atmospheres.
Itsgeneralfeaturesinclude,Ref.[4312]:
Lowdensity,
Highthermalconductivity,
Lowthermalexpansion,
Goodthermalshockresistance,
Highelectricalresistance,
Lowdielectricconstantandlosstangent,
Goodchemicalresistance.
PBN is used for thinwalled electrical insulators, heating element parts and components for the
semiconductorprocessingindustry.
43.9.2
Typical properties
Table 43.9.1 summarises properties for some examples of commerciallyavailable boron nitride
materials,Ref.[4312],[4316],[4317].
341
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.9.3
43.9.3.1
Several of the St. Gobain (formerly Carborundum Corp.) Combat boron nitride grades have been
usedininsertsinHalleffectthrusters,Ref.[4316].
Hall effect thrusters were invented in the USA and developed into the SPT stationary plasma
thrusterintheexUSSR.Thethrustersaresmallrocketenginesthatuseapowerfulmagneticfieldto
acceleratealowdensityplasmaandsoproducethrust.
CombatgradesMandM26,alongwithHPandAX05,havebeenfabricatedintoawidevarietyof
thrusterinserts.Eachgradehasdemonstratedsputtererosionresistance,secondaryionemission,gas
absorptionandoutgassingthatarewellwithinthenecessarylimits,Ref.[4316].
342
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.91Technicalceramics:boronnitridetypicalproperties
COMBAT
AX05 Grade
COMBAT
ZSBN Grade
COMBAT
M Grade
(40%BN + 60%
Silica)
HBR Grade
(calcium borate)
40
-
94
-
1920
1900
1910
2000
2.9
19.9
-
15.3
16.4
-
14.2
4.2
-
100
1.4
-
11
-
218
5
-
143.3
30.1
17.9
31.7
68.9
255
23.4
17.9
21.4
36.8
106.9
144.1
44.5
43.7
60.2
62.0
51.7
41.3
331
186.6
75.8
113.0
70.8
62.0
70.5
48.2
23.
4
-
19.4
33.7
27.0
29.0
78.0
130.0
22.6
40.2
55
33
11.85
2.95
1.0
3.2
0.87
0.3
Applications(examples)
Key:
PBN
COMBAT
HP Grade
-
COMBAT
A Grade
-
Property
Direction (2)
Examplesofcommerciallyavailableboronnitridegrades
193
COMBATisatradenameofSaintGobain,HBRisatradenameofGEAdvancedCeramics;
(1)averagevalues;(2)Pressingorcrystaldirection;(3)OtherGEAdvancedCeramicgrades
available,includingcompositemixtureBN+AlNgrade;PBNdatafromMorgan
PerformanceMaterials.
343
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.9.3.2
Boron nitride grades from Sintec Keramic (D), have been used in the propulsion system on the
SMART1spaceprobe,Ref.[4345]:
BNcomposite,usedintheplasmachamber.
PBNparts,usedintheelectricalfeedofthePPSthruster.
LaunchedSeptember2003,SMART1wasthefirstESAspaceprobetogototheMoon.Itsaimswere
totesttheadvancedtechnologyneededforfuturescientificplanetarymissions.Thisinvolvedtesting
miniaturisationtechnologywhilstexploringtheMoonfromorbit,Ref.[4346].
43.10
Carbon
Carbon-Graphites
Diamond
Pyrolytic carbon
Siliconised carbon
Fibres for reinforcing composites, which have a wide range of properties and characteristics, [See also:
Chapter 2; 42.6].
Foams
Nano materials, e.g. carbon black (particles); CNT nanotubes; CNF nanofibres, [See also: Chapter
102].
CarbonmaterialsareerroneouslydescribedasgraphiteintheUSA.Inthecontextofthishandbook,
thetermgraphiteisusedonlyforthesoft,hexagonallycrystallised,allotropeofcarbon.
43.10.1.2 Graphite
Graphite is a relatively soft and weak material because of its platelike crystalline structure. It
possesses good selflubricating capabilities, making it useful at temperatures where other lubricants
arenotreliable,e.g.atloworhightemperatures.Inthevacuumofspace,graphitelosesitslubricating
properties and is abrasive. It can however be combined with other lubricants known to perform
correctlyinthespaceenvironment,[See:ECSSQ7071].
Thepropertiesofgraphiteareanisotropiciftheflakestructureisfullyaligned.Notallcommercially
availablegradesofgraphitearealigned,sotheirpropertiesaremoreisotropic.
344
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Graphite is used in a structural, or semistructural, role in many industry sectors for handling and
processing corrosive chemicals, often at high temperatures, e.g. heat exchangers, large tubes and
vessels,Ref.[4321],[4322].
Apartfromdensifiedformsofgraphite,poroustypesarealsoavailable,e.g.:
Exfoliatedgraphite(alsocalledgraphitefoilintheUSA)isabinderless,flexiblesheetmaterial
produced by expanding an interlocked graphite flake structure by over 100 times in the
thickness direction. The exfoliation process effectively forms an interlocked, porous material
with a layered structure that renders it flexible. The composition is pure graphite with a low
levelofresiduefrommaterialsusedintheexfoliationprocess.Propertiesareanisotropicdueto
thealignmentoflayersparalleltothesurface.Boththeelectricalandthermalconductivityare
highinplanebutlowerfortheoutofplanedirection.Exfoliatedflexiblegraphiteisusedfor
hightemperature gaskets and seals (asbestos replacement) and thermal interfaces. It is also
under evaluation for applications such as electronics (EMI shielding), vibration damping and
applicationsintheelectrochemicalindustries,Ref.[4342]
Carbon foams, which are rigid porous graphitic materials, are under consideration for
spacecraft thermal management systems, Ref. [4323], [4324], [4325]. The properties of the
foams, e.g. density, strength and thermal or electrical characteristics, can be adapted during
manufacturetosuitvariousapplications.
Carbonbased refractories, as a solid matrix phase used to bind graphite flakes or other
constituents,e.g.siliconcarbide.
CarbonGraphites,alsoknownasmechanicalcarbons.
43.10.1.4 Carbon-Graphites
Also known as mechanical carbons, carbongraphites are a combination of amorphous carbon and
graphite. There are a range of materials available, varying in composition of these two phases. The
aim is to produce a material which is strong and hard, but with a low coefficient of friction. Some
grades provide excellent corrosion resistance, whereas others can operate for extended periods at
temperatures above 315C. The maximum use temperature is usually determined by the oxidation
rate in an oxidising environment, e.g. air. In nonoxidising atmospheres (inert or reducing) and
vacuum,themaximumusetemperatureisabout3000C.
Carbongraphites are, in general, chemicallyinert, temperature resistant, lightweight, resilient,
dimensionally stable and impermeable to gases and liquids, Ref. [4319]. Depending on the
processing, some carbongraphite grades can exhibit anisotropic properties, though less so than
pyrolyticcarbons.Inthesegrades,theflakesinthegraphiticphasearealignedtoenablethematerial
characteristicstobedirectionallyoptimised,e.g.conductivitiesandoxidationresistance.
Components can be moulded to shape or machined to size with close tolerances. Items can also be
impregnatedwithavarietyofsubstances,fromresinstometalcompoundstoenhanceperformanceor
permeability. They can be plated, vulcanised to rubber, cemented or shrunkfit into housings or
retainers,Ref.[4319].
Mechanical carbon materials are typically used in a variety of bearings, seals and pumps. Some
examplesofaerospaceapplicationsinclude:SpaceShuttle;MarsLander;aircraftturbineenginemain
345
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
shaftseals(highspeed,hightemperature,cyclicconditions);shaftsealstopreventhotgasesaffecting
bearings.
43.10.1.6 Diamond
Diamond is a wellknown hard, wearresistant material. Natural diamonds are limited by the small
availablesizestoapplicationssuchasprecisionbearingsinsmallequipmentorabrasivesandcutting
tools. Developments in synthetic processing techniques now enable large, simple shapes to be
manufactured rather than just thin films or coatings deposited on substrates. Consequently more
potentialapplicationsnowexist,e.g.opticalandthermalmanagementcomponents,[See:43.17].
Particles in a variety of shapes and sizes, e.g. carbon black which is an established industrial product
commerciallyavailableinmanydifferentgrades,Ref.[4356].
Structures, e.g. CNT carbon nanotubes; CNF carbon nanofibres of various forms and aspect ratios,
e.g.severaltensofnanometresindiameter,severaltensofmicrometerslong.Theirappearance
can be described as platelets, herringbone, screwtype. Papers and foams can be made from
mixtures ofCNT and CNF, Ref.[4353]. All thesematerials are recent innovationsandstillin
theearlystagesofdevelopmentandevaluation,Ref.[4354].
Carbon black is produced by subjecting hydrocarbons, such as heavy residual fueloil feedstock, to
extremely high temperatures in a carefully controlled combustion process. Fine adjustment of the
production process parameters results in a different size and structure of the carbon black and
provides the range of commercial grades. The primary carbon particles are of the order of 12nm to
75nminsize,althoughtheseareprocessedtoformaggregatesthefinestofwhichtendtobemicron
size, e.g. 0.1m to 0.6 m, Ref. [4356]. Carbon black is an established and widelyused industrial
product.Sometypicalapplicationexamplesinclude:
Reinforcing agent in elastomers, e.g. vulcanised rubber products, such as rubber tyres for
vehicles;drivebelts;hoses;gasketsandseals,[Seealso:75.3].
Polymers, e.g. conductive packaging, films, fibres, mouldings, pipes, semiconductive cable
compounds,conductiveresinsandsimilarcompounds.
Coatings,e.g.pigments,provideconductivity,UVprotection.
Tonersandprintinginks.
346
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Carbon nano materials are essentially extremely fine filler substances that, when added in small
quantities, are seen as a means of enhancing the characteristics of engineering materials by some
amount,e.g.electricalandthermalconductivityofpolymers,ceramics,glasses,Ref.[4353].
Incomposites,incorporatingnanomaterialsofvariouscompositionsaimstoimprovetheperformance
ofthematrixphase,e.g.mechanicalandthermophysicalpropertiesofpolymerresins,Ref.[4355].
[Seealso:Chapter102]
Table43.101Technicalceramics:carbontypestypicalproperties
Property
(2)
Carbon
100%
Carbon
graphite
(70%:30%)
Carbon
graphite
(30%:70%)
Graphite
100%
1700
100
300
62
21
1720
85
208
62
17
1750
65
145
52
14
1800
40
55
28
10
12
85
315
315
315
455
(1)Thetemperaturelimitisdeterminedbytheoxidationrateinair;(2)Dependingontheprocessing,
propertiesofcarbongraphitescanbeanisotropicduetothealignmentofthegraphitephase.Non
alignedphasesgivemoreisotropiccharacteristics.
Excluding reinforcement fibres and carboncarbon composites, of the various types of carbons
available,thoseconsideredforaerospaceapplicationsare:
43.10.2.2 Carbon-Graphites
Thepropertiesofsomecommerciallyavailablegradesofcarbongraphitematerialsaresummarisedin
Table43.10.2,Ref.[4319],[4320].
347
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.102Technicalceramics:carbongraphitegradestypicalproperties
Key
EK 2000
EK 2209
EK 3205
EK 24
Resi
n
-
None
Antimony
None
1820
1770
2250
1700
(2)
2.5 (2)
8.0 (2)
110
110
115
105
137.
9
138
200
200
260
180
55.1
55.2
48
20.7
13.8
12.4
75
27.0
65
26.0
95
30.0
60
18.0
71
14
14
20
14
5.0
3.8
4.0
4.1
MAM&T
P-03
MAM&T
P-7454
Applications(examples)
76
1850
1770
1800
10
90
65
75
90
275.8
179.
3
86.2
2000
2.5 (2)
Hardness (Shore
Scleroscope)
Hardness (Rockwell B,
HR5/100)
Compressive strength
(MPa)
Transverse strength
(MPa)
Flexural strength (MPa)
Youngs modulus (GPa)
Fracture toughness (MPa
m1/2)
Thermal conductivity
(WmK, 20C)
Coefficient of thermal
expansion, 20C to 200C
(10-6 /C)
MAM&T
CJPS
MAM&T
P-5N
Property
Seal components in
cryogenic pumps in Space
Shuttle main engines
Examplesofcommerciallyavailablecarbongraphitegrades
2.5
MAM&TgradesfromMorganAdvancedMaterials&Technologyandusedinspaceapplications
(stated);SelectedcarbongraphiteEKgradesfromSGLCarbon,forhighloadapplications;(1)
Impregnated;(2)Openporosity,%;(3)Severaldifferentdryrunninggradesavailable.
CarbonGraphite materials are used mainly in sealing and bearing applications, where material
selectioninvolvesconsiderationofloads,speeds,temperatures,matingmaterials,costconstraintsand
projectedvolumes.
Manycarbonbasedmaterialtypesareavailable,withvariousmodificationsforparticulardesignsand
environments, e.g. for high temperatures or corrosive materials.Depending on the particular grade,
carbongraphites can be manufacturedin a variety of shapesandsizes, e.g. cylinders up to530 mm
diameter200mmhigh;platesupto600mm325mm130mmthick,typically.
348
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Some grades have safety approvals for use within specific environments, e.g. oxidising conditions,
foodcontact,potablewater.
43.10.2.3 Foams
Porousformsofcarbonincludeflexible,exfoliatedgraphite,[See:Graphite]andrigidfoams.
ConductedaspartofanongoingAFRLprogramintheUSA,thepotentialusesofcarbonfoamsin
spacecraftthermalmanagementsystemsisunderevaluationbyNorthropGrummanSpace,Ref.[43
23].
Spacecraft thermal management systems comprising of lightweight, thermallyconductive materials
are considered necessary to accommodate high heat dissipation in military and communications
payloads.Theseapplicationsareincreasinglyusingdenselypackedelectronicsforextendedmission
lives,Ref.[4323].
Optimised designs for spacecraft radiators using carbon foams can potentially simplify radiator
structures. Reducing the need for doublers and heat pipes to dissipate the heat generated by the
electronicswhilstmeeting,orlowering,themassbudgetforthethermalmanagementsystem.
PropertiesofthecarbonfoamsunderconsiderationbyNorthroparegiveninTable43.10.3,Ref.[43
23],[4324].AllthecarbonfoamscitedareofUSorigin.
Thepropertiesofcarbonfoamsareanisotropic.
349
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.103Technicalceramics:carbonfoamstypicalproperties
Examplesofdevelopmentcarbonfoams
TRLMER
Touchstone Research Corporati
Laboratory
on
CFOAM
25
(3)
Grade (4)
not stated
900
61
95
350
>15
5.5
2.1
5.9
0.84
0.07 to
0.7
0.1 to
100
1.5 to 2
-
0.84
1.4
2.3 to 10.2
25
0.18 to
5.0
5 to 210
150
100 to 125
5.8
-
1.5 to 2
-
245
70
1.02
3.26
1.07
1.31
1.5 to 2
-
400
160 to
800
-
Pitch
precurs
or
Pitch
precursor
Uniform microstructure;
high stiffness
Panel sizes (approx.):
400 mm 350 mm 12 mm thick.
500
Comments
POCO
HTC
160 to
620
-
Coal-based product
Thermal conductivity
(WmK)
in-plane
out-of-plane
CTE, (ppm/K)
in-plane (50C to 150C)
(600C to 800C)
out-of-plane (50C to
150C)
(600C to 800C)
Grade (4)
not
stated
Ultramet
CVD pyrolytic
graphite on
reticulated
vitreous carbon
230 to 610
Composition
Grade (4)
not
stated
Property
(5)
Grade (4)
not
stated
Key AllsourcescitedareofUSorigin;POCOFOAMandPOCOHTMaretrademarksofPocoGraphiteInc.(USA);
CFOAMisatrademarkofTRLTouchstoneResearchLaboratory(USA).(1)Licensedmanufacturerof
thermallyconductivegraphitefoamdevelopedbyOakRidgeNationalLabs.(USA);(2)POCOFOAMgrade:
Outgassing(ASTME595):TMLtotalmassloss=0.031%;VCMvolatilecondensiblematter=0.017%;(3)
CFOAMfireresistancepassISO,MILandASTMstandards;(4)Rangeofpropertiesforfoammaterials
fromsource;Ref.[4323];(5)Propertiesareanisotropic
350
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.11
Fusedsilica,whichisusedforitsthermalshockresistance.
Fusedquartz(vitreoussilica),whichisusedforopticalapplications.
Both types of materials possess low thermal conductivity and high electrical resistivity and are
virtually inert to the majority of aggressive chemicals over a wide range of temperatures. The main
exceptionsare:
HF(hydrofluoricacid),whichreactsatalltemperatures.
Phosphoricacidabove200C.
Causticoxidesreactslowlyatambienttemperaturesbutincreaseswithtemperature.
Someliquidmetals.
Somemetaloxidesabove800C.
Silicabasedmaterialsareavailableas:
castablesandslips,
various standard shapes and forms (tubes, plates, discs), e.g. plate sizes up to 1.2m 0.6m
10mmthick;tubes0.8m1.5mlong.
components.
fibrousforms(insulationproducts),[Seealso:Chapter99].
powders or microspheres, which are used as fillers and additives for other materials, e.g.
pottingcompounds.
nano materials, which areunder evaluation for many variedapplications, e.g.fine particulate
additivesinthepolymermatrixphaseofcomposites,Ref.[4355].
Usesofsilicabasedmaterialsarewideranging,fromcomponentsinmaterialsprocessingindustries
andopticalapplicationstoradomesandnosecones,e.g.Patriotmissilesystem.
For missile nose cones, the design drivers are transparency to various microwave energies, coupled
withmechanicalstrengthtoenablethemissilesystemtowithstanderosionandthelargetemperature
excursionswhileflyingathypervelocitiesthroughtheatmosphere,Ref.[4314].
TheSpaceShuttleOrbiterusessilicaforexternalwindowsandwithintheTPS,[Seealso:71.5].
351
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.111Technicalceramics:silicatypicalproperties
Key:
99.9999
99.8(1)
2210 (2)
2150
THERMO-SIL
ISOMOLDED (3)
(3)
2005
1970
2020
9
-
10
-
7.5
-
2000
50
207
75.9
18.6
56.2
11.4
37.2
38.2
34.5
2150
74
0.84
0.75
0.62
0.54
0.54
0.6
0.5
0.8
Applications
(examples)
99.95
THERMO-SIL UHS
Property
THERMO-SIL HS (3)
SPECTROSIL
VITREOSIL
Examplesofcommerciallyavailablesilicagrades
VITREOSILandSPECTROSILaretradenamesofSt.GobainQuartz,THERMOSILand
ISOMOLDEDaretradenamesofCeradyneInc.;(1)Rangeofpurities:Highpurity
transparentgrade,puritiesallexceed99%,butvarywithopacity;(2)Transparent
grade;(3)Averagevalues;
352
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.12
Silicon carbide
Lowdensity,
Hardnessandwearresistance,
Highstrength,
Lowthermalexpansion,
Highthermalconductivity,
Usefulelectronicproperties,
Chemical resistance; good oxidation and hotcorrosion resistance, depending on purity and
processingroute,
ThermalShockresistance,
Hightemperaturestrength,dependingontheprocessingroute,
Thermalstabilitytoveryhightemperatures(2200Cto2800C,dependingonthegrade).
43.12.1.2 Processing
The processing routes use various techniques to compact and densify powders or deposit material
fromavapourphase,Ref.[431]:
Hot pressing of pure silicon carbide to produce high density materials needs both a high
temperature and high pressure, e.g. above 2000C at 2 GPa. Additions of alumina or boron
carbidecanreducethepressurenecessary.
Reaction bonded or sintered materials vary in composition and process details. These are
usually fully dense, but can contain some free silicon. Applications include wearparts and
hightemperature precision components. To improve the hightemperature capability of
reactionbonded materials, a nitriding process to convert any free silicon to silicon nitride
resultsinmaterialsknownasnitrogenbondedsiliconcarbide,Ref.[4347].
Siliconinfiltrated silicon carbide is a process where silicon carbide powder is mixed with
carbon or graphite then compacted into a green shape. Silicon, as either a liquid or vapour
phase, infiltrates the green shape and reacts with the carbon to form silicon carbide which
bonds the silicon carbide particles together. Usually around 10% residual, unreacted, silicon
remains in the densified item. This affects the hightemperature performance, i.e. the melting
pointofpuresiliconisabout1400C.AsimilarprocessisusedtomanufactureCesicinwhicha
353
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
carbon felt rather than carbon powder is used to react with the liquid silicon to form silicon
carbide.
Chemical vapour processes, either CVD deposition or CVI infiltration, rely on the reduction of
siliconandcarboncontainingchemicalsathightemperatures.Thesetechniquesproducehigh
puritysiliconcarbidewithhighoxidationresistance.Depositioncanbeonasubstratetoforma
protective coating, e.g. oxidation protection of porous or nonporous substrate materials;
whereas infiltration can be used to densify green shapes by producing silicon carbide within
interstices. CVI processes are used to create silicon carbidebased ceramic matrix composites,
[See:88.22].
354
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.121Technicalceramics:siliconcarbidescomparisonofmaterials
propertiesproducedbydifferentprocessroutes
1300C
Fracture toughness
(MPam1/2)
Thermal conductivity
(WmK, 20C)
CTE, (10-6 /C)
Applications(examples)
Key:
SiC 54S
Isostatic
pressed +
Sintered
CVD (1)
CVD (1)
3150
2000
3000
483
3790
103
449
124
414
-
CERATREX
SC-3P
Cesic
Silicon
infiltration
2900
3100
-
3150
Performance
SiC
SiC 100
Isostatic
pressed +
sintered
CERALLOY
146-IS
Hot pressed
(6)
PUREBIDE
CERASIC
(6)
2 - 10
>3100
2650
3150
3210
3200
<3.5
0
1.5
0
2200
3000
552
2751
2.3
-
2.2
-
2.3
-
2.8
-
2.8
-
3000
2200
450
375
450
>130
365 (2)
450 (2)
375
450
450
450
560 (2)
-
440
420
225
415
450 (2)
440
152 345
-
3.5
2.5
3.5
>4.6
170
115
180
420
4.5
4.8 (5)
4.6 (5)
430
(2)
2.94
(3)
3.1
160
110
250
200
0.003
3.8 (8)
4.4 (9)
4.5 (4)
4.5 (5)
Corrosion resistance; wear resistance; nearnet shape to 400 mm OD.
2650
3100
-
0% free
Si
5
99.3
(7)
99.9995
Hardness (Vickers)
99.9995
Porosity (apparent, %)
Porosity (open, %)
Reaction
bonded
Pressureless
sintering
Processingmethod
Property
Self-sintered
PUREBIDE
Examplesofcommerciallyavailablesiliconcarbidegrades
PUREBIDE&HALSIC:MorganAM&T;PerformanceSiC:MorganAdvancedCeramics(CVDDiv.);CERASIC:ToshibaCeramics
Co.;CERATREX&CERALLOY:Ceradyne;SiC100:BoostecIndustries(F);CesicECM(D);SiC54S:Bettini(I);(1)Chemical
vapourdeposition;(2)4pointbendtest;(3)microindentationtest;(4)20Cto950C;(5)20Cto1000C;(6)Rangeofpropertiesfor
variouscommercialgrades;(7)20Kto100K;(8)20Cto400C;(9)20Cto800C.
355
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Cesic
SiC54S
SiC100
43.12.3.3 Foams
Whilst the majority of commerciallyavailable silicon carbide grades are densified materials (low
porosity), some specialist suppliers produce deliberately, openpore materials, Ref. [4328], [4339],
[4359],[4360],e.g.:
Ultramet(USA).
SchaferCorp(USA)
DuocelfromERGMaterialsandAerospaceCorporation(USA)
SiCLigaFillfoamsfromFraunhoferIKTS(D)
Ceramic foams were originally developed as filters for molten metal about 40years ago. During
processing, an open cell structure forms that resembles that of polyurethane foam but in which the
porewalls(knownasligaments)arehollow.Thesehollowwallsaretheninfiltratedtoproducesolid
ligamentsthatprovideasubstantialincreaseinstrength,Ref.[4339].
SiC foams are now considered to have potential uses in space structures as possible replacement
materialsforglassceramicsorberylliumandasacompetitortoconventionalsiliconcarbideusedfor
some large, lightweight mirrors and structures, Ref. [4329], [4339], [4357], [4358], [4359], [4361]
andascoresforsandwichpanels,[Seealso:Chapter26].
The majority pf SiC foams are of USA origin. A summary of properties for Duocel of interest for
sandwichpanelcoresisprovided,[See:Table26.3.7].
WithinEurope,FraunhoferIKTS(D)hasdevelopedSiCLigaFillfoams,Ref.[4339].Highstrength
LigaFillfoamscontainbetween70%and90%pores,withcellsizesintherangeof10to60poresper
inch(4to25porespercentimetre,i.e.porediametersfrom0.4to2.5mm),typically.Fractureloads,
determinedbyindentationtests,areintherangeof900Nto7500N,dependingonthefoamstructure.
Hightemperature resistance is toabout 1300C, Ref. [4339]. Sandwich panels, comprisingof silicon
carbideskins(matorplates)canbeassembledtofoamcoresbyapastetechnique,Ref.[4339].
AnotherproductCeranet,alsodevelopedbyFraunhoferIKTS,isnotfoambutalightweightsilicon
carbidematerialwithanetlikestructure.
356
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.12.4 Cesic
43.12.4.1 Introduction
Cesic is high-performance technical ceramic material from ECM (Munich, D). It contains a mixture of silicon
carbide, silicon and carbon phases after processing, Ref. [4357]. The material was evaluated for the
development of the optical bench of the NIRSpec instrument on the JWST James Web Space Telescope,
[See:43.18]andalsomirrorsforNIRSpec,Ref.[4358].
357
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
CARBON BLANK
Carbon felt infiltrated with phenolic resin.
Moulded under pressure to form a blank.
Vacuum heat-treatment.
Carbon blank size: 1100 mm 1100 mm 80 mm
ASSEMBLY OF BLANKS
(bonding)
MACHINING OF BLANKS
(CNC milling and pre-holes)
INSPECTION
(green body)
SILICON INFILTRATION
[See: Figure 43.12.2]
INSPECTION
(cracks; geometry)
FINAL MACHINING
EDM technique
Grinding (diamond tools)
FINAL INSPECTION
Non-destructive test (dye penetrant; ultrasonic)
Geometry
Mass
Figure43.121Cesic:Basicprocessingsequence
The Cesic process is known as directtoshape because the carbon greenbody shape is produced
closetothefinalsizeandshapeofthefinalstructure.
Directtoshape implies better dimensional control than other processes described as nearnet
shape.
During the infiltration process, the transformation from carbon to silicon carbide that occurs is a
solidtosolid reaction; hence no deformation occurs due to effects such as gravity. Whereas some
ceramics, processed by different methods, exhibit large dimensional changes during manufacture,
358
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Cesic undergoes a low, controlled shrinkage of only 0.2%. This enables closetolerance structural
partstobeproducedandreducestheneedformachining.
Dependingontheparticularstructurebeingmade,additionalprocessescanbeused,Ref.[4357],e.g.
mirrors, which have a surface preparation step prior to coating and a polishing stage after
coating.Theopticalqualityisalsoestablishedduringthefinalinspection.
small components do not always need assembly of multiple carbon blanks; maximum blank
thickness80mm.
large structures can be produced as subassemblies, which are then joined after silicon
infiltration,finalmachiningandinspectionsteps.
Cesic silicon infiltration facilities at ECM (Munich, Germany) capable of processing up to 2.4 m diameter structures.
Figure43.122Cesic:Siliconinfiltrationprocessingequipment
43.12.4.5 Machining
EDM and wire erosion machining is possible because Cesic is electrically conductive. The EDM
technique offers a number of advantages over grinding, e.g. fast and accurate, so less expensive. For large areas,
the tolerances achievable are flatness <10m; position 20m. Combining wire erosion machining
(preliminary)withEDM(finishing)achievestolerancesof10m for an 7mm hole.
359
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Isotropywasdemonstratedbysamplestakenfromdifferentorientations,i.e.samplesdenotedasx,y
andzdirections.
Thetestsconductedincluded,Ref.[4357]:
coefficientofthermalexpansion,fromRTto20K
4pointbendingtoanASTMstandard.
Biaxialtest,atRTandlowtemperature(liquidnitrogen).
Table43.122Cesic:Mechanicalproperties
Property(1)
Density
(kg/m3)
Value
2650
Comment
Ref. [4357]
Modulus, E (GPa)
Specific bending stiffness, E/ (MPa)
Strength (MPa)
Fracture toughness, KIC
Bending strength, at RT (MPa): large
sample:
225
>13.7
>130
>4.6
Mean
Maximum
Minimum
SD
Weibull
Bending strength, at RT (MPa): small
sample:
Mean
Maximum
Minimum
SD
Weibull
Directionality (bending strength):
x-direction (MPa)
y-direction (MPa)
z-direction (MPa)
Bi-axial bending strength, at RT, (MPa)
SD
Bi-axial bending strength, at LN2 temp,
(MPa)
SD
Key:
(1) SD standard deviation;
111.1
152.3
80.7
15.7
11
ASTMC1341
(150mm 30 mm 3mm);
97 samples tested, Ref. [4357].
148.9
171.6
128.1
13.0
13.6
ASTMC1341
(80mm 30 mm 3mm);
21 samples tested, Ref. [4357].
147.4
151.3
146.9
164.2
22.2
162.9
(2)
20.4
Ref. [4357]
Preliminary tests, Ref. [4357].
360
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Value
<0.003
Comment
Michelson
interferometry
technique, 15 samples
tested
160
35
TheresultsofCTEtestsonmaterialsproducedfromthreedifferentbatches,i.e.infiltrationofdifferent
batches of carbon, and tested in different directions are shown in Figure 43.12.3, Ref. [4357]. The
average value determined from the curves is 238.6m/m with a maximum variation of 5.3m/m at
20K.
Thesamplesforzdirectiontestswerejoinedpriortosiliconinfiltrationbecausethethicknesslimitof
thecarbonblankis80mm(testsamplesize:250mm30mm10mm).
GiventhattheCTEinthezdirectionarethesameasthoseintheotherdirections,wheresamplesdid
notcontainjoints,thisshowsthatthejoiningmethoddevelopedbyECMdoesnotaffectthematerial
expansionorcontractioncharacteristics.
CTEmeasurementon15samplesfrom3batchesofmaterialstestedinx,yandzdirections,wherez
directionsamplescontainedjointsmadepriortosiliconinfiltration.
Figure43.123Cesic:Coefficientofthermalexpansion
361
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure43.124Cesicceramic:Exampleofintegrallystiffenedpanel
43.12.4.10
Applications: Mirrors
An ESAfunded study compared Cesic with Bettini SiC-54S for the types of mirrors envisaged for the
NIRSpec programme, [See also: SiC-54S]. Not only the materials were evaluated, but optical coatings,
manufacturing of test mirrors and performance at cryogenictemperatureswerealsoinvestigated,Ref.[43
58].
43.12.4.11
362
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.12.5
SiC 54S
43.12.5.1 Introduction
ProducedbyBettiniinItaly,SiC54hasbeenevaluatedfordimensionallystablespacestructures.
An ESAfunded study compared Bettini SiC54 with ECM Cesic with for the types of mirrors
envisagedfortheNIRSpecprogramme,Ref.[4358].
Figure43.125SiC54Sceramic:Processsequence
ThebasicprocesswasusedtomanufacturetestmirrorsfortheNIRSpecprogramme.Toimprovethe
surface polishing capability, a coating was applied to the surface to meet NIRSpec microroughness
demands,Ref.[4358].
Snecmasproprietaryisothermalchemicalvapourinfiltration(ICVISiC)coatingprocesswasusedto
depositadense,homogeneousSiClayerontheSiC54substrates.Theprocessisconductedatalower
temperaturecomparedwithotherchemicalvapourprocesses,Ref.[4358].
363
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.12.5.5 Machining
Prior to densification by sintering, machining is carried out on the green body either after the cold
isostaticpressingstep(turning)orafterthedebindingstep(milling).
Teststandard
Value
Porosity:
Open (%)
Closed (%)
Bulk density (g/cm3)
Flexural strength, 4-point, (MPa)
Batch 1
Batch 2
Pf (1) = 63.21%
Bending strength (4-point)
Specific strength, /
Allowable strength, adm
Compressive strength (MPa)
Youngs modulus (GPa):
Specific stiffness, E/
Allowable modulus, E adm
Hardness, Vickers HV 0.5 (GPa)
Fracture toughness, KIC (MPa m1/2)
Weibull modulus
Poissons ratio
Allowable Poissons ratio, adm
EN 623-2
EN 843-1
EN 843-1
EN 843-1
DIN 51067T1
ENV 843-2
ENV 843-4
DIN 51109
ENV 843-5
ENV 843-2
-
0
1.5
3.15
365
369.5 61.4
364.1 64.7
390.28
225 (4)
71
82 (3)
2200
415 1.7 (2)
132
400 (3)
2.3
4
7
0.15 0.001 (2)
0.16 (3)
364
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Teststandard
Value
EN 821-2
EN 821-1
110
130
48
EN 821-1
EN 821-1
(1)
3.8
4.4
(1)
(1)
(2)
(2)
(2)
(2)
(2)
-
2.2
1.0
660
392
106
2
1300
(1)MeasuredbyMichelsonInterferometrytechnique(GalileoAvionica,Italy);(2)Special
testfixtureformeasuringthermalcapacitybetween4Kand293K.
Firsteigenfrequency:>300Hz
Mass:<1.5kg,includingrearmountcollar
Designload:50g(30gsimultaneouslyalongdirections(+x,+y,+z)or(+x,+y,z).
Operatingtemperature:35K,withqualifications20K.
Themirroris170mmdiameter,witharearintegralmountingcollar.
Themirrorsurfaceissphericalwitha600mmradiusofcurvature.Theopenbackfaceofthemirroris
flatwithadepthattheedgeof30mm.Thecellsareequilateraltriangles.
365
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure43.126SiC54S:NIRSpecprototypemirror
43.12.6
SiC-100
43.12.6.1 General
As of August 2004, CoorsTek (USA) and Boostec (France) have a licensing agreement that covers a
wide range of design, processing and manufacturing technologies associated with silicon carbide
mirrorsandstructuralsystemsforopticalapplications,Ref.[4327].Thisincludeshighperformance,
spacebasedtelescopesforearthobservation,astronomyanddefence.Someexamplesinclude:
ROCSAT 2
ROSETTA
OWL
FIRST
ALADIN
ARAGO
VLT-NAOS
GAIA
43.12.6.2 Source
SiC100 has been developed by EADS Astrium SAS together with the manufacturing company Boostec S.A.,
France.
366
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
occupy the tetrahedral sites of thestructure. The materialis polycrystallineand fullyisotropic. The
meangrainsizeisabout5m.
Keyadvantagesfortheproductionofhighperformancecomponentsorsystemsinclude:
NearlypureSiC,nosecondaryphase.
Isotropicphysicalproperties.
Highmechanicalstrengthandstiffness,insensitivitytomechanicalfatigue.
Highthermalconductivityandlowthermalstrain.
Highstability.
Highresistancetoaggressiveenvironments.
SiCpowderpreparation,
Isostaticpressing,
Greenforming,alsocalledgreenmachining,
Sintering,
Grinding,
Milling,
Polishing,
Inspection.
Figure43.12.7showsthestepbystepSiC100productionprocess,Ref.[43111].
367
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure43.127SiC100:ProductionprocessschematicforHerschelprimary
mirror
43.12.6.5 SiC powder preparation
Sinteredsiliconcarbide(SiC)rawmaterialisproducedbymixinghighpuritySiCwithsinteringaids
and binder additives which aid production of largescale products from this finegrained material.
Initially, the powder is ball milled to a precise submicron size distribution. The sintering aids
compriselessthan1%byweightofthesinteredmaterial.
368
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.12.6.8 Sintering
Sintering techniques have improved dramatically in the last 30 years. New furnace technology with
computer controlled zones, optimised gas flow, and vacuum environments now enable sintering of
very large and complex products. The challenge is to produce a uniform temperature during the
sintering process that peaks in excess of 2100C whilst maintaining an environment which removes
binders and prevents oxygen exposure. SiC powder is kept under vacuum or an inert atmosphere
duringtheentiresinteringprocesstoavoiddegradation.Thesinteringprocesstypicallytakesbetween
20hoursand120hours,dependingonthesizeandcomplexityoftheload.
Duringtheprocess,thereare3basicstages:binderburnoutupto500C,densification(shrinkageof
about20%)upto2100C,thencooldown.Theprocessneedstobecontrolledprecisely.Notreaching
the full sintering temperature for the required time can produce a part that is not fully dense.
Exceeding the sintering conditions cancause excessive grain growth, which could be detrimental to
materialproperties.
43.12.6.9 Grinding
GrindingofsinteredSiCissimilartogrindingofothertypesofceramicmaterials.Abrasivediamond
wheelsaresuitabletoolsforthepurpose.Typically,grindingisdonewithalargeflowofwaterbased
coolant to prevent excessive heat. For optical applications, grinding is avoided in order to maintain
the ultimate strength of the material measured in the as fired surface condition. As with most
ceramics,grindingcancausesubsurfacedamagethatcanlowerthestrength by50%ormorewhen
comparedwithanasfiredorhighlypolishedsurface.However,lappingandpolishingoperationscan
removethedamagecausedbygrindingandsorecoverthestrength.
43.12.6.10
Milling
Design details such as interface attachment holes and recessed mounting surfaces are milled in
accordancewithprecisegeometricanddimensionalrequirements.CNCmillingmachineswithupto5
axes are generally used to perform these operations. Machining times for these operations are
relativelylong.Onlydiamondtoolingwithsubstantialcoolantiseffectiveformilling.
43.12.6.11
Polishing
MostopticalpolishingtechniquescanbeappliedtoSiCoptics.Conventionalabrasivepolishingwith
pads and pitch along with advanced techniques such as computercontrolled polishing, ion beam
figuring and magnetorheological finishing have been demonstrated. Diamond is the only abrasive
mediumthatiseffectiveinpolishing.Optimisedremovalratescanbecomparablewithremovalrates
formoretraditionalopticalsubstratematerials.
43.12.6.12
Inspection
Several inprocess and final inspection steps are applied to SiC100 optical projects. Although some
special products are subject to designspecific testing and qualification requirements, the usual
inspectionstepsare:
Greenbodyqualification:Therawmaterialisqualifiedbyusingtestcouponsfordensity,pore
distributionandstrength.
Aspressed blank: The blank is visually inspected for cracks and measured for dimensional
accuracy.
Assintered part: The sintered part undergoes a dye penetrant inspection for cracks and
porosity.
369
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Ground /machined parts: Dye penetrant inspection for cracks. Dimensional and geometrical
inspectionmeasurements.
Prooftesting:Finalpartscanundergoprooftestingand/orvibrationtestingpriortointegration
intotheopticalsubsystem.
Table 43.12.6 summarises the manufacturing size constraints (as of 2006). It gives the practical size
limitations,determinedbyavailableprocessfacilities,intermsoffinishedpartsize,i.e.aftershrinkage
andmachining,Ref.[43111].
Table43.126SiC100:Manufacturingsizeconstraintspracticalsizelimitations
forfinishedpart
Process
Isostatic pressing
Green machining
Sintering
Grinding
CVD SiC
Brazing
Sizelimitations(m)
Cylindrical:
Rectangular:
Rectangular:
Cylindrical:
Rectangular:
Rectangular:
Cylindrical:
Rectangular:
Cylindrical:
Cylindrical:
1.0
1.0 1.7
0.6 2.0
1.5
1.0 3.0
1.4 1.8
3.5
1.0 5.0
1.5
3.5
(Status2006)
43.12.6.13
Material properties
Material properties are given in Table 43.12.7, Ref. [43110]. Typical characteristics of SiC100 are
statedontheBoostecwebpage.
370
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.127SiC100:Typicalcharacteristics
Typicalcharacteristics
Chemical
Physical
Thermal
Free Silicon
Crystal structure
Mean grain size
Total porosity
Open porosity
Apparent bulk density
Theoretical density
Coefficient of thermal expansion
Thermal conductivity
Specific heat
Mechanical
Electrical
Service
Conditions
Weibull modulus
Compressive strength
Young's modulus
Shear modulus
Poisson's ratio
KIC toughness
Electrical resistivity
Maximum working temperature
Value
500 g load
wt %
10-6 m
vol %
vol %
kg / m3
kg / m3
10-6/C
10-6/C
10-6/C
W/m K
W/m K
W/m K
J/kg K
J/kg K
J/kg K
C
GPa
20C
MPa
450
1000C
1400C
20C
MPa
MPa
MPa
GPa
GPa
MN m-3/2
Ohm m
C
450
450
10
3000
420
180
0.16
3.5
105
1450
1800
20C to 500C
20C to 1000C
20C to 1400C
20C
500C
1000C
20C
500C
1000C
Units
20C
Air
Inert
atmosphere
0
alpha SiC
5
< 3.5
0
3100
3210
4.0
4.6
5.2
180
68
40
680
1040
1180
325
22
Status: (30.05.2006)
43.12.6.14
Outgassing
Theresultsofoutgassingtests,conductedinaccordancewithECSSQ7001andECSSQST7002,are
giveninTable43.12.7,Ref.[43112].
Table43.128SiC100:MicroVCMtestE544outgassingvalues
SiC-100
TML(%)
RML(%)
CVCM(%)
0.01
0.00
0.00
ThemeasuredoutgassingpropertiesofSiC100werewithinthosestatedinECSSQST7002.NoFTIR
spectrumwasfoundfromthecondensedmaterial.
371
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.12.6.15
Assembly technologies
Conventionalprocesses,suchasadhesivebondingwithepoxyorusingmechanicalfasteners(bolting),
areusedtoassembleSiCparts.Thesetechnologiesoffermicrometricstabilityperformancesufficient
formoststructuralapplicationsorfixings.
Formirrordevelopment,thestabilitydemandismuchmoresevere,soothersprocessesareused.Two
differentassemblytechnologiesforSiC100havebeenachievedinparallel,Ref.[43111],[43113]:
Ceramic bonding.
Brazing.
Bothoftheseassemblymethodsarenowwellestablishedorqualifiedforspaceuse.
43.12.6.16
Ceramic bonding
Ceramicbondingisaprocessthatenablesassemblyofseparategreenbodypartsbeforesinteringto
produce a pure SiC item at the end of the process. The technique uses adhesive containing SiC
particlestobondthetwogreenbodiestogether.Greenbodymachiningofthefullassemblycanthen
proceedintheusualmanner.
Aftersintering,amonolithicSiCpartisobtainedandthebondedinterfacecanhardlybedetectedwith
thenakedeye.Thistechniqueneedsmillingandsinteringfacilitiescapableofhandlingthefinalitem
dimensions. The maximum size that can currently be manufactured is about 1.5 m in diameter. An
exampleofaproductjoinedbyceramicbondingisthe1mdiameterDemonstrationMirror.
43.12.6.17
Brazing
For larger monolithic pieces, brazing is the best solution. The brazing process enables of a large
numberofsinteredSiCpartstobejoinedinasinglestep.Thepiecestobebrazedarepositionedusing
jigs. During the process the braze material fills the gap between the pieces by capillary action. The
operationiscarriedoutathightemperatureunderanonoxidizingatmosphere.Thethicknessofthe
brazedjointsistypicallyaround50m.
Themajoradvantagesofbrazingaretheeaseofprocessingandtheabsenceofanydistortionarising
fromthebrazedjointsduringservice.TheentireassemblybehavesasifitwasmadeofasingleSiC
element. Limited by the dimensions of available brazing furnaces, the maximum size that can
currently be achieved is about 3.8 m in diameter, e.g. 3.5 m diameter for the HERSCHEL primary
mirrormadeof12brazedsegments.
Examples:
43.12.6.18
Design guidelines
SomegeneraldesignguidelinesforthemanufacturingofSiC100componentsare,Ref.[43111]:
Thickness>0.5mm,<20mm.
Keepthicknesstransitionstolessthanan8to1ratio.
Webthicknessminimum0.5mmwithaspectratio(heighttothickness)lessthan80to1.
Exteriorchamfers0.5mmto2mm.
372
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Fillets>1.5mmforbottomofpockets.
Fillets>3mmforvertical.
Asfired(nopostsintermachining)1%lineartoleranceforpocketsandnoncriticalfeatures.
Actual product design parameters have many factors that determine the prudent design rules. An
optimaldesignisachievedbyevaluationonacasebycasebasis.
43.12.6.19
A 1 m diameter Demonstration Mirror, shown in Figure 43.12.8, was manufactured for visible
wavelengthapplications,withtwoimportantrequirements,Ref.[43113]:
Lightweight
Representativeoftheactualneedsofopticaldevices,inordertodemonstratethefeasibilityof
largediametermirrors.
Figure43.128SiC100:1mdiameterDemonstrationMirrorreadytopolish
ThevisiblewavelengthrangeimpliesthataSiCCVDchemicalvapourdepositionlayerisnecessary
beforepolishingandcoatinginordertoachievethedesiredsurfaceroughness.
The 1 m mirror has a concave parabolic shape (primary reflector of Cassegrain telescope). The rear
sideislightweight.Itisanoptimisedopenbackstructure,whichistheeasiestwayofmachiningthe
sinteredSiCblank.
Themirrorwasmanufacturedfromgreenpartsthatarejoinedinthegreenstatebyceramicbonding,
asshowninFigure43.12.9.
373
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
15.3 kg mass after grinding, equivalent to less than 20 kg/m with lateral interfaces. An optimisation of
supporting points by analysis enabledamassreductionof50%.
Stiffness of the mirror over 280 Hz (mirror alone) and 175 Hz with supporting devices.
43.12.6.20
The brazing technique for joining was successfully verified by manufacturing of the HERSCHEL
DemonstratorBreadboard,whichiscomposedof9singlesegments,asshowninFigure43.12.10,Ref.
[43113].
374
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Duringthethermaltest,nodistortionresultingfrombrazingorfromCTEvariationbetweensegments
wasmeasuredwithinanaccuracyof0.3m,Ref.[43113].
Owingtothethinnessofthebrazedjoint,ithasnoinfluenceonthepolishingprocessanddoesnot
create any discontinuity. Brazed pieces have been polished without problems even for optical
accuraciesinavisiblewavelengthapplication.
43.12.6.21
The 3.5 m diameter primary mirror blank for the HERSCHEL telescope was fabricated by brazing
together12siliconcarbide(SiC)segments,asshowninFigure43.12.11,Ref.[43113].
Figure43.1211SiC100:3.5mdiameterHERSCHELPrimaryMirror
manufacturedbybrazing12SiCsegments
Toprovidemechanicalstability,temporarystiffeningribswerepositionedontheinternalsurfaceof
thesegment,bothduringthemanufacturingofthesegmentsandwhilstthemirrorblankwasbeing
assembled. These were in addition to the external surface stiffeners that are part of the final mirror
configuration.
Oncetheassemblyprocesswascompleted,themirrorblankwasmachinedbygrindingtoremovethe
temporary stiffening ribs, to reduce the thickness of the mirror shell to 3 mm, and to achieve the
correct shell profile ready for polishing, as shown in Figure 43.12.12, Ref. [43113]. The machining
processreducedthemassofthemirrorblankfrom720kgto240kg.
375
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure43.1212SiC100:3.5mdiameterHERSCHELPrimaryMirrorafter
assembly
43.12.6.22
During a preparatory technology development activity for the JWST NIRSpec instrument, a
technologydemonstrator(theOpticalBenchBreadboard)wassuccessfullymanufacturedandtested,
Ref. [43114]. Objectives were to manufacture and test an optical bench breadboard model,
representativeindimensions,shapeanddesign,fortheactualsizeNIRSpecinstrumentopticalbench.
Thestudyobjectiveswereto:
validatethecompletemanufacturingsequenceincludingjoiningbybrazing,
demonstratethefeasibilityoftheallceramicSiCconceptforoperationat30K,
providedesignfiguresfortheactualNIRSpecbenchdesign.
Figure43.12.13showsthesuccessfullytestedOpticalBenchBreadboard,whichwasmanufacturedin
SiC100intwohalvesthenjoinedbybrazing.
376
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure43.1213SiC100:NIRSpecOpticalBenchBreadboard
43.12.6.23 Applications: NIRSpec Optical Assembly for James Webb Space
Telescope
NIRSpecnearinfraredmultiobjectspectrographisoneofthreeastronomicalinstrumentsonboard
the future James Webb Space Telescope (JWST). Its configuration, shown in Figure 43.12.14, is a
dispersive spectrograph capable of observing astronomical objects in the 1 m to 5 m wavelength
range,Ref.[43115].
Figure43.1214SiC100:OpticalAssemblyofNIRSpecforJamesWebbSpace
Telescope
The NIRSpec optical bench is a large planar structure (1.8 m 1.25 m) made of SiC100. It carries
mirrors,filters,mechanismsandtheFocalPlaneAssembly.AuniquefeatureoftheSpectrographis
its athermal design, where most of its components, particularly mirrors, mechanisms and structure,
aremadefromthesamematerialinordertoavoiddistortionresultingfromthermoelasticmismatch.
Thelargebaseplateisajoinedstructuremanufacturedfromtwomonolithicpartsbrazedtogether.
377
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.12.6.24
OtherhighprecisioncomponentsmadeofSiC100forspaceapplicationsaredescribedontheBoostec
website.
43.13
Silicon nitride
highstiffness,
lowthermalexpansion,
goodcreepresistance,
goodthermalshockresistance,
notelectricallyconductive(pure).
Siliconnitridecanbeusedupto1500Cinvacuum.Itdisassociatesat1850Cinnitrogenatmospheres.
43.13.1.2 Sialon
Sialonisamodifiedformofsiliconnitrideinwhichaluminiumandoxygenaresubstitutedforsilicon
and nitrogen to produce silicon aluminium oxynitride. In general they possess good strength,
fracture and wear resistance. Applications include wear parts and hightemperature engine
components.Theadditionoftitaniumcarbideproducesconductivesialons.
43.13.1.3 Processing
Theperformanceofcommerciallyavailablesiliconnitridegradesisaffectedbytheprocessingroute.
This determines the microstructure, e.g. grain size, residual porosity levels, secondary phases, and
consequently the mechanical characteristics and hightemperature resistance. The characteristics of
siliconnitridematerialsproducedbydifferentprocessingroutescanbesummarisedas:
Sintered materials can have strengths approaching those of hot pressed variants and shaped
parts can be made that are not possible by hot pressing. Modified compositions can increase
toughnessattheexpenseofstrength.
RBSN reaction bonded silicon nitride, or reaction sintered, are usually porous and have
moderate strengths but high thermal shock resistance. Uses tend to be for refractories,
exploiting their nonwetting by molten metals. Modified processing can produce fine, even
dispersionsofporosityimprovingthestrength.
378
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.131Technicalceramics:siliconnitridescomparisonofmaterials
propertiesproducedbydifferentprocessroutes
Dynacer
SSN
SSN
(MAC SSNS)
RBSN (1)
(MAC RBSNS)
CERALLOY
147-01B
Dynacer
RBSN
CERALLOY
147-31N
CERALLOY
147-5
Examplesofcommerciallyavailablesiliconnitridegrades
sintere
d
sintere
d
reactio
n
bonded
reactio
n
bonded
reactio
n
bonded
sintered
reaction
bonded
hot
pressed
Property
Processingmethod
Silicon nitride content
(%, typ.)
Grain size (m)
Bulk density (kg/m3)
99
99
72
92
>98.5
3250
3200
2300
2500
3200
3300
2500
20
(open)
16
1500
800
1100
1800
1800
2000
>3000
650
550
200
190
190
700 to 800
930
Key:
290
280
170
175
170
310
320
8.0
2.5
3.0
6.0
6.0
25
15
12
14
16
26
35
3.0
3.3
3.1
3.2
3.0
3.1
3.2
not stated
Wear parts
650
Applications(examples)
650
not stated
Hardness
Vickers (GPa, Hv0.5kg)
Vickers (kg/mm2,
Hv0.3kg)
Compressive strength
(MPa)
Flexural strength, 20C
(MPa)
Youngs modulus, 20C
(GPa)
Fracture toughness
(MPam1/2)
Thermal conductivity,
20C
(WmK)
CTE, (10-6 /C) 20C to
1000C
MACgradesaretradenamesofMorganAdvancedCeramics;CERALLOYisatradenameof
CeradyneInc.Dynacer=DynamicCeramicLtd.(1)Lowdensityporousgrade.
379
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.14
Fullystabilised:usedlargelyasrefractoriesbecauseoftheirresistancetoattackbymanymolten
metals.
Partiallystabilised:PSZgradeshavecombinedstrengthandtoughness,makingthemsuitable
forengineeringcomponents.
TZP tetragonal zirconia polycrystal, which have high strengths but moderate usage
temperatures.
TTZ transformation toughened zirconia undergoes a phase change that results in beneficial
compressivestresses,e.g.surfacesundergoingmachiningoratcracktips.
380
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.141Technicalceramics:partiallystabilisedzirconiatypicalproperties
Key:
DURA-Z
CoorsTek
YTZP
CEROXIDE
Z900
(MAC Z940R)
94.0
MgO
MgO
Y2O3
3.0% Y2O3
5720
-
5720
-
6020
-
6080
0
5.4% Y2O3
0.25% Al2O3
<1
6000
0
11
78
11.8
77
11.8
77
12.7
81
84
12.5
80
2000
1750
1750
2500
550
620
758
900
1000
200
200
200
210
205
200
8.4
11
11
13
10.0
2.5
2.2
2.2
2.2
2.9
2.9
(2)
10.2
10.3
9.5 (1)
Industrial applications
Industrial applications
Applications
(examples)
Industrial applications
CoorsTek
TTZ
Stabilised
96.5
Industrial applications
3.5%
MgO
60
5700
0
10
Process equipment parts:
(pumps, valves) in
corrosive or abrasive
sectors.
Property
Z 500
(MAC 965R)
Examplesofcommerciallyavailablepartiallystabilisedzirconia
grades
10.1
900
MACgradesaretradenamesofMorganAdvancedCeramics;CEROXIDEisatradenameofSCT
SocietedesCeramiquesTechniques,(F);DURAZisatradenameofCoorsTek.(1)20Cto
600C;(2)20Cto1000C;(3)includeshafniumoxidecontent.
381
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.15
43.15.1 Introduction
43.15.1.1 General characteristics
Glassceramicsareformedfrommoltenglasswhichisthencrystallisedbyheattreatment.Theyconsist
of mixtures of several oxides which form complex, multiphase microstructures. In general the
properties can be tailored by controlling the crystalline structure of the glass matrix. Unlike
conventional sintered ceramics, glass ceramics do not contain porosity which can adversely affect
mechanicalperformance.
Applications for glass ceramics are many and varied; from domestic cookware and appliances, to
industrialusesandstaticanddynamicaerospaceengineeringcomponents,e.g.radomes,engineparts
andmirrorsubstratesforterrestrialorspacetelescopes.
Glassceramicsarestableathightemperatures,havenearzerocoefficientsofthermalexpansionand
areresistanttomanyformsofhightemperaturecorrosionandoxidation.
43.15.1.2 Composition
Themaintypesofglassceramicmaterialsare:
LASlithiumaluminiumsilicate(betaspodumene),whichhasnearzerothermalexpansionup
toabout430C.Whilstthehighsilicacontentgiveslowexpansioncharacteristicsitdoeslower
thestrength.
MASmagnesiumaluminiumsilicate(cordierite),whichingeneral,isbothstrongerandmore
corrosion resistant than LAS. A modified, multiphase version of MAS which contains
aluminiumtitanatehascorrosionresistanceuptoabout1100C.
Zerodur, produced by Schott AG. Zerodur is a wellknown glass ceramic within the space
industryforapplicationssuchasmirrorsubstratesandopticalbenches,[Seealso:43.19].
ULE,producedbyCorningCorp.ULEisatitaniasilicateglassusedwithinthespaceindustry
forapplicationssuchasmirrors.
Macor, which is produced by Corning Corp. but is available throughout Europe from
distributors.
Chemicalmachinablegrades.
GlassbondedMica,alsoknownasaceramoplastic,
382
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Someexamplesofcommerciallyavailableglassceramicsevaluatedforspaceapplicationsinclude:
HubbleSpaceTelescope:ULEformainmirror;Zerodurforsecondarymirror.
ELTextremelylargetelescopes(Zerodur)
SST(Zerodur)
43.15.2.2 Zerodur
SchottAGproducesZerodur,aglassceramicwithanextremelylowthermalexpansioncoefficient.
Generalcharacteristicsare,Ref.[4335]:
nearzerothermalexpansionwith3Dhomogeneity,
highinternalquality,
goodprocessingbehaviour,
polishabletoahighaccuracy,
easilycoated,
lowHeliumpermeability,
nonporous,
goodchemicalstability.
Zerodurhasbeenevaluatedforapplicationssuchaslightweightmirrorsforastronomicaltelescopes,
bothspacebasedandterrestrial,includingELTprojectsforextremelylargetelescopes(20mto100m).
CommerciallyavailablegradesofZerodurglassesarecategorisedby,Ref.[4335],[4336]:
thermalexpansioncharacteristics,fromClass0to2.
internal quality is determined by the presence and size of inclusions (number and maximum
dimension),striaeandbulkstress(measuredbybirefringence).
Foropticalapplications,theZerodurgradesareknownasstandardorspecial,whereClass0to3
stipulates the internal quality, Ref. [36]. Zerodur M is a variation intended for applications where
processing involves cooling rates more than 0.1K/min, which can affect the CTE values of
components.WhilstZerodurcanbeusedupto600C(mechanicalpartsandwindows),amodified
material known as Zerodur K20 is intended for applications up to 850C. This material has an
expansioncoefficientof1.5106/Katroomtemperatureand2.0106/K(20Cto700C).
Table 43.15.1 gives the basic properties of Zerodur standard grade, Ref. [4335]. Standard grade
ZerodurcoversmaterialsuptoexpansionClass2.
383
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Composition
Grain size (m)
Bulk density (kg/m3)
Porosity apparent (%)
Hardness: Knoop (0.1/20)
Tensile strength, MOR (MPa)
Compressive strength, 20C (MPa)
Flexural strength, 20C (MPa)
Youngs modulus, 20C (GPa)
Shear modulus, 20C (GPa)
Fracture toughness (MPam1/2)
Thermal conductivity, 20C (Wm K)
Coefficient of thermal expansion, (106 /K)
Expansion Class, (10-6 /K), 0C to
50C:
Class 2
Class 1
Class 0
Applications(examples)
Key:
SchottAG.commerciallyavailable
Zerodurglassceramic
not stated
2530
0
620
90.3
1.46
0
0 0.10
0 0.05
0 0.02
Astronomy mirrors, inc. GTC Gran Telescopio Canarias (42
inch mirror); ROSAT; SST
solar telescope.
ZerodurisatradenameofSchottAG(D);
43.15.2.3 ULE
CorningInc.ULEultralowexpansionisarangeoftitaniumsilicateglasseswhichhaveparticular
characteristics suitable for applications needing thermomechanical stability combined with optical
performance.ULEhasbeenevaluatedforapplicationssuchaslightweightmirrorsforastronomical
telescopes, both spacebased and terrestrial, and spacecraft applications. Although the basic
characteristicsofthematerialsarethesame,thedifferentcommerciallyavailablegradesofULEare
categorisedby,Ref.[4333]:
thermalexpansioncharacteristics,whichstateguaranteedmaximumlimits(linearcoefficientof
thermalexpansion;deltaCTEvariationsinaxialandradialdirectionsofapart),
opticalretardation,whichismeasuredbybirefringence,
inclusion quality, i.e. the guaranteed maximum numbers of seeds, bubbles and opaque
inclusions.
384
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
ThemaingradesofULEglassesareknownas,Ref.[4333]:
Premium,whichhasthelowestCTEvariations,opticalretardationandinclusions.
Mirror, which exhibits slightly larger CTE variations and birefringence than premium grade,
butthepresenceofinclusionsaredividedintocriticalandnoncriticalzonesandthesizeand
numberpresentaredifferent.
Standard, where the CTE and birefringence values are the same as mirror grade and the
inclusionsarethesameasmirrornoncriticalzone.
Tooling,whichhasnolimitsgivenforCTE,opticalorinclusions.
CorningCorp.commerciallyavailable
ULEglass
Composition
Grain size (m)
Bulk density (kg/m3)
Porosity apparent (%)
Hardness: Knoop (kg/mm2, 200g load)
Tensile strength, MOR (MPa)
Compressive strength, 25C (MPa)
Flexural strength, 25C (MPa)
Youngs modulus, 25C (GPa)
Shear modulus, 25C (GPa)
Fracture toughness (MPam1/2)
Thermal conductivity, 25C (Wm C)
Coefficient of thermal expansion, (10-9 /K)
CTE maximum variation, (10-9 /K) 5C to
35C
Applications(examples)
Key:
titanium silicate
2210
0
460
49.8
69.6
29.0
1.31
0 (0 ppb/C)
30 ( 30 ppb/C)
Astronomy mirrors, e.g. 4.2 m primary
mirror for Lowell Observatory's
Discovery Channel Telescope.
ULEisatradenameofCorningCorporation(USA);
385
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.15.2.4 Macor
Macorisamachinableglassceramicwhichcanbemachinedinitsfiredstateusingconventionaltools.
ItscompositionisaproprietaryoxidemixcontainingSi,Mg,Al,K,BandF,Ref.[4312].Someofits
characteristicsinclude:
modulus, 68 GPa,
high-temperature resistance similar to conventional glass ceramics, e.g. 800C (continuous), 1000C (no
load),
Someexamplesofaerospaceapplicationsinclude,Ref.[4312]:
ShapedpartsonSpaceShuttleOrbiter,e.g.retainingringsathingepoints,windowsanddoors.
NASAs spaceborne gamma radiation detector uses large pieces of Macor, in which frame
corners are joined by a combination of machined (buttlap) mechanical joints and a sealing
glass.
386
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure43.151Glassceramics:Coefficientofthermalexpansionwithtemperature
materialsforopticalinstrumentsinspace
387
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.15.4 ZERODUR
43.15.4.1 General
Schott AG produce several grades of material. Zerodur glass ceramic is an inorganic, nonporous
material,madebyaprocessofcontrolledvolumecrystallisation.Itcontainsacrystallisedphaseanda
residualglassphasewhichtogetherdeterminethepropertiesofthematerial.Zerodurcontains70to
78weightpercentcrystallinephasewithahighquartzstructure.Thiscrystallinephasehasanegative
linearthermalexpansion,whilstthatoftheglassphaseispositive.Thecrystalshaveanaveragesizeof
about50nm.
Zerodurhasanextremelowcoefficientofthermalexpansion,whichevencanbecomezeroorslightly
negativeinsometemperatureranges.AnotheruniquecharacteristicofZerodurisitsexceptionalgood
homogeneity.Eveninlargematerialblocks,thefluctuationsofmechanicalandthermalpropertiesare
nearly not measurable. A good transparency in the range of about 400nm to 2300nm enables a
verificationoftheinnerqualityofZerodur.Ifneeded,bubblesorinclusionsinZeroduraredetectable.
43.15.4.2 Processing
The Zerodur manufacturing sequence is based on established and proven methods used in the
productionofhighhomogeneityopticalglasses;asshowninFigure43.15.2.
Figure43.152Zerodur:Productionprocessschematic
Themeltiscastintomouldsandinsertedintoannealingovenstocooldowntherawcastingtoroom
temperatureinacontrolledwayforseveralweeks.Intheceramisationprocessthematerialisheated
upagaintoachievecontrollednucleationandgrowthofthecrystalphase;asshowninFigure43.15.3.
388
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure43.153Zerodur:Annealingprocess
The ceramisation process has a large influence on the final homogeneity of CTE within the blank.
Dependingonthesizeofthepart,itcantakeuptoseveralmonths,Ref.[4364].Afterceramisationthe
materialcanbeprocessedtoitsfinalshape.
389
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure43.154Zerodur:Summaryofengineeringdata
43.15.5.2 Mechanical properties
ThemechanicalpropertiesofZerodurare:
Fracture toughness, KIC : 0.9 MPa m1/2, Ref. [4383], [4385], [4396]
Bending strength and Weibull parameters: Values are dependent on the surface condition, [See: Design].
390
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
nd=1.5424(587.6nm).
ng=1.5544(435.8nm).
Transmission;asshowninFigure 43.15.5fora5mmthicksample,Ref.[4387].
Figure43.155Zerodur:Opticaltransmissioncurve
43.15.5.4 Electrical properties
TheelectricalpropertiesofZerodurare,Ref.[4387]:
Dielectric constant:
8.0(1kHz).
7.4(1MHz).
29 10-3 (1kHz).
15 10-3 (1 MHz).
CTE coefficient of thermal expansion, : 0 0.10 10-6/K, over temperature range 0C to 50C, Ref.
[4387]
391
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
The thermalexpansion characteristicsasa functionof temperature,Ref.[4370], [4374], [4387], [43
102]areshowninFigure43.15.6for0Kto900K,Ref.[4387].
Zerodur is compared with different materials in Figure 43.15.7, Ref. [4374], [43102] and Figure
43.15.8,[4374].
Figure43.156Zerodur:Thermalexpansioncryogenicbehaviour
Figure43.157Zerodur:Coefficientofthermalexpansiondifferentglass
ceramics
392
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure43.158Zerodur:Thermalexpansionofdifferentglassceramics
In Figure 43.15.9, the thermal conductivity is plotted as function of temperature for different glasses, Ref. [4394]. The values of thermal conductivity for Zerodur are located between the two limiting curves in the diagram.
Rangeofthermalconductivityofglasseswithcurvesattemperaturesbetween0Kand500K.Thedata
forZerodur are near to the upper limiting curve high silicate containing glasses, Ref. [4394].
Figure43.159Zerodur:Thermalconductivitycharacteristicsofdifferentglasses
393
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
microstructureofthesurfacewhichistensionstressedbytheloadapplied,
areaofthesurfaceexposedtotensilestress,
rateofstressincrease,
environmentalconditions
A mechanical failure of glass occurs if two conditions occur together, firstly the presence of tensile
stressatthesurfaceandsecondlythepresenceofaflawintheregionofthetensilestress.Inthecaseof
largeflaws,i.e.morethanabout0.5mmasanorderofmagnitude,orattoohightensilestressesglass
breaksimmediatelyorwithinshortduration.
Ifflawsaresmall,e.g.wellbelow0.5mmorofmicroscopicdimensions,suchflawsgrowslowlyunder
the influence of the tensile stress. If microcracks exceed a critical length their growth accelerates
rapidlyandthematerialfails.Thelargestmicroflawwithinatensilestressloadedareadeterminesthe
strengthofthematerial.
Example: Conservative bending strength values for longterm applications of optical glass and
Zerodur are 8 MPa and 10 MPa respectively. The values are valid for normal surface conditions
withoutscratchesandflaws.
F ( ) 1 exp ( / 0 )
[43.151]
wheretheWeibullparametersare:
Weibull factor, given by the slope of the Weibull line and provides a measure for
the scatter of distribution.
The distribution function is widely used in product lifetime statistics and enables deriving of
predicted failure rates for collectives of identical parts. Based on test results obtained under well
defined conditions, design strengths for loads and conditions defined by special application
requirementscanbecalculated.
394
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
R ) andforaparticularglasstype
andsurfacecondition.
0 ( S L , 63%, R ) is the characteristic strength for the laboratory test surface area SL and stress
increaserateR.Inthemodelemployedthedesignstrengthdependsontheparameters:
SV
RV
tV
FV
ThedesignstrengthisderivedfromthelaboratorystrengthbydividingitbyfFOS,thesocalledfactor
ofsafety:
k 0 / f FOS
[43.152]
The factor of safety fFOS is determined as a product of the area factor, probability factor and fatigue
factor.
TheformulaefortheindividualfactorsarederivedonthebasisoftheWeibullmodelusingthelaws
onprobability:
f FOS f A f P f F
[43.153]
where:
fA
area factor
fB
probability factor
ff
fatigue factor
Theareafactor,fA,isdeterminedusingtheexpression:
f A ( S V / S L )1 /
[43.154]
395
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Eqn. [43.154] assumes constant stress within the loaded area. It is a conservative approach since in
many cases the tensile stress has a maximum value that decreases with distance away from that
maximum.
Foramoreprecisecalculation,Seff,Visused.Thisisobtainedbyweightingthemaximumstresswith
thestressdistributionfunctioninsteadofSV.
Theprobabilityfactor,fp,isdeterminedusingtheexpression:
fp
1 1/
(ln
)
1 FV
[43.155]
Thefatiguefactor,fF,isdeterminedusingthegeneralexpression:
teff ,V
fF
teff , L
1/ n
[43.156]
Where:
t eff,V
t eff,L
Ref.[4382]givesamoredetaileddescriptionofparametersteff,Vandteff,L.
Inthespecialcaseofastressloadconstantintime,Eq[43.156]readsexplicitly:
f F (tV f A f P R (n 1) / 0 )1 / n
[43.157]
For application cases with timevarying loads teff,V is calculated instead of tV by using a weighting
functionthatdescribestheloadvariationwithtime.
The stress corrosion constant, n, has been determined for several glass types. If no experimental
resultsareavailable,ncanbeestimatedaccordingtotheexpression:
n 38 2.6
[43.158]
Where:
396
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
ThederivationsoftheformulaeandmoredetailedinformationaboutthecalculationofthefactorsfA,
fPandfFaregiveninRef.[4382].
Table43.15.3showthemeasuredresultsforthecharacteristicbendingstrength,0,Weibullfactorand
stresscorrosionconstant,n,forZerodur,Ref.[4396].
ThetestprocedurewasaccordingtoDIN522921DoubleringmethodR306withastressincreasing
rateof2MPa/s,roomclimateconditionsandatestareaof113mm2.
FailureofprobabilitycurvesofbendingstrengthfordifferentsurfaceconditionsareshowninFigure
43.15.10andFigure43.15.11andasafunctionoftestareainFigure43.15.12,Ref.[4396].
BendingstrengthunderconstantloadisshowninFigure43.15.13,Ref.[4396].
Table43.153Zerodur:Characteristicstrength,Weibullfactorandstress
corrosionfactor
397
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure43.1510Zerodur:Failureprobabilityfortestsurfacesprocessedwith
bondedgritofdifferentsizes
Figure43.1511Zerodur:FailureprobabilityofZerodurfortestsurfaces
processedwithloosegritofdifferentsizes
398
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
The values for the test surface area SL = 113 mm2 are measured by test. Test conditions: Rate of stress
increase 2MPa/s; test surface processed with D 151, air as surrounding medium. The values for the
other test surfaces are calculated.
Figure43.1512Zerodur:Failureprobability,F,asafunctionoftestsurfacearea,
SL
Figure43.1513Zerodur:Bendingstrengthunderconstantload
399
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
K I 2 0 a
[43.159]
Where:
Aflawresultsinfractureif:
K I K IC
[43.1510]
KICisthecriticalstressintensityfactorforcrackmodeI(tensileforcesnormaltothecrackplane,crack
propagation perpendicular to the forces). KIC is a material constant. For glasses without additional
strengtheningthevalueistypically1.
Table43.15.4providessomefracturetoughnessvaluesforsomeglasses,Ref.[4383],[4385],[4396].
Table43.154Zerodur:Fracturetoughnessofsomeglasses
Foragivennominalstress,theplatewillbreakforacriticaldepthacdeterminedby:
K
ac IC
2 0
[43.1511]
400
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Example:
ForthecharacteristicstrengthofZerodurofsampleswithD64surfacecondition064MPa,(taken
fromTable43.15.1)andZerodurKIC0.9MPam1/2,thecriticalflawsize,ac,isapproximately49m.
Mostglassesexhibitslowcrackgrowthforastressintensityfactorwellbelowthecriticalvalue.The
mostimportantsubcriticalcrackgrowthoccursinthepresenceofwater(amountslessthen10mgper
m2).Thevelocityofthecrackcanbedescribedusing,Ref.[4384]:
K (a )
da
A I
dt
K
IC
[43.1512]
Where:
a
a constant
TypicalvaluesforthestresscorrosionconstantofZeroduraregiveninTable43.15.1.
Typically,thesubcriticalcrackgrowcanstartfrom0.25KIC.
Someothertypicalapplicationsinclude:
Terrestrialastronomicaltelescopes,[See:43.xx].
OpticalbenchforLISApathfindermission,[See:43.xx].
Hubblespacetelescopesecondarymirror.
JWSTJamesWebbspacetelescope(successortoHubble).
MirrorsubstratesandmandrelsforXRaytelescopes.
Opticalelementsforcometprobes.
Ringlasergyroscopes.
Lightweighthoneycombmirrorsupports.
401
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Themaincharacteristicscanbesummarisedas:
Verylowthermalexpansion.
Hightemperatureshockresistance.
Highoperatingtemperature.
Such properties have made ULE of interest for use in various applications needing dimensional
precision, e.g. tool reference blocks, components, lasers, solid and lightweight mirror blanks (large
astronomical telescopes; space satellites). Both small and large items can be made successfully, e.g.
fromafewmillimetrestoseveralmetres.
43.15.8.2 Processing
ULE is made by flame hydrolysis. Pure liquid silicon tetrachloride and titanium tetrachloride are
mixedandthevapoursaredeliveredtoafurnace,wheretheyreactchemicallyandtheglassdroplets
depositonaspinningturntable.Theresultingmaterialisatransparentglassceramicwithextremely
lowcoefficientofthermalexpansion(nearzeroatRT)providingdimensionalstability.CTEvariation
withineachbatcharetypically<15ppb/C,radiallyandaxially.
Table43.155ULE:Summaryofengineeringdata
402
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
nD=1.4828(589nm)
nF=1.4892(486nm)
Figure43.1514ULE:Transmissioncurve
43.15.9.4 Electrical properties
TheelectricalpropertiesofULEare,Ref.[43107]:
403
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
CTE maximumvariation(5Cto35C):3010-9/K
ThethermalexpansioncharacteristicsasafunctionoftemperatureareshowninFigure43.15.15for 100Cto+100C,Ref.[43106].
[Seealso:Figure43.15.7andFigure43.15.8inwhichULEiscomparedwithdifferentmaterials].
Figure43.1515ULE:Thermalexpansioncharacteristics
General
ULE zeroexpansion glass was originally developed for the space industry to ensure the critical
performanceofopticalsystemsattheextremetemperaturesencounteredduringspacemissions.
ManyofthemajorobservatoriesworldwidehaveprimarymirrorsmadeofULE.
Sometypicalapplicationsinclude:
Ultralowexpansionsubstrates
404
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Lengthstandards
Lightweighthoneycombmirrormounts
Astronomicaltelescopes
Precisionmeasurementtechnology
Lasercavities
43.15.11.2
TheHubblemaintelescopemirrorusedULEglassasastructuralmaterial.Toreduceweight,thefront
andbackmirrorplateswerefusedtoahoneycombcoredesign.Thelightweightingtechniquesused
for the Hubble mirror have been extended to other space programs and many groundbased
astronomy applications. The weight of these large mirrors, therefore, is reduced to one eighth the
weightofanequalsizedsolidmirror.
43.15.11.3
Future applications
Currentandfuturespacebasedtelescopesenvisagemirrorsthatarelessthan10percentoftheweight
ofanequalsizedsolidmirror.
ThetechnologyhasbeenadaptedforuseintheGOESWeatherSatellites.
43.16
Speciality materials
43.16.1 Introduction
Althoughclassedastechnicalceramics,thereareawidevarietyofothermaterialsthatofferparticular
characteristicsofpotentialinterestforuseinopticalequipmentandstructures,including:
Beryllia.
Sapphire.
Synthetic diamond.
43.16.2 Beryllia
Berylliumoxide,BeO,isanelectricalinsulatorwithahighthermalconductivityofabout250Wm/K.
Thesepropertieshavemadeitofinterestinthethermalmanagementofelectronics.Itisalsousedin
microwave applications, for items such as windows and radomes. The low thermal neutron
absorptionmakesitusefulinthenuclearindustry.
An example of a commercial >99.5% pure BeO grade is Ceradyne Ceralloy 418, a high thermal
conductivitymaterialforuseinapplicationsneedingheattransfercoupledwithdielectricproperties,
e.g.electronicandmicrowavetubesandIRhighintensityarclamps,Ref.[4338].
Whilstofferingsomeinterestingcharacteristics,theknownhumantoxicityofberylliameansthatvery
specialisedhandlingisneededduringprocessing.Thiswasamajorincentiveforthedevelopmentof
alternativehighthermalconductivityceramics,e.g.aluminiumnitridegrades.
405
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.16.3 Sapphire
Synthetic sapphire is an essentially 100% pure, transparent form of alumina consisting of single
crystal (or polycrystalline), hexagonal, alphaalumina. The characteristics vary with respect to the
opticalaxisofthecrystal.
Thegeneralcharacteristicsinclude:
Hardnessapproachingdiamond,e.g.Mohs9,
Strength,~2000MPa(compressive);~900MPa(flexural),
Stiffness,~400GPa,
Fracturetoughness,~2MPam1/2,
Wearresistance(scratchandabrasion),
Wideopticaltransmissionband,e.g.fromUVtonearIR,
Highmeltingtemperature,approximately2050C,
Highelectricalresistance(insulator),
Chemicallyinert,
Goodcorrosionresistance,excepttosomeveryhotcausticcompounds,
Highthermalconductivity,i.e.betterthancopperatcryogenictemperatures.
Numerousgradesofsapphirearecommerciallyavailable,theseareusuallyclassedbytheirintended
application,e.g.formechanicaloropticalapplications(thenbylighttransmissionfrequency).
Sapphire is used for precision mechanical components (bearings, wearparts, coatings) and within
opticalsystems,e.g.lasersystemsandwindowsforimagingsystems.Productformsincludestandard
shapes,suchasrods,tubesandsubstrates,alongwithcustomshapes,e.g.optoelectronicdevicesand
LCDscreens.
Polycrystallinematerial,
Veryhard(Mohs10),
Highstiffness,
Highthermalconductivity,
LowCTE,
Goodchemicalresistance(acidsandbases),
Electricalinsulator,
Usefulopticalproperties,e.g.transparenttovisible,infraredandUV.
406
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
These combined properties have made synthetic diamond of interest for a wide range of
industrialapplications,e.g.abrasivesandcuttingtoolstocoatingsandshapedpartsforoptical
imagingsystemsand,recently,tweeterconesinloudspeakers,Ref.[439].
Themaintypesofsyntheticdiamondcanbegroupedas:
Abrasives,
Coatings,
Shapedparts.
43.16.4.2 Coatings
Coatings are deposited onto other materials, usually to improve wear and abrasion resistance.
Depending on the proprietary processes used, diamond or DLC diamondlike coatings can be
depositedontopolymers,metals,ceramicsandglass,Ref.[4312].
43.16.4.4 Developments
Borondopeddiamondhasptypesemiconductorcharacteristics,withpotentialusesintheelectronics
industry,Ref.[4337].
Singlecrystal synthetic diamond, in useable sizes, is under development as a potential replacement
forsiliconinhightemperature,highpowerelectronics,Ref.[4337].
43.17
CVD diamond
43.17.1 Introduction
Since natural diamond flew as a crucial component in one of the Pioneer Venus experimental
payloadsinthemid1970s,diamondtechnologyhasadvancedconsiderably.
UsingproprietaryCVDchemicalvapourdepositiontechniques,thinplatesandshapesinhighpurity
synthetic diamond can now be produced. This has greatly increased the potential applications for
diamond,asmanywereimpracticalduetosizeandshapeusingnaturalmaterial.
Excludingabrasives,someexamplesinclude,Ref.[438],[439],[4310],[4311]:
Optical applications, e.g. windows for missile systems, uses in highpower laser systems,
infraredimagingandprocesscontrolandanalysis,highpowermicrowavesystems.
Thermalmanagementproducts;e.g.substratesforhighpowerelectronicdevices.
Wear parts, e.g. bearings, seals and cutting tools for advanced materials such as MMCs and
CMCs.
Cuttingbladesforprecisionindustrialandmedicaluses.
407
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Parts for analytical and research equipment, operating at very high pressures (0.5Mbar) and
extremetemperatures(bothhighandcryogenic).
Alldiamondproductsareextremelyhardandabrasionresistant,butthebulkmechanical,opticaland
thermalpropertiesofmaterialsfromdifferentsourcescanvarysignificantly.
CommerciallyavailableCVDdiamondmaterialscanbegroupedas,Ref.[438]:
Optical grades: optically transparent with disc thicknesses from 0.3 mm to 1.2 mm and
diameterstypicallyupto120mm,
Mechanicalgrades:darkerinappearancewithbettermechanicalproperties,i.e.strength.Plates
uptotypically140mmdiameter.
Thermalgrades,whichareacompromisebetweenthermalconductivityandcost.
408
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.171Technicalceramics:CVDdiamondtypicalproperties
Property
DiafilmOP
Density (kg/m3)
Mechanical:
Hardness (GPa)
Fracture toughness (MPa m1/2)
Youngs modulus (GPa)
Poissons ratio
Tensile strength (MPa):
Nucleation surface
Growth surface
Physical:
Refractive index
Thermal expansion coefficient (ppm/K)
Thermal conductivity (W/m K)
Thermal shock FOM (1) (x 103 W/m)
Specific heat capacity (J/gK)
Dielectric constant, D
Loss tangent (10-6)
Environmental:
Rain impact DTV (m/s)
Sand erosion (mg/kg)
Key:
(1)
3515
Comments
81 18
5.3 to 7.0
1000 to 1100
0.1
800 [11]
400 [23]
2.375
1.0
4.4
1900 to 2200
1100
1000 (approx.)
0.52
5.68 0.15
8 to 20
525
21 6
Fine grain
Coarse grain
at 10m
at 300 K
at 1000 K
at 300K
at 500K
[See: Key]
300K
35 GHz
145 GHz
2 mm drop size
at 100m/s
C300/600 sand
FOM=S(1)k/E;where:=thermalexpansioncoefficient;E=Youngs
modulus;=Poissonsratio;S=strength;k=thermalconductivity
For optical and mechanical grades, the Weibull modulus (for tensile strength), determined from the
results of 3pointbend fracture tests, is given in Table 43.17.2, Ref. [438]. Values corrected for
thicknessvariationarealsoincluded.Ahighvalueindicatesareproduciblestrength.Forcomparison
purposes, typical values for other competitive materials are: sapphire: 2.1, zinc sulphide: 5.4, silicon
carbide:10,Ref.[438].
Table43.172Technicalceramics:CVDdiamondWeibullmodulus
CVDdiamondgrade
Growthsurface
(thicknesscorrected)
Nucleationsurface
Mechanical
9.8 (11.6)
6.5
Optical
11.6 (23.1)
11
409
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
TypicalstiffnessvaluesformaterialgradesatroomtemperatureareshowninTable43.17.3,Ref.[43
8].
Table43.173Technicalceramics:CVDdiamondYoungsmodulus
CVDdiamondgrade
Roomtemperature
Youngsmodulus(GPa)
Mechanical
1166
Optical
1133
Youngs modulus for CVD diamond materials is linked to the occurrence of defects. Materials with
high concentrations of micronsize voids and microcracks give the lowest values, emphasising the
need for rigorous process control. It also shows the importance to designers of accurate property
valuesformaterialgrades,Ref.[438].
The effect of increasing temperature on modulus is moreorless insignificant between room
temperature and 700C; a 5% loss typically. At higher temperatures, the modulus drops as the
diamondbeginstooxidise.
410
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
performingtheiraerodynamicandIRopticalrolesduringtheshort,highvelocitymissileflight,they
resistenvironmentaldegradationformuchlongerperiodswhilemountedonthecarrieraircraft.
Theimportantpropertiesformaterialsinthisroleare:
goodopticaltransmissioncharacteristicsintheimagingsystemwaveband,
highstrengthandstiffness,tosupporthighflightloads(onaircraftandafterdeployed),
preciseshapeandgoodgeometricaltolerances,foraccurateimaging,
goodenvironmentalresistancetotheimpactofrainandsandathighvelocities,
good thermal shock resistance to cope with the high thermal gradients generated during
accelerationandmanoeuvres.
MaterialstraditionallyusedforLWIRlongwavelengthinfrared(8mto14m)detectionsystemsare
ZincSulphideandGermanium.Thesehavepoorerosionresistancetorainandsand,socoatingsare
appliedtoimprovetheirperformance.
AdesigndevelopmentexercisemanufacturedopticalqualityCVDdiamondwindowsintheformof
freestandingdomes,70mmdiameterandover1mmthick.Theradiusofeachsurfacewasmachined
to1m,Ref.[438].
In addition to IR, diamond also has high transparency in other spectral ranges (wavelengths from
0.3m to 3.0m and 7.0m to >500m), enabling it to be used in multispectral windows, e.g.
combinedvisible,IRimagingandlaserrangingsystems.Othermaterialstendtohaveamuchmore
limited transparency range, e.g. 0.4m to 11.5m for ZnS, depending on the grade and 1.8m to
23.0mforGe.
Formissiles,thethermomechanicalcharacteristicsofCVDdiamondaresuperiortoothermaterials.
Diamond has very high thermal conductivity and low thermal expansion, which makes it very
resistant to thermal shock. Thermal shock for CVD diamond can attain a FOM value (103 W/m) of
1000, whereas Ge is 6.1 and ZnS grades are about 2.5. The maximum extended window operating
temperature (in air) for CVD diamond is 1023K, compared with 873K for ZnS. Above these
temperatures,masslossoccursduetooxidation.
TheenvironmentalerosionresistanceofCVDdiamondisconsiderablybetterthanothermaterialsfor
this application. Impacts from highvelocity water drops, simulating operational rain impact, can
seriouslyaffectthemechanicalstrengthofwindowsandreducetheirtransmissioncapabilities,hence
imagingquality.
Repeated sandgrain impact erodes the material surface and degrades the optical transmission
characteristics.ThehardnessandabrasionresistanceofCVDdiamondmakesitthemostresistantof
all the IR materials, including sapphire (used for 3m to 5m spectral band); as shown in Figure
43.17.1,Ref.[438].
Retained transmission for CVD diamond is different depending on which production surface is
exposedtosanderosion,i.e.upperboundisnucleationsurface;lowerboundisgrowthsurface.
411
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Retained transmission for CVD diamond is different depending on which production surface is exposed to sand
erosion, i.e. upper bound is nucleation surface; lower bound is growth surface.
Figure43.171Technicalceramics:CVDdiamondsanderosion
43.17.4.3 High-power laser systems
A common problem for highpowerlaser windowsmadefrom conventionalmaterials, such as Zinc
Selenide (ZnSe), is thermal distortion of the beam. This is caused by thermallyinduced refractive
indexgradientswherethewindowisheatedbythetransmittedbeam,Ref.[438],[4344].
The characteristics of optical grade CVD diamond (high thermal conductivity, low absorption
coefficient,lowtemperaturecoefficientofrefractiveindex)minimisetheseeffects,enablingitsusein
highpowerCO2laserssystemsforexitwindows,outputcouplers,beamsplittersandlenses,Ref.[43
8],[4344].
Table 43.17.4 compares the typical properties of CVD diamond with ZnSe, materials of interest for
highpowerlasersystems,Ref.[438].
412
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.174Technicalceramics:CVDdiamondtypicalopticalpropertiesfor
highpowerlasersystems
Property
Thermal conductivity
(W/mK)
Absorption, at 10.6m
(/cm)
dn/dT (10-6 /K)
Key:
CVDdiamond
(opticalgrade)
2000
0.05
(1)
10
ZnSe
17
0.0005
(2)
57
(1)Valuesrangefrom0.1to0.03;
(2)AlthoughthebulkabsorptionofZnSeislower,inpracticetheappliedcoatingsystem
resultsinconsiderablyhighertemperaturerisesinZnSewindowsthanincoated
CVDdiamondundertestcomparableconditions.
Size: window 100 mm diameter and 1.6mm to 2.3mm thick, depending on microwave
frequency.
Dielectricloss:relativelyuniformoverthewindowareatoavoidhotspots.
Hermeticjoiningofthediamondwindowintoametalflangetosustainhighvacuum.
Modelling of the thermal performance of CVD diamond windows transversed by a 1.2 MW beam
showedthatformaterialswithadielectriclossvalueoftan<104,thecentraltemperaturerisewas
lessthan240Cwithasimplewatercoolededge,whichistolerablefordiamond.
Table43.17.5givessometypicalpropertiesofcommerciallyavailableDiafilmdielectricgradeCVD
diamond,Ref.[438].
For highpower Gyrotron tube applications, the predicted temperature rise in dielectric grade
materials is under 15C. This means that CVD diamond dielectric grades can perform above 1MW,
andalsoincontinuouswavemodeatpowersaround0.5MWwithouttheneedforcryocooling.
413
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.175Technicalceramics:CVDdiamondtypicaldielectricproperties
forhighpowermicrowavesystems
Property(2)
Diafilm(1)
Comments
(dielectricgrade)(3)
20 to 50
0.0014 to 0.0035
5.68
(1)DiafilmisatradenameofElementSix(UK,NL);
(2)Datameasuredatfrequency=145GHz(wavelength,=2.1mm);
(3)availablesizes:upto120mmdiameterand2.25mmthick.
fibreopticassembly,whereadiamondcuttingbladesproducecleancleavageofopticalgrade
glassfilaments.
medicalapplications,e.g.
Ultrasharpdiamondscalpelsforopthalmicsurgery.
Laserscalpels,wherethediamondbladeiscombinedwithalasercauterisingsystem.
Ultramicrotamy for the preparation of very thin, typically 100nm thick, slices of tissue for clinical
analysis.
43.18
43.18.1 Introduction
Under ESA contract, Alcatel Space (F) and ECM (D), designed, manufactured and tested a flight
representativeopticalbenchmadeofCesic.ThiswasanapplicationfortheNIRSpecinstrumenton
theJamesWebSpaceTelescope.
Theopticalbenchwassuccessfullysubmittedtointensiveshakervibrationtests,upto80g,without
problemandshowedveryhighstabilitywhentesteddowntoatemperatureof30K.
414
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
High specific stiffness and large mechanical dimensional stability (no residual deformation), and thermal
and thermoelasticperformances.
High thermal conductivity, high /a ratio enabling through thermal conduction, good thermo-elastic
behaviour, homogeneity, low coefficient of thermalexpansionandremarkablecryogenicbehaviour.
[See:43.1]
43.18.2.2 Cesic
From amongst the many different types of ceramic materials, Cesic from ECM in Germany was
selectedbyAlcatelSpaceasthebestcandidateforuseinthedevelopmentofstructuresandmirrorsof
future space instruments. Knowledge of the material itself, along with all the associated processes,
enabledCesictobeconsideredasamaturetechnology.
CesicisaceramicmadeofSiC,SiandC.Itismadebythereaction,athightemperaturebetweenaC
Cgreenshapeandliquidsilicon,Ref.[4357].
[Seealso:43.12]
Manufacture and test an optical bench representative of NIRspec in dimensions, shape and
designinorderto:
demonstratethefeasibilityoftheconcept,
validatetheentiremanufacturingprocesses.
Theequippedbenchcansupportthemechanicallaunchenvironmentwithoutdamage.
Validateloadsintroducedbythebenchtoequipmentduetoitsdampingbehaviour.
Verify bench stability under tests down to the cryogenic working temperature of 30 K.
415
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
The designand size constraints usedfor the benchwere the optical and launch loads, butalso took
intoaccounttheflexibiltyofmanufacturingpartswithCesic;notablybyproducingahalfclosedback
design to maximise stiffness, Ishaped stiffeners, thin ribs to minimise mass, CC blocks at interface
junctionsandholescutusingEDMelectrodischargemachiningtechniques.
Figure43.18.1showsthemainfeaturesofthedemonstratoropticalbenchproduced.
I-shaped
stiffeners to
optimise specific
stiffness
Seconda ry ribs and hole s for mirr or
sup port I/F and fixing by bo lts
Figure43.181NIRSpecopticalbenchdevelopment:Cesic
structure
ceramic demonstrator
416
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Machined surfaces
with close parallel
tolerances
Joint line
Articulated
load points
Figure43.182NIRSpecopticalbenchdevelopment:TestsetupandIbeam
samplewithjointline
Figure43.183NIRSpecopticalbenchdevelopment:Testsetupforinstrumented
benchcells
43.18.3.5 Vibration testing
Theentirebenchwastestedundervibration.Theobjectivesoftheopticalbenchvibrationtestswere
to:
Identify the dynamics behaviour of such representative flight bench, e.g. amplification,
dampingcoefficient.
Validatethestiffnessofthebench.
Validatethestrengthandidentifytheeventualmarginfortheallowablestrengthnecessaryfor
thesizingofafutureNIRspecflightbench.
To establish the strength and margins, the bench underwent vibration testing up to the maximum
sinuslevelpossiblebytheshaker,i.e.morethan80gatshakerlevel.Thevibrationlevelsimposedon
417
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
the test bed exceed the qualification loads experienced by a fullsized flight bench, the bench was
thereforequalifiedforflight.
Figure43.18.4showsthebenchinstalledontheshaker.
Figure43.184NIRSpecopticalbenchdevelopment:Testsetupforshaker
vibrationtests
TheFEMpredictionwascorroboratedbythetestresults,whichconfirmedthematerialpropertiesand
alsotheabilitytopredictstiffness,stressandstrengthbehaviour.
The bench eigenfrequency is above 500Hz and the amplification factor, measured during OBB sine
test,islessthanQ=30,solimitingloadsinducedoncriticalequipmentundervibrationandnotching.
Invar rule
Extension
bench at 90
BENCH
Thermal
sensors
Cryo panels
Thermal
straps
Figure43.185NIRSpecopticalbenchdevelopment:Testsetupforcryogenic
temperaturetest
418
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
During the test, the inplane contraction and the outofplane stability was measured by a speckle
holographic interferometric method. This technique provides an accuracy of around 1m on the
wholecyclewitharesolutionof0.1m.ThemeasurementwasperformedbyHOLO3.
Duringthecryogenictest,allthecriteriaweremetsuccessfully,i.e.:
Temperatureoflessthan30KwasreachedbyOBB.
Thermalcontractionwasaspredictedfrommeasurementofsamples:
contractionwashomogeneousonthewholebenchsurface;asshowninFigure43.18.6.
benchdeformationwaszerofrom100Kto30K;asshowninFigure43.18.7,whereallthe
curves from different positions are combined to also show that the contraction was
homogeneousoverthesurface.
Outofplane deformation was quasizero between 293K and 30K; as shown in Figure 43.18.8.
Thisenablesgoodopticalalignmenttobemaintainedduringcooldownfrom300Kto40K.No
hysteresiswasobservedduringtheentirethermalcycle.
The overall results of the cryo testing demonstrated that the bench structure made of Cesic was
highly stable. It was concluded that Cesic is a suitable material for making dimensionallystable
structuresoperatingundercryogenicconditions.
419
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
+100
+50
-50
-100
Figure43.186NIRSpecopticalbenchdevelopment:Thermalcontractionunder
cryogenictest
420
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Figure43.187NIRSpecopticalbenchdevelopment:Lineardisplacementunder
cryogenictest
Figure43.188NIRSpecopticalbenchdevelopment:Outofplanedisplacement
undercryogenictest
421
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.18.4 Conclusions
The large development study, performed jointly by Alcatel Space and ECM and supported by ESA,
demonstratedthatCesicisamaturetechnologywhichcanbeconsideredforapplicationsneeding:
Mechanicalproperties,e.g.highstrength,insensitivetofatigue,goodsurfacefinishes,atjoints
andinterfaces,boltedjointsunderhighloads.
Processing using an established material production route, along with accurate machining by
EDMtoprovideprecisioninterfaces.
Mirrormanufacturingcapability,i.e.abletoproducelargelightweightandstiffmirrors;mirror
withintegratedfilteringMFD.
Costandtimeefficientmanufacturing.
Potential to evolve further, e.g. manufacturing of more complex shapes and structures;
enhancedproperties.
43.19
43.19.1 Introduction
For over 30 years, Zerodur has been a material favoured for mirror substrates of terrestrial and
orbitaltelescopes.Morethan200astronomicalmirrorblankswithdiametersbetween1mand2mhave
beenproduced,Ref.[4368].
The ability to produce large amounts with reproducible quality makes it suitable for future ELT
extremelylargetelescopesinthe20mto100mclass.
Modern fabrication technologies enable the production of structures with more than 65% weight
reduction.Owingtoitsgoodhomogeneityofcoefficientofthermalexpansion,Zerodurisalsousedas
a mandrel material for shaping mirror shells, such as those envisaged in future Xray telescope
projects
The material has been used in a large number of optical instruments for different space missions,
including the secondary mirror of the Hubble Space Telescope. It is also intended to be used in its
successor;JWSTJamesWebbSpaceTelescope.
Somefurtherapplicationsforspaceinclude:
MirrorsubstratesforXraytelescopes.
Opticalelementsforcometprobes.
Ringlasergyroscopes.
Lightweighthoneycombmirrorsupports.
422
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table43.191Zerodur:Overviewofterrestrialastronomicaltelescopemirrors
Figure43.191Zerodur:OpticalbenchforLISApathfindermission
423
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
43.20
References
43.20.1 General
[431]
R.Hussey&J.WilsonRJTechnicalConsultants
AdvancedTechnicalCeramicsDirectoryandDatabook
Chapman&Hall,ISBN0412803100(1998)
[432]
ThinkCeramicsTechnicsheKeramikerwebsite
(www.keramverband.de)
NOTE
TechnicalceramicmaterialsclassedaccordingtoENV12212;listed
underC...asperIEC672.
[433]
MorganAdvancedMaterialsandTechnology,(USA):
Privatecommunication(2005)
[434]
CARESsoftware:ExtractfromNASAwebsite(June2005):website:
http://www.grc.nasa.gov/WWW/LPB/cares/index.html
[435]
S.J.SchneiderJnr:ChairISO/TC206Fineceramics
Assessmentofinternationalstandardisationneedsforceramicmaterials
StatusofISO/TC206Fineceramics,
ISOBulletin(Feb2003)
[436]
ISOwebsite:www.iso.ch
[437]
EN60672:Ceramicandglassinsulatingmaterials
[438]
R.S.Sussmann:ElementSixDeBeersInd.Diamonds(UK)
ApplicationsofDiamondSynthesizedbyChemicalVapourDeposition;
Chapter2inHardMaterials,EditorR.Riedel.PublishedbyWileyVCH,
(2000),p574622
[439]
ElementSix(NL;UK)(website:www.e6.com)
Diafilm OP datasheet (2004)
[4310]
H.P.Godfriedetal:DrukkerInternational/ElementSix(NL)
UseofCVDdiamondinhighpowerCO2lasersandlaserdiodearrays;
InAdvancedHighPowerLasersproceedingsofSPIEVol.3889(2000),
p553563.ISBN0277786X/00
[4311]
C.S.Pickles&R.S.Sussman:ElementSix(UK)
Diamond:alasersbestfriend
PhysicsWorld(July2000),p2526
[4312]
MorganGroup(UK)
AdvancedCeramics:www.morganadvancedceramics.com
Boronnitride:www.performancematerial.com
Carbons:www.morganamt.com
Siliconcarbide(CVD):www.performancematerial.com
424
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[4313]
SaintGobainQuartz(websitewww.quartz.saintgobain.com)
[4314]
CeradyneInc.(websitewww.ceradyne.com)
[4315]
KyoceraCorp.(websitewww.kyocera.co.jp)
[4316]
St.Gobain(F):Boronnitride(websitewww.bn.saintgobain.com)
[4317]
GEAdvancedCeramics(websitewww.advceramics.com)
[4318]
J.Boylan:MorganAdvancedMaterials&Technology
CarbonGraphiteMaterials
MaterialsWorld,Vol.4,no.12(December1996),pp.707708
[4319]
J.Boylan:MorganAdvancedMaterials&Technology
Privatecommunication(June2005)
[4320]
SGLCarbon(D)website(websitewww.sglcarbon.com)
[4321]
CarboneLorraine(France)website(www.chem.carbonelorraine.com)
[4322]
Schunk(D)website(www.schunkgraphite.com)
[4323]
Dr.E.Silverman:NorthropGrummanSpaceTechnology(USA)
MultifunctionalCarbonFoamDevelopmentforSpacecraftApplications
SAMPEJournal,Vol.41,No.3May/June2005
[4324]
PocoGraphiteInc.(USA)website(www.poco.com)
[4325]
M.M.Roweetal:TRLTouchstoneResearchLaboratory,(USA);website
(www.trl.com)
Casestudiesofcarbonfoamtooling
SAMPEJournal,Vol.41,No.4July/August2005.
[4326]
ToshibaCeramics(Japan)website(www.tocera.co.jp)
[4327]
Boostec(France)website(www.boostec.com)
[4328]
Ultramet(USA)website(www.ultramet.com)
[4329]
SchaferCorp(USA)website(www.schafercorp.com)
[4330]
DynamicCeramicLtd.(UK)website(www.dynamcer.com)
[4331]
SCT(France)website(www.sctceramics.com)
[4332]
CoorsTek(USA)website(www.coorstek.com)
[4333]
CorningCorporation(USA)website(www.corning.com)
[4334]
B.Ackermanetal:CorningCorporation(USA)
ImprovedcharacteristicsofULE glass for meeting EUVL needs; SPIE
Conference2003
425
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[4335]
SchottAG(D)website(www.schott.com)
[4336]
ZerodurSchottLithotecAG(D)website(www.schott.com)
[4337]
A.Yarnell
Themanyfacetsofmanmadediamonds
ChemicalandEngineeringNews,February2,2004
[4338]
MatWebwebsite(www.matls.com)
[4339]
LigaFillceramicsfoams:FraunhoferInstituteforCeramicTechnologies
andSinteredMaterialswebsite(www.ikts.fhg.de)
[4340]
J.Adleretal:FraunhoferInstituteIKTS,Dresden(D).
SISICLigaFill foams and related net-like structures: New lightweight and
low-cost materials for spaceborne applications, Proceedings of EUROMAT 99,
Vol. 1 - Materials for TransportationTechnology;PeterJ.Winkler(Editor)
ISBN:3527301240(April2000)
[4341]
Dr.M.A.Mooreetal:MorganCrucibleCo.Ltd.(UK)
Hightemperatureinsulatingrefractories:Technical,economic,health&
safetyandenvironmentalissues
5thEuropeanConferenceonIndustrialFurnacesandBoilers,Espinho,
Porto,Portugal,April2000
[4342]
XiangchengLuoetal:NewYorkStateUniversity,USA
Electronicapplicationsofflexiblegraphite
JournalofElectronicMaterials,Vol.31,No.5(2002)
[4343]
PioneerVenusmissionfromNASAwebsite(2005)
http://nssdc.gsfc.nasa.gov/planetary/pioneer_venus.html
[4344]
H.P.Godfriedetal:DrukkerInt./ElementSix(NL,UK)
UseofCVDdiamondinhighpowerCO2lasersandlaserdiodearrays
ProceedingsofSPIEAdvancedHighpowerLasers,15November1999,
Osaka,Japan.
Vol.3889(2000)ISBN0277786X00
[4345]
SintecKeramik(D)website(www.sinteckeramik.com)
[4346]
B.H.Foingetal.
SMART1mission,technologiesandscience:withsolarpowertothe
Moon
Presentedat5thIAAInternationalConferenceonLowCostPlanetary
Missions,24thSeptember2003
[4347]
CeramResearch(UK)website(www.ceram.co.uk)
[4348]
Dr.W.Hanson&Dr.J.FernieTWI(UK)
CeramicJoiningAnoverview
MaterialsWorld,Vol.6No.9pp.52436,September1998
426
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[4349]
Dr.NoelN.Nemeth:NASAGlennResearchCentre(USA)
NASACARES:Privatecommunication(September2005)
[4350]
N.N.Nemethetal:NASAGlennResearchCentre(USA)
LifetimeReliabilityPredictionofCeramicStructuresunderTransient
ThermomechanicalLoads
NASATP2005212505(September2005)
[4351]
N.N.Nemethetal:NASAGlennResearchCentre(USA)
FabricationandProbabiliticFractureStrengthPredictionofHighaspect
ratioSingleCrystalSiliconCarbideMicrospecimenswithStress
Concentration
Prepublicationissue:JournalofThinSolidFilms(20052006)
[4352]
GalileoAvionica(I)
TradeoffofMirrorMaterials(Cesic,SiC54)MaunfacturingofTest
MirrorsandCharacterisationatCryogenicTemperatures
ExecutiveSummary(June2004)
ESTECContractNo.16355/02/NL/VD
[4353]
FutureCarbonGmbH(D)
Presentation(September2004)
[4354]
NeueMaterialienWurzburgGmbH(D)
Presentation(September2004)
[4355]
T.Mahrholzetal:DLR(D)
FibrereinforcedNanocompositesforSpacecraftStructures
ProceedingsofEuropeanConferenceonSpacecraftstructures,Materials
andMechanicalTestingESAESTECNoordwijk(NL)1012May,2005.
ESASP581(August2005)
[4356]
CabotCorporation(USA)
PDFfile:FundamentalsofCarbonBlack
[4357]
M.Krdel:ECM(Munich,Germany)
Cesic - Engineering material for optics and structures
ProceedingsofEuropeanConferenceonSpacecraftstructures,Materials
andMechanicalTestingESAESTECNoordwijk(NL)1012May,2005.
ESASP581(August2005)
[4358]
GalileoAvionica
TradeoffMirrorMaterials(CesicandSiC54)Manufacturingoftest
mirrorsandcharacterisationatcryogenictemperatures
ExecutiveSummary(June2004)
ESAESTECContractNo.16355/02/NL/VD
[4359]
A.Novietal.
LightweightSiCfoamedmirrorsforspaceapplications
OptomechanicalDesignandEngineering2001
(Ed.A.E.Hatheway),ProceedingsofSPIEVol.4444,2001
427
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[4360]
ERGMaterialsandAerospaceCorporation(USA)
DuocelSiliciumCarbideFoamDatasheets
[4361]
A.Obst:ESAESTEC(NL)
Designofsandwichstructuresforspaceapplications
Chapter18Theoryandapplicationsofsandwichstructures
Ed.R.A.Shenoietal.,UniversityofSouthampton,UK,2005
[4362]
BettiniSpa(I):InformationanddataonSiC54Sdoesnotappearonthe
websiteandisbyrequestonly.
[4363]
DrLucaMazzucchi:BettiniSpa(I)
SiC54SFabrication
Privatecommunication(February2006)
[4364]
HansBach(Editor)
LowThermalExpansionGlassCeramics,
SpringerVerlag,1995
[4365]
W.APlummer&H.EHagy
PrecisionThermalExpansionmeasurementsonLowExpansionOptical
Materials
AppliedOptics,Vol.7,No.5,p.825831,1968
[4366]
R.Muelleretal
UltraprecisionDilatometerSystemforThermalExpansion
measurementsonLowExpansionGlasses
Proceedingsof12thThermalExpansionSymposium,Pittsburgh/PA.
(Editors:P.S.Gaal&D.E.Apostolescu)1997
[4367]
InaMitraetal
OptimizedGlassceramicSubstrateMaterialsforEUVLApplications
ProceedingsofSPIE5374,EmergingLithographicTechnologiesVIII
(2004)
[4368]
P.Hartmann&H.F.Morian
100YearsofMirrorBlanksProceedingsof2ndWorkshoponExtremely
LargeTelescopes,Proc.BckaskogworkshoponELT
[4369]
R.Jedamziketal
Homogeneityofthecoefficientoflinearthermalexpansionof
ZERODUR
ProceedingsSPIEVol.5868OpticalMaterialsandStructures
TechnologiesII(2005)p.241251
[4370]
O.Lindig&WPannhorst
ThermalexpansionandlengthstabilityofZERODURindependence
ontemperatureandtime
AppliedOptics,Vol.24,No.20,p.23303334,1985
428
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[4371]
F.BayerHelmsetal
LngenstabilittbeiRaumtemperaturvonProbenderGlaskeramik
ZERODUR
Metrologia21,p.4957,1985
[4372]
R.Haugetal
LengthvariationinZERODURMinthetemperaturerangefrom60C
to+100C
AppliedOptics,Vol.28,No.19,1989
[4373]
R.B.Robertsetal
ThermalpropertiesofZERODURatlowtemperaturesCryogenics22,
p.566,November1982
[4374]
J.H.Burgeetal
ThermalexpansionofBorosilicateglass,ZERODUR,ZERODURM,
andunceramizedZERODURatlowtemperatures
AppliedOptics,Vol.38,p.7161,1999
[4375]
J.W.Baer&W.P.Lotz
Figuretestingof300mmZERODURmirrorsatcryogenic
temperatures
ProceedingsofSPIECryogenicOpticalSystemsandInstrumentsIX,Vol.
4822,2002
[4376]
SchottAG:ZERODURglassceramic
Catalogue10162e09043.0
[4377]
K.SchillingSCHOTTInternalreport303/91Mainz1991
[4378]
H.Richter&G.Kleer:FraunhoferInstitutfrWerkstoffmechanik,Freiburg
(D)
ReportV24/83(1983)
[4379]
M.J.Viens
NASATechnicalmemorandum4185(1990)
[4380]
F.Kerkhofetal:
Glastech.Berichte54(1981)No.8p.265to277
[4381]
G.Exner&O.Lindig
GlastechBerichte55(1982)No.5p.107to117
[4382]
G.Exner,SchottGlaswerke,Mainz(D)
GlastechBerichte56(1983)Nr.11,p.299312
[4383]
H.Bach&N.Neuroth(Editors)
Thepropertiesofopticalglass
SpringerVerlag1998
[4384]
S.M.Wiederhorn,L.H.Bolz
Stresscorrosionandstaticfatigueofglass
J.Am.Ceram.Soc.53,543548(1970)
429
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[4385]
M.J.Viens
FracturetoughnessandcrackgrowthparametersofZERODUR
NASATechnicalMemorandumA969903(1990)
[4386]
INSACOInc.(USA)http://www.insaco.com/MatPages/zerodur.asp
[4387]
PraezisionsGlas&OptikGmbH,Iserlohn(D)
http://www.pgoonline.com/intl/katalog/zerodur.html
[4388]
SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheetfromwebsite
http://www.schott.com/optics_devices/english/
2TIE25Striaeinopticalglass
[4389]
SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheet
2TIE26Homogeneityofopticalglass
[4390]
SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheet
2TIE27Stressinopticalglass
[4391]
SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheet
2TIE28Bubblesandinclusionsinopticalglass
[4392]
SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheet
2TIE29Refractiveindexanddispersion
[4393]
SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheet
2TIE30Chemicalpropertiesofopticalglass
[4394]
SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheet
2TIE31Mechanicalandthermalpropertiesofopticalglass
[4395]
SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheet
2TIE32Thermalloadsonopticalglass
[4396]
SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheet
2TIE33DesignstrengthofopticalglassandZerodur
[4397]
SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheet
2TIE34RoHSfrequentlyaskedquestionsJuly2005
[4398]
SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheet
2TIE34RoHSAnnexpresentstatus
[4399]
SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheet
2TIE34RoHSHazardoussubstancesinopticalglass
[43100] SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Data
2TIE35Transmittanceofopticalglass
[43101] SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheet
2TIE36Fluorescenceofopticalglass
430
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
[43102] SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheet
2TIE37ThermalexpansionofZERODUR
[43103] SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheet
2TIE38LightweightingofZERODUR
[43104] SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheet
2TNE03Materialsafetydatasheetabbreviationexplanation
[43105] SCHOTTAG,Mainz(D):Datasheet
2TNE04Testreportfordeliverylots
[43106] INSACOInc.(USA)
http://www.insaco.com/MatPages/corning_ule_glass.asp
[43107] PraezisionsGlas&OptikGmbH,Iserlohn(D)
http://www.pgoonline.com/intl/katalog/ule.html
[43108] CorningCorp.(USA):SemiconductorOptics
http://www.corning.com/semiconductoroptics/technical_information/
<SEARCHforULE>
CorningInternationalEurope,Wiesbaden(D);email
cieurope@corning.com
[43109] A.A.vanVeggel:EindhovenTechnicalUniversity/TNO(NL)
ExperimentalEvaluationoftheStabilityandMechanicalBehaviourof
ContactsinSiliconCarbidefortheDesignoftheBasicAngleMonitoring
SystemofGAIA
ProceedingsofEuropeanConferenceonSpacecraftstructures,Materials
andMechanicalTestingESAESTECNoordwijk(NL)1012May,2005.
ESASP581(August2005)
[43110] BoostecS.A.website:http://www.boostec.com/index.htm
Materialcharacteristics:
http://www.boostec.com/SiCTypicalCharacteristics.pdf
Otherhighprecisioncomponents:http://www.boostec.com/real.htm
[43111] S.Williams&P.Deny:CoorsTekInc(USA)/BoostecIndustries(F),
OverviewoftheproductionofsinteredSiCopticsandopticalsub
assemblies,
OpticalMaterialsAndStructuresTechnologiesII(OEI402),
SPIEOpticsandPhotonics2005,SanDiego,CA
[43112] G.vanPapendrecht
OutgassingtestonSiliconcarbidesamples
MaterialsReportNumber:3959,QMCreportnumber:QMC2004/099,21
June2004,MaterialsPhysicsandChemistrySection,Materialsand
ProcessesDivision,ESTEC
[43113] CastelD.(Astrium),DenauxD.(Astrium),BourgoinM.(Boostec),Mercier
K.(CNESToulouse)
NewTechnologyforManufacturingVeryLargeSiCMirror
431
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
EuropeanConferenceonSpacecraftStructures,MaterialsandMechanical
Testing,Toulouse,(France),1113December2002
[43114] OpticalBenchBreadboard,
NearInfraredSpectrographforJWST,
FinalReport,Doc.No.:NGSTASDTR007,dated18.3.2004
[43115] SI01NIRSPECDesignReporttoESTEC,
Doc.No.NIRSASDRP0001,dated01.10.2004
43.20.2 Sources
Dataareforillustrativepurposesonlyandcannotbeusedfordesign.
All data presented and cited within the text are summarised from informationprovided directly by
materialsuppliersorobtainedfromtheirwebsites(toend2005).
ECSSQ7071
ECSSQST7001
ECSSQST7002
Datafortheselectionofspacematerials
andprocesses,previouslyESAPSS01701.
Cleanlinessandcontaminationcontrol
Thermalvacuumoutgassingtestforthe
screeningofspacematerials;previously
ESAPSS01702
EN606721
EN606722
EN606722
Fineceramics(advancedceramics,advanced
technicalceramics),[See:43.3]
CeramicandglassinsulatingmaterialsPart1:
Definitionsandclassification
CeramicandglassinsulatingmaterialsPart2:
Methodsoftest
CeramicandglassinsulatingmaterialsPart3:
Specificationforindividualmaterials
[Seealso:81.9forCENceramicrelatedstandards]
432
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
44
Magnesium alloys and their composites
44.1
Introduction
44.1.1
General
The main magnesium alloys are listed, together with their chemical compositions and typical
mechanicalproperties.
Bothdiscontinuouslyreinforcedandcontinuousfibrereinforcedcompositesaredescribed,alongwith
potentialapplicationsforboth.
44.1.2
Features
Thebasicfeaturesofmagnesiumalloysinclude:
Low thermal stability, giving limitations in terms of thermal performance (usually to temperatures below
100C, but new alloys extend range towards 200C).
Processing, where the c.p.h. crystal structure of most magnesium alloys meansthatextrudedandsheet
products are more difficult to manufacture than aluminium alloys, hence more costly. Good
fluidityofmagnesiumcastingalloysmeansthatawiderangeofnearnetshapecomponentsare
available.
[Seealso:ECSSQ7071]
44.1.3
Alloy classification
Table 44.1.1 provides the ASTM system of alloy and temper designations for magnesium alloys.
Conventionalalloyspecifications,plussupplierproductcodes,areprovidedinRef.[446],[4420].
433
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table44.11Magnesiumalloys:ASTMdesignationsystemalloysandtempers
Firstpart
Indicates the two
principal alloying
elements
Consists of two
code letters
representing the
two main alloying
elements
arranged in order
of decreasing
percentage (or
alphabetically if
percentages
equal)
A - aluminium
B - bismuth
C - copper
D - cadmium
E - rare earth
F - iron
G - magnesium
H - thorium
J - strontium
K - zirconium
L - lithium
M - manganese
N - nickel
P - lead
Q - silver
R - chromium
S - silicon
T - tin
V - gadolinium
W - yttrium
X - calcium
Y - antimony
Z - zinc
Secondpart
Indicates the
amounts of the two
principal alloying
element
Consists of two
numbers
corresponding to
rounded percentages
of the two main
alloying elements,
arranged in same
order as alloy codes in
first part
Thirdpart
Fourthpart
Indicates minor
variations to the
basic designation
Indicates condition
(temper)
Consists of a letter
of the alphabet
assigned in order
as compositions
become standard
F-as fabricated
O-annealed, recrystallised
(wrought products only)
H-strain hardened
H11 (slight) to H18 (fully) strain hardened
H21 to H28 - strain
hardened and partially
annealed (H21 softest)
H31 to H38 - strain
hardened and stabilised to
prevent age softening
T1- cooled and naturally
aged
Whole numbers
Letters of alphabet
except I and O
434
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
44.1.4
Environmental aspects
44.1.4.1
General
Magnesium is resistant to attack by alkalis but is attacked by most acids. Similarly, magnesium is
attackedbycommonacidicsaltssuchaschloridesolutionsfoundintheformofseawater.Therefore,
unlessamagnesiumcomponentistofunctioninaninnocuousenvironment,itshouldnotbeusedin
servicewithoutsomeformofprotectivetreatment.
Magnesium alloys are not prone to intergranular attack since the grain boundaries are cathodic
compared with the actual grains and would therefore be cathodically protected if exposed to a
corrosiveenvironment.
Inaddition,mostmagnesiumalloys,withtheexceptionofthemagnesiumaluminiumalloys,arenot
susceptible to stress corrosion cracking under normal conditions and at stresses up to 0.2% Proof
Stressvalues,Ref.[449].
[Seealso:ECSSQST7036]
Cathodicimpurities,e.g.iron,nickel,copper,canhaveasignificanteffectonthecorrosionbehaviour
of unprotected magnesium alloys and are therefore controlled to low levels in alloys specified for
aerospaceanddefenceapplications.
Conversely,surfacecontamination,forexamplebyminutecathodicparticlesresultingfromabrasive
blastingwithcastironorsteelshot,mayresultinhighcorrosionrates.
Galvaniccorrosioncanalsoariseatdissimilarmetalattachments,suchasnuts,boltsandrivets,unless
thenecessaryprecautionsaretaken.
44.1.4.2
Protection systems
A number of well proven protective coating systems and techniques are available and these are
generally based on anodising or a chemical conversion treatment (usually chromating) followed by
painting, Ref. [449]. However, chromating is being phased out due to health and safety legislation
concerning chromate baths and a number of new protective systems have been developed, such as
Tagnite,KeroniteandOxsilan.Thedesignerthereforeneedstoconsultthematerial,component
supplierorspecialisttreatmentcompaniesatanearlystage.
44.1.5
Machining
Theflammabilityoffinelydividedmagnesiumintheformofmachiningswarforgrindingdustmeans
thatduecaremustbeexercisedwhenmachiningmagnesiumalloys.
Likewise, there is potential for hydrogen generation should water based cutting fluids be used.
However, magnesium alloys show very good free cutting and may be machined faster, without
cutting fluids and at lower power than aluminium alloys, allowing complex shapes with close
tolerancestobeeasilymanufactured.
Guidanceonmachiningparametersandtherelevantsafetyproceduresarewelldocumented,Ref.[44
10],althoughthiswillnormallybetheresponsibilityofthecomponentsupplier.
435
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
44.1.6
44.1.7
Material availability
44.1.7.1
General
ManyoftheestablishedmagnesiumalloyscontainedThoriumasamajoralloyingelement.Owingto
concerns over residual radioactivity, these alloys have been withdrawn from regular commercial
supplyandarethereforenotincludedinthishandbook.
Also,whilstsuperlightmagnesiumlithiumalloysweredevelopedinthe1960s(andusedintheUS
Saturn programme)and the higherlithiumalloyshave a b.c.c.structure which is moreamenable to
extrusionorrolling,difficultiesinthefoundryproceduresandconcernsovercorrosionresistancein
aqueousenvironmentshavelimitedtheuseofthesealloys.FurtherworkiscontinuinginGermany,
Ref.[4413],andJapanbutnonewalloyshaveasyetbeenregisteredcommercially.
44.1.7.2
Sources
Table44.1.2liststhemajorcommercialsourcesofmagnesiumalloys.Alloysandproductformsvary
betweensuppliers,Ref.[446].
NOTE
Table44.12Magnesiumalloys:Sourcesexamples
Supplier
Website
Alubin (Israel)
AMTS, Wrought Product
Division (Israel) (1)
Dead Sea Magnesium (Israel)
Hydro Magnesium (Norway)
Magnesium Elektron (UK)
Otto Fuchs (D)
Timminco (Canada)
www.alubin.com
www.magnesiumtechnologies.com
www.dsmag.co.il
www.hydromagnesium.com
www.magnesium-elektron.com
www.otto-fuchs.com
www.timminco.com
Key:
(1)LinkswithChemetallGmbH(D)forsurfacetreatment.
436
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
44.1.8
Future developments
Muchofthedevelopmentactivityonmagnesiumalloysinrecentyearshascentredonapplicationsin
the automotive industry, where weight reduction has been seen as a means to improving fuel
efficiency.Becauseofthegoodcastabilityandeconomicsofhighvolumeprocesses,thethrustofthis
has been on alloys for pressure diecasting. The drawbacks with existing casting alloys have been
twofold:poorhightemperaturepropertiesandlowroomtemperatureductility.
Alloys have now been introduced with improved properties both at room temperature and in
elevatedtemperaturecreepresistance.
Whilst diecastings may not have been normally considered for aerospace applications, the
improvementsinprocesstechnologyhaveresultedintheavailabilityofhighqualitycomponentswith
closetolerancenearnetshape.Also,whilsthighinitialtoolingcostsareinvolved,theoverallcostof
thecomponentscanstillbecompetitivewithalternativemanufacturingroutesevenatlowvolumes,
Ref.[4415].Someofthenewdiecastingalloysarethereforegiven,[See:44.2].
There has also been much activity in attempts to improve the economics of production of wrought
magnesiumproductswhichhavetraditionallybeenmorecostlythanaluminiumproductsduetothe
lowerprocessingspeedsofmagnesiumalloys.
Magnesium sheet products produced by twinroll casting are becoming available and work is also
progressingonimprovedextrusionprocesses.
A new high strength extruded alloy, Elektron 675, has recently been announced by Magnesium
Elektronand,whilstthisisstillundergoingfinaldevelopment,itstensilepropertiesat200Carebetter
than2024or7075aluminiumalloyswhichmakesitofpotentialinterestforaerospaceapplications.
FurtherworkcontinuesatvariousUniversitiesandresearchcentresonalloysforhighertemperature
applications, superlight MgLi alloys and on Mgbased MMCs. However, the economics of
productionmeanthatfewofthesearelikelytoreachcommercialavailability.
44.2
Magnesium alloys
44.2.1
Chemical composition
Table 44.2.1 indicates the nominal chemical compositions of many magnesium alloys. The
compositions are classed by the method used for processing and the alloys are listed using their
ASTMdesignationsandUNSnumberswhereregistered,Ref.[4420],[4421],covering:
Die castings
Wrought products
[Seealso:Table44.1.1forASTMdesignationsystem]
Someproprietaryalloysarealsoincludedtogetherwithsomerecentalloys,Ref.[441],[447],[448].
Variations in alloy chemical composition can exist in different specification systems for equivalent
alloys.Careshouldbeexercisedwhencomparingalloysacrossdifferentstandardssystems,Ref.[44
6].
437
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table44.21Magnesiumalloys:Nominalchemicalcompositions
Alloy
Composition,wt%
Al
Mn
Zn
Zr
Notes
Rare
earths
ASTM No.
UNS No.
Other
(a)
AZ63A
M11630
0.15
AZ81A
M11810
7.6
0.13
0.7
AZ91E
M11918
8.7
0.13
0.7
AZ92A
M11920
0.1
EQ21A
M12210
0.7
2.25(c)
1.5 Ag
EZ33A
M12330
2.55
0.7
3.25
...
K1A
M18010
0.7
...
...
QE22A
M18220
0.7
2.15(c)
2.5 Ag
WE43B
M18432
0.7
3.0(d)
4.0 Y
WE54A
M18410
0.7
3.5(d)
5.2 Y
ZC63A
M16331
0.25
2.7 Cu
ZE41A
M16410
4.25
0.7
1.25
ZK51A
M16510
4.55
0.7
AM20
2.0
0.40
0.20 max
AM50A
M10500
4.9
0.26
0.20 max
AM60B
M10602
0.24
0.20 max
AE42
0.50 max
0.20 max
2.5
AS21
0.4
1.0 Si
AS41B
M10412
4.25
0.35
0.12
1.0 Si
AZ91D
M11916
0.15
0.7
AZ10A
M11100
1.2
0.2
0.4
AZ31B
M11310
0.2
E
F, S, E
AZ61A
M11610
6.5
0.15
0.95
F, E
AZ80A
M11800
8.5
0.12
0.5
F, E
LA141A
M14141
1.25
0.15
14 Li
S, E
M1A
M15100
1.6
0.3 Ca
WE43B
M18432
0.7
4.0 Y
F, E
WE54A
M18410
0.7
5.2 Y
F, E
ZE10A
M16100
1.25
ZK31
0.7
0.17
-
F, E (g)
ZK60A
M16600
5.5
0.7
F, E
ZM21
1.0
2.0
S, E
Sandandpermanentmouldcastings
(b)
(e)
Diecastings
(b)
(f)
Wroughtproducts
3.0(d)
3.5(d)
438
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Recentalloys
Sandandpermanentmouldcastings
Notes
Elektron
21
MRI-201S
M12310
0.3
0.7
4.5(h)
MRI-202S
AE44
0.50 max
0.20 max
AJ52X
4.9
0.3
1.3 Sr
AJ62
6.3
0.4
2.5 Sr
AS31
3.5
0.50 max
0.20 max
1.0 Si
MRI-153M
MRI-230D
(j)
(j)
Diecastings
(k)
(l)
(m)
(k)
(j)
(j)
Wroughtproducts
Elektron
675
Key:
(n)
(a)
Magnesiumalloyscontainingthorium(codeletterH)additionshavebeenremovedfromthis
Handbook,duetoconcernsoverresidualradioactivity,butmaystillbeavailableto
specialorderforreplacementpurposes.
(b)
Highpurity(lowFe,Ni,Cu)versionsforimprovedcorrosionresistance
(c)
Rareearthelementsareintheformofdidymium(amixtureofrareearthelementsmadechieflyof
neodymiumandpraseodymium).
(d)
Rareearthsare2.0to2.5%and1.5to2.0%NdforWE43AandWE54A,respectively,withthe
remainderbeingheavyrareearths.
(e)
ElektronRZ5
(f)
F,forging;S,sheetandplate;E,extrudedbar,shape,tube,andwire.
(g)
ElektronZW3
(h)
Proprietaryalloy,MagnesiumElektron,rareearthsare3.0%Nd,1.5%Gd
(j)
Proprietaryalloy,DeadSeaMagnesium,compositionnotpublished
(k)
Proprietaryalloy,HydroMagnesium
(l)
Proprietaryalloy,NorandaMagnesium,typicalcomposition
(m)
Proprietaryalloy,NorandaMagnesium,licensedtoMagnesiumElektron
(n)
Developmentalloy,MagnesiumElektron,compositionnotpublished
Many magnesium alloys have also been registered with SAE International for an aerospace, AMS,
standard. Like many former defence standards these apply to specific temper conditions and forms
andaretooextensivetobeincludedinthishandbook.
European standards and specifications (EN) are being developed and adopted. These are
progressivelysupersedingthevariousNationalstandardsinmemberstates,Ref.[446].
Aerospace EN specification designations are controlled by AECMA and also apply to a particular
alloy,conditionsandforms,e.g.prEN2731MagnesiumalloyMGC46001T6Sandcasting
439
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
44.2.2
Mechanical properties
44.2.2.1
Table44.2.2givestypicalroomtemperaturemechanicalpropertiesforavarietyofmagnesiumalloys.
Recentalloysareincluded,Ref.[441],[447],[448].
[Seealso:Table44.1.1foralloydesignationsystem]
Table44.22Magnesiumalloys:Typicalmechanicalproperties,atroom
temperature
Alloy
Yieldstrength
Tensile
strength
Tensile
Compressive
MPa
MPa
MPa
Bearing
Elongation
in50mm
Shearstrength
MPa
MPa
145
Sandandpermanentmouldcastings
130
130
360
AZ63A-T6
275
AZ81A-T4
275
83
83
305
15
125
AZ91E-T6
AZ92A-T6
275
145
145
360
145
275
150
150
450
150
EQ21A-T6
235
195
195
152
EZ33A-T5
160
110
110
275
145
K1A-F
180
55
125
19
55
QE22A-T6
260
195
195
WE43B-T6
250
180
187
162
WE54A-T6
280
205
172
150
ZC63A-T6
210
125
ZE41A-T5
205
140
140
350
3.5
160
ZK51A-T5
205
165
165
325
3.5
160
Elektron 21T6
MRI-201S-T6
280
170
168
172
260
170
190
MRI-202S-T6
250
150
145
AM20
206
94
16
AM50A
220
120
113
6 - 10
AM60B
220
130
130
6-8
AS21
230
120
106
12
AS41
240
130
10
AE42
237
134
103
8 - 10
AZ91D
230
150
165
140
AE44
245
142
10
AJ52X
232
145
AJ62
227
138
Diecastings
74
440
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Yieldstrength
Alloy
Tensile
strength
Tensile
Compressive
Bearing
Elongation
in50mm
Shearstrength
AS31
MPa
216
MPa
130
MPa
-
MPa
-
%
8
MPa
-
MRI-153M
250
170
170
MRI-230D
235
180
180
AZ31B-H24
290
220
180
325
15
160
LA141A-T7
145
125
23
ZE10A-H24
234
152
ZM21-H14
250
165
5-8
AZ10A-F
240
145
10
AZ31B-F
AZ61A-F
260
200
97
230
15
130
310
230
130
285
16
140
AZ80A-T5
380
275
240
165
LA141A-T7
139
108
23
...
M1A-F
255
180
83
195
12
125
WE43B-T6
270
190
10
WE54A-T6
275
190
10
ZK31-F
305
225
200 - 250
145
ZK60A-T5
365
305
250
405
11
180
ZM21-F
230
150
Elektron 675
400
300
130 - 165
-
6
7
Sheetandplate
Extrudedbarsandshapes
69
-
(a)
Forgings
AZ61A-F
275
160
AZ80A-T5
WE43B-T6
290
280
200
180
WE54A-T6
295
195
ZK31-F
290
205
165 - 215
ZK60A-T5
365
305
250
405
11
180
Key:
(a)Developmentalloyprovisionaldata
441
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
44.2.2.2
Magnesiumalloysdonotundergoductilebrittletransitionandlowtemperatureductilityshowonly
smallfallscomparedwithroomtemperaturevalues.Someexamplesoftensilepropertiesat196C are
given in Table 44.2.3.
Table44.23Magnesiumalloys:Typicallowtemperaturetensilepropertiesat
196C
Alloy
Yieldstrength
Tensilestrength
Elongation
MPa
MPa
Castalloys
AZ91C-T6
180
310
1.7
AZ92A-T6
195
320
0.8
EZ33A-T5
154
QE22A-T6
233
359
2.4
ZE41A-T5
245
Elektron 21-T6
270
460
Wroughtalloys
ZK31-F
44.2.2.3
442
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table44.24Magnesiumalloys:Typicaltensilepropertiesatelevated
temperatures
Testtemperature
150C
Alloy
YS
(MPa)
200C
UTS
(MPa)
YS
(MPa)
250C
UTS
(MPa)
YS
(MPa)
300C
UTS
(MPa)
YS
(MPa)
UTS
(MPa)
55 (b)
55 (b)
AZ63A-T6
AZ92A-T6
EQ21A-T6
180
SandandPermanentMouldCastings
165
110 (a)
195
115
(a)
211
191
152
169
170
EZ33A-T5
85
140
75
130
70
110
55
85
QE22A-T6
208
260
170
215
80 (b)
185
145
WE43B-T6
245
115
155
WE54A-T6
195
255
183
241
175
230
140
180
ZE41A-T5
120
170
100
135
80
110
55
85
MRI-201S
170
245
MRI-202S
145
220
Elektron 21T6
165
255
160
240
145
185
95
155
132 (b)
Diecastings
AE42
AS21
75
130
AS41
85
152
AZ91D
110
159
AJ62
MRI-153M
135
190
MRI-230D
150
205
AZ80A-T5
235
WE43B-T6
185
Extrusions
170
235
130
210
69 (b)
175
240
165
230
WE54A-T6
185
245
250
ZK31-F
100
150
50
125
15
100
ZK60A-T5
180
41 (b)
Elektron
675
290
380
95
150
60
Sheet
105
40
65
48 (b)
AZ31B-H24
Key:
(a)Testedat205C;(b)Testedat315C
Magnesium alloys generally show a rapid fall off in strength above 150C and much of the
development work has centred on improving this situation. The sand casting alloys based on rare
earthadditions,e.g.WE43andWE54,havelargelyovercometheproblemswithearlieralloysandthe
newer alloy, Elektron 21, shows good promise as a lower cost alloy with good corrosion resistance.
443
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
WE54showsalossofductilityafter>5000hoursatelevatedtemperaturesandwherethismightbea
problemalloyWE43ispreferred.
ForextrudedproductstheWEalloysalsoshowthebestperformanceamongsttheestablishedalloys
but recent work by Magnesium Elektron has resulted in a new alloy, Elektron 675, with high
temperature strength exceeding that of many aluminium alloys. Preliminary data for this alloy is
provided,[See:Table44.2.4].
The WE alloys and Elektron 21 also show the best longer term creep properties, as shown in Table
44.2.5
Thenewerdiecastingalloyshavebeendevelopedforimprovedelevatedtemperaturepropertiesand
although the short term tensile properties are not much different from AZ91 they show improved
longertermcreepresistance.
Table44.25Magnesiumalloys:Typicalelevatedtemperaturecreepproperties
TestTemperature
Alloy
150C
200C
250C
Stress(MPa)toproduce0.2%strainin1000hours
SandandPermanentMouldCastings
EQ21A-T6
134
52
19
EZ33A-T5
57
20
WE43B-T6
110
37
WE54A-T6
170
35
ZE41A-T5
80
15.5
Extrusions
ZK31-F
17
Sheet
AZ31B-H24
17
Stress(MPa)toproduce0.1%strainin100hours
SandandPermanentMouldCastings
AZ92A-T6
12
WE43B-T6
150
ZE41A-T5
40
Elektron 21-T6
100
Diecastings
AE42
65
40
20
AS21
38
30
AS41
15
15
AZ91D
20
444
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
44.2.2.4
Fatiguedataformagnesiumalloyshas,formanyyears,beenlimited,Ref.[447].Thishasbecomea
requirement for their application in automotive and aerospace sectors. However, magnesium alloys
aresimilartootheralloysinthatfatiguestrengthdependsontensilestrength,Ref.[4411].Theratiois
not so well defined as for some other metals since whilst solidsolution strengthening increases the
fatigue strength of magnesium alloys, cold working and precipitation strengthening produce little
improvementinfatiguestrengthatlongerlives.
When compared with data for A357 aluminium alloy, SN curves for AZ91E and WE43 show that
although A357 performs well at low cycles the situation changes so that WE43 has the better
propertiesathighcycles.Thelowerstrengthalloy,AZ91E,haslowerpropertiesatlowcyclesbutat
highcyclesthedifferencecomparedwithWE43islessmarked,Ref.[4411].
RoomtemperaturefatiguestrengthsofsomemagnesiumalloysaregiveninTable44.2.6togetherwith
fracturetoughnessKIcvalues.
Table44.26Magnesiumalloys:Typicalfatigueandfracturetoughnessproperties
atroomtemperature
Alloy
Fatiguestrength(a)
Fracturetoughness,K1C
MPa
MPam
SandandPermanentMouldCastings
AZ91E-T6
70
13.2
AZ81A-T4
70
EQ21A-T6
100 - 110
16.4
EZ33A-T5
60
WE43B-T6
80
15.9
WE54A-T6
97
14.3
ZE41A-T5
100
15.1 - 16.3
Elektron 21-T6
15
Diecastings
AZ91D
70
AM50A
70
AM60B
70
Extrusions
ZK31A-F
122
45.6
WE54A-T5
145
15 - 17
200 (b)
Sheet
AZ31B-H24
Key:
100 (c)
(a)
510 cycles,rotatingbendtest
(b)
5107cycles,pullpulltest,R=0.1(ASTME466)
(c)
5107cycles,cantileverbendtest
(d)
Developmentalloy,provisionaldata
28
445
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Inadditiontoalloymanufacturersfatiguedata,astudyconsideredthefatigueperformanceofseveral
recentalloys(AM50,AM60,AE42,WE43andRZ5),Ref.[447]:
Stress-lifefunctions(stressamplitudeversusfatiguelife)forroundandflatspecimensofWE43
andRZ5alloys.
44.2.2.5
Damping capacity
Magnesiumalloysingeneralshowhigherdampingcapacitythanmostcommonstructuralmetals.
InparticularmagnesiumalloyK1AshowsaspecificdampingcapacityaroundtwicethatoftheCu
Mndampingalloysandsixtimesbetterthangreycastiron,showninTable44.2.7.
MagnesiumK1Athereforefindsaerospaceapplicationswherevibrationdampingisimportant.
Table44.27Magnesiumalloys:Dampingcapacityofselectedalloys
andothermetals
Alloy
Specificdampingcapacityat10%ofyield
stress
Castalloys
K1A
60
AZ91E
0.2
AZ80A-T4
0.02
EQ21A-T6
0.22
EZ33A-T5
4.5
WE43B-T6
0.09
WE54A-T6
0.17
ZE41A-T5
1
Othermetals
1100 aluminium
0.3
0.25
Other Al alloys
<0.2
10
20 - 40
44.3
44.3.1
Discontinuousreinforcementsformagnesiumalloysaregroupedas:
446
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
44.3.2
Theadditionofparticulatestoabasemagnesiumalloy:
Increasestheinitialtensilemodulus,
Increasesyieldandtensilestrengths,providedmodestadditionsofparticlesaremade.
Reduceselongation,fortheoptimisedcompositeswith12to15volumepercentageparticles.
Reduction of CTE, from 26 106 /C to 20 106 /C, for a 20% addition of silicon carbide
particles.
44.3.3
Processing
44.3.3.1
General
In the USA,atomised ZK60A alloy inpowder form has been consolidated with both SiC and boron
carbideparticles.
MagnesiumElektron(UK),preferthecheapermeltstirringroutetocreatethecompositeusingZC63
andAZ91castingalloysorvariantsonZC71wroughtalloy,Ref.[4417].
Shortfibreandwhiskerreinforcedcompositesareusuallypreparedbymeltinfiltrationofpreformsby
squeezecastingorpressurediecastingtechniques,Ref.[4414].
44.3.3.2
ManytypesofceramicwhiskersandpolycrystallinefibreshavebeenevaluatedbytheWorldHealth
Organisations International Agency for Research on Cancer (Monograph 43, 1988) as possibly
carcinogenic to humans, and are subject to occupational health and safety risk control measures in
somejurisdictions.
Exposuretorespirabledustscontainingthesematerialsshouldbeavoided.Suchdustsarenotlikelyto
bereleasedfromMMCsintheirnormalhandlinganduse,butcontrolmeasuresneedtobetakenifthe
materialsaremachined,cutorsubjecttoabrasion.
RefertomanufacturersandsuppliersSafetyDataSheetsforfurtherhealthandsafetyinformation.
44.3.4
Properties
RepresentativepropertiesoftheSiCreinforcedAZ61alloycompositearegiveninTable44.3.1.
Table44.31SiCparticulatereinforcedAZ61magnesiumalloy:Typical
mechanicalproperties
Material
AZ61
AZ61 + 2%SiC
AZ61 + 5%SiC
Modulus
0.2%PS
UTS
Elongation
(GPa)
(MPa)
(MPa)
(%)
44
60
66
190
242
261
290
310
321
18
2.0
1.2
447
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
For highstrength, highrigidity applications, Magnesium Elektron MELRAM 072 contains 12%SiC
(10mmeanparticlesize)usingamatrixbasedontheZC71alloy.
Toimprovetheextrudabilityandroomtempertatureductility,thematrixcompositionwasmodified
to Mg4.5%Zn0.5%Mn, and the extruded product given a cold drawing operation, which also
improveddimensionalaccuracy.ThismaterialwasrenamedMELRAM072TS.
TypicalmechanicalpropertiesforbothvariantsareshowninTable44.3.2,Ref.[446].
Table44.32SiCparticulatereinforcedmagnesiumalloy:Typicalmechanical
properties
Material(1)
MELRAM 072
ZC71 + 12%SiC
MELRAM 072TS
Mg-4.5%Zn-0.5%Mn +
12%SiC
Key(1):
Modulus
YS
UTS
Elongation
(GPa)
(MPa)
(MPa)
(%)
63
370
398
1.5
63
311
344
MELRAMMagnesiumElektron,developmentMMC(1998).
44.4
44.4.1
Types of composite
Thetypesofcontinuousreinforcementconsideredformagnesiumalloysare:
carbonfibre,
siliconcarbidefibre.
Workhascentredoncontinuouscarbonfibrereinforcedmagnesiumalloys.
Table44.4.1showsexamplesofMMCs,Ref.[442],[443],[444],[445],[4416],[4418].
Table44.41ContinuousfibrereinforcedmagnesiumMMCmaterials:Examples
Fibre
Matrix
Comments
Carbonfibre
T300
Mg-1Al
M40
K63B12
Mg 99.85
AZ31
P55
AZ91C
P100
AZ31B
AZ61A
Squeeze cast.
Susceptible to galvanic corrosion.
Gas pressure infiltration
Gas pressure infiltration
Design for near zero CTE.
Laser absorptivity tests.
Siliconcarbide
SCS-2
ZE41
Cast rod.
448
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
44.4.2
Features
CarbonfibrereinforcedmagnesiumMMCsoffer:
Consequentlytheyhavebeenconsideredashavingpotentialusesinaerospaceapplications,Ref.[44
2],[4416],[4418].
44.4.3
Processing
The starting point for all continuous fibrereinforced magnesium composites is a fibre preform. The
mostpopularproductionmethodisfilamentwindingalthoughweaving,knittingandvariantsthereof
arealsoemployed.Tosomeextentthechosenmethoddependsonthetypeofcarbonfibreused.
The magnesium matrix is incorporated by molten metal techniques which depend upon the chosen
typeofpreform.Thus,topreventdamagetofilamentwoundpreformstheseareusuallygaspressure
infiltratedwhilstwovenorknittedpreformsareusuallymorerobustandsqueezecastingorpressure
diecastingtechniquesmayalsobeemployed.
In carbonMg MMCs the properties are dictated primarily by the reinforcement, the matrix serving
mainly to hold the fibres together. The important factors are therefore the nature of the bonding
betweenfibreandmatrixandtheavoidanceofanydegradationoffibrepropertiestointeractionwith
the matrix. These are therefore prime factors in the selection of the matrix alloy although prior
treatmentsmayalsobeappliedtothefibresurfaces.
44.4.4
Properties
Table44.4.2givesgeneralmechanicalpropertydataonmagnesiumMMCmaterials,Ref.[441],[443],
[444],[4418].
Themaininterestincarbonfibrereinforcedmagnesiumcompositesforspaceapplicationsappearsto
be in materials with low CTE coefficient of thermal expansion, together with high thermal
conductivity.
Published information is sparse, but data from USbased work indicates CTE of 1.67ppm/K with
conductivityof180W/mKcomparedwith0.5ppm/Kand1.5W/mkforfusedsilicaand26ppm/Kand
122W/mKforpuremagnesium,Ref.[4416].
449
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table44.42MagnesiumcontinuousreinforcedMMCs:Typicalmechanical
properties
Composite
Fibre
vol.
(%)
P55/AZ91C+AZ31B faces
P55/AZ91C+AZ31B faces
P100/AZ91C+AZ31B faces
12.7
23.3
28.4
P100/AZ91C+AZ61A faces
37.0
T300/MgAl1
45
M40/Mg
65
SCS-2/ZE41
34
46
50
37
Typicalproperties
UTS
(MPa)
E
(GPa)
Carbonfibre
367
85.5
543
135
574
237
489
290
284
258
Failure
strain(%)
Comments
0.29
0.48
0.42
-
Single ply
Three ply
Single ply
RT/Tensile
RT/Compressive
149C/Compressi
ve
260C/Compressi
ve
Longitudinal
Transverse
-
294
247
214
263
440
150
1500
105
30
235
Siliconcarbide
1000
169.6
1524
209.6
1331
230.3
1379
180.6
0.83
0.88
0.78
0.95
675C/5 mins
675C/10 mins
44.4.5
Environmental resistance
44.4.5.1
Galvanic corrosion
Magnesium MMCs suffer from one severe problem in that they are highly susceptible to galvanic
corrosion;thisisduetothepotentialdifferencebetweenfibreandmatrix.
A study on the corrosion of T300 carbon fibres in Mg1Al alloy showed corrosion occurred in a
laboratoryenvironmentandcorrosivepenetrationwasintheorderof100mperyear,Ref.[442].
Further studies have shown, however, that both the selection of matrix alloy and fibre coating
techniquescanreducedetrimentalcorrosioneffects.
Galvanic corrosion can be controlled by proper and adequate protection methods, such as painting.
Such protection methods rely on being intact and not disrupted during the entire manufacturing,
assembly,storageandservicelifeofthefinisheditem,Ref.[4419].
Whilstthemechanicalandthermalexpansionofthesematerialsshowspromiseforspaceapplications,
considerableeffortisneededtoreducethecorrosionaspectsandproductioncosts.
[Seealso:ECSSQ7071]
450
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
44.5
Potential applications
44.5.1
Alloys
Theverylowdensityofmagnesiumisanobviousattraction,andalthoughthestiffnessandstrengths
ofthealloysaremodest,thesearegoodwhenconsideredonaspecificbasisi.e.strengthtoweight
ratio.SatelliteapplicationshaveusedAZ31,AZ61(AZM),AZ80andZK60alloys.
A MgLi development alloy, Ref. [4412], has a very low specific gravity of 1.35, although it never
reachedcommercialstatusandisnowobsolete.However,workcontinuesonotherMgLialloysand
compositesbaseduponthem,Ref.[4413],[4414].
[Seealso:ECSSQ7071]
Conventional alloy developments have increased properties at elevated temperatures, e.g. RZ5
(ZE41A)to130C;WE43andWE54to300C(shortterm)and250C(longterm)andtheneweralloy
Elektron 21 shows excellent promise. These alloys are finding uses in applications such as
transmissioncasingsformilitary,civilaircraftandhelicopters,Ref.[448].
Magnesium Elektron have recently announced the development of a new extruded alloy, Elektron
675,whichisclaimedtohavegreaterstrengthattemperaturesabove100Cthanwrought2000series
and 7000series aluminium alloys. At 200C, yield strength is 290MPa, and the ultimate tensile
strengthis380MPa.Thisisover100%strongerthan2024aluminium,andmorethan200%stronger
than7075.
44.5.2
Composites
Improvementsinstiffnesscanbeachievedbytheadditionoffibresandparticlestogivecomposites.
Specialised components can be made in continuous fibre composites, mostly with carbon fibre for
dimensionalstability.However,forlonglifestructures,thecorrosioncharacteristicsofmagnesium
based composites causes concern and the economics of production of these materials has mitigated
againsttheirdevelopmentandwideravailability.
The field of metalmatrix composites is still relatively new and rapidly developing. To assist the
engineerinupdatinginformationontechnologyandpotentialsuppliersaThematicNetworkentitled
MMCAssesshasbeenestablishedwithE.C.fundingandisadministeredbytheUniversityofVienna.
Itprovidesengineerswiththestatusofthesematerials.
44.5.3
Space
44.5.3.1
General
Magnesiumalloysaremostlikelytobeusedintheformofmachinedcastings,forgingsorextruded
rod or bar. However, as in the case of aluminium alloy aerospace components, there is a growing
trendtouseextrudedbilletforforgingstockorforprecisionmachiningforlongercomponents.
Given the mandatory limitations imposed on the use of magnesium materials in space, possible
applicationsremain:
Dimensionallystabletubesandstruts.
Endfittingsandconnectionsforlatticestructures.
Mirrorsubstrates.
451
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
44.5.3.2
Satellite
Figure44.5.1showsamagnesiumalloymomentumwheelbracketforasatellite.Thisitemis250mm
150 mm 80 mm and was machined from ZK60A-T5 extruded bar and treated with ALGAN 2 plus
OXSILANMG0611,Ref.[4422].
Thisitemis250mm 150 mm 80 mm and was machined from ZK60A-T5 extruded bar and treated with
ALGAN2plusOXSILANMG0611,Ref.[4422].
Figure44.51Magnesiumalloys:Momentumwheelbracketforsatellite
Example
44.5.3.3
Mirrors
Magnesiumbased composites are under consideration for light weight mirrors. MetGraf Mg is a
tradenameofMMCC(USA)
Figure 44.5.2 shows an example of a carbonreinforced magnesium alloy lattice structure used to
supportsiliconbasedreflectors,Ref.[4416].
452
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Attachment of Si and SiC membranes to
Lightweighted MetGraf Mg substrates with pre and post polishing options
Figure44.52Carbonfibrereinforcedmagnesiumalloy:Spacemirrors
(experimental)Example
44.6
References
44.6.1
General
[441]
PropertiesandSelection:NonferrousAlloysandSpecialPurpose
Materials
ASMHandbook,10thEdition,Volume2
ASMInternational.ISBN0871703785(V.2)
[442]
B.J.Macleanetal
ThermalMechanicalBehaviourofGraphite/MagnesiumComposite
MartinMariettaAerospaceProceedingsofSymposiumonMechanical
BehaviourofMetalMatrixComposites
Dallas,Texas.February16thto18th,1982
[443]
I.W.Hall
CorrosionofCarbon/MagnesiumMetalMatrixComposites
UniversityofDelawareScriptaMetallurgica.Vol.21,1987
[444]
D.J.Changetal
CompressivePropertiesandLaserAbsorptivityofUnidirectionalMetal
MatrixComposites
TheAerospaceCorporationReportNo.SDTR8681
30thSeptember1986
[445]
EngineeredMaterialsHandbook.Volume1.COMPOSITES
ASMInternational,MetalsPark,Ohio
453
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
ISBN0871702797(v.1)
[446]
B.Hussey&J.Wilson:RJTechnicalConsultants,UK
LightAlloysDirectory&Databook
Chapman&Hall(1998).ISBN0412804107
[447]
HJ.Ertelt:ISDInstituteforStatics&Dynamics,D
SomeFatiguePropertiesofMagnesiumAlloys
ProceedingsofESAEuropeanConferenceonSpacecraftStructures,
Materials&MechanicalTesting,Braunschweig,D.46November,1998.
ESASP428,p263268
[448]
ExtractfromMagnesiumElektronwebsite:www.magnesium
elektron.com(April2003).
[449]
DataSheet256,SurfaceTreatmentsforMagnesiumAlloysinAerospace
&Defence
MagnesiumElektron,1997:www.magnesiumelektron.com
[4410]
DataSheet254,MachiningMagnesiumAlloys
MagnesiumElektron,2000:www.magnesiumelektron.com
[4411]
FatigueandFracture
ASMHandbook,volume19
ASMInternational.ISBN0871703858
[4412]
NASASP5028,
TechnicalandEconomicStatusofMagnesiumLithiumAlloys,PaulD.
Frost,August1965
http://ntrs.nasa.gov/archive/nasa/casi.ntrs.nasa.gov/19650020351_1965020
351.pdf
[4413]
F.W.Bachet.al.
SFB390PrjectA4:DensityReducedMagnesiumAlloyswithIncreased
Ductility
UniversityofHanover,Germany
http://www.iw.unihannover.de/sfb/sfb390/englisch/index_e.html
[4414]
S.Kudela
Magnesiumlithiummatrixcompositesanoverview
Int.J.ofMaterials&ProductTechnology,Vol.18,Nos1/2/3,2003,p91
115
[4415]
A.A.Luo
Recentmagnesiumalloydevelopmentsforelevatedtemperature
applications
InternationalMaterialsReviews,2004,Vol.49,No1,p1330
[4416]
J.A.Cornie,L.Ballard,E.Chen&S.Zhang
Developmentofgraphitefiberreinforcedmagnesiumalloysfor
lightweightmirrorsubstratesandzeroCTEmeteringstructures
454
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
NationalSpace&MissileMaterialsSymposium:Seattle,2125June2004
LINK
44.6.2
[4417]
J.F.King,T.E.Wilks&G.D.Wardlow
PropertiesandapplicationsofmagnesiumMMCmaterials
IMA53,conf.Proc.,Ube,Japan,1996,p7782
[4418]
A.Schoberth
Overviewoncontinuousfibrereinforcedlightmetals
MMCVIII,MetallicComposites&Foams,26/27.11.2001,TheInstituteof
Materials,London
http://mmcassess.tuwien.ac.at/public/cont_fibers.pdf
[4419]
A.Schoberth
ContinuouscarbonfiberreinforcedMgalloys
paperinmmcdatasectionofMMCAssesswebsite
http://mmcassess.tuwien.ac.at/index1.htm
[4420]
ASTMB27504:StandardPracticeforCodificationofCertainNonferrous
MetalsandAlloys,CastandWrought
ASTMInternational,100BarrHarborDrive,POBoxC700,West
Conshohocken,PA194282959,USA
[4421]
ASTME52783(Reapproved2003):StandardPracticeforNumbering
MetalsandAlloys(UNS)
ASTMInternational,100BarrHarborDrive,POBoxC700,West
Conshohocken,PA194282959,USA
[4422]
AMTS(Israel)privatecommunication(2005)
Sources
Alubin:www.alubin.com
AMTS,WroughtProductDivision:www.magnesiumtechnologies.com
DeadSeaMagnesium:www.dsmag.co.il
HydroMagnesium:www.hydromagnesium.com
MagnesiumElektron:www.magnesiumelektron.com
OttoFuchs:www.ottofuchs.com
Timminco:www.timminco.com
44.6.3
Organisations
InternationalMagnesiumAssociation:www.intlmag.org
IsraeliConsortiumfortheDevelopmentofMagnesium:www.dmtc.org.il
MMCAssess:mmcassess.tuwien.ac.at
455
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
44.6.4
ECSS standards
[See:ECSSwebsite]
ECSSQ7071
ECSSQST7036
ECSSQST7037
44.6.5
Datafortheselectionofspacematerialsand
processes;previouslyESAPSS01701
Materialselectionforcontrollingstress
corrosioncracking;previouslyESAPSS01
736
Determinationofthesusceptibilityofmetals
tostresscorrosioncracking;previouslyESA
PSS01737
ASTM standards
[See:ASTMwebsite]
ASTMB27504
ASTME52783
StandardPracticeforCodificationofCertain
NonferrousMetalsandAlloys,CastandWrought
StandardPracticeforNumberingMetalsand
Alloys(UNS).Reapproved2003
456
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
45
Copper alloys and their composites
45.1
Introduction
Copper alloys are not considered for structural applications, unless the application has exacting
electricalorthermalconductivityrequirements.
Themechanicalpropertiesofthealloyscanbeimprovedbyusingreinforcement,buttheconductivity
oftensuffersasaresult.
Some copper alloys exhibit a shape memory effect. These alloys, sometimes known as smart
materials,canbeusedasactuators,[See:91.5].
45.2
Copper alloys
45.2.1
Precipitation hardening
Therangeofcopperalloysislarge,Ref.[451].Thosealloyswhichareofpreliminaryinterestinclude
the precipitationhardened systems which have enhanced strengths without loss of conductivity.
Thesealloysinclude:
CuBe,
CuAg,
CuZr,
CuCr.
AnexampleisNarloyZ.
These alloys form the baseline for many industrial applications, but can be considered as lacking in
certainareasofpropertyoptimisation;mostnotablyhightemperaturecreepresistance(~500C)and
dimensional stability. This has initiated some reinforced copper and composite developments
appropriatetospaceapplications.
457
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
45.3
45.3.1
Addingveryfinedispersionsofalumina(Al2O3)andtitaniumdiboride(TiB2),inlowconcentrations,
hasachievedsignificantimprovementsinselectedpropertiesoverprecipitationhardenedsystems.
CopperODSalloysarepreparedbyapowderroute.
45.3.2
Properties
Whilstmaintaininggoodconductivity,thehardness,wearresistanceandcreepresistancehavebeen
improved. This is most noticeable in the retention of strength to higher temperatures than the
conventionalalloys,asshowninFigure45.3.1.
Figure45.31CopperODSalloys:Elevatedtemperaturestressruptureproperties
ofGlidcopODSalloyscomparedwithsomehighconductivitycopperalloys
Table 45.3.1 gives the ambient temperature properties attainable by ODS alloys, whilst Table 45.3.2
andTable45.3.3providedataat538C.
458
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table45.31CopperODSalloys:Ambienttemperaturetensileproperties
Material/Temper
Modulus
(GPa)
[See:Key]
Proofstress
UTS(MPa)
0.2(MPa)
Straintofailure
(%)
Cl5710:Cu+0.2wt.%.Al203,
As fabricated
Cold worked 98.5% RA
105
106
270
540
325
565
20
-
470
615
19
3.5
485
585
16
10
15720:Cu+0.4wt.%.Al203,
As fabricated
Cold worked 98% RA
113
113
365
585
Cl5735:Cu+0.7wt.%.Al203,
As fabricated
Cold worked 56% RA
123
123
420
565
Cl5715,GlidcopAl15:Cu+0.3wt.%.Al203
As hipped
As extruded
Extruded + 98% cold
work
130
130
255
331
360
413
26
20
130
613
661
Cl5725,GlidcopAl25:Cu+0.5wt.%.Al203,
As hipped
As extruded
Extruded + 98% cold
work
130
130
295
345
410
4,34
18
21
130
613
675
GlidcopAl25:Cu+0.5wt.%.Al203,
As hipped
As extruded
130
130
413
655
517
737
13
6
SutekMXT5Cu+5vol.%TiB2
620
Key:
ASMMetalsHandbook,10thEdition,1990.
Manufacturersdata,SCMMetalProductsInc,USA.
Manufacturersdata,SutekCorp,USA.
675
459
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table45.32CopperODSalloys:Shorttermpropertiesat538C
Material
C15715,GlidCop Al-15:
Cu-0.3 wt.%Al2O3
C15725,GlidCop Al-25:
Cu-0.5 wt.%Al2O3
Sutek MXT-5A:
Cu-5 vol.% TiB2
Key:
Temper
YS0.2
UTS
(MPa)
(MPa)
(%)
As HIP
85
85
As HIP
105
120
Unknow
n
145
145
Manufacturersdata:SCMMetalProductsInc.,USA.
Manufacturersdata:SutekCorporation,USA.
HIP:Hotisostaticpressing
Table45.33CopperODSalloys:Creepstrengthat538C
Material(Tempernotstated)
100hrCreeprupturestrength(MPa)
190
260
45.4
45.4.1
General
Thereisvirtuallynopublishedinformationontheuseofparticleordiscontinuousfibrestoreinforce
copper.
45.4.2
Problems
Indicationsarethat:
Additions of inorganic, insulative phases such as SiC, Al2O3 and B4C noticeably reduce
conductivitycharacteristics.
Additionofparticlestoprecipitationhardenedsystemsislikelytoaffectthemicrostructureof
thematrixalloy.
Theadditionofparticlestopurecopperdoesnotgivesubstantialimprovementsinstrengthto
matchprecipitationhardenedorODSalloys.
Problemsariseinobtainingsatisfactorybondingbetweenparticleandmatrix,Ref.[452].
460
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
45.5
45.5.1
General
ThesematerialshavebeenstudiedintheUSAtoprovidesupportforthespaceprogrammes.
45.5.2
45.5.2.1
Carbon fibre
Interesthascentredoncarbonfibre(graphite)reinforcedmaterialsusingpitchfibres(AmocoP100).
Thepitchfibrescontributeto:
Thermal conductivity: The pitch fibres increase the conductivity beyond that possible with
copperalone.
Verylowcoefficientofthermalexpansion,albeitanisotropic.
45.5.2.2
Tungsten filaments
Compositeswith10%tungstenfilamentshavebeenproposedforcombustionlinerswhere:
This suggests opportunities for the copper wall thickness to be reduced to increase its heat transfer
coefficientwithoutsacrificingstrength.
45.5.3
Properties
45.5.3.1
General
Detailedinformationonmaterialsisawaited.
45.5.3.2
Thermal characteristics
Table 45.5.1 presents the thermal characteristics of fibrereinforced copper compared with carbon
fibre/aluminiumcomposites.
461
ECSSEHB3220Part4A
20March2011
Table45.51Continuousfibrereinforcedcopper:Thermalconductivityof
carbon/Cuandcarbon/Alcomposites
Thermalconductivity
CTE
(W/mK)
(ppm/C)
Material
Pure Copper
P100/Copper (UD)
P100/Copper
(0/90)s
P100/6063 Al (UD)
P100/6063 Al
(0/90)s
Key:
Long.
398
454
305
Trans.
398
140
305
Long.
16.5
2.0
5.76
Trans.
16.5
11.7
5.76
339
216
94
216
1.62
5.04
26.6
5.04
Propertiesgivenforcomparativepurposes.
Nominally40%carbonfibre.
Density
(kg/m3)
8960
5600
5700
2450
2470
45.6
Potential applications
Copper is not considered a structural material because its density is too high with respect to its
strengthandstiffness.Itsattributesmainlyrelatetoitsexcellentelectricalandthermalconductivity.
For practical systems using these conductivity characteristics there is a need to improve the
mechanical properties, notably wear resistance and hightemperature stability. Unfortunately most
methodsofachievingthistendtoimpairtheconductivity.
Twomaterialswithpossibleusesinspaceareoxidedispersionstrengthened(ODS)alloysandcarbon
(pitch)fibrereinforcedcopper.
Potentialapplicationsinclude:
Rocketenginecombustionliners.
Heatexchangersandradiators.
Spacepowersystems.
45.7
References
45.7.1
General
[451]
MetalsHandbook,Volume2,TenthEdition
PropertiesandSelection:NonferrousAlloysandSpecialPurpose
Materials
ASMInternational,ISBN0871703785(v.2),1990
[452]
J.F.Mason
ThedevelopmentofHighConductivity/ThermallyStableCopperbased
Composites
WorkOrderNo.17.BNFFulmerReportR1176/10/1
November1990forESTECContract7090/87/NL/PP
462